gdb: Look for compilation directory relative to directory search path
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 Initial support for the FreeBSD/riscv target and native configuration
550 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
551 Computer Laboratory (Department of Computer Science and Technology)
552 under DARPA contract HR0011-18-C-0016 ("ECATS"), as part of the DARPA
553 SSITH research programme.
554
555 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
556 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
557 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
558 Stafford Horne.
559
560 @node Sample Session
561 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
562
563 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
564 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
565 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
566
567 @iftex
568 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
569 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
570 @end iftex
571
572 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
573 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
574
575 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
576 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
577 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
578 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
579 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
580 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
581 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
582 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
583 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
584
585 @smallexample
586 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
587 $ @b{./m4}
588 @b{define(foo,0000)}
589
590 @b{foo}
591 0000
592 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
593
594 @b{bar}
595 0000
596 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
597
598 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
599 @b{baz}
600 @b{Ctrl-d}
601 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
606
607 @smallexample
608 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
609 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
610 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
611 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
612 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
613 the conditions.
614 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
615 for details.
616
617 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
618 (@value{GDBP})
619 @end smallexample
620
621 @noindent
622 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
623 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
624 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
625 that examples fit in this manual.
626
627 @smallexample
628 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
629 @end smallexample
630
631 @noindent
632 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
633 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
634 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
635 @code{break} command.
636
637 @smallexample
638 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
639 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
640 @end smallexample
641
642 @noindent
643 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
644 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
645 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
646
647 @smallexample
648 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
649 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
650 @b{define(foo,0000)}
651
652 @b{foo}
653 0000
654 @end smallexample
655
656 @noindent
657 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
658 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
659 context where it stops.
660
661 @smallexample
662 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
663
664 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
665 at builtin.c:879
666 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
667 @end smallexample
668
669 @noindent
670 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
671 the next line of the current function.
672
673 @smallexample
674 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
676 : nil,
677 @end smallexample
678
679 @noindent
680 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
681 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
682 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
683 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
684
685 @smallexample
686 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
687 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
688 at input.c:530
689 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
690 @end smallexample
691
692 @noindent
693 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
694 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
695 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
696 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
697 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
698 stack frame for each active subroutine.
699
700 @smallexample
701 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
702 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
703 at input.c:530
704 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
705 at builtin.c:882
706 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
707 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
708 at macro.c:71
709 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
710 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
711 @end smallexample
712
713 @noindent
714 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
715 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
716 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
717
718 @smallexample
719 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
720 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
722 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
723 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
724 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
725 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
726 : xstrdup(rq);
727 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
728 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
729 @end smallexample
730
731 @noindent
732 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
733 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
734 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
735 (@code{print}) to see their values.
736
737 @smallexample
738 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
739 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
740 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
741 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
742 @end smallexample
743
744 @noindent
745 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
746 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
747 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
748
749 @smallexample
750 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
751 533 xfree(rquote);
752 534
753 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
754 : xstrdup (lq);
755 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
756 : xstrdup (rq);
757 537
758 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
759 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
760 540 @}
761 541
762 542 void
763 @end smallexample
764
765 @noindent
766 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
767 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
768
769 @smallexample
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
771 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
773 540 @}
774 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
775 $3 = 9
776 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
777 $4 = 7
778 @end smallexample
779
780 @noindent
781 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
782 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
783 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
784 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
785 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
786 assignments.
787
788 @smallexample
789 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
790 $5 = 7
791 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
792 $6 = 9
793 @end smallexample
794
795 @noindent
796 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
797 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
798 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
799 example that caused trouble initially:
800
801 @smallexample
802 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
803 Continuing.
804
805 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
806
807 baz
808 0000
809 @end smallexample
810
811 @noindent
812 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
813 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
814 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
815
816 @smallexample
817 @b{Ctrl-d}
818 Program exited normally.
819 @end smallexample
820
821 @noindent
822 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
823 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
824 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
825
826 @smallexample
827 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
828 @end smallexample
829
830 @node Invocation
831 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
832
833 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
834 The essentials are:
835 @itemize @bullet
836 @item
837 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
838 @item
839 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
840 @end itemize
841
842 @menu
843 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
844 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
845 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
846 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
847 @end menu
848
849 @node Invoking GDB
850 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
851
852 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
853 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
854
855 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
856 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
857
858 The command-line options described here are designed
859 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
860 options may effectively be unavailable.
861
862 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
863 specifying an executable program:
864
865 @smallexample
866 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
867 @end smallexample
868
869 @noindent
870 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
871 specified:
872
873 @smallexample
874 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
875 @end smallexample
876
877 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument or use option
878 @code{-p}, if you want to debug a running process:
879
880 @smallexample
881 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
882 @value{GDBP} -p 1234
883 @end smallexample
884
885 @noindent
886 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234}. With option @option{-p} you
887 can omit the @var{program} filename.
888
889 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
890 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
891 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
892 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
893 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
894
895 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
896 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
897 option processing.
898 @smallexample
899 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
900 @end smallexample
901 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
902 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
903
904 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
905 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
906 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
907
908 @smallexample
909 @value{GDBP} --silent
910 @end smallexample
911
912 @noindent
913 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
914 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
915
916 @noindent
917 Type
918
919 @smallexample
920 @value{GDBP} -help
921 @end smallexample
922
923 @noindent
924 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
925 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
926
927 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
928 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
929 @samp{-x} option is used.
930
931
932 @menu
933 * File Options:: Choosing files
934 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
935 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
936 @end menu
937
938 @node File Options
939 @subsection Choosing Files
940
941 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
942 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
943 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
944 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
945 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
946 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
947 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
948 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
949 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
950 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
951 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
952 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
953 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
954
955 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
956 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
957 argument and ignore it.
958
959 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
960 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
961 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
962 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
963 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
964
965 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
966 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
967 @c it.
968
969 @table @code
970 @item -symbols @var{file}
971 @itemx -s @var{file}
972 @cindex @code{--symbols}
973 @cindex @code{-s}
974 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
975
976 @item -exec @var{file}
977 @itemx -e @var{file}
978 @cindex @code{--exec}
979 @cindex @code{-e}
980 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
981 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
982
983 @item -se @var{file}
984 @cindex @code{--se}
985 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
986 file.
987
988 @item -core @var{file}
989 @itemx -c @var{file}
990 @cindex @code{--core}
991 @cindex @code{-c}
992 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
993
994 @item -pid @var{number}
995 @itemx -p @var{number}
996 @cindex @code{--pid}
997 @cindex @code{-p}
998 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
999
1000 @item -command @var{file}
1001 @itemx -x @var{file}
1002 @cindex @code{--command}
1003 @cindex @code{-x}
1004 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
1005 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
1006 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1007
1008 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1009 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1010 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1011 @cindex @code{-ex}
1012 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1013
1014 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1015 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1016
1017 @smallexample
1018 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1019 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1020 @end smallexample
1021
1022 @item -init-command @var{file}
1023 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1024 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1025 @cindex @code{-ix}
1026 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1027 after loading gdbinit files).
1028 @xref{Startup}.
1029
1030 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1031 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1032 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1033 @cindex @code{-iex}
1034 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1035 after loading gdbinit files).
1036 @xref{Startup}.
1037
1038 @item -directory @var{directory}
1039 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1040 @cindex @code{--directory}
1041 @cindex @code{-d}
1042 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1043
1044 @item -r
1045 @itemx -readnow
1046 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1047 @cindex @code{-r}
1048 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1049 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1050 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1051
1052 @item --readnever
1053 @anchor{--readnever}
1054 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1055 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1056 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1057 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1058 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1059 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1060 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1061 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1062 @end table
1063
1064 @node Mode Options
1065 @subsection Choosing Modes
1066
1067 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1068 batch mode or quiet mode.
1069
1070 @table @code
1071 @anchor{-nx}
1072 @item -nx
1073 @itemx -n
1074 @cindex @code{--nx}
1075 @cindex @code{-n}
1076 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1077 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1078
1079 @table @code
1080 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1081 This is the system-wide init file.
1082 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1083 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1084 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1085 have been processed.
1086 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1087 This is the init file in your home directory.
1088 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1089 command options have been processed.
1090 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1091 This is the init file in the current directory.
1092 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1093 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1094 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1095 @end table
1096
1097 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1098 For documentation on how to write command files,
1099 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1100
1101 @anchor{-nh}
1102 @item -nh
1103 @cindex @code{--nh}
1104 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1105 in your home directory.
1106 @xref{Startup}.
1107
1108 @item -quiet
1109 @itemx -silent
1110 @itemx -q
1111 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1112 @cindex @code{--silent}
1113 @cindex @code{-q}
1114 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1115 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1116
1117 @item -batch
1118 @cindex @code{--batch}
1119 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1120 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1121 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1122 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1123 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1124 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1125 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1126
1127 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1128 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1129 make this more useful, the message
1130
1131 @smallexample
1132 Program exited normally.
1133 @end smallexample
1134
1135 @noindent
1136 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1137 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1138 mode.
1139
1140 @item -batch-silent
1141 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1142 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1143 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1144 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1145 for an interactive session.
1146
1147 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1148 messages, for example.
1149
1150 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1151 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1152
1153 @item -return-child-result
1154 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1155 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1156 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1157
1158 @itemize @bullet
1159 @item
1160 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1161 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1162 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1163 @item
1164 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1165 @item
1166 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1167 the exit code will be -1.
1168 @end itemize
1169
1170 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1171 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1172 interface.
1173
1174 @item -nowindows
1175 @itemx -nw
1176 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1177 @cindex @code{-nw}
1178 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1179 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1180 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1181
1182 @item -windows
1183 @itemx -w
1184 @cindex @code{--windows}
1185 @cindex @code{-w}
1186 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1187 used if possible.
1188
1189 @item -cd @var{directory}
1190 @cindex @code{--cd}
1191 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1192 instead of the current directory.
1193
1194 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1195 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1196 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1197 @cindex @code{-D}
1198 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1199 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1200 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1201
1202 @item -fullname
1203 @itemx -f
1204 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1205 @cindex @code{-f}
1206 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1207 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1208 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1209 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1210 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1211 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1212 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1213 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1214 frame.
1215
1216 @item -annotate @var{level}
1217 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1218 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1219 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1220 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1221 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1222 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1223 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1224 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1225 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1226
1227 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1228 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1229
1230 @item --args
1231 @cindex @code{--args}
1232 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1233 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1234 This option stops option processing.
1235
1236 @item -baud @var{bps}
1237 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1238 @cindex @code{--baud}
1239 @cindex @code{-b}
1240 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1241 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1242
1243 @item -l @var{timeout}
1244 @cindex @code{-l}
1245 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1246 for remote debugging.
1247
1248 @item -tty @var{device}
1249 @itemx -t @var{device}
1250 @cindex @code{--tty}
1251 @cindex @code{-t}
1252 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1253 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1254
1255 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1256 @item -tui
1257 @cindex @code{--tui}
1258 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1259 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1260 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1261 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1262 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1263 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1264
1265 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1266 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1267 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1268 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1269 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1270 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1271
1272 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi3}) causes
1273 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} version 3 (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1274 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 9.1. @sc{gdb/mi}
1275 version 2 (@code{mi2}), included in @value{GDBN} 6.0 and version 1 (@code{mi1}),
1276 included in @value{GDBN} 5.3, are also available. Earlier @sc{gdb/mi}
1277 interfaces are no longer supported.
1278
1279 @item -write
1280 @cindex @code{--write}
1281 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1282 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1283 (@pxref{Patching}).
1284
1285 @item -statistics
1286 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1287 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1288 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1289
1290 @item -version
1291 @cindex @code{--version}
1292 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1293 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1294
1295 @item -configuration
1296 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1297 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1298 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1299 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1300
1301 @end table
1302
1303 @node Startup
1304 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1305 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1306
1307 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1308
1309 @enumerate
1310 @item
1311 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1312 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1313
1314 @item
1315 @cindex init file
1316 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1317 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1318 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1319 that file.
1320
1321 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1322 @item
1323 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1324 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1325 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1326 that file.
1327
1328 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1329 @item
1330 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1331 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1332 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1333 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1334 gets loaded.
1335
1336 @item
1337 Processes command line options and operands.
1338
1339 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1340 @item
1341 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1342 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1343 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1344 This is only done if the current directory is
1345 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1346 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1347 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1348 @value{GDBN}.
1349
1350 @item
1351 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1352 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1353 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1354 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1355
1356 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1357 you must do something like the following:
1358
1359 @smallexample
1360 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1361 @end smallexample
1362
1363 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1364 off too late.
1365
1366 @item
1367 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1368 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1369 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1370
1371 @item
1372 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1373 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1374 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1375 @end enumerate
1376
1377 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1378 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1379 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1380 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1381 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1382 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1383
1384 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1385 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1386
1387 @cindex init file name
1388 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1389 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1390 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1391 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1392 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1393 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1394 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1395 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1396
1397
1398 @node Quitting GDB
1399 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1400 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1401 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1402
1403 @table @code
1404 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1405 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1406 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1407 @itemx q
1408 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1409 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1410 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1411 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1412 error code.
1413 @end table
1414
1415 @cindex interrupt
1416 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1417 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1418 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1419 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1420 until a time when it is safe.
1421
1422 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1423 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1424 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1425
1426 @node Shell Commands
1427 @section Shell Commands
1428
1429 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1430 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1431 just use the @code{shell} command.
1432
1433 @table @code
1434 @kindex shell
1435 @kindex !
1436 @cindex shell escape
1437 @item shell @var{command-string}
1438 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1439 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1440 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1441 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1442 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1443 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1444 @end table
1445
1446 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1447 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1448 @value{GDBN}:
1449
1450 @table @code
1451 @kindex make
1452 @cindex calling make
1453 @item make @var{make-args}
1454 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1455 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1456 @end table
1457
1458 @table @code
1459 @kindex pipe
1460 @kindex |
1461 @cindex send the output of a gdb command to a shell command
1462 @anchor{pipe}
1463 @item pipe [@var{command}] | @var{shell_command}
1464 @itemx | [@var{command}] | @var{shell_command}
1465 @itemx pipe -d @var{delim} @var{command} @var{delim} @var{shell_command}
1466 @itemx | -d @var{delim} @var{command} @var{delim} @var{shell_command}
1467 Executes @var{command} and sends its output to @var{shell_command}.
1468 Note that no space is needed around @code{|}.
1469 If no @var{command} is provided, the last command executed is repeated.
1470
1471 In case the @var{command} contains a @code{|}, the option @code{-d @var{delim}}
1472 can be used to specify an alternate delimiter string @var{delim} that separates
1473 the @var{command} from the @var{shell_command}.
1474
1475 Example:
1476 @smallexample
1477 @group
1478 (gdb) p var
1479 $1 = @{
1480 black = 144,
1481 red = 233,
1482 green = 377,
1483 blue = 610,
1484 white = 987
1485 @}
1486 @end group
1487 @group
1488 (gdb) pipe p var|wc
1489 7 19 80
1490 (gdb) |p var|wc -l
1491 7
1492 @end group
1493 @group
1494 (gdb) p /x var
1495 $4 = @{
1496 black = 0x90,
1497 red = 0xe9,
1498 green = 0x179,
1499 blue = 0x262,
1500 white = 0x3db
1501 @}
1502 (gdb) ||grep red
1503 red => 0xe9,
1504 @end group
1505 @group
1506 (gdb) | -d ! echo this contains a | char\n ! sed -e 's/|/PIPE/'
1507 this contains a PIPE char
1508 (gdb) | -d xxx echo this contains a | char!\n xxx sed -e 's/|/PIPE/'
1509 this contains a PIPE char!
1510 (gdb)
1511 @end group
1512 @end smallexample
1513 @end table
1514
1515 The convenience variables @code{$_shell_exitcode} and @code{$_shell_exitsignal}
1516 can be used to examine the exit status of the last shell command launched
1517 by @code{shell}, @code{make}, @code{pipe} and @code{|}.
1518 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}.
1519
1520 @node Logging Output
1521 @section Logging Output
1522 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1523 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1524
1525 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1526 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1527
1528 @table @code
1529 @kindex set logging
1530 @item set logging on
1531 Enable logging.
1532 @item set logging off
1533 Disable logging.
1534 @cindex logging file name
1535 @item set logging file @var{file}
1536 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1537 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1538 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1539 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1540 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1541 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1542 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1543 @item set logging debugredirect [on|off]
1544 By default, @value{GDBN} debug output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1545 Set @code{debugredirect} if you want debug output to go only to the log file.
1546 @kindex show logging
1547 @item show logging
1548 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1549 @end table
1550
1551 You can also redirect the output of a @value{GDBN} command to a
1552 shell command. @xref{pipe}.
1553 @node Commands
1554 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1555
1556 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1557 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1558 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1559 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1560 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1561
1562 @menu
1563 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1564 * Command Settings:: How to change default behavior of commands
1565 * Completion:: Command completion
1566 * Command Options:: Command options
1567 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1568 @end menu
1569
1570 @node Command Syntax
1571 @section Command Syntax
1572
1573 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1574 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1575 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1576 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1577 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1578 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1579
1580 @cindex abbreviation
1581 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1582 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1583 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1584 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1585 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1586 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1587 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1588
1589 @cindex repeating commands
1590 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1591 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1592 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1593 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1594 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1595 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1596 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1597
1598 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1599 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1600 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1601
1602 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1603 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1604 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1605 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1606 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1607
1608 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1609 @cindex comment
1610 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1611 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1612 Files,,Command Files}).
1613
1614 @cindex repeating command sequences
1615 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1616 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1617 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1618 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1619 for editing.
1620
1621
1622 @node Command Settings
1623 @section Command Settings
1624 @cindex default behavior of commands, changing
1625 @cindex default settings, changing
1626
1627 Many commands change their behavior according to command-specific
1628 variables or settings. These settings can be changed with the
1629 @code{set} subcommands. For example, the @code{print} command
1630 (@pxref{Data, ,Examining Data}) prints arrays differently depending on
1631 settings changeable with the commands @code{set print elements
1632 NUMBER-OF-ELEMENTS} and @code{set print array-indexes}, among others.
1633
1634 You can change these settings to your preference in the gdbinit files
1635 loaded at @value{GDBN} startup. @xref{Startup}.
1636
1637 The settings can also be changed interactively during the debugging
1638 session. For example, to change the limit of array elements to print,
1639 you can do the following:
1640 @smallexample
1641 (@value{GDBN}) set print elements 10
1642 (@value{GDBN}) print some_array
1643 $1 = @{0, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90...@}
1644 @end smallexample
1645
1646 The above @code{set print elements 10} command changes the number of
1647 elements to print from the default of 200 to 10. If you only intend
1648 this limit of 10 to be used for printing @code{some_array}, then you
1649 must restore the limit back to 200, with @code{set print elements
1650 200}.
1651
1652 Some commands allow overriding settings with command options. For
1653 example, the @code{print} command supports a number of options that
1654 allow overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set
1655 print} subcommands. @xref{print options}. The example above could be
1656 rewritten as:
1657 @smallexample
1658 (@value{GDBN}) print -elements 10 -- some_array
1659 $1 = @{0, 10, 20, 30, 40, 50, 60, 70, 80, 90...@}
1660 @end smallexample
1661
1662 Alternatively, you can use the @code{with} command to change a setting
1663 temporarily, for the duration of a command invocation.
1664
1665 @table @code
1666 @kindex with command
1667 @kindex w @r{(@code{with})}
1668 @cindex settings
1669 @cindex temporarily change settings
1670 @item with @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
1671 @itemx w @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
1672 Temporarily set @var{setting} to @var{value} for the duration of
1673 @var{command}.
1674
1675 @var{setting} is any setting you can change with the @code{set}
1676 subcommands. @var{value} is the value to assign to @code{setting}
1677 while running @code{command}.
1678
1679 If no @var{command} is provided, the last command executed is
1680 repeated.
1681
1682 If a @var{command} is provided, it must be preceded by a double dash
1683 (@code{--}) separator. This is required because some settings accept
1684 free-form arguments, such as expressions or filenames.
1685
1686 For example, the command
1687 @smallexample
1688 (@value{GDBN}) with print array on -- print some_array
1689 @end smallexample
1690 @noindent
1691 is equivalent to the following 3 commands:
1692 @smallexample
1693 (@value{GDBN}) set print array on
1694 (@value{GDBN}) print some_array
1695 (@value{GDBN}) set print array off
1696 @end smallexample
1697
1698 The @code{with} command is particularly useful when you want to
1699 override a setting while running user-defined commands, or commands
1700 defined in Python or Guile. @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
1701
1702 @smallexample
1703 (@value{GDBN}) with print pretty on -- my_complex_command
1704 @end smallexample
1705
1706 To change several settings for the same command, you can nest
1707 @code{with} commands. For example, @code{with language ada -- with
1708 print elements 10} temporarily changes the language to Ada and sets a
1709 limit of 10 elements to print for arrays and strings.
1710
1711 @end table
1712
1713 @node Completion
1714 @section Command Completion
1715
1716 @cindex completion
1717 @cindex word completion
1718 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1719 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1720 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1721 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, command options, and the names of symbols
1722 in your program.
1723
1724 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1725 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1726 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1727 enter it). For example, if you type
1728
1729 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1730 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1731 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1732 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1733 @smallexample
1734 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1735 @end smallexample
1736
1737 @noindent
1738 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1739 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1740
1741 @smallexample
1742 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1743 @end smallexample
1744
1745 @noindent
1746 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1747 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1748 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1749 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1750 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1751 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1752
1753 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1754 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1755 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1756 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1757 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1758 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1759 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1760 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1761 example:
1762
1763 @smallexample
1764 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1765 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1766 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1767 make_abs_section make_function_type
1768 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1769 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1770 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1771 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1772 @end smallexample
1773
1774 @noindent
1775 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1776 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1777 command.
1778
1779 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1780 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1781 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1782 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1783 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1784
1785 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1786 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1787 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1788
1789 @smallexample
1790 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1791 main
1792 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1793 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1794 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1795 @end smallexample
1796
1797 @noindent
1798 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1799
1800 @table @code
1801 @kindex set max-completions
1802 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1803 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1804 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1805 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1806 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1807 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1808 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1809 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1810 completion slow.
1811 @kindex show max-completions
1812 @item show max-completions
1813 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1814 during completion.
1815 @end table
1816
1817 @cindex quotes in commands
1818 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1819 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1820 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1821 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1822 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1823 @value{GDBN} commands.
1824
1825 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1826 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1827 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1828 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1829 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1830 Operators}).
1831
1832 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1833 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1834 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1835 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1836 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1837 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1838 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1839 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1840 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1841
1842 @smallexample
1843 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1844 func<int>() func<float>()
1845 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1846 @end smallexample
1847
1848 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1849 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1850 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1851 function:
1852
1853 @smallexample
1854 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1855 func<int>() func<float>()
1856 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1857 @end smallexample
1858
1859 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1860 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1861 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1862 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1863 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1864 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1865
1866 @smallexample
1867 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1868 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1869 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1870 bubble(double)
1871 @end smallexample
1872
1873 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1874 require quoting.
1875
1876 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1877 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1878 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1879 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1880
1881 @cindex completion of structure field names
1882 @cindex structure field name completion
1883 @cindex completion of union field names
1884 @cindex union field name completion
1885 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1886 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1887 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1888 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1889 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1890 left-hand-side:
1891
1892 @smallexample
1893 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1894 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1895 to_data to_isatty to_write
1896 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1897 to_flush to_read
1898 @end smallexample
1899
1900 @noindent
1901 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1902 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1903 follows:
1904
1905 @smallexample
1906 struct ui_file
1907 @{
1908 int *magic;
1909 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1910 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1911 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1912 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1913 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1914 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1915 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1916 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1917 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1918 void *to_data;
1919 @}
1920 @end smallexample
1921
1922 @node Command Options
1923 @section Command options
1924
1925 @cindex command options
1926 Some commands accept options starting with a leading dash. For
1927 example, @code{print -pretty}. Similarly to command names, you can
1928 abbreviate a @value{GDBN} option to the first few letters of the
1929 option name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous, and you can also use
1930 the @key{TAB} key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word
1931 in an option (or to show you the alternatives available, if there is
1932 more than one possibility).
1933
1934 @cindex command options, raw input
1935 Some commands take raw input as argument. For example, the print
1936 command processes arbitrary expressions in any of the languages
1937 supported by @value{GDBN}. With such commands, because raw input may
1938 start with a leading dash that would be confused with an option or any
1939 of its abbreviations, e.g.@: @code{print -r} (short for @code{print
1940 -raw} or printing negative @code{r}?), if you specify any command
1941 option, then you must use a double-dash (@code{--}) delimiter to
1942 indicate the end of options.
1943
1944 @cindex command options, boolean
1945
1946 Some options are described as accepting an argument which can be
1947 either @code{on} or @code{off}. These are known as @dfn{boolean
1948 options}. Similarly to boolean settings commands---@code{on} and
1949 @code{off} are the typical values, but any of @code{1}, @code{yes} and
1950 @code{enable} can also be used as ``true'' value, and any of @code{0},
1951 @code{no} and @code{disable} can also be used as ``false'' value. You
1952 can also omit a ``true'' value, as it is implied by default.
1953
1954 For example, these are equivalent:
1955
1956 @smallexample
1957 (@value{GDBP}) print -object on -pretty off -element unlimited -- *myptr
1958 (@value{GDBP}) p -o -p 0 -e u -- *myptr
1959 @end smallexample
1960
1961 You can discover the set of options some command accepts by completing
1962 on @code{-} after the command name. For example:
1963
1964 @smallexample
1965 (@value{GDBP}) print -@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1966 -address -max-depth -repeats -vtbl
1967 -array -null-stop -static-members
1968 -array-indexes -object -symbol
1969 -elements -pretty -union
1970 @end smallexample
1971
1972 Completion will in some cases guide you with a suggestion of what kind
1973 of argument an option expects. For example:
1974
1975 @smallexample
1976 (@value{GDBP}) print -elements @key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1977 NUMBER unlimited
1978 @end smallexample
1979
1980 Here, the option expects a number (e.g., @code{100}), not literal
1981 @code{NUMBER}. Such metasyntactical arguments are always presented in
1982 uppercase.
1983
1984 (For more on using the @code{print} command, see @ref{Data, ,Examining
1985 Data}.)
1986
1987 @node Help
1988 @section Getting Help
1989 @cindex online documentation
1990 @kindex help
1991
1992 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1993 using the command @code{help}.
1994
1995 @table @code
1996 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1997 @item help
1998 @itemx h
1999 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
2000 display a short list of named classes of commands:
2001
2002 @smallexample
2003 (@value{GDBP}) help
2004 List of classes of commands:
2005
2006 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
2007 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2008 data -- Examining data
2009 files -- Specifying and examining files
2010 internals -- Maintenance commands
2011 obscure -- Obscure features
2012 running -- Running the program
2013 stack -- Examining the stack
2014 status -- Status inquiries
2015 support -- Support facilities
2016 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
2017 stopping the program
2018 user-defined -- User-defined commands
2019
2020 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
2021 commands in that class.
2022 Type "help" followed by command name for full
2023 documentation.
2024 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
2025 (@value{GDBP})
2026 @end smallexample
2027 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
2028
2029 @item help @var{class}
2030 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
2031 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
2032 help display for the class @code{status}:
2033
2034 @smallexample
2035 (@value{GDBP}) help status
2036 Status inquiries.
2037
2038 List of commands:
2039
2040 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
2041 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
2042 info -- Generic command for showing things
2043 about the program being debugged
2044 show -- Generic command for showing things
2045 about the debugger
2046
2047 Type "help" followed by command name for full
2048 documentation.
2049 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
2050 (@value{GDBP})
2051 @end smallexample
2052
2053 @item help @var{command}
2054 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
2055 short paragraph on how to use that command.
2056
2057 @kindex apropos
2058 @item apropos [-v] @var{regexp}
2059 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
2060 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
2061 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. The optional flag @samp{-v},
2062 which stands for @samp{verbose}, indicates to output the full documentation
2063 of the matching commands and highlight the parts of the documentation
2064 matching @var{regexp}. For example:
2065
2066 @smallexample
2067 apropos alias
2068 @end smallexample
2069
2070 @noindent
2071 results in:
2072
2073 @smallexample
2074 @group
2075 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
2076 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
2077 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
2078 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
2079 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
2080 @end group
2081 @end smallexample
2082
2083 @noindent
2084 while
2085
2086 @smallexample
2087 apropos -v cut.*thread apply
2088 @end smallexample
2089
2090 @noindent
2091 results in the below output, where @samp{cut for 'thread apply}
2092 is highlighted if styling is enabled.
2093
2094 @smallexample
2095 @group
2096 taas -- Apply a command to all threads (ignoring errors
2097 and empty output).
2098 Usage: taas COMMAND
2099 shortcut for 'thread apply all -s COMMAND'
2100
2101 tfaas -- Apply a command to all frames of all threads
2102 (ignoring errors and empty output).
2103 Usage: tfaas COMMAND
2104 shortcut for 'thread apply all -s frame apply all -s COMMAND'
2105 @end group
2106 @end smallexample
2107
2108 @kindex complete
2109 @item complete @var{args}
2110 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
2111 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
2112 command you want completed. For example:
2113
2114 @smallexample
2115 complete i
2116 @end smallexample
2117
2118 @noindent results in:
2119
2120 @smallexample
2121 @group
2122 if
2123 ignore
2124 info
2125 inspect
2126 @end group
2127 @end smallexample
2128
2129 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
2130 @end table
2131
2132 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
2133 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
2134 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
2135 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
2136 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
2137 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
2138 Index}.
2139
2140 @c @group
2141 @table @code
2142 @kindex info
2143 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
2144 @item info
2145 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
2146 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
2147 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
2148 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
2149 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
2150 @w{@code{help info}}.
2151
2152 @kindex set
2153 @item set
2154 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
2155 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
2156 @code{set prompt $}.
2157
2158 @kindex show
2159 @item show
2160 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
2161 @value{GDBN} itself.
2162 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
2163 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
2164 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
2165 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
2166
2167 @kindex info set
2168 To display all the settable parameters and their current
2169 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
2170 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
2171 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
2172 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
2173 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
2174 @end table
2175 @c @end group
2176
2177 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
2178 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
2179
2180 @table @code
2181 @kindex show version
2182 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
2183 @item show version
2184 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2185 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
2186 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
2187 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
2188 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
2189 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
2190 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2191 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
2192 @value{GDBN}.
2193
2194 @kindex show copying
2195 @kindex info copying
2196 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
2197 @item show copying
2198 @itemx info copying
2199 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
2200
2201 @kindex show warranty
2202 @kindex info warranty
2203 @item show warranty
2204 @itemx info warranty
2205 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
2206 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2207
2208 @kindex show configuration
2209 @item show configuration
2210 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
2211 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
2212 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
2213 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
2214 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
2215 your report.
2216
2217 @end table
2218
2219 @node Running
2220 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
2221
2222 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
2223 debugging information when you compile it.
2224
2225 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
2226 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
2227 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
2228 kill a child process.
2229
2230 @menu
2231 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
2232 * Starting:: Starting your program
2233 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
2234 * Environment:: Your program's environment
2235
2236 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
2237 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
2238 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
2239 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
2240
2241 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
2242 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
2243 * Forks:: Debugging forks
2244 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
2245 @end menu
2246
2247 @node Compilation
2248 @section Compiling for Debugging
2249
2250 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
2251 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
2252 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
2253 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
2254 and addresses in the executable code.
2255
2256 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
2257 the compiler.
2258
2259 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
2260 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2261 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2262 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2263 executables containing debugging information.
2264
2265 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2266 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2267 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2268 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2269 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2270
2271 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2272 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2273 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2274
2275 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2276 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2277 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2278 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2279 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2280 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2281
2282 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2283 gcc, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2284 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2285
2286 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2287 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2288 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2289 format in @value{GDBN}.
2290
2291 @need 2000
2292 @node Starting
2293 @section Starting your Program
2294 @cindex starting
2295 @cindex running
2296
2297 @table @code
2298 @kindex run
2299 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2300 @item run
2301 @itemx r
2302 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2303 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2304 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2305 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2306 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2307
2308 @end table
2309
2310 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2311 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2312 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2313 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2314 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2315 message like this one:
2316
2317 @smallexample
2318 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2319 Try "help target" or "continue".
2320 @end smallexample
2321
2322 @noindent
2323 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2324 first (@pxref{load}).
2325
2326 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2327 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2328 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2329 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2330 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2331 divided into four categories:
2332
2333 @table @asis
2334 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2335 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2336 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2337 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2338 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2339 the arguments.
2340 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2341 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2342 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2343 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2344 below for details).
2345
2346 @item The @emph{environment.}
2347 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2348 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2349 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2350 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2351
2352 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2353 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2354 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2355 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2356 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2357 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2358 Directory}.
2359
2360 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2361 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2362 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2363 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2364 set a different device for your program.
2365 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2366
2367 @cindex pipes
2368 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2369 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2370 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2371 wrong program.
2372 @end table
2373
2374 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2375 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2376 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2377 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2378 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2379
2380 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2381 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2382 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2383 your current breakpoints.
2384
2385 @table @code
2386 @kindex start
2387 @item start
2388 @cindex run to main procedure
2389 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2390 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2391 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2392 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2393 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2394 procedure, depending on the language used.
2395
2396 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2397 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2398 the @samp{run} command.
2399
2400 @cindex elaboration phase
2401 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2402 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2403 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2404 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2405 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2406 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2407 will remain to halt execution.
2408
2409 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2410 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2411 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2412 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2413 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2414
2415 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2416 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2417 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2418 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2419 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2420 use the @code{starti} command.
2421
2422 @kindex starti
2423 @item starti
2424 @cindex run to first instruction
2425 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2426 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2427 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2428 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2429 the start of the elaboration phase.
2430
2431 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2432 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2433 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2434 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2435 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2436 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2437 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2438 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2439 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2440 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2441 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2442 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2443
2444 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2445 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2446 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2447 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2448
2449 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2450 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2451 environment:
2452
2453 @smallexample
2454 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2455 (@value{GDBP}) run
2456 @end smallexample
2457
2458 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2459 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2460
2461 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2462 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2463 @item set startup-with-shell
2464 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2465 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2466 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2467 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2468 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2469 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2470 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2471 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2472 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2473 startup failures such as:
2474
2475 @smallexample
2476 (@value{GDBP}) run
2477 Starting program: ./a.out
2478 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2479 @end smallexample
2480
2481 @noindent
2482 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2483 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2484 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2485 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2486 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2487 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2488
2489 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2490 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2491 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2492 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2493 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2494 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2495
2496 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2497 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2498 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2499 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2500 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2501 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2502
2503 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2504 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2505 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2506
2507 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2508 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2509
2510 @smallexample
2511 (@value{GDBP}) run
2512 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2513 @end smallexample
2514
2515 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2516 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2517
2518 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2519 @code{target native} command. For example,
2520
2521 @smallexample
2522 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2523 (@value{GDBP}) run
2524 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2525 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2526 (@value{GDBP}) run
2527 Starting program: ./a.out
2528 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2529 @end smallexample
2530
2531 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2532 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2533 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2534 disconnect.
2535
2536 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2537 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2538 proc}, @code{info os}.
2539
2540 @kindex set disable-randomization
2541 @item set disable-randomization
2542 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2543 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2544 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2545 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2546 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2547
2548 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2549 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2550
2551 @smallexample
2552 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2553 @end smallexample
2554
2555 @item set disable-randomization off
2556 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2557 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2558 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2559 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2560 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2561 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2562
2563 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2564 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2565 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2566 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2567 a code at its expected addresses.
2568
2569 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2570 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2571 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2572 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2573 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2574 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2575 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2576 a randomly chosen address.
2577
2578 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2579 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2580 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2581 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2582 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2583
2584 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2585 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2586
2587 @item show disable-randomization
2588 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2589 the virtual address space of the started program.
2590
2591 @end table
2592
2593 @node Arguments
2594 @section Your Program's Arguments
2595
2596 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2597 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2598 @code{run} command.
2599 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2600 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2601 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2602 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2603 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2604
2605 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2606 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2607 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2608 the program, not by the shell.
2609
2610 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2611 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2612
2613 @table @code
2614 @kindex set args
2615 @item set args
2616 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2617 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2618 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2619 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2620 it again without arguments.
2621
2622 @kindex show args
2623 @item show args
2624 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2625 @end table
2626
2627 @node Environment
2628 @section Your Program's Environment
2629
2630 @cindex environment (of your program)
2631 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2632 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2633 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2634 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2635 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2636 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2637 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2638
2639 @table @code
2640 @kindex path
2641 @item path @var{directory}
2642 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2643 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2644 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2645 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2646 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2647 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2648 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2649
2650 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2651 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2652 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2653 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2654 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2655 @var{directory} to the search path.
2656 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2657 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2658
2659 @kindex show paths
2660 @item show paths
2661 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2662 environment variable).
2663
2664 @kindex show environment
2665 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2666 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2667 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2668 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2669 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2670
2671 @kindex set environment
2672 @anchor{set environment}
2673 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2674 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2675 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2676 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2677 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2678 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2679 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2680 null value.
2681 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2682 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2683
2684 For example, this command:
2685
2686 @smallexample
2687 set env USER = foo
2688 @end smallexample
2689
2690 @noindent
2691 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2692 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2693 are not actually required.)
2694
2695 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2696 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2697 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2698 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2699 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2700
2701 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2702 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2703 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2704
2705 @kindex unset environment
2706 @anchor{unset environment}
2707 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2708 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2709 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2710 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2711 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2712
2713 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2714 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2715 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2716 @end table
2717
2718 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2719 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2720 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2721 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2722 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2723 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2724 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2725 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2726 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2727 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2728
2729 @node Working Directory
2730 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2731
2732 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2733 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2734 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2735 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2736 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2737 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2738 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2739 debugging.
2740
2741 @table @code
2742 @kindex set cwd
2743 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2744 @anchor{set cwd command}
2745 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2746 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2747 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2748 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2749 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2750 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2751 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2752 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2753 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2754 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2755 fallback.
2756
2757 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2758 the @code{cd} command.
2759 @xref{cd command}.
2760
2761 @kindex show cwd
2762 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2763 @item show cwd
2764 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2765 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2766 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2767
2768 @kindex cd
2769 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2770 @anchor{cd command}
2771 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2772 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2773 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2774
2775 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2776 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2777 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2778 @xref{set cwd command}.
2779
2780 @kindex pwd
2781 @item pwd
2782 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2783 @end table
2784
2785 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2786 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2787 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2788 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2789 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2790 current working directory of the debuggee.
2791
2792 @node Input/Output
2793 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2794
2795 @cindex redirection
2796 @cindex i/o
2797 @cindex terminal
2798 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2799 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2800 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2801 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2802 running your program.
2803
2804 @table @code
2805 @kindex info terminal
2806 @item info terminal
2807 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2808 program is using.
2809 @end table
2810
2811 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2812 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2813
2814 @smallexample
2815 run > outfile
2816 @end smallexample
2817
2818 @noindent
2819 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2820
2821 @kindex tty
2822 @cindex controlling terminal
2823 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2824 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2825 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2826 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2827 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2828
2829 @smallexample
2830 tty /dev/ttyb
2831 @end smallexample
2832
2833 @noindent
2834 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2835 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2836 that as their controlling terminal.
2837
2838 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2839 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2840 terminal.
2841
2842 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2843 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2844 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2845 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2846
2847 @cindex inferior tty
2848 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2849 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2850 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2851 program.
2852
2853 @table @code
2854 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2855 @kindex set inferior-tty
2856 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2857 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2858 @value{GDBN}.
2859
2860 @item show inferior-tty
2861 @kindex show inferior-tty
2862 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2863 @end table
2864
2865 @node Attach
2866 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2867 @kindex attach
2868 @cindex attach
2869
2870 @table @code
2871 @item attach @var{process-id}
2872 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2873 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2874 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2875 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2876 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2877
2878 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2879 executing the command.
2880 @end table
2881
2882 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2883 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2884 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2885 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2886
2887 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2888 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2889 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2890 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2891 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2892 Specify Files}.
2893
2894 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2895 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2896 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2897 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2898 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2899 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2900 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2901
2902 @table @code
2903 @kindex detach
2904 @item detach
2905 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2906 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2907 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2908 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2909 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2910 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2911 executing the command.
2912 @end table
2913
2914 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2915 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2916 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2917 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2918 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2919 Messages}).
2920
2921 @node Kill Process
2922 @section Killing the Child Process
2923
2924 @table @code
2925 @kindex kill
2926 @item kill
2927 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2928 @end table
2929
2930 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2931 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2932 is running.
2933
2934 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2935 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2936 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2937 outside the debugger.
2938
2939 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2940 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2941 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2942 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2943 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2944 breakpoint settings).
2945
2946 @node Inferiors and Programs
2947 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2948
2949 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2950 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2951 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2952 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2953 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2954 from multiple executables.
2955
2956 @cindex inferior
2957 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2958 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2959 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2960 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2961 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2962 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2963 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2964 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2965 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2966 threads running in it.
2967
2968 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2969 inferiors}}:
2970
2971 @table @code
2972 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2973 @item info inferiors
2974 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2975 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2976 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2977 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2978
2979 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2980
2981 @enumerate
2982 @item
2983 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2984
2985 @item
2986 the target system's inferior identifier
2987
2988 @item
2989 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2990
2991 @end enumerate
2992
2993 @noindent
2994 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2995 indicates the current inferior.
2996
2997 For example,
2998 @end table
2999 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3000
3001 @smallexample
3002 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3003 Num Description Executable
3004 2 process 2307 hello
3005 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
3006 @end smallexample
3007
3008 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
3009
3010 @table @code
3011 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
3012 @item inferior @var{infno}
3013 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
3014 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
3015 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
3016 @end table
3017
3018 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
3019 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
3020 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
3021 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
3022 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
3023 information on convenience variables.
3024
3025 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
3026 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
3027 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
3028 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
3029 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
3030 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
3031
3032 @table @code
3033 @kindex add-inferior
3034 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
3035 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
3036 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
3037 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
3038 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
3039 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
3040
3041 @kindex clone-inferior
3042 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
3043 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
3044 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
3045 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
3046 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
3047
3048 @smallexample
3049 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3050 Num Description Executable
3051 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
3052 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
3053 Added inferior 2.
3054 1 inferiors added.
3055 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3056 Num Description Executable
3057 2 <null> helloworld
3058 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
3059 @end smallexample
3060
3061 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
3062
3063 @kindex remove-inferiors
3064 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3065 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
3066 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
3067 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
3068
3069 @end table
3070
3071 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
3072 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
3073 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
3074 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
3075
3076 @table @code
3077 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3078 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
3079 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
3080 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
3081 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
3082 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
3083
3084 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3085 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
3086 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
3087 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
3088 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
3089 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
3090 @end table
3091
3092 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
3093 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
3094 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
3095 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
3096
3097
3098 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
3099 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
3100
3101 @table @code
3102 @kindex set print inferior-events
3103 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
3104 @item set print inferior-events
3105 @itemx set print inferior-events on
3106 @itemx set print inferior-events off
3107 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
3108 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
3109 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
3110 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
3111
3112 @kindex show print inferior-events
3113 @item show print inferior-events
3114 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
3115 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
3116 @end table
3117
3118 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
3119 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
3120 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
3121
3122
3123 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
3124 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
3125 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
3126 info program-spaces}} command.
3127
3128 @table @code
3129 @kindex maint info program-spaces
3130 @item maint info program-spaces
3131 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
3132 @value{GDBN}.
3133
3134 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
3135
3136 @enumerate
3137 @item
3138 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3139
3140 @item
3141 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
3142 the @code{file} command.
3143
3144 @end enumerate
3145
3146 @noindent
3147 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
3148 indicates the current program space.
3149
3150 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
3151 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
3152 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
3153
3154 @smallexample
3155 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
3156 Id Executable
3157 * 1 hello
3158 2 goodbye
3159 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
3160 @end smallexample
3161
3162 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
3163 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
3164 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
3165 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
3166 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
3167
3168 @smallexample
3169 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
3170 Id Executable
3171 * 1 vfork-test
3172 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
3173 @end smallexample
3174
3175 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
3176 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
3177 @end table
3178
3179 @node Threads
3180 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
3181
3182 @cindex threads of execution
3183 @cindex multiple threads
3184 @cindex switching threads
3185 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
3186 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
3187 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
3188 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
3189 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
3190 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
3191 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
3192
3193 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
3194 programs:
3195
3196 @itemize @bullet
3197 @item automatic notification of new threads
3198 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
3199 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
3200 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
3201 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
3202 @item thread-specific breakpoints
3203 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
3204 messages on thread start and exit.
3205 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
3206 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
3207 isn't compatible with the program.
3208 @end itemize
3209
3210 @cindex focus of debugging
3211 @cindex current thread
3212 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
3213 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
3214 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
3215 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
3216 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
3217
3218 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
3219 @cindex thread identifier (system)
3220 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
3221 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
3222 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
3223 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
3224 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
3225 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
3226 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
3227 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
3228
3229 @smallexample
3230 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
3231 @end smallexample
3232
3233 @noindent
3234 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
3235 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
3236 further qualifier.
3237
3238 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
3239 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
3240 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
3241 @c program?
3242 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
3243 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
3244 @c threads ab initio?
3245
3246 @anchor{thread numbers}
3247 @cindex thread number, per inferior
3248 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
3249 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
3250 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
3251 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
3252 between threads of different inferiors.
3253
3254 @cindex qualified thread ID
3255 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
3256 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
3257 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
3258 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
3259 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
3260 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3261 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3262 inferior.
3263
3264 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3265 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3266 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3267 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3268
3269 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3270 @cindex thread ID lists
3271 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3272 argument. A list element can be:
3273
3274 @enumerate
3275 @item
3276 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3277 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3278 @samp{1}.
3279
3280 @item
3281 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3282 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3283 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3284
3285 @item
3286 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3287 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3288 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3289 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3290 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3291
3292 @end enumerate
3293
3294 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3295 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3296 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3297 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3298 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3299 7.1}.
3300
3301
3302 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3303 @cindex global thread number
3304 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3305 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3306 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3307 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3308 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3309 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3310
3311 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3312 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3313 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3314
3315 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3316 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3317 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3318 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3319 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3320 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3321 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3322 general information on convenience variables.
3323
3324 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3325 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3326 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3327
3328 @smallexample
3329 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3330 @end smallexample
3331
3332 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3333
3334 @smallexample
3335 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3336 @end smallexample
3337
3338 @table @code
3339 @kindex info threads
3340 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3341
3342 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3343 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3344 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3345 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3346
3347 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3348
3349 @enumerate
3350 @item
3351 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3352
3353 @item
3354 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3355 option was specified
3356
3357 @item
3358 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3359
3360 @item
3361 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3362 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3363 program itself.
3364
3365 @item
3366 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3367 @end enumerate
3368
3369 @noindent
3370 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3371 indicates the current thread.
3372
3373 For example,
3374 @end table
3375 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3376
3377 @smallexample
3378 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3379 Id Target Id Frame
3380 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3381 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3382 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3383 at threadtest.c:68
3384 @end smallexample
3385
3386 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3387 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3388 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3389
3390 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3391 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3392
3393 @smallexample
3394 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3395 Id GId Target Id Frame
3396 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3397 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3398 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3399 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3400 @end smallexample
3401
3402 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3403 Solaris-specific command:
3404
3405 @table @code
3406 @item maint info sol-threads
3407 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3408 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3409 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3410 @end table
3411
3412 @table @code
3413 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3414 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3415 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3416 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3417 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3418 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3419
3420 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3421 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3422
3423 @smallexample
3424 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3425 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3426 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3427 8 printf ("hello\n");
3428 @end smallexample
3429
3430 @noindent
3431 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3432 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3433 threads.
3434
3435 @anchor{thread apply all}
3436 @kindex thread apply
3437 @cindex apply command to several threads
3438 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3439 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3440 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3441 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3442 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3443 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3444 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3445 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3446
3447 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3448 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3449 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3450 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3451 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3452
3453 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3454 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3455 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3456 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3457
3458 @table @code
3459 @item -c
3460 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3461 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3462 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3463 @item -s
3464 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3465 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3466 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3467 are not printed.
3468 @item -q
3469 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3470 information.
3471 @end table
3472
3473 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3474
3475 @kindex taas
3476 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3477 @item taas [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
3478 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}}.
3479 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3480
3481 The @code{taas} command accepts the same options as the @code{thread
3482 apply all} command. @xref{thread apply all}.
3483
3484 @kindex tfaas
3485 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3486 @item tfaas [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
3487 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s -- frame apply all -s [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}}.
3488 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3489 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3490 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3491 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3492 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3493 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3494 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3495
3496 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3497 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3498 is, using:
3499 @smallexample
3500 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3501 @end smallexample
3502
3503 The @code{tfaas} command accepts the same options as the @code{frame
3504 apply} command. @xref{frame apply}.
3505
3506 @kindex thread name
3507 @cindex name a thread
3508 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3509 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3510 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3511 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3512
3513 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3514 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3515 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3516 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3517 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3518
3519 @kindex thread find
3520 @cindex search for a thread
3521 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3522 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3523 matches the supplied regular expression.
3524
3525 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3526 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3527 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3528 is the LWP id.
3529
3530 @smallexample
3531 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3532 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3533 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3534 Id Target Id Frame
3535 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3536 @end smallexample
3537
3538 @kindex set print thread-events
3539 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3540 @item set print thread-events
3541 @itemx set print thread-events on
3542 @itemx set print thread-events off
3543 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3544 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3545 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3546 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3547 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3548
3549 @kindex show print thread-events
3550 @item show print thread-events
3551 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3552 have started and exited.
3553 @end table
3554
3555 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3556 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3557 programs with multiple threads.
3558
3559 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3560 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3561
3562 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3563 @table @code
3564 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3565 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3566 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3567 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3568 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3569 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3570 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3571 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3572 macro.
3573
3574 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3575 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3576 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3577 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3578 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3579 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3580
3581 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3582 refers to the default system directories that are
3583 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3584 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3585 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3586
3587 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3588 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3589 was loaded in the inferior process.
3590
3591 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3592 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3593 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3594 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3595 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3596 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3597 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3598
3599 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3600 only on some platforms.
3601
3602 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3603 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3604 Display current libthread_db search path.
3605
3606 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3607 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3608 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3609 @item set debug libthread-db
3610 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3611 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3612 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3613 @end table
3614
3615 @node Forks
3616 @section Debugging Forks
3617
3618 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3619 @cindex multiple processes
3620 @cindex processes, multiple
3621 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3622 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3623 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3624 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3625 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3626 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3627 will cause it to terminate.
3628
3629 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3630 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3631 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3632 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3633 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3634 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3635 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3636 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3637 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3638 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3639
3640 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3641 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3642 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3643 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3644
3645 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3646 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3647 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3648
3649 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3650 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3651
3652 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3653 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3654
3655 @table @code
3656 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3657 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3658 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3659 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3660 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3661
3662 @table @code
3663 @item parent
3664 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3665 unimpeded. This is the default.
3666
3667 @item child
3668 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3669 unimpeded.
3670
3671 @end table
3672
3673 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3674 @item show follow-fork-mode
3675 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3676 @end table
3677
3678 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3679 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3680 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3681
3682 @table @code
3683 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3684 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3685 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3686 retain debugger control over them both.
3687
3688 @table @code
3689 @item on
3690 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3691 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3692 independently. This is the default.
3693
3694 @item off
3695 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3696 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3697 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3698 is held suspended.
3699
3700 @end table
3701
3702 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3703 @item show detach-on-fork
3704 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3705 @end table
3706
3707 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3708 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3709 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3710 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3711 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3712 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3713
3714 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3715 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3716 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3717 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3718 and Programs}.
3719
3720 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3721 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3722 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3723 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3724 the child process's @code{main}.
3725
3726 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3727 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3728
3729 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3730 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3731 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3732 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3733 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3734 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3735 command.
3736
3737 @table @code
3738 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3739 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3740
3741 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3742 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3743
3744 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3745
3746 @table @code
3747 @item new
3748 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3749 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3750 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3751 original inferior.
3752
3753 For example:
3754
3755 @smallexample
3756 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3757 (gdb) info inferior
3758 Id Description Executable
3759 * 1 <null> prog1
3760 (@value{GDBP}) run
3761 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3762 Program exited normally.
3763 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3764 Id Description Executable
3765 1 <null> prog1
3766 * 2 <null> prog2
3767 @end smallexample
3768
3769 @item same
3770 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3771 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3772 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3773 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3774 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3775
3776 For example:
3777
3778 @smallexample
3779 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3780 Id Description Executable
3781 * 1 <null> prog1
3782 (@value{GDBP}) run
3783 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3784 Program exited normally.
3785 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3786 Id Description Executable
3787 * 1 <null> prog2
3788 @end smallexample
3789
3790 @end table
3791 @end table
3792
3793 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3794 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3795
3796 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3797 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3798 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3799
3800 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3801 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3802
3803 @cindex checkpoint
3804 @cindex restart
3805 @cindex bookmark
3806 @cindex snapshot of a process
3807 @cindex rewind program state
3808
3809 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3810 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3811 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3812 later.
3813
3814 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3815 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3816 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3817 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3818 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3819
3820 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3821 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3822 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3823 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3824 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3825 start again from there.
3826
3827 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3828 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3829
3830 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3831
3832 @table @code
3833 @kindex checkpoint
3834 @item checkpoint
3835 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3836 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3837 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3838
3839 @kindex info checkpoints
3840 @item info checkpoints
3841 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3842 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3843 listed:
3844
3845 @table @code
3846 @item Checkpoint ID
3847 @item Process ID
3848 @item Code Address
3849 @item Source line, or label
3850 @end table
3851
3852 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3853 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3854 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3855 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3856 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3857 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3858 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3859
3860 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3861 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3862 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3863 the debugger.
3864
3865 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3866 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3867 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3868
3869 @end table
3870
3871 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3872 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3873 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3874 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3875 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3876 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3877 previously read data can be read again.
3878
3879 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3880 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3881 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3882 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3883 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3884 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3885
3886 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3887 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3888 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3889 different execution path this time.
3890
3891 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3892 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3893 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3894 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3895 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3896 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3897 potentially pose a problem.
3898
3899 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3900
3901 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3902 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3903 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3904 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3905 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3906 next.
3907
3908 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3909 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3910 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3911 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3912 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3913
3914 @node Stopping
3915 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3916
3917 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3918 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3919 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3920
3921 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3922 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3923 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3924 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3925 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3926 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3927 explicitly request this information at any time.
3928
3929 @table @code
3930 @kindex info program
3931 @item info program
3932 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3933 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3934 @end table
3935
3936 @menu
3937 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3938 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3939 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3940 Skipping over functions and files
3941 * Signals:: Signals
3942 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3943 @end menu
3944
3945 @node Breakpoints
3946 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3947
3948 @cindex breakpoints
3949 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3950 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3951 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3952 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3953 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3954 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3955 program.
3956
3957 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3958 the executable is run.
3959
3960 @cindex watchpoints
3961 @cindex data breakpoints
3962 @cindex memory tracing
3963 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3964 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3965 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3966 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3967 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3968 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3969 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3970 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3971 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3972 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3973 same commands.
3974
3975 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3976 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3977 Automatic Display}.
3978
3979 @cindex catchpoints
3980 @cindex breakpoint on events
3981 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3982 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3983 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3984 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3985 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3986 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3987 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3988
3989 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3990 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3991 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3992 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3993 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3994 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3995 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3996 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3997 enable it again.
3998
3999 @cindex breakpoint ranges
4000 @cindex breakpoint lists
4001 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
4002 @cindex lists of breakpoints
4003 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
4004 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
4005 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
4006 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
4007 are operated on.
4008
4009 @menu
4010 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
4011 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
4012 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
4013 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
4014 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
4015 * Conditions:: Break conditions
4016 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
4017 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
4018 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
4019 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
4020 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
4021 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
4022 @end menu
4023
4024 @node Set Breaks
4025 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
4026
4027 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
4028 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
4029 @c
4030 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
4031
4032 @kindex break
4033 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
4034 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
4035 @cindex latest breakpoint
4036 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
4037 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
4038 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
4039 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
4040 convenience variables.
4041
4042 @table @code
4043 @item break @var{location}
4044 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
4045 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
4046 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
4047 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
4048 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
4049
4050 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
4051 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
4052 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
4053 that situation.
4054
4055 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
4056 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
4057 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
4058
4059 @item break
4060 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
4061 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
4062 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
4063 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
4064 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
4065 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
4066 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
4067 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
4068 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
4069 inside loops.
4070
4071 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
4072 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
4073 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
4074 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
4075 existed when your program stopped.
4076
4077 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
4078 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
4079 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
4080 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
4081 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
4082 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
4083 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
4084
4085 @kindex tbreak
4086 @item tbreak @var{args}
4087 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
4088 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
4089 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
4090 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
4091
4092 @kindex hbreak
4093 @cindex hardware breakpoints
4094 @item hbreak @var{args}
4095 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
4096 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
4097 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
4098 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
4099 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
4100 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
4101 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
4102 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
4103 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
4104 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
4105 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
4106 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
4107 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
4108 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
4109 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
4110 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4111 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4112 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4113
4114 @kindex thbreak
4115 @item thbreak @var{args}
4116 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
4117 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
4118 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
4119 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
4120 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
4121 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
4122 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
4123 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
4124
4125 @kindex rbreak
4126 @cindex regular expression
4127 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
4128 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
4129 @item rbreak @var{regex}
4130 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
4131 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
4132 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
4133 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
4134 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
4135 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
4136
4137 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
4138 to print the list of all breakpoints it sets according to the
4139 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
4140 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
4141 language of the breakpoint's function, other values mean to use
4142 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
4143
4144 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
4145 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
4146 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
4147 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
4148 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
4149 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
4150
4151 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
4152 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
4153 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
4154 classes.
4155
4156 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
4157 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
4158 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
4159
4160 @smallexample
4161 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
4162 @end smallexample
4163
4164 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
4165 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
4166 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
4167 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
4168 every function in a given file:
4169
4170 @smallexample
4171 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
4172 @end smallexample
4173
4174 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
4175 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
4176
4177 @kindex info breakpoints
4178 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
4179 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4180 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4181 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
4182 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
4183 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
4184 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
4185
4186 @table @emph
4187 @item Breakpoint Numbers
4188 @item Type
4189 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
4190 @item Disposition
4191 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
4192 @item Enabled or Disabled
4193 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
4194 that are not enabled.
4195 @item Address
4196 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
4197 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
4198 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
4199 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
4200 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
4201 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
4202 @item What
4203 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
4204 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
4205 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
4206 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
4207 @end table
4208
4209 @noindent
4210 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
4211 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
4212 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
4213 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
4214 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
4215 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
4216
4217 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
4218 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
4219 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
4220 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
4221
4222 @noindent
4223 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
4224 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
4225 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
4226 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
4227 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
4228
4229 @noindent
4230 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
4231 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
4232 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
4233 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
4234 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
4235 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
4236
4237 @noindent
4238 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
4239 @code{info break} also displays that count.
4240
4241 @end table
4242
4243 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
4244 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
4245 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
4246 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
4247
4248 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
4249 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
4250 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
4251 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
4252
4253 @itemize @bullet
4254 @item
4255 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
4256
4257 @item
4258 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
4259 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
4260
4261 @item
4262 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
4263 correspond to any number of instantiations.
4264
4265 @item
4266 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
4267 several places where that function is inlined.
4268 @end itemize
4269
4270 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
4271 the relevant locations.
4272
4273 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4274 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4275 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4276 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4277 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4278 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4279 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4280
4281 For example:
4282
4283 @smallexample
4284 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4285 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4286 stop only if i==1
4287 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4288 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4289 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4290 @end smallexample
4291
4292 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4293 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4294 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4295 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4296 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4297 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4298 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4299 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4300 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4301 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4302 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4303
4304 @cindex pending breakpoints
4305 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4306 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4307 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4308 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4309 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4310 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4311 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4312 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4313 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4314 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4315 is not yet resolved.
4316
4317 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4318 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4319 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4320 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4321 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4322 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4323
4324 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4325 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4326 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4327 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4328
4329 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4330 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4331 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4332
4333 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4334 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4335 address specification to an address:
4336
4337 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4338 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4339 @table @code
4340 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4341 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4342 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4343
4344 @item set breakpoint pending on
4345 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4346 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4347
4348 @item set breakpoint pending off
4349 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4350 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4351 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4352
4353 @item show breakpoint pending
4354 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4355 @end table
4356
4357 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4358 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4359 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4360
4361 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4362 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4363 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4364 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4365 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4366 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4367 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4368 breakpoints.
4369
4370 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4371
4372 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4373 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4374 @table @code
4375 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4376 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4377 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4378 breakpoint must be used.
4379
4380 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4381 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4382 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4383 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4384 @end table
4385
4386 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4387 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4388 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4389 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4390 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4391 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4392 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4393 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4394 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4395
4396 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4397 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4398 @table @code
4399 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4400 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4401 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4402 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4403
4404 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4405 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4406 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4407 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4408 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4409 @end table
4410
4411 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4412 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4413 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4414
4415 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4416 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4417
4418 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4419
4420 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4421 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4422 @table @code
4423 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4424 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4425 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4426 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4427 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4428
4429 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4430 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4431 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4432 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4433 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4434 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4435 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4436 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4437 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4438 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4439 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4440 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4441 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4442
4443 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4444 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4445 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4446 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4447 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4448 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4449 @end table
4450
4451
4452 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4453 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4454 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4455 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4456 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4457 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4458 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4459 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4460
4461
4462 @node Set Watchpoints
4463 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4464
4465 @cindex setting watchpoints
4466 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4467 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4468 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4469 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4470 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4471
4472 @itemize @bullet
4473 @item
4474 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4475
4476 @item
4477 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4478 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4479 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4480
4481 @item
4482 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4483 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4484 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4485 @end itemize
4486
4487 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4488 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4489 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4490 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4491 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4492 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4493 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4494 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4495 the expression changes.
4496
4497 @cindex software watchpoints
4498 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4499 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4500 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4501 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4502 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4503 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4504 culprit.)
4505
4506 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4507 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4508 slow down the running of your program.
4509
4510 @table @code
4511 @kindex watch
4512 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4513 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4514 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4515 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4516 to watch the value of a single variable:
4517
4518 @smallexample
4519 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4520 @end smallexample
4521
4522 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4523 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4524 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4525 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4526 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4527 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4528
4529 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4530 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4531 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4532 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4533 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4534 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4535 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4536 error.
4537
4538 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4539 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4540 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4541 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4542 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4543 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4544 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4545 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4546 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4547 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4548 Examples:
4549
4550 @smallexample
4551 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4552 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4553 @end smallexample
4554
4555 @kindex rwatch
4556 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4557 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4558 by the program.
4559
4560 @kindex awatch
4561 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4562 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4563 or written into by the program.
4564
4565 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4566 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4567 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4568 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4569 @end table
4570
4571 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4572 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4573 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4574 a never-changing value:
4575
4576 @smallexample
4577 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4578 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4579 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4580 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4581 @end smallexample
4582
4583 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4584 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4585 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4586 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4587 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4588 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4589
4590 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4591 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4592 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4593 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4594 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4595 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4596 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4597 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4598
4599 @table @code
4600 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4601 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4602 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4603
4604 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4605 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4606 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4607 @end table
4608
4609 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4610 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4611 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4612
4613 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4614
4615 @smallexample
4616 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4617 @end smallexample
4618
4619 @noindent
4620 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4621
4622 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4623 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4624 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4625 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4626 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4627 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4628 will print a message like this:
4629
4630 @smallexample
4631 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4632 @end smallexample
4633
4634 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4635 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4636 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4637 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4638 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4639 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4640 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4641 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4642
4643 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4644 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4645 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4646 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4647 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4648 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4649
4650 @smallexample
4651 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4652 @end smallexample
4653
4654 @noindent
4655 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4656
4657 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4658 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4659 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4660 expression with separately allocated resources.
4661
4662 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4663 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4664 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4665
4666 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4667 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4668 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4669 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4670 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4671 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4672 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4673 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4674 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4675
4676 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4677 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4678 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4679 watched expression from every thread.
4680
4681 @quotation
4682 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4683 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4684 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4685 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4686 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4687 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4688 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4689 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4690 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4691 @end quotation
4692
4693 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4694
4695 @node Set Catchpoints
4696 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4697 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4698 @cindex exception handlers
4699 @cindex event handling
4700
4701 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4702 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4703 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4704
4705 @table @code
4706 @kindex catch
4707 @item catch @var{event}
4708 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4709
4710 @table @code
4711 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4712 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4713 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4714 @kindex catch throw
4715 @kindex catch rethrow
4716 @kindex catch catch
4717 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4718 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4719
4720 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4721 regular expression will be caught.
4722
4723 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4724 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4725 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4726 exception being thrown.
4727
4728 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4729 @value{GDBN}:
4730
4731 @itemize @bullet
4732 @item
4733 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4734 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4735 supported.
4736
4737 @item
4738 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4739 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4740 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4741 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4742 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4743 built.
4744
4745 @item
4746 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4747 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4748
4749 @item
4750 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4751 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4752 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4753 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4754
4755 @item
4756 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4757 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4758 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4759 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4760 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4761 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4762 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4763 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4764 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4765
4766 @item
4767 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4768
4769 @item
4770 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4771 @end itemize
4772
4773 @item exception @r{[}@var{name}@r{]}
4774 @kindex catch exception
4775 @cindex Ada exception catching
4776 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4777 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4778 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4779 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4780 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4781
4782 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4783 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4784 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4785 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4786 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4787 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4788 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4789 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4790
4791 @item exception unhandled
4792 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4793 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4794
4795 @item handlers @r{[}@var{name}@r{]}
4796 @kindex catch handlers
4797 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4798 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4799 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4800 specified at the end of the command
4801 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4802 only when this specific exception is handled.
4803 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4804
4805 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4806 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4807 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4808 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4809 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4810 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4811 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4812 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4813 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4814
4815 @item assert
4816 @kindex catch assert
4817 A failed Ada assertion.
4818
4819 @item exec
4820 @kindex catch exec
4821 @cindex break on fork/exec
4822 A call to @code{exec}.
4823
4824 @anchor{catch syscall}
4825 @item syscall
4826 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4827 @kindex catch syscall
4828 @cindex break on a system call.
4829 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4830 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4831 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4832 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4833 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4834 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4835 will be caught.
4836
4837 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4838 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4839 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4840 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4841
4842 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4843 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4844 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4845 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4846
4847 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4848 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4849 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4850 available choices.
4851
4852 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4853 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4854 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4855 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4856 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4857 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4858 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4859 behind the OS upgrades).
4860
4861 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4862 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4863 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4864 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4865 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4866 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4867 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4868 syscall groups available on your environment.
4869
4870 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4871 arguments to it:
4872
4873 @smallexample
4874 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4875 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4876 (@value{GDBP}) r
4877 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4878
4879 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4880 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4881 (@value{GDBP}) c
4882 Continuing.
4883
4884 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4885 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4886 (@value{GDBP})
4887 @end smallexample
4888
4889 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4890
4891 @smallexample
4892 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4893 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4894 (@value{GDBP}) r
4895 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4896
4897 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4898 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4899 (@value{GDBP}) c
4900 Continuing.
4901
4902 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4903 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4904 (@value{GDBP})
4905 @end smallexample
4906
4907 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4908 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4909 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4910
4911 @smallexample
4912 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4913 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4914 (@value{GDBP}) r
4915 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4916
4917 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4918 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4919 (@value{GDBP}) c
4920 Continuing.
4921
4922 Program exited normally.
4923 (@value{GDBP})
4924 @end smallexample
4925
4926 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4927
4928 @smallexample
4929 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4930 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4931 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4932 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4933 (@value{GDBP}) r
4934 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4935
4936 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4937 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4938
4939 (@value{GDBP}) c
4940 Continuing.
4941 @end smallexample
4942
4943 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4944 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4945 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4946 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4947
4948 @smallexample
4949 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4950 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4951 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4952 (@value{GDBP})
4953 @end smallexample
4954
4955 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4956 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4957 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4958 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4959 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4960 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4961
4962 @smallexample
4963 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4964 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4965 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4966 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4967 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4968 (@value{GDBP})
4969 @end smallexample
4970
4971 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4972
4973 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4974 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4975
4976 @smallexample
4977 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4978 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4979 @end smallexample
4980
4981 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4982
4983 @item fork
4984 @kindex catch fork
4985 A call to @code{fork}.
4986
4987 @item vfork
4988 @kindex catch vfork
4989 A call to @code{vfork}.
4990
4991 @item load @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4992 @itemx unload @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4993 @kindex catch load
4994 @kindex catch unload
4995 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4996 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4997 matches one of the affected libraries.
4998
4999 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5000 @kindex catch signal
5001 The delivery of a signal.
5002
5003 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
5004 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
5005 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
5006
5007 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
5008 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
5009 signal names.
5010
5011 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
5012 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
5013 will be caught.
5014
5015 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
5016 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
5017 catchpoint.
5018
5019 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
5020 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
5021 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
5022 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
5023 commands.
5024
5025 @end table
5026
5027 @item tcatch @var{event}
5028 @kindex tcatch
5029 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
5030 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
5031
5032 @end table
5033
5034 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
5035
5036
5037 @node Delete Breaks
5038 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
5039
5040 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
5041 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
5042 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
5043 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
5044 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
5045 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
5046
5047 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
5048 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
5049 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
5050 their breakpoint numbers.
5051
5052 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
5053 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
5054 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
5055
5056 @table @code
5057 @kindex clear
5058 @item clear
5059 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
5060 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
5061 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
5062 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
5063
5064 @item clear @var{location}
5065 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
5066 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
5067 most useful ones are listed below:
5068
5069 @table @code
5070 @item clear @var{function}
5071 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
5072 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
5073
5074 @item clear @var{linenum}
5075 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
5076 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
5077 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
5078 @end table
5079
5080 @cindex delete breakpoints
5081 @kindex delete
5082 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
5083 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5084 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
5085 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
5086 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
5087 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
5088 @end table
5089
5090 @node Disabling
5091 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
5092
5093 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
5094 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
5095 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
5096 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
5097 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
5098
5099 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
5100 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
5101 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
5102 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
5103 do not know which numbers to use.
5104
5105 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
5106 affects all of its locations.
5107
5108 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
5109 different states of enablement:
5110
5111 @itemize @bullet
5112 @item
5113 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
5114 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
5115 @item
5116 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
5117 @item
5118 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
5119 disabled.
5120 @item
5121 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
5122 N times, then becomes disabled.
5123 @item
5124 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
5125 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
5126 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
5127 @end itemize
5128
5129 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
5130 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
5131
5132 @table @code
5133 @kindex disable
5134 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
5135 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5136 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
5137 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
5138 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
5139 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
5140 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
5141
5142 @kindex enable
5143 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5144 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
5145 become effective once again in stopping your program.
5146
5147 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
5148 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
5149 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
5150
5151 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
5152 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
5153 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
5154 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
5155 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
5156 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
5157 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
5158
5159 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
5160 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
5161 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
5162 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
5163 @end table
5164
5165 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
5166 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
5167 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
5168 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
5169 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
5170 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
5171 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
5172 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
5173 Stepping}.)
5174
5175 @node Conditions
5176 @subsection Break Conditions
5177 @cindex conditional breakpoints
5178 @cindex breakpoint conditions
5179
5180 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5181 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
5182 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
5183 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
5184 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
5185 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
5186 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
5187 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
5188
5189 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
5190 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
5191 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
5192 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
5193 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
5194
5195 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
5196 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
5197 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
5198 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
5199 one.
5200
5201 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
5202 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
5203 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
5204 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
5205 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
5206 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
5207 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
5208 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
5209 conditions for the
5210 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
5211 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
5212
5213 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
5214 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
5215 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
5216 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
5217 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
5218 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
5219
5220 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
5221 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
5222 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
5223 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
5224 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
5225
5226 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
5227 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
5228 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
5229 with the @code{condition} command.
5230
5231 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
5232 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
5233 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
5234 catchpoint.
5235
5236 @table @code
5237 @kindex condition
5238 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
5239 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
5240 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
5241 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
5242 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
5243 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
5244 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
5245 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
5246 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
5247 prints an error message:
5248
5249 @smallexample
5250 No symbol "foo" in current context.
5251 @end smallexample
5252
5253 @noindent
5254 @value{GDBN} does
5255 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
5256 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
5257 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
5258
5259 @item condition @var{bnum}
5260 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
5261 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
5262 @end table
5263
5264 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
5265 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
5266 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
5267 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
5268 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
5269 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
5270 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
5271 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
5272 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
5273 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
5274 your program reaches it.
5275
5276 @table @code
5277 @kindex ignore
5278 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5279 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5280 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5281 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5282 takes no action.
5283
5284 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5285 a count of zero.
5286
5287 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5288 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5289 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5290 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5291
5292 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5293 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5294 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5295
5296 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5297 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5298 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5299 Variables}.
5300 @end table
5301
5302 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5303
5304
5305 @node Break Commands
5306 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5307
5308 @cindex breakpoint commands
5309 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5310 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5311 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5312 enable other breakpoints.
5313
5314 @table @code
5315 @kindex commands
5316 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5317 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5318 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5319 @itemx end
5320 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5321 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5322 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5323
5324 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5325 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5326
5327 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5328 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5329 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5330 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5331 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5332 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5333 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5334 Expressions}).
5335 @end table
5336
5337 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5338 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5339
5340 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5341 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5342 that resumes execution.
5343
5344 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5345 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5346 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5347 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5348 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5349
5350 @kindex silent
5351 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5352 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5353 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5354 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5355 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5356 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5357
5358 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5359 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5360 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5361
5362 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5363 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5364
5365 @smallexample
5366 break foo if x>0
5367 commands
5368 silent
5369 printf "x is %d\n",x
5370 cont
5371 end
5372 @end smallexample
5373
5374 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5375 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5376 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5377 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5378 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5379 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5380 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5381
5382 @smallexample
5383 break 403
5384 commands
5385 silent
5386 set x = y + 4
5387 cont
5388 end
5389 @end smallexample
5390
5391 @node Dynamic Printf
5392 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5393
5394 @cindex dynamic printf
5395 @cindex dprintf
5396 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5397 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5398 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5399 having to recompile it.
5400
5401 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5402 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5403 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5404 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5405 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5406 redirects to files and so forth.
5407
5408 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5409 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5410 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5411 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5412 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5413 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5414 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5415
5416 @table @code
5417 @kindex dprintf
5418 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5419 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5420 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5421 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5422
5423 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5424 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5425 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5426 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5427 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5428 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5429
5430 @table @code
5431 @item gdb
5432 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5433 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5434
5435 @item call
5436 @kindex dprintf-style call
5437 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5438 @code{printf}).
5439
5440 @item agent
5441 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5442 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5443 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5444 support running commands on the target.
5445 @end table
5446
5447 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5448 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5449 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5450 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5451 command.
5452
5453 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5454 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5455 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5456 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5457 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5458 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5459
5460 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5461 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5462 you could do the following:
5463
5464 @example
5465 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5466 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5467 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5468 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5469 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5470 (gdb) info break
5471 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5472 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5473 continue
5474 (gdb)
5475 @end example
5476
5477 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5478 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5479 the variable settings.
5480
5481 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5482 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5483 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5484 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5485 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5486 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5487
5488 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5489 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5490 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5491
5492 @end table
5493
5494 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5495 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5496 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5497 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5498 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5499 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5500
5501 @node Save Breakpoints
5502 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5503
5504 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5505 breakpoints}} command.
5506
5507 @table @code
5508 @kindex save breakpoints
5509 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5510 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5511 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5512 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5513 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5514 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5515 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5516 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5517 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5518 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5519 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5520 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5521 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5522 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5523 that can no longer be recreated.
5524 @end table
5525
5526 @node Static Probe Points
5527 @subsection Static Probe Points
5528
5529 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5530 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5531 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5532 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5533 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5534
5535 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5536 ELF-compatible systems:
5537
5538 @itemize @bullet
5539
5540 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5541 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5542 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5543 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5544 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5545 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5546 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5547 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5548
5549 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5550 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5551 C@t{++} languages.
5552 @end itemize
5553
5554 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5555 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5556 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5557 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5558 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5559 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5560 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5561 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5562 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5563
5564 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5565 probes}, with optional arguments:
5566
5567 @table @code
5568 @kindex info probes
5569 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5570 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5571 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5572 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5573
5574 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5575 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5576 probes from all providers are listed.
5577
5578 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5579 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5580 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5581
5582 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5583 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5584 given, all object files are considered.
5585
5586 @item info probes all
5587 List the available static probes, from all types.
5588 @end table
5589
5590 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5591 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5592 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5593 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5594 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5595
5596 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5597 commands, with optional arguments:
5598
5599 @table @code
5600 @kindex enable probes
5601 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5602 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5603 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5604 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5605
5606 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5607 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5608 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5609
5610 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5611 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5612 given, all object files are considered.
5613
5614 @kindex disable probes
5615 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5616 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5617 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5618 @end table
5619
5620 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5621 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5622 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5623 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5624 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5625 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5626 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5627 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5628 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5629 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5630 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5631 at the current probe point.
5632
5633 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5634 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5635 an error message.
5636
5637
5638 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5639 @node Error in Breakpoints
5640 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5641
5642 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5643 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5644
5645 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5646 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5647 @smallexample
5648 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5649 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5650 @end smallexample
5651
5652 @noindent
5653 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5654 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5655 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5656
5657 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5658 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5659
5660 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5661 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5662 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5663
5664 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5665 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5666 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5667 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5668
5669 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5670 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5671 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5672 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5673 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5674 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5675 first in the bundle.
5676
5677 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5678 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5679 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5680 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5681 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5682 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5683 is hit.
5684
5685 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5686 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5687
5688 @smallexample
5689 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5690 @end smallexample
5691
5692 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5693 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5694 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5695 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5696 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5697 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5698 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5699 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5700
5701 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5702 adjusted breakpoints:
5703
5704 @smallexample
5705 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5706 to 0x00010410.
5707 @end smallexample
5708
5709 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5710 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5711 frequently than expected.
5712
5713 @node Continuing and Stepping
5714 @section Continuing and Stepping
5715
5716 @cindex stepping
5717 @cindex continuing
5718 @cindex resuming execution
5719 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5720 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5721 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5722 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5723 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5724 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5725 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5726 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5727 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5728 handlers}).)
5729
5730 @table @code
5731 @kindex continue
5732 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5733 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5734 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5735 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5736 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5737 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5738 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5739 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5740 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5741 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5742
5743 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5744 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5745 @code{continue} is ignored.
5746
5747 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5748 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5749 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5750 @code{continue}.
5751 @end table
5752
5753 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5754 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5755 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5756 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5757
5758 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5759 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5760 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5761 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5762 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5763 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5764
5765 @table @code
5766 @kindex step
5767 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5768 @item step
5769 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5770 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5771 abbreviated @code{s}.
5772
5773 @quotation
5774 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5775 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5776 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5777 @c distinction here.
5778 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5779 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5780 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5781 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5782 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5783 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5784 below.
5785 @end quotation
5786
5787 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5788 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5789 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5790 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5791 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5792 called within the line.
5793
5794 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5795 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5796 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5797 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5798 was any debugging information about the routine.
5799
5800 @item step @var{count}
5801 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5802 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5803 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5804
5805 @kindex next
5806 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5807 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5808 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5809 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5810 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5811 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5812 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5813 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5814
5815 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5816
5817
5818 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5819 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5820 @c
5821 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5822 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5823 @c function are executed without stopping.
5824
5825 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5826 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5827 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5828
5829 @kindex set step-mode
5830 @item set step-mode
5831 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5832 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5833 @itemx set step-mode on
5834 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5835 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5836 information rather than stepping over it.
5837
5838 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5839 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5840 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5841
5842 @item set step-mode off
5843 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5844 debug information. This is the default.
5845
5846 @item show step-mode
5847 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5848 source line debug information.
5849
5850 @kindex finish
5851 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5852 @item finish
5853 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5854 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5855 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5856
5857 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5858 ,Returning from a Function}).
5859
5860 @kindex set print finish
5861 @kindex show print finish
5862 @item set print finish @r{[}on|off@r{]}
5863 @itemx show print finish
5864 By default the @code{finish} command will show the value that is
5865 returned by the function. This can be disabled using @code{set print
5866 finish off}. When disabled, the value is still entered into the value
5867 history (@pxref{Value History}), but not displayed.
5868
5869 @kindex until
5870 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5871 @cindex run until specified location
5872 @item until
5873 @itemx u
5874 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5875 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5876 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5877 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5878 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5879 than the address of the jump.
5880
5881 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5882 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5883 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5884 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5885 through the next iteration.
5886
5887 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5888 stack frame.
5889
5890 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5891 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5892 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5893 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5894 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5895
5896 @smallexample
5897 (@value{GDBP}) f
5898 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5899 206 expand_input();
5900 (@value{GDBP}) until
5901 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5902 @end smallexample
5903
5904 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5905 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5906 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5907 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5908 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5909 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5910 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5911
5912 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5913 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5914 argument.
5915
5916 @item until @var{location}
5917 @itemx u @var{location}
5918 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5919 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5920 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5921 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5922 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5923 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5924 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5925 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5926 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5927 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5928 invocations have returned.
5929
5930 @smallexample
5931 94 int factorial (int value)
5932 95 @{
5933 96 if (value > 1) @{
5934 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5935 98 @}
5936 99 return (value);
5937 100 @}
5938 @end smallexample
5939
5940
5941 @kindex advance @var{location}
5942 @item advance @var{location}
5943 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5944 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5945 @ref{Specify Location}.
5946 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5947 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5948 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5949 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5950
5951
5952 @kindex stepi
5953 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5954 @item stepi
5955 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5956 @itemx si
5957 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5958
5959 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5960 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5961 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5962 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5963
5964 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5965
5966 @need 750
5967 @kindex nexti
5968 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5969 @item nexti
5970 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5971 @itemx ni
5972 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5973 proceed until the function returns.
5974
5975 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5976
5977 @end table
5978
5979 @anchor{range stepping}
5980 @cindex range stepping
5981 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5982 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5983 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5984 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5985 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5986 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5987 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5988 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5989 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5990 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5991 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5992 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5993 if necessary:
5994
5995 @table @code
5996 @kindex set range-stepping
5997 @kindex show range-stepping
5998 @item set range-stepping
5999 @itemx show range-stepping
6000 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
6001
6002 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
6003 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
6004 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
6005 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
6006 default is @code{on}.
6007
6008 @end table
6009
6010 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
6011 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
6012 @cindex skipping over functions and files
6013
6014 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
6015 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
6016 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
6017 a particular file when stepping.
6018
6019 For example, consider the following C function:
6020
6021 @smallexample
6022 101 int func()
6023 102 @{
6024 103 foo(boring());
6025 104 bar(boring());
6026 105 @}
6027 @end smallexample
6028
6029 @noindent
6030 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
6031 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
6032 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
6033 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
6034
6035 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
6036 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
6037 is called from many places.
6038
6039 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
6040 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
6041 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
6042 @code{foo}.
6043
6044 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
6045 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
6046 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
6047
6048 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
6049 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
6050 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
6051 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
6052 the underlying system.
6053 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
6054 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
6055
6056 @table @code
6057 @kindex skip
6058 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
6059 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
6060 that specify what to skip.
6061 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
6062
6063 @table @code
6064 @item -file @var{file}
6065 @itemx -fi @var{file}
6066 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
6067
6068 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
6069 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
6070 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
6071 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
6072 over when stepping.
6073
6074 @smallexample
6075 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
6076 @end smallexample
6077
6078 @item -function @var{linespec}
6079 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
6080 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
6081 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
6082 @xref{Specify Location}.
6083
6084 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
6085 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
6086 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
6087 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
6088
6089 This form is useful for complex function names.
6090 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
6091 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
6092 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
6093 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
6094 regular expression makes this easier.
6095
6096 @smallexample
6097 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
6098 @end smallexample
6099
6100 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
6101 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
6102
6103 @smallexample
6104 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
6105 @end smallexample
6106 @end table
6107
6108 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
6109 will be skipped.
6110
6111 @kindex skip function
6112 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
6113 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
6114 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
6115 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
6116
6117 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
6118 will be skipped.
6119
6120 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
6121 @kbd{skip function file}.)
6122
6123 @kindex skip file
6124 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
6125 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
6126 will be skipped over when stepping.
6127
6128 @smallexample
6129 (gdb) skip file boring.c
6130 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
6131 @end smallexample
6132
6133 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
6134 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
6135 @end table
6136
6137 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
6138 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
6139
6140 @table @code
6141 @kindex info skip
6142 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6143 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
6144 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
6145 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
6146
6147 @table @emph
6148 @item Identifier
6149 A number identifying this skip.
6150 @item Enabled or Disabled
6151 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
6152 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
6153 @item Glob
6154 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
6155 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
6156 @item File
6157 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
6158 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
6159 @item RE
6160 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
6161 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
6162 @item Function
6163 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
6164 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
6165 @end table
6166
6167 @kindex skip delete
6168 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6169 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
6170 skips.
6171
6172 @kindex skip enable
6173 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6174 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
6175 skips.
6176
6177 @kindex skip disable
6178 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
6179 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
6180 skips.
6181
6182 @kindex set debug skip
6183 @item set debug skip @r{[}on|off@r{]}
6184 Set whether to print the debug output about skipping files and functions.
6185
6186 @kindex show debug skip
6187 @item show debug skip
6188 Show whether the debug output about skipping files and functions is printed.
6189
6190 @end table
6191
6192 @node Signals
6193 @section Signals
6194 @cindex signals
6195
6196 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
6197 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
6198 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
6199 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
6200 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
6201 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
6202 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
6203 requested an alarm).
6204
6205 @cindex fatal signals
6206 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
6207 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
6208 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
6209 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
6210 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
6211 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
6212
6213 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
6214 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
6215 signal.
6216
6217 @cindex handling signals
6218 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
6219 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
6220 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
6221 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
6222 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
6223
6224 @table @code
6225 @kindex info signals
6226 @kindex info handle
6227 @item info signals
6228 @itemx info handle
6229 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
6230 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
6231 the defined types of signals.
6232
6233 @item info signals @var{sig}
6234 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
6235
6236 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
6237
6238 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
6239 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
6240 for details about this command.
6241
6242 @kindex handle
6243 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
6244 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
6245 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
6246 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
6247 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
6248 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
6249 say what change to make.
6250 @end table
6251
6252 @c @group
6253 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
6254 Their full names are:
6255
6256 @table @code
6257 @item nostop
6258 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
6259 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
6260
6261 @item stop
6262 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
6263 the @code{print} keyword as well.
6264
6265 @item print
6266 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
6267
6268 @item noprint
6269 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
6270 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
6271
6272 @item pass
6273 @itemx noignore
6274 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
6275 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
6276 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
6277
6278 @item nopass
6279 @itemx ignore
6280 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
6281 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
6282 @end table
6283 @c @end group
6284
6285 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
6286 program until you
6287 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
6288 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
6289 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
6290 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
6291 program sees that signal when you continue.
6292
6293 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6294 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6295 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6296 erroneous signals.
6297
6298 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6299 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6300 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6301 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6302 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6303 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6304 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6305 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6306 Program a Signal}.
6307
6308 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6309 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6310
6311 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6312 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6313 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6314 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6315 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6316 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6317 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6318 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6319 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6320 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6321 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6322 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6323 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6324
6325 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6326
6327 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6328 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6329 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6330 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6331
6332 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6333 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6334 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6335 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6336
6337 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6338 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6339
6340 @smallexample
6341 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6342 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6343 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6344 (@value{GDBP}) c
6345 Continuing.
6346
6347 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6348 main () sigusr1.c:28
6349 28 p = 0;
6350 (@value{GDBP}) si
6351 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6352 9 @{
6353 @end smallexample
6354
6355 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6356 program to receive the signal first:
6357
6358 @smallexample
6359 (@value{GDBP}) n
6360 28 p = 0;
6361 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6362 (@value{GDBP}) si
6363 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6364 9 @{
6365 (@value{GDBP})
6366 @end smallexample
6367
6368 @cindex extra signal information
6369 @anchor{extra signal information}
6370
6371 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6372 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6373 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6374 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6375 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6376 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6377 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6378 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6379 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6380 system header.
6381
6382 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6383 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6384
6385 @smallexample
6386 @group
6387 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6388 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6389 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6390 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6391 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6392 type = struct @{
6393 int si_signo;
6394 int si_errno;
6395 int si_code;
6396 union @{
6397 int _pad[28];
6398 struct @{...@} _kill;
6399 struct @{...@} _timer;
6400 struct @{...@} _rt;
6401 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6402 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6403 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6404 @} _sifields;
6405 @}
6406 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6407 type = struct @{
6408 void *si_addr;
6409 @}
6410 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6411 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6412 @end group
6413 @end smallexample
6414
6415 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6416
6417 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6418 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6419 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6420 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6421 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6422 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6423 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6424 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6425 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6426 information is displayed.
6427
6428 The usual output of a segfault is:
6429 @smallexample
6430 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6431 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6432 68 value = *(p + len);
6433 @end smallexample
6434
6435 While a bound violation is presented as:
6436 @smallexample
6437 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6438 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6439 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6440 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6441 68 value = *(p + len);
6442 @end smallexample
6443
6444 @node Thread Stops
6445 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6446
6447 @cindex stopped threads
6448 @cindex threads, stopped
6449
6450 @cindex continuing threads
6451 @cindex threads, continuing
6452
6453 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6454 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6455 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6456 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6457 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6458 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6459 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6460 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6461 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6462
6463 @menu
6464 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6465 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6466 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6467 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6468 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6469 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6470 @end menu
6471
6472 @node All-Stop Mode
6473 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6474
6475 @cindex all-stop mode
6476
6477 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6478 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6479 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6480 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6481 underfoot.
6482
6483 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6484 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6485 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6486
6487 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6488 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6489 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6490 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6491 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6492 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6493 stops.
6494
6495 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6496 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6497 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6498 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6499
6500 @cindex automatic thread selection
6501 @cindex switching threads automatically
6502 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6503 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6504 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6505 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6506 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6507 thread.
6508
6509 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6510 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6511
6512 @table @code
6513 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6514 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6515 @cindex lock scheduler
6516 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6517 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6518 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6519 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6520 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6521 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6522 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6523 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6524 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6525 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6526 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6527 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6528 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6529 @code{on} in replay mode.
6530
6531 @item show scheduler-locking
6532 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6533 @end table
6534
6535 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6536 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6537 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6538 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6539 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6540 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6541 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6542 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6543 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6544 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6545 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6546 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6547 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6548 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6549
6550 @table @code
6551 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6552 @item set schedule-multiple
6553 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6554 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6555 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6556 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6557 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6558 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6559
6560 @item show schedule-multiple
6561 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6562 multiple processes.
6563 @end table
6564
6565 @node Non-Stop Mode
6566 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6567
6568 @cindex non-stop mode
6569
6570 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6571 @c with more details.
6572
6573 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6574 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6575 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6576 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6577 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6578 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6579
6580 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6581 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6582 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6583 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6584 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6585 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6586 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6587 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6588 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6589 independently and simultaneously.
6590
6591 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6592 or attach to your program:
6593
6594 @smallexample
6595 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6596 set pagination off
6597
6598 # Finally, turn it on!
6599 set non-stop on
6600 @end smallexample
6601
6602 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6603
6604 @table @code
6605 @kindex set non-stop
6606 @item set non-stop on
6607 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6608 @item set non-stop off
6609 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6610 @kindex show non-stop
6611 @item show non-stop
6612 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6613 @end table
6614
6615 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6616 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6617 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6618 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6619 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6620 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6621 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6622 default.
6623
6624 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6625 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6626 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6627
6628 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6629 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6630 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6631 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6632 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6633
6634 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6635 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6636 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6637 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6638 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6639
6640 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6641
6642 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6643 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6644 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6645 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6646 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6647 previously current thread.
6648
6649 @node Background Execution
6650 @subsection Background Execution
6651
6652 @cindex foreground execution
6653 @cindex background execution
6654 @cindex asynchronous execution
6655 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6656
6657 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6658 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6659 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6660 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6661 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6662 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6663
6664 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6665 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6666
6667 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6668 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6669 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6670 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6671 are:
6672
6673 @table @code
6674 @kindex run&
6675 @item run
6676 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6677
6678 @item attach
6679 @kindex attach&
6680 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6681
6682 @item step
6683 @kindex step&
6684 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6685
6686 @item stepi
6687 @kindex stepi&
6688 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6689
6690 @item next
6691 @kindex next&
6692 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6693
6694 @item nexti
6695 @kindex nexti&
6696 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6697
6698 @item continue
6699 @kindex continue&
6700 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6701
6702 @item finish
6703 @kindex finish&
6704 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6705
6706 @item until
6707 @kindex until&
6708 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6709
6710 @end table
6711
6712 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6713 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6714 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6715 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6716 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6717 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6718
6719 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6720 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6721
6722 @table @code
6723 @kindex interrupt
6724 @item interrupt
6725 @itemx interrupt -a
6726
6727 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6728 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6729 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6730 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6731 @end table
6732
6733 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6734 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6735
6736 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6737 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6738 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6739
6740 @table @code
6741 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6742 @cindex thread breakpoints
6743 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6744 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6745 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6746 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6747 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6748 specify some source line.
6749
6750 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6751 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6752 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6753 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6754 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6755
6756 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6757 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6758 program.
6759
6760 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6761 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6762 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6763
6764 @smallexample
6765 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6766 @end smallexample
6767
6768 @end table
6769
6770 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6771 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6772 thread list. For example:
6773
6774 @smallexample
6775 (@value{GDBP}) c
6776 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6777 @end smallexample
6778
6779 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6780 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6781 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6782 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6783 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6784 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6785 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6786 command.
6787
6788 @node Interrupted System Calls
6789 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6790
6791 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6792 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6793 @cindex premature return from system calls
6794 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6795 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6796 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6797 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6798 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6799 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6800 stop execution.
6801
6802 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6803 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6804 style anyways.
6805
6806 For example, do not write code like this:
6807
6808 @smallexample
6809 sleep (10);
6810 @end smallexample
6811
6812 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6813 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6814
6815 Instead, write this:
6816
6817 @smallexample
6818 int unslept = 10;
6819 while (unslept > 0)
6820 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6821 @end smallexample
6822
6823 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6824 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6825 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6826 @value{GDBN}.
6827
6828 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6829 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6830 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6831 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6832
6833 @node Observer Mode
6834 @subsection Observer Mode
6835
6836 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6837 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6838 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6839 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6840 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6841
6842 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6843 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6844 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6845 mode.
6846
6847 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6848 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6849 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6850 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6851 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6852
6853 @table @code
6854
6855 @kindex observer
6856 @item set observer on
6857 @itemx set observer off
6858 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6859 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6860 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6861 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6862
6863 @item show observer
6864 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6865
6866 @kindex may-write-registers
6867 @item set may-write-registers on
6868 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6869 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6870 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6871 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6872
6873 @item show may-write-registers
6874 Show the current permission to write registers.
6875
6876 @kindex may-write-memory
6877 @item set may-write-memory on
6878 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6879 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6880 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6881 defaults to @code{on}.
6882
6883 @item show may-write-memory
6884 Show the current permission to write memory.
6885
6886 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6887 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6888 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6889 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6890 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6891 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6892
6893 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6894 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6895
6896 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6897 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6898 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6899 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6900 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6901 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6902 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6903
6904 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6905 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6906
6907 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6908 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6909 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6910 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6911 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6912 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6913 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6914
6915 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6916 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6917
6918 @kindex may-interrupt
6919 @item set may-interrupt on
6920 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6921 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6922 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6923 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6924 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6925
6926 @item show may-interrupt
6927 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6928
6929 @end table
6930
6931 @node Reverse Execution
6932 @chapter Running programs backward
6933 @cindex reverse execution
6934 @cindex running programs backward
6935
6936 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6937 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6938 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6939 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6940
6941 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6942 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6943 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6944 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6945 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6946 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6947
6948 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6949 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6950 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6951 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6952 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6953 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6954 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6955 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6956 prior values@footnote{
6957 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6958 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6959 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6960
6961 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6962 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6963 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6964 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6965 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6966 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6967 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6968 }.
6969
6970 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} has built-in support for reverse
6971 execution, activated with the @code{record} or @code{record btrace}
6972 commands. @xref{Process Record and Replay}. Some remote targets,
6973 typically full system emulators, support reverse execution directly
6974 without requiring any special command.
6975
6976 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6977 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6978
6979 @table @code
6980 @kindex reverse-continue
6981 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6982 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6983 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6984 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6985 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6986 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6987 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6988
6989 @kindex reverse-step
6990 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6991 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6992 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6993 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6994
6995 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6996 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6997 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6998 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6999 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
7000 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
7001
7002 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
7003 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
7004
7005 @kindex reverse-stepi
7006 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
7007 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7008 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
7009 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
7010 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
7011 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
7012 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
7013
7014 @kindex reverse-next
7015 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
7016 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7017 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
7018 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
7019 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
7020 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
7021 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
7022 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
7023 line of a function back to its return to its caller
7024 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
7025
7026 @kindex reverse-nexti
7027 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
7028 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
7029 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
7030 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
7031 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
7032 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
7033 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
7034 frame) is reached.
7035
7036 @kindex reverse-finish
7037 @item reverse-finish
7038 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
7039 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
7040 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
7041 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
7042
7043 @kindex set exec-direction
7044 @item set exec-direction
7045 Set the direction of target execution.
7046 @item set exec-direction reverse
7047 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
7048 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
7049 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
7050 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
7051 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
7052 @item set exec-direction forward
7053 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
7054 This is the default.
7055 @end table
7056
7057
7058 @node Process Record and Replay
7059 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
7060 @cindex process record and replay
7061 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
7062
7063 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
7064 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
7065 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
7066
7067 @cindex replay mode
7068 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
7069 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
7070 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
7071 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
7072 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
7073 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
7074 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
7075 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
7076 execution log.
7077
7078 @cindex record mode
7079 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
7080 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
7081 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
7082 for future replay.
7083
7084 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
7085 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
7086 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
7087 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
7088 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
7089 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
7090
7091 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
7092 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
7093 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
7094 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
7095
7096 Currently, process record and replay is supported on ARM, Aarch64,
7097 Moxie, PowerPC, PowerPC64, S/390, and x86 (i386/amd64) running
7098 GNU/Linux. Process record and replay can be used both when native
7099 debugging, and when remote debugging via @code{gdbserver}.
7100
7101 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
7102 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
7103
7104 @table @code
7105 @kindex target record
7106 @kindex target record-full
7107 @kindex target record-btrace
7108 @kindex record
7109 @kindex record full
7110 @kindex record btrace
7111 @kindex record btrace bts
7112 @kindex record btrace pt
7113 @kindex record bts
7114 @kindex record pt
7115 @kindex rec
7116 @kindex rec full
7117 @kindex rec btrace
7118 @kindex rec btrace bts
7119 @kindex rec btrace pt
7120 @kindex rec bts
7121 @kindex rec pt
7122 @item record @var{method}
7123 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
7124 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
7125 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
7126 recording methods are available:
7127
7128 @table @code
7129 @item full
7130 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
7131 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
7132 execution.
7133
7134 @item btrace @var{format}
7135 Hardware-supported instruction recording, supported on Intel
7136 processors. This method does not record data. Further, the data is
7137 collected in a ring buffer so old data will be overwritten when the
7138 buffer is full. It allows limited reverse execution. Variables and
7139 registers are not available during reverse execution. In remote
7140 debugging, recording continues on disconnect. Recorded data can be
7141 inspected after reconnecting. The recording may be stopped using
7142 @code{record stop}.
7143
7144 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
7145 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
7146 formats are available:
7147
7148 @table @code
7149 @item bts
7150 @cindex branch trace store
7151 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
7152 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
7153 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
7154
7155 @item pt
7156 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
7157 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
7158 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
7159 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
7160
7161 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
7162 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
7163 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
7164
7165 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
7166 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
7167 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
7168 buffer-size with care.
7169 @end table
7170
7171 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
7172 @end table
7173
7174 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
7175 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
7176 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
7177 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
7178
7179 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
7180 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
7181 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
7182 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
7183 doesn't support displaced stepping.
7184
7185 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
7186 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
7187 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
7188 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
7189 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
7190 does not support these two modes.
7191
7192 @kindex record stop
7193 @kindex rec s
7194 @item record stop
7195 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
7196 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
7197 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
7198
7199 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
7200 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
7201 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
7202 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
7203 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
7204
7205 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
7206 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
7207 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
7208 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
7209 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
7210
7211 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
7212 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
7213
7214 @kindex record goto
7215 @item record goto
7216 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
7217 ways to specify the location to go to:
7218
7219 @table @code
7220 @item record goto begin
7221 @itemx record goto start
7222 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
7223
7224 @item record goto end
7225 Go to the end of the execution log.
7226
7227 @item record goto @var{n}
7228 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
7229 @end table
7230
7231 @kindex record save
7232 @item record save @var{filename}
7233 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
7234 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
7235 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
7236
7237 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7238
7239 @kindex record restore
7240 @item record restore @var{filename}
7241 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
7242 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
7243
7244 @kindex set record full
7245 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
7246 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
7247 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
7248 recording method. Default value is 200000.
7249
7250 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
7251 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
7252 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
7253 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
7254 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
7255 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
7256 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
7257 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
7258
7259 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
7260 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
7261 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
7262
7263 @kindex show record full
7264 @item show record full insn-number-max
7265 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
7266 recording method.
7267
7268 @item set record full stop-at-limit
7269 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
7270 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
7271 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
7272 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
7273 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
7274 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
7275 oldest one to be deleted.
7276
7277 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
7278 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
7279
7280 @item show record full stop-at-limit
7281 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
7282
7283 @item set record full memory-query
7284 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
7285 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
7286 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
7287 case.
7288
7289 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
7290 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
7291 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
7292 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
7293 results.
7294
7295 @item show record full memory-query
7296 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
7297
7298 @kindex set record btrace
7299 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
7300 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
7301 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
7302 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
7303 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7304 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7305 You can use the following command for that:
7306
7307 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7308 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7309 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7310 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7311 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7312 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7313 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7314 position.
7315
7316 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7317 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7318 errata when decoding the trace.
7319
7320 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7321 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7322 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7323 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7324 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7325 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7326 which the trace was recorded.
7327
7328 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7329 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7330 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7331 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7332 disable the workarounds.
7333
7334 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7335 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7336 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7337 (default).
7338
7339 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7340 identifiers are currently supported:
7341
7342 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7343
7344 @item @code{intel}
7345 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7346
7347 @end multitable
7348
7349 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7350 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7351
7352 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7353 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7354 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7355
7356 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7357 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7358 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7359 supports.
7360
7361 @smallexample
7362 (gdb) info record
7363 Active record target: record-btrace
7364 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7365 Buffer size: 16kB.
7366 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7367 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7368 (gdb) info record
7369 Active record target: record-btrace
7370 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7371 Buffer size: 16kB.
7372 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7373 @end smallexample
7374
7375 @kindex show record btrace
7376 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7377 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7378
7379 @item show record btrace cpu
7380 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7381 workarounds.
7382
7383 @kindex set record btrace bts
7384 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7385 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7386 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7387 format. Default is 64KB.
7388
7389 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7390 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7391 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7392 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7393 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7394 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7395 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7396
7397 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7398 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7399
7400 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7401 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7402
7403 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7404 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7405 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7406
7407 @kindex set record btrace pt
7408 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7409 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7410 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7411 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7412
7413 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7414 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7415 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7416 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7417 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7418 actual buffer size for each thread.
7419
7420 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7421 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7422
7423 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7424 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7425
7426 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7427 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7428 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7429
7430 @kindex info record
7431 @item info record
7432 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7433 method:
7434
7435 @table @code
7436 @item full
7437 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7438 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7439
7440 @itemize @bullet
7441 @item
7442 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7443 @item
7444 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7445 @item
7446 Highest recorded instruction number.
7447 @item
7448 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7449 @item
7450 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7451 @item
7452 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7453 @end itemize
7454
7455 @item btrace
7456 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7457
7458 @itemize @bullet
7459 @item
7460 Recording format.
7461 @item
7462 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7463 @item
7464 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7465 instructions.
7466 @item
7467 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7468 @end itemize
7469
7470 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7471 @itemize @bullet
7472 @item
7473 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7474 @end itemize
7475
7476 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7477 @itemize @bullet
7478 @item
7479 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7480 @end itemize
7481 @end table
7482
7483 @kindex record delete
7484 @kindex rec del
7485 @item record delete
7486 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7487 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7488 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7489 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7490
7491 @kindex record instruction-history
7492 @kindex rec instruction-history
7493 @item record instruction-history
7494 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7495 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7496 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7497 are printed in execution order.
7498
7499 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7500 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7501 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7502
7503 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7504 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7505 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7506 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7507 @code{/p} modifier.
7508
7509 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7510 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7511 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7512
7513 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7514 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7515
7516 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7517 disassemble:
7518
7519 @table @code
7520 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7521 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7522 @var{insn}.
7523
7524 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7525 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7526 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7527 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7528 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7529 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7530
7531 @item record instruction-history
7532 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7533
7534 @item record instruction-history -
7535 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7536
7537 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7538 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7539 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7540 number @var{end} is included.
7541 @end table
7542
7543 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7544
7545 @kindex set record
7546 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7547 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7548 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7549 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7550 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7551
7552 @kindex show record
7553 @item show record instruction-history-size
7554 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7555 instruction-history} command.
7556
7557 @kindex record function-call-history
7558 @kindex rec function-call-history
7559 @item record function-call-history
7560 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7561 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7562 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7563 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7564 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7565 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7566 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7567 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7568 given together.
7569
7570 @smallexample
7571 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7572 1 void foo (void)
7573 2 @{
7574 3 @}
7575 4
7576 5 void bar (void)
7577 6 @{
7578 7 ...
7579 8 foo ();
7580 9 ...
7581 10 @}
7582 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7583 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7584 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7585 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7586 @end smallexample
7587
7588 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7589 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7590 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7591 to print:
7592
7593 @table @code
7594 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7595 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7596
7597 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7598 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7599 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7600 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7601 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7602
7603 @item record function-call-history
7604 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7605
7606 @item record function-call-history -
7607 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7608
7609 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7610 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7611 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7612 @end table
7613
7614 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7615
7616 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7617 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7618 Define how many lines to print in the
7619 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7620 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7621
7622 @item show record function-call-history-size
7623 Show how many lines to print in the
7624 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7625 @end table
7626
7627
7628 @node Stack
7629 @chapter Examining the Stack
7630
7631 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7632 stopped and how it got there.
7633
7634 @cindex call stack
7635 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7636 is generated.
7637 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7638 the arguments of the call,
7639 and the local variables of the function being called.
7640 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7641 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7642 stack}.
7643
7644 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7645 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7646
7647 @cindex selected frame
7648 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7649 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7650 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7651 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7652 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7653 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7654
7655 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7656 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7657 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7658
7659 @menu
7660 * Frames:: Stack frames
7661 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7662 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7663 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7664 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7665 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7666
7667 @end menu
7668
7669 @node Frames
7670 @section Stack Frames
7671
7672 @cindex frame, definition
7673 @cindex stack frame
7674 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7675 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7676 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7677 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7678 which the function is executing.
7679
7680 @cindex initial frame
7681 @cindex outermost frame
7682 @cindex innermost frame
7683 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7684 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7685 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7686 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7687 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7688 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7689 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7690 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7691
7692 @cindex frame pointer
7693 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7694 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7695 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7696 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7697 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7698 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7699
7700 @cindex frame level
7701 @cindex frame number
7702 @value{GDBN} labels each existing stack frame with a @dfn{level}, a
7703 number that is zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that
7704 called it, and so on upward. These level numbers give you a way of
7705 designating stack frames in @value{GDBN} commands. The terms
7706 @dfn{frame number} and @dfn{frame level} can be used interchangeably to
7707 describe this number.
7708
7709 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7710 @c underflow problems.
7711 @cindex frameless execution
7712 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7713 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7714 @smallexample
7715 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7716 @end smallexample
7717 generates functions without a frame.)
7718 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7719 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7720 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7721 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7722 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7723 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7724 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7725
7726 @node Backtrace
7727 @section Backtraces
7728
7729 @cindex traceback
7730 @cindex call stack traces
7731 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7732 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7733 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7734 stack.
7735
7736 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7737 @kindex backtrace
7738 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7739 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7740 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7741 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7742 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7743 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7744
7745 @table @code
7746 @item backtrace [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{qualifier}]@dots{} [@var{count}]
7747 @itemx bt [@var{option}]@dots{} [@var{qualifier}]@dots{} [@var{count}]
7748 Print the backtrace of the entire stack.
7749
7750 The optional @var{count} can be one of the following:
7751
7752 @table @code
7753 @item @var{n}
7754 @itemx @var{n}
7755 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7756 number.
7757
7758 @item -@var{n}
7759 @itemx -@var{n}
7760 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7761 number.
7762 @end table
7763
7764 Options:
7765
7766 @table @code
7767 @item -full
7768 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7769 with the optional @var{count} to limit the number of frames shown.
7770
7771 @item -no-filters
7772 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7773 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7774 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7775 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7776 support.
7777
7778 @item -hide
7779 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7780 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7781 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{-hide}
7782 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7783 @end table
7784
7785 The @code{backtrace} command also supports a number of options that
7786 allow overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set
7787 backtrace} and @code{set print} subcommands:
7788
7789 @table @code
7790 @item -past-main [@code{on}|@code{off}]
7791 Set whether backtraces should continue past @code{main}. Related setting:
7792 @ref{set backtrace past-main}.
7793
7794 @item -past-entry [@code{on}|@code{off}]
7795 Set whether backtraces should continue past the entry point of a program.
7796 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-entry}.
7797
7798 @item -entry-values @code{no}|@code{only}|@code{preferred}|@code{if-needed}|@code{both}|@code{compact}|@code{default}
7799 Set printing of function arguments at function entry.
7800 Related setting: @ref{set print entry-values}.
7801
7802 @item -frame-arguments @code{all}|@code{scalars}|@code{none}
7803 Set printing of non-scalar frame arguments.
7804 Related setting: @ref{set print frame-arguments}.
7805
7806 @item -raw-frame-arguments [@code{on}|@code{off}]
7807 Set whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
7808 Related setting: @ref{set print raw-frame-arguments}.
7809
7810 @item -frame-info @code{auto}|@code{source-line}|@code{location}|@code{source-and-location}|@code{location-and-address}|@code{short-location}
7811 Set printing of frame information.
7812 Related setting: @ref{set print frame-info}.
7813 @end table
7814
7815 The optional @var{qualifier} is maintained for backward compatibility.
7816 It can be one of the following:
7817
7818 @table @code
7819 @item full
7820 Equivalent to the @code{-full} option.
7821
7822 @item no-filters
7823 Equivalent to the @code{-no-filters} option.
7824
7825 @item hide
7826 Equivalent to the @code{-hide} option.
7827 @end table
7828
7829 @end table
7830
7831 @kindex where
7832 @kindex info stack
7833 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7834 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7835
7836 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7837 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7838 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7839 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7840 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7841 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7842 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7843 multi-threaded program.
7844
7845 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7846 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7847 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7848 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7849 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7850 line number.
7851
7852 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7853 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7854
7855 @smallexample
7856 @group
7857 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7858 at builtin.c:993
7859 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7860 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7861 at macro.c:71
7862 (More stack frames follow...)
7863 @end group
7864 @end smallexample
7865
7866 @noindent
7867 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7868 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7869 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7870
7871 @noindent
7872 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7873 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7874 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7875 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7876 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7877 The command @kbd{set print frame-info} (@pxref{Print Settings}) controls
7878 what frame information is printed.
7879
7880 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7881 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7882 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7883 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7884 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7885 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7886 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7887 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7888 such a backtrace might look like:
7889
7890 @smallexample
7891 @group
7892 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7893 at builtin.c:993
7894 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7895 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7896 at macro.c:71
7897 (More stack frames follow...)
7898 @end group
7899 @end smallexample
7900
7901 @noindent
7902 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7903 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7904
7905 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7906 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7907 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7908
7909 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7910 @cindex program entry point
7911 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7912 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7913 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7914 @code{main}@footnote{
7915 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7916 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7917 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7918 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7919 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7920 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7921
7922 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7923 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7924
7925 @table @code
7926 @item set backtrace past-main
7927 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7928 @anchor{set backtrace past-main}
7929 @kindex set backtrace
7930 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7931
7932 @item set backtrace past-main off
7933 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7934 default.
7935
7936 @item show backtrace past-main
7937 @kindex show backtrace
7938 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7939
7940 @item set backtrace past-entry
7941 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7942 @anchor{set backtrace past-entry}
7943 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7944 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7945 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7946
7947 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7948 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7949 application. This is the default.
7950
7951 @item show backtrace past-entry
7952 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7953
7954 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7955 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7956 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7957 @anchor{set backtrace limit}
7958 @cindex backtrace limit
7959 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7960 or zero means unlimited levels.
7961
7962 @item show backtrace limit
7963 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7964 @end table
7965
7966 You can control how file names are displayed.
7967
7968 @table @code
7969 @item set filename-display
7970 @itemx set filename-display relative
7971 @cindex filename-display
7972 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7973
7974 @item set filename-display basename
7975 Display only basename of a filename.
7976
7977 @item set filename-display absolute
7978 Display an absolute filename.
7979
7980 @item show filename-display
7981 Show the current way to display filenames.
7982 @end table
7983
7984 @node Selection
7985 @section Selecting a Frame
7986
7987 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7988 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7989 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7990 of the stack frame just selected.
7991
7992 @table @code
7993 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7994 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7995 @item frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7996 @item f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
7997 The @command{frame} command allows different stack frames to be
7998 selected. The @var{frame-selection-spec} can be any of the following:
7999
8000 @table @code
8001 @kindex frame level
8002 @item @var{num}
8003 @item level @var{num}
8004 Select frame level @var{num}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
8005 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
8006 innermost one, and so on. The highest level frame is usually the one
8007 for @code{main}.
8008
8009 As this is the most common method of navigating the frame stack, the
8010 string @command{level} can be omitted. For example, the following two
8011 commands are equivalent:
8012
8013 @smallexample
8014 (@value{GDBP}) frame 3
8015 (@value{GDBP}) frame level 3
8016 @end smallexample
8017
8018 @kindex frame address
8019 @item address @var{stack-address}
8020 Select the frame with stack address @var{stack-address}. The
8021 @var{stack-address} for a frame can be seen in the output of
8022 @command{info frame}, for example:
8023
8024 @smallexample
8025 (gdb) info frame
8026 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
8027 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
8028 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
8029 source language c++.
8030 Arglist at unknown address.
8031 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
8032 @end smallexample
8033
8034 The @var{stack-address} for this frame is @code{0x7fffffffda30} as
8035 indicated by the line:
8036
8037 @smallexample
8038 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
8039 @end smallexample
8040
8041 @kindex frame function
8042 @item function @var{function-name}
8043 Select the stack frame for function @var{function-name}. If there are
8044 multiple stack frames for function @var{function-name} then the inner
8045 most stack frame is selected.
8046
8047 @kindex frame view
8048 @item view @var{stack-address} @r{[} @var{pc-addr} @r{]}
8049 View a frame that is not part of @value{GDBN}'s backtrace. The frame
8050 viewed has stack address @var{stack-addr}, and optionally, a program
8051 counter address of @var{pc-addr}.
8052
8053 This is useful mainly if the chaining of stack frames has been
8054 damaged by a bug, making it impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign
8055 numbers properly to all frames. In addition, this can be useful
8056 when your program has multiple stacks and switches between them.
8057
8058 When viewing a frame outside the current backtrace using
8059 @command{frame view} then you can always return to the original
8060 stack using one of the previous stack frame selection instructions,
8061 for example @command{frame level 0}.
8062
8063 @end table
8064
8065 @kindex up
8066 @item up @var{n}
8067 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
8068 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
8069 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
8070
8071 @kindex down
8072 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
8073 @item down @var{n}
8074 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
8075 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
8076 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
8077 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
8078 @end table
8079
8080 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
8081 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
8082 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
8083 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
8084
8085 @need 1000
8086 For example:
8087
8088 @smallexample
8089 @group
8090 (@value{GDBP}) up
8091 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
8092 at env.c:10
8093 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
8094 @end group
8095 @end smallexample
8096
8097 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
8098 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
8099 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
8100 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
8101 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
8102 for details.
8103
8104 @table @code
8105 @kindex select-frame
8106 @item select-frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8107 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
8108 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
8109 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
8110 output might be unnecessary and distracting. The
8111 @var{frame-selection-spec} is as for the @command{frame} command
8112 described in @ref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
8113
8114 @kindex down-silently
8115 @kindex up-silently
8116 @item up-silently @var{n}
8117 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
8118 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
8119 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
8120 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
8121 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
8122 distracting.
8123 @end table
8124
8125 @node Frame Info
8126 @section Information About a Frame
8127
8128 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
8129 stack frame.
8130
8131 @table @code
8132 @item frame
8133 @itemx f
8134 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
8135 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
8136 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
8137 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
8138 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
8139
8140 @kindex info frame
8141 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
8142 @item info frame
8143 @itemx info f
8144 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
8145 including:
8146
8147 @itemize @bullet
8148 @item
8149 the address of the frame
8150 @item
8151 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
8152 @item
8153 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
8154 @item
8155 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
8156 @item
8157 the address of the frame's arguments
8158 @item
8159 the address of the frame's local variables
8160 @item
8161 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
8162 @item
8163 which registers were saved in the frame
8164 @end itemize
8165
8166 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
8167 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
8168 the usual conventions.
8169
8170 @item info frame @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8171 @itemx info f @r{[} @var{frame-selection-spec} @r{]}
8172 Print a verbose description of the frame selected by
8173 @var{frame-selection-spec}. The @var{frame-selection-spec} is the
8174 same as for the @command{frame} command (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting
8175 a Frame}). The selected frame remains unchanged by this command.
8176
8177 @kindex info args
8178 @item info args [-q]
8179 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
8180
8181 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
8182 printing header information and messages explaining why no argument
8183 have been printed.
8184
8185 @item info args [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
8186 Like @kbd{info args}, but only print the arguments selected
8187 with the provided regexp(s).
8188
8189 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose names
8190 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
8191
8192 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the arguments whose
8193 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
8194 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
8195 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
8196 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
8197 of special characters or quotes.
8198
8199 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
8200 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
8201 @var{type_regexp}.
8202
8203 @item info locals [-q]
8204 @kindex info locals
8205 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
8206 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
8207 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
8208
8209 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
8210 printing header information and messages explaining why no local variables
8211 have been printed.
8212
8213 @item info locals [-q] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
8214 Like @kbd{info locals}, but only print the local variables selected
8215 with the provided regexp(s).
8216
8217 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose names
8218 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
8219
8220 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the local variables whose
8221 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
8222 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
8223 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
8224 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
8225 of special characters or quotes.
8226
8227 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a local variable
8228 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
8229 @var{type_regexp}.
8230
8231 The command @kbd{info locals -q -t @var{type_regexp}} can usefully be
8232 combined with the commands @kbd{frame apply} and @kbd{thread apply}.
8233 For example, your program might use Resource Acquisition Is
8234 Initialization types (RAII) such as @code{lock_something_t}: each
8235 local variable of type @code{lock_something_t} automatically places a
8236 lock that is destroyed when the variable goes out of scope. You can
8237 then list all acquired locks in your program by doing
8238 @smallexample
8239 thread apply all -s frame apply all -s info locals -q -t lock_something_t
8240 @end smallexample
8241 @noindent
8242 or the equivalent shorter form
8243 @smallexample
8244 tfaas i lo -q -t lock_something_t
8245 @end smallexample
8246
8247 @end table
8248
8249 @node Frame Apply
8250 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
8251 @anchor{frame apply}
8252 @kindex frame apply
8253 @cindex apply command to several frames
8254 @table @code
8255 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{option}]@dots{} @var{command}
8256 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
8257 @var{command} to one or more frames.
8258
8259 @table @code
8260 @item @code{all}
8261 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
8262
8263 @item @var{count}
8264 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
8265 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
8266
8267 @item @var{-count}
8268 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
8269 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
8270
8271 @item @code{level}
8272 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
8273 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
8274 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
8275 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
8276 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
8277 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
8278
8279 @end table
8280
8281 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
8282 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
8283 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}.
8284 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
8285
8286 The @code{frame apply} command also supports a number of options that
8287 allow overriding relevant @code{set backtrace} settings:
8288
8289 @table @code
8290 @item -past-main [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8291 Whether backtraces should continue past @code{main}.
8292 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-main}.
8293
8294 @item -past-entry [@code{on}|@code{off}]
8295 Whether backtraces should continue past the entry point of a program.
8296 Related setting: @ref{set backtrace past-entry}.
8297 @end table
8298
8299 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
8300 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
8301 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
8302 following options can be used to fine-tune these behaviors:
8303
8304 @table @code
8305 @item -c
8306 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
8307 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
8308 @code{frame apply} then continues.
8309 @item -s
8310 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
8311 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
8312 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
8313 are not printed.
8314 @item -q
8315 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
8316 information.
8317 @end table
8318
8319 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
8320 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
8321 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
8322 @code{#1 main} frame.
8323
8324 @smallexample
8325 @group
8326 (gdb) frame apply all p j
8327 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8328 No symbol "j" in current context.
8329 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
8330 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8331 No symbol "j" in current context.
8332 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8333 $1 = 5
8334 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
8335 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8336 $2 = 5
8337 (gdb)
8338 @end group
8339 @end smallexample
8340
8341 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
8342 information before the command output:
8343
8344 @smallexample
8345 @group
8346 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
8347 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
8348 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8349 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
8350 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8351 (gdb)
8352 @end group
8353 @end smallexample
8354
8355 If the flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
8356 @smallexample
8357 @group
8358 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
8359 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
8360 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
8361 (gdb)
8362 @end group
8363 @end smallexample
8364
8365 @end table
8366
8367 @table @code
8368
8369 @kindex faas
8370 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
8371 @item faas @var{command}
8372 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
8373 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
8374
8375 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
8376 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
8377 is, using:
8378 @smallexample
8379 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
8380 @end smallexample
8381
8382 The @code{faas} command accepts the same options as the @code{frame
8383 apply} command. @xref{frame apply}.
8384
8385 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
8386 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
8387 @end table
8388
8389
8390 @node Frame Filter Management
8391 @section Management of Frame Filters.
8392 @cindex managing frame filters
8393
8394 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
8395 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
8396
8397 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
8398 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
8399
8400 @table @code
8401 @kindex info frame-filter
8402 @item info frame-filter
8403 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
8404 their name, priority and enabled status.
8405
8406 @kindex disable frame-filter
8407 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
8408 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8409 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8410 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8411 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8412 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8413 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
8414 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
8415 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8416 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
8417 may be enabled again later.
8418
8419 @kindex enable frame-filter
8420 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8421 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8422 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
8423 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
8424 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8425 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
8426 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
8427 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
8428 @var{filter-dictionary}.
8429
8430 Example:
8431
8432 @smallexample
8433 (gdb) info frame-filter
8434
8435 global frame-filters:
8436 Priority Enabled Name
8437 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8438 100 Yes Reverse
8439
8440 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8441 Priority Enabled Name
8442 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8443
8444 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8445 Priority Enabled Name
8446 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
8447
8448 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
8449 (gdb) info frame-filter
8450
8451 global frame-filters:
8452 Priority Enabled Name
8453 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
8454 100 Yes Reverse
8455
8456 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8457 Priority Enabled Name
8458 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8459
8460 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8461 Priority Enabled Name
8462 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8463
8464 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
8465 (gdb) info frame-filter
8466
8467 global frame-filters:
8468 Priority Enabled Name
8469 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8470 100 Yes Reverse
8471
8472 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8473 Priority Enabled Name
8474 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8475
8476 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8477 Priority Enabled Name
8478 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8479 @end smallexample
8480
8481 @kindex set frame-filter priority
8482 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
8483 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8484 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8485 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8486 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8487 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8488
8489 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8490 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8491 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8492 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8493 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8494 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8495 dictionary resides.
8496
8497 Example:
8498
8499 @smallexample
8500 (gdb) info frame-filter
8501
8502 global frame-filters:
8503 Priority Enabled Name
8504 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8505 100 Yes Reverse
8506
8507 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8508 Priority Enabled Name
8509 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8510
8511 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8512 Priority Enabled Name
8513 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8514
8515 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8516 (gdb) info frame-filter
8517
8518 global frame-filters:
8519 Priority Enabled Name
8520 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8521 50 Yes Reverse
8522
8523 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8524 Priority Enabled Name
8525 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8526
8527 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8528 Priority Enabled Name
8529 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8530 @end smallexample
8531 @end table
8532
8533 @node Source
8534 @chapter Examining Source Files
8535
8536 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8537 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8538 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8539 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8540 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8541 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8542 source files by explicit command.
8543
8544 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8545 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8546 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8547
8548 @menu
8549 * List:: Printing source lines
8550 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8551 * Edit:: Editing source files
8552 * Search:: Searching source files
8553 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8554 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8555 @end menu
8556
8557 @node List
8558 @section Printing Source Lines
8559
8560 @kindex list
8561 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8562 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8563 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8564 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8565 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8566
8567 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8568
8569 @table @code
8570 @item list @var{linenum}
8571 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8572 current source file.
8573
8574 @item list @var{function}
8575 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8576 @var{function}.
8577
8578 @item list
8579 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8580 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8581 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8582 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8583 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8584
8585 @item list -
8586 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8587 @end table
8588
8589 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8590 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8591 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8592
8593 @table @code
8594 @kindex set listsize
8595 @item set listsize @var{count}
8596 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8597 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8598 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8599 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8600
8601 @kindex show listsize
8602 @item show listsize
8603 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8604 @end table
8605
8606 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8607 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8608 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8609 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8610 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8611
8612 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8613 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8614 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8615 to specify some source line.
8616
8617 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8618
8619 @table @code
8620 @item list @var{location}
8621 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8622
8623 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8624 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8625 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8626 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8627 the same source file as the first location.
8628
8629 @item list ,@var{last}
8630 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8631
8632 @item list @var{first},
8633 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8634
8635 @item list +
8636 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8637
8638 @item list -
8639 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8640
8641 @item list
8642 As described in the preceding table.
8643 @end table
8644
8645 @node Specify Location
8646 @section Specifying a Location
8647 @cindex specifying location
8648 @cindex location
8649 @cindex source location
8650
8651 @menu
8652 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8653 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8654 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8655 @end menu
8656
8657 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8658 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8659 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8660 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8661 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8662
8663 @node Linespec Locations
8664 @subsection Linespec Locations
8665 @cindex linespec locations
8666
8667 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8668 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8669 specifying a linespec:
8670
8671 @table @code
8672 @item @var{linenum}
8673 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8674
8675 @item -@var{offset}
8676 @itemx +@var{offset}
8677 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8678 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8679 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8680 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8681 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8682 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8683 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8684 linespec.
8685
8686 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8687 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8688 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8689 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8690 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8691 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8692 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8693
8694 @item @var{function}
8695 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8696 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8697
8698 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8699 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8700 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8701 means in all packages.
8702
8703 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8704 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8705 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8706
8707 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8708 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8709 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8710 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8711
8712 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8713
8714 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8715 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8716
8717 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8718 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8719 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8720 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8721 functions in different source files.
8722
8723 @item @var{label}
8724 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8725 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8726 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8727 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8728
8729 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8730 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8731 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8732 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8733 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8734 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8735
8736 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8737 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8738 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8739 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8740 each one of those probes.
8741 @end table
8742
8743 @node Explicit Locations
8744 @subsection Explicit Locations
8745 @cindex explicit locations
8746
8747 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8748 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8749
8750 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8751 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8752 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8753 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8754 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8755
8756 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8757 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8758 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8759 the symbol table to know.
8760
8761 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8762 following table:
8763
8764 @table @code
8765 @item -source @var{filename}
8766 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8767 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8768 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8769 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8770 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8771
8772 @item -function @var{function}
8773 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8774 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8775 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8776 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8777
8778 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8779 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8780 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8781 means in all packages.
8782
8783 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8784 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8785 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8786 breakpoint on both symbols.
8787
8788 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8789
8790 @item -qualified
8791
8792 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8793 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8794
8795 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8796 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8797 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8798
8799 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8800 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8801 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8802
8803 @item -label @var{label}
8804 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8805 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8806 selected stack frame.
8807
8808 @item -line @var{number}
8809 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8810 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8811 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8812 relative to the current line.
8813 @end table
8814
8815 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8816 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8817
8818 @node Address Locations
8819 @subsection Address Locations
8820 @cindex address locations
8821
8822 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8823 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8824
8825 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8826 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8827 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8828 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8829 source files.
8830
8831 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8832 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8833 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8834 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8835 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8836 of @var{address}:
8837
8838 @table @code
8839 @item @var{expression}
8840 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8841
8842 @item @var{funcaddr}
8843 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8844 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8845 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8846 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8847 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8848 (although the Pascal form also works).
8849
8850 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8851 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8852
8853 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8854 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8855 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8856 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8857 functions with identical names in different source files.
8858 @end table
8859
8860 @node Edit
8861 @section Editing Source Files
8862 @cindex editing source files
8863
8864 @kindex edit
8865 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8866 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8867 The editing program of your choice
8868 is invoked with the current line set to
8869 the active line in the program.
8870 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8871 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8872
8873 @table @code
8874 @item edit @var{location}
8875 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8876 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8877 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8878 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8879 command most commonly used:
8880
8881 @table @code
8882 @item edit @var{number}
8883 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8884
8885 @item edit @var{function}
8886 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8887 @end table
8888
8889 @end table
8890
8891 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8892 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8893 @footnote{
8894 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8895 following command-line syntax:
8896 @smallexample
8897 ex +@var{number} file
8898 @end smallexample
8899 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8900 the file where to start editing.}.
8901 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8902 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8903 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8904 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8905 @smallexample
8906 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8907 export EDITOR
8908 gdb @dots{}
8909 @end smallexample
8910 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8911 @smallexample
8912 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8913 gdb @dots{}
8914 @end smallexample
8915
8916 @node Search
8917 @section Searching Source Files
8918 @cindex searching source files
8919
8920 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8921 regular expression.
8922
8923 @table @code
8924 @kindex search
8925 @kindex forward-search
8926 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8927 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8928 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8929 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8930 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8931 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8932 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8933 @code{fo}.
8934
8935 @kindex reverse-search
8936 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8937 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8938 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8939 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8940 this command as @code{rev}.
8941 @end table
8942
8943 @node Source Path
8944 @section Specifying Source Directories
8945
8946 @cindex source path
8947 @cindex directories for source files
8948 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8949 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8950 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8951 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8952 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8953 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8954 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8955
8956 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8957 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, does not record a compilation
8958 directory, and the @dfn{source path} is @file{/mnt/cross}.
8959 @value{GDBN} would look for the source file in the following
8960 locations:
8961
8962 @enumerate
8963
8964 @item @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
8965 @item @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
8966 @item @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}
8967
8968 @end enumerate
8969
8970 If the source file is not present at any of the above locations then
8971 an error is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8972 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8973 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8974 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8975 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8976 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8977
8978 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8979 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above,
8980 except that non-absolute file names are not looked up literally. If
8981 the @dfn{source path} is @file{/mnt/cross}, the source file is
8982 recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, and no compilation directory is
8983 recorded, then @value{GDBN} will search in the following locations:
8984
8985 @enumerate
8986
8987 @item @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}
8988 @item @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}
8989
8990 @end enumerate
8991
8992 @kindex cdir
8993 @kindex cwd
8994 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8995 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8996 @cindex compilation directory
8997 @cindex current directory
8998 @cindex working directory
8999 @cindex directory, current
9000 @cindex directory, compilation
9001 The @dfn{source path} will always include two special entries
9002 @samp{$cdir} and @samp{$cwd}, these refer to the compilation directory
9003 (if one is recorded) and the current working directory respectively.
9004
9005 @samp{$cdir} causes @value{GDBN} to search within the compilation
9006 directory, if one is recorded in the debug information. If no
9007 compilation directory is recorded in the debug information then
9008 @samp{$cdir} is ignored.
9009
9010 @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former tracks the
9011 current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
9012 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
9013 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
9014
9015 If a compilation directory is recorded in the debug information, and
9016 @value{GDBN} has not found the source file after the first search
9017 using @dfn{source path}, then @value{GDBN} will combine the
9018 compilation directory and the filename, and then search for the source
9019 file again using the @dfn{source path}.
9020
9021 For example, if the executable records the source file as
9022 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, the compilation directory is
9023 recorded as @file{/project/build}, and the @dfn{source path} is
9024 @file{/mnt/cross:$cdir:$cwd} while the current working directory of
9025 the @value{GDBN} session is @file{/home/user}, then @value{GDBN} will
9026 search for the source file in the following loctions:
9027
9028 @enumerate
9029
9030 @item @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9031 @item @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9032 @item @file{/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9033 @item @file{/home/user/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9034 @item @file{/mnt/cross/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9035 @item @file{/project/build/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9036 @item @file{/home/user/project/build/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}
9037 @item @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9038 @item @file{/project/build/foo.c}
9039 @item @file{/home/user/foo.c}
9040
9041 @end enumerate
9042
9043 If the file name in the previous example had been recorded in the
9044 executable as a relative path rather than an absolute path, then the
9045 first look up would not have occurred, but all of the remaining steps
9046 would be similar.
9047
9048 When searching for source files on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where
9049 absolute paths start with a drive letter (e.g.
9050 @file{C:/project/foo.c}), @value{GDBN} will remove the drive letter
9051 from the file name before appending it to a search directory from
9052 @dfn{source path}; for instance if the executable references the
9053 source file @file{C:/project/foo.c} and @dfn{source path} is set to
9054 @file{D:/mnt/cross}, then @value{GDBN} will search in the following
9055 locations for the source file:
9056
9057 @enumerate
9058
9059 @item @file{C:/project/foo.c}
9060 @item @file{D:/mnt/cross/project/foo.c}
9061 @item @file{D:/mnt/cross/foo.c}
9062
9063 @end enumerate
9064
9065 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
9066 source files.
9067
9068 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
9069 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
9070 each line is in the file.
9071
9072 @kindex directory
9073 @kindex dir
9074 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{$cdir}
9075 and @samp{$cwd}, in that order.
9076 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
9077
9078 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
9079 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
9080
9081 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
9082 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
9083 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
9084 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
9085 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
9086 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
9087 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
9088 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
9089 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
9090 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
9091 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
9092 name to look up the sources.
9093
9094 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
9095 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
9096 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
9097 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
9098 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
9099 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
9100 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
9101 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
9102
9103 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
9104 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
9105 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
9106 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
9107 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
9108 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
9109 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
9110
9111 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
9112 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
9113 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
9114 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
9115 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
9116 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
9117 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
9118 command.
9119
9120 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
9121 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
9122 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
9123 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
9124 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
9125 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
9126 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
9127
9128 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
9129 @cindex default source path substitution
9130 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
9131 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
9132 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
9133 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
9134 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
9135 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
9136 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
9137 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
9138 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
9139 together.
9140
9141 @table @code
9142 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
9143 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
9144 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
9145 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
9146 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
9147 part of absolute file names) or
9148 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
9149 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
9150
9151 The special strings @samp{$cdir} (to refer to the compilation
9152 directory, if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} (to refer to the
9153 current working directory) can also be included in the list of
9154 directories @var{dirname}. Though these will already be in the source
9155 path they will be moved forward in the list so @value{GDBN} searches
9156 them sooner.
9157
9158 @item directory
9159 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
9160
9161 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
9162 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
9163
9164 @item set directories @var{path-list}
9165 @kindex set directories
9166 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
9167 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
9168
9169 @item show directories
9170 @kindex show directories
9171 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
9172
9173 @anchor{set substitute-path}
9174 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
9175 @kindex set substitute-path
9176 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
9177 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
9178 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
9179
9180 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
9181 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
9182
9183 @smallexample
9184 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
9185 @end smallexample
9186
9187 @noindent
9188 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
9189 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
9190 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
9191
9192 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
9193 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
9194 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
9195 the substitution.
9196
9197 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
9198
9199 @smallexample
9200 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
9201 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
9202 @end smallexample
9203
9204 @noindent
9205 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
9206 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
9207 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
9208 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
9209
9210
9211 @item unset substitute-path [path]
9212 @kindex unset substitute-path
9213 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
9214 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
9215 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
9216
9217 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
9218
9219 @item show substitute-path [path]
9220 @kindex show substitute-path
9221 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
9222 which would rewrite that path, if any.
9223
9224 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
9225 rules.
9226
9227 @end table
9228
9229 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
9230 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
9231 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
9232
9233 @enumerate
9234 @item
9235 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
9236
9237 @item
9238 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
9239 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
9240 directories in one command.
9241 @end enumerate
9242
9243 @node Machine Code
9244 @section Source and Machine Code
9245 @cindex source line and its code address
9246
9247 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
9248 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
9249 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
9250 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
9251 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
9252 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
9253 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
9254 well as hex.
9255
9256 @table @code
9257 @kindex info line
9258 @item info line
9259 @itemx info line @var{location}
9260 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
9261 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
9262 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
9263 information about the current source line is printed.
9264 @end table
9265
9266 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
9267 the object code for the first line of function
9268 @code{m4_changequote}:
9269
9270 @smallexample
9271 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
9272 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
9273 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
9274 @end smallexample
9275
9276 @noindent
9277 @cindex code address and its source line
9278 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
9279 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
9280 @smallexample
9281 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
9282 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
9283 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
9284 @end smallexample
9285
9286 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
9287 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
9288 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
9289 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
9290 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
9291 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
9292 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
9293 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9294 Variables}).
9295
9296 @cindex info line, repeated calls
9297 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
9298 specifying a location will display information about the next source
9299 line.
9300
9301 @table @code
9302 @kindex disassemble
9303 @cindex assembly instructions
9304 @cindex instructions, assembly
9305 @cindex machine instructions
9306 @cindex listing machine instructions
9307 @item disassemble
9308 @itemx disassemble /m
9309 @itemx disassemble /s
9310 @itemx disassemble /r
9311 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
9312 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
9313 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
9314 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
9315 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
9316 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
9317 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
9318 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
9319 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
9320 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
9321
9322 @table @code
9323 @item @var{start},@var{end}
9324 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
9325 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
9326 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
9327 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
9328 @end table
9329
9330 @noindent
9331 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
9332 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
9333
9334 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
9335 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
9336
9337 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
9338 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
9339 @end table
9340
9341 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
9342 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
9343
9344 @smallexample
9345 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
9346 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
9347 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
9348 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
9349 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
9350 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
9351 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
9352 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
9353 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
9354 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
9355 End of assembler dump.
9356 @end smallexample
9357
9358 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
9359 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
9360 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
9361
9362 @smallexample
9363 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
9364 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9365 5 @{
9366 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
9367 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
9368 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
9369 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
9370 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
9371
9372 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
9373 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
9374 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
9375
9376 7 return 0;
9377 8 @}
9378 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
9379 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
9380 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
9381
9382 End of assembler dump.
9383 @end smallexample
9384
9385 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
9386 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
9387 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
9388 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
9389 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
9390 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
9391 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
9392 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
9393 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
9394
9395 @file{foo.h}:
9396
9397 @smallexample
9398 int
9399 foo (int a)
9400 @{
9401 if (a < 0)
9402 return a * 2;
9403 if (a == 0)
9404 return 1;
9405 return a + 10;
9406 @}
9407 @end smallexample
9408
9409 @file{foo.c}:
9410
9411 @smallexample
9412 #include "foo.h"
9413 volatile int x, y;
9414 int
9415 main ()
9416 @{
9417 x = foo (y);
9418 return 0;
9419 @}
9420 @end smallexample
9421
9422 @smallexample
9423 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
9424 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9425 5 @{
9426
9427 6 x = foo (y);
9428 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9429 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9430
9431 7 return 0;
9432 8 @}
9433 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9434 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9435 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9436 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9437
9438 End of assembler dump.
9439 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
9440 Dump of assembler code for function main:
9441 foo.c:
9442 5 @{
9443 6 x = foo (y);
9444 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
9445
9446 foo.h:
9447 4 if (a < 0)
9448 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
9449 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
9450
9451 6 if (a == 0)
9452 7 return 1;
9453 8 return a + 10;
9454 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
9455 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
9456 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
9457 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
9458
9459 foo.c:
9460 6 x = foo (y);
9461 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
9462
9463 7 return 0;
9464 8 @}
9465 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
9466 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
9467
9468 foo.h:
9469 5 return a * 2;
9470 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
9471 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
9472 End of assembler dump.
9473 @end smallexample
9474
9475 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
9476
9477 @smallexample
9478 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
9479 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
9480 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
9481 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
9482 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
9483 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
9484 End of assembler dump.
9485 @end smallexample
9486
9487 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
9488 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
9489 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
9490 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
9491
9492 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
9493 mnemonics or other syntax.
9494
9495 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
9496 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
9497 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
9498 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
9499 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
9500
9501 @table @code
9502 @kindex set disassembler-options
9503 @cindex disassembler options
9504 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
9505 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
9506 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
9507 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
9508 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
9509 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
9510 The default value is the empty string.
9511
9512 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
9513 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
9514 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
9515 and S/390.
9516
9517 @kindex show disassembler-options
9518 @item show disassembler-options
9519 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
9520 @end table
9521
9522 @table @code
9523 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
9524 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
9525 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
9526 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
9527 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
9528 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
9529
9530 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
9531 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
9532 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
9533 assemblers for x86-based targets.
9534
9535 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
9536 @item show disassembly-flavor
9537 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
9538 @end table
9539
9540 @table @code
9541 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
9542 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
9543 @item set disassemble-next-line
9544 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
9545 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
9546 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
9547 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
9548 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
9549 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
9550 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
9551 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
9552 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
9553 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
9554 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
9555 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
9556 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
9557 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
9558 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
9559 instruction.
9560 @end table
9561
9562
9563 @node Data
9564 @chapter Examining Data
9565
9566 @cindex printing data
9567 @cindex examining data
9568 @kindex print
9569 @kindex inspect
9570 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9571 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9572 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9573 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9574 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9575 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9576
9577 @table @code
9578 @item print [[@var{options}] --] @var{expr}
9579 @itemx print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f} @var{expr}
9580 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9581 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9582 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9583 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9584 Formats}.
9585
9586 @anchor{print options}
9587 The @code{print} command supports a number of options that allow
9588 overriding relevant global print settings as set by @code{set print}
9589 subcommands:
9590
9591 @table @code
9592 @item -address [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9593 Set printing of addresses.
9594 Related setting: @ref{set print address}.
9595
9596 @item -array [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9597 Pretty formatting of arrays.
9598 Related setting: @ref{set print array}.
9599
9600 @item -array-indexes [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9601 Set printing of array indexes.
9602 Related setting: @ref{set print array-indexes}.
9603
9604 @item -elements @var{number-of-elements}|@code{unlimited}
9605 Set limit on string chars or array elements to print. The value
9606 @code{unlimited} causes there to be no limit. Related setting:
9607 @ref{set print elements}.
9608
9609 @item -max-depth @var{depth}|@code{unlimited}
9610 Set the threshold after which nested structures are replaced with
9611 ellipsis. Related setting: @ref{set print max-depth}.
9612
9613 @item -null-stop [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9614 Set printing of char arrays to stop at first null char. Related
9615 setting: @ref{set print null-stop}.
9616
9617 @item -object [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9618 Set printing C@t{++} virtual function tables. Related setting:
9619 @ref{set print object}.
9620
9621 @item -pretty [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9622 Set pretty formatting of structures. Related setting: @ref{set print
9623 pretty}.
9624
9625 @item -repeats @var{number-of-repeats}|@code{unlimited}
9626 Set threshold for repeated print elements. @code{unlimited} causes
9627 all elements to be individually printed. Related setting: @ref{set
9628 print repeats}.
9629
9630 @item -static-members [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9631 Set printing C@t{++} static members. Related setting: @ref{set print
9632 static-members}.
9633
9634 @item -symbol [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9635 Set printing of symbol names when printing pointers. Related setting:
9636 @ref{set print symbol}.
9637
9638 @item -union [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9639 Set printing of unions interior to structures. Related setting:
9640 @ref{set print union}.
9641
9642 @item -vtbl [@code{on}|@code{off}]
9643 Set printing of C++ virtual function tables. Related setting:
9644 @ref{set print vtbl}.
9645 @end table
9646
9647 Because the @code{print} command accepts arbitrary expressions which
9648 may look like options (including abbreviations), if you specify any
9649 command option, then you must use a double dash (@code{--}) to mark
9650 the end of option processing.
9651
9652 For example, this prints the value of the @code{-r} expression:
9653
9654 @smallexample
9655 (@value{GDBP}) print -r
9656 @end smallexample
9657
9658 While this repeats the last value in the value history (see below)
9659 with the @code{-raw} option in effect:
9660
9661 @smallexample
9662 (@value{GDBP}) print -r --
9663 @end smallexample
9664
9665 Here is an example including both on option and an expression:
9666
9667 @smallexample
9668 @group
9669 (@value{GDBP}) print -pretty -- *myptr
9670 $1 = @{
9671 next = 0x0,
9672 flags = @{
9673 sweet = 1,
9674 sour = 1
9675 @},
9676 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
9677 @}
9678 @end group
9679 @end smallexample
9680
9681 @item print [@var{options}]
9682 @itemx print [@var{options}] /@var{f}
9683 @cindex reprint the last value
9684 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9685 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9686 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9687 @end table
9688
9689 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9690 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9691 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9692
9693 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9694 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9695 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9696 Table}.
9697
9698 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9699 @kindex explore
9700 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9701 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9702 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9703 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9704 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9705 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9706 embedded in the higher level data types.
9707
9708 @table @code
9709 @item explore @var{arg}
9710 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9711 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9712 @end table
9713
9714 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9715 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9716 C program as
9717
9718 @smallexample
9719 struct SimpleStruct
9720 @{
9721 int i;
9722 double d;
9723 @};
9724
9725 struct ComplexStruct
9726 @{
9727 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9728 int arr[10];
9729 @};
9730 @end smallexample
9731
9732 @noindent
9733 followed by variable declarations as
9734
9735 @smallexample
9736 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9737 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9738 @end smallexample
9739
9740 @noindent
9741 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9742 @code{explore} command as follows.
9743
9744 @smallexample
9745 (gdb) explore cs
9746 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9747 the following fields:
9748
9749 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9750 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9751
9752 Enter the field number of choice:
9753 @end smallexample
9754
9755 @noindent
9756 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9757 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9758 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9759 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9760 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9761 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9762 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9763 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9764
9765 @smallexample
9766 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9767 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9768 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9769 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9770
9771 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9772 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9773
9774 Press enter to return to parent value:
9775 @end smallexample
9776
9777 @noindent
9778 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9779 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9780 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9781 to explore.
9782
9783 @smallexample
9784 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9785 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9786
9787 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9788
9789 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9790
9791 Press enter to return to parent value:
9792 @end smallexample
9793
9794 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9795 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9796 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9797 level data structure).
9798
9799 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9800 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9801 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9802 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9803 same example as above, your can explore the type
9804 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9805 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9806
9807 @smallexample
9808 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9809 @end smallexample
9810
9811 @noindent
9812 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9813 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9814 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9815 example.
9816
9817 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9818 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9819 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9820 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9821 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9822
9823 @table @code
9824 @item explore value @var{expr}
9825 @cindex explore value
9826 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9827 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9828 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9829 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9830 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9831
9832 @item explore type @var{arg}
9833 @cindex explore type
9834 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9835 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9836 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9837 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9838 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9839 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9840 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9841 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9842 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9843 @end table
9844
9845 @menu
9846 * Expressions:: Expressions
9847 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9848 * Variables:: Program variables
9849 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9850 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9851 * Memory:: Examining memory
9852 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9853 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9854 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9855 * Value History:: Value history
9856 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9857 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9858 * Registers:: Registers
9859 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9860 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9861 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9862 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9863 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9864 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9865 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9866 character set than GDB does
9867 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9868 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9869 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9870 @end menu
9871
9872 @node Expressions
9873 @section Expressions
9874
9875 @cindex expressions
9876 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9877 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9878 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9879 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9880 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9881 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9882 @ref{Compilation}.
9883
9884 @cindex arrays in expressions
9885 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9886 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9887 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9888 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9889 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9890 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9891
9892 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9893 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9894 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9895 languages.
9896
9897 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9898 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9899
9900 @cindex casts, in expressions
9901 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9902 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9903 at that address in memory.
9904 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9905
9906 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9907 to programming languages:
9908
9909 @table @code
9910 @item @@
9911 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9912 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9913
9914 @item ::
9915 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9916 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9917
9918 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9919 @cindex type casting memory
9920 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9921 @cindex casts, to view memory
9922 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9923 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9924 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9925 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9926 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9927 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9928 @end table
9929
9930 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9931 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9932 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9933
9934 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9935 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9936 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9937 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9938 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9939 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9940 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9941
9942 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9943 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9944 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9945 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9946 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9947 as well.
9948
9949 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9950 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9951 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9952 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9953 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9954 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9955 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9956 choices.
9957
9958 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9959 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9960 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9961
9962 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9963 @smallexample
9964 @group
9965 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9966 [0] cancel
9967 [1] all
9968 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9969 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9970 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9971 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9972 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9973 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9974 > 2 4 6
9975 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9976 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9977 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9978 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9979 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9980 breakpoints.
9981 (@value{GDBP})
9982 @end group
9983 @end smallexample
9984
9985 @table @code
9986 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9987 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9988 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9989
9990 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9991 is ambiguous.
9992
9993 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9994 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9995 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9996 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9997 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9998 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9999 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
10000 in the use of the menu.
10001
10002 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
10003 when an ambiguity is detected.
10004
10005 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
10006 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
10007
10008 @kindex show multiple-symbols
10009 @item show multiple-symbols
10010 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
10011 @end table
10012
10013 @node Variables
10014 @section Program Variables
10015
10016 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
10017 in your program.
10018
10019 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
10020 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
10021
10022 @itemize @bullet
10023 @item
10024 global (or file-static)
10025 @end itemize
10026
10027 @noindent or
10028
10029 @itemize @bullet
10030 @item
10031 visible according to the scope rules of the
10032 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
10033 @end itemize
10034
10035 @noindent This means that in the function
10036
10037 @smallexample
10038 foo (a)
10039 int a;
10040 @{
10041 bar (a);
10042 @{
10043 int b = test ();
10044 bar (b);
10045 @}
10046 @}
10047 @end smallexample
10048
10049 @noindent
10050 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
10051 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
10052 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
10053 the block where @code{b} is declared.
10054
10055 @cindex variable name conflict
10056 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
10057 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
10058 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
10059 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
10060 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
10061 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
10062 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
10063
10064 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
10065 @ifnotinfo
10066 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
10067 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
10068 @end ifnotinfo
10069 @smallexample
10070 @var{file}::@var{variable}
10071 @var{function}::@var{variable}
10072 @end smallexample
10073
10074 @noindent
10075 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
10076 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
10077 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
10078 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
10079
10080 @smallexample
10081 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
10082 @end smallexample
10083
10084 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
10085 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
10086 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
10087 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
10088 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
10089
10090 @smallexample
10091 void
10092 foo (int a)
10093 @{
10094 if (a < 10)
10095 bar (a);
10096 else
10097 process (a); /* Stop here */
10098 @}
10099
10100 int
10101 bar (int a)
10102 @{
10103 foo (a + 5);
10104 @}
10105 @end smallexample
10106
10107 @noindent
10108 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
10109 here is what you might see
10110 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
10111
10112 @smallexample
10113 (@value{GDBP}) p a
10114 $1 = 10
10115 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
10116 $2 = 5
10117 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
10118 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
10119 (@value{GDBP}) p a
10120 $3 = 5
10121 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
10122 $4 = 0
10123 @end smallexample
10124
10125 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
10126 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
10127 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
10128 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
10129 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
10130
10131 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
10132 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
10133 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
10134 @code{some_global}.
10135
10136 @smallexample
10137 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
10138 $1 = 23
10139 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
10140 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
10141 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
10142 $2 = 27
10143 @end smallexample
10144
10145 @cindex wrong values
10146 @cindex variable values, wrong
10147 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
10148 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
10149 @quotation
10150 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
10151 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
10152 scope, and just before exit.
10153 @end quotation
10154 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
10155 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
10156 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
10157 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
10158 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
10159 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
10160 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
10161 variable definitions may be gone.
10162
10163 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
10164 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
10165 when compiling.
10166
10167 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
10168 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
10169 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
10170 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
10171 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
10172 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
10173 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
10174
10175 @smallexample
10176 No symbol "foo" in current context.
10177 @end smallexample
10178
10179 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
10180 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
10181 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
10182 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
10183 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
10184
10185 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
10186 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
10187 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
10188 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
10189
10190 @cindex no debug info variables
10191 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
10192 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
10193 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
10194 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
10195 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
10196 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
10197 example, in a C program:
10198
10199 @smallexample
10200 (@value{GDBP}) p var
10201 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
10202 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
10203 $1 = 3.14
10204 @end smallexample
10205
10206 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
10207 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
10208 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
10209 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
10210 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
10211
10212 @smallexample
10213 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
10214 29 i++;
10215 (gdb) next
10216 30 e (i);
10217 (gdb) print i
10218 $1 = 31
10219 (gdb) print i@@entry
10220 $2 = 30
10221 @end smallexample
10222
10223 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
10224 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
10225 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
10226 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
10227 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
10228 For program code
10229
10230 @smallexample
10231 char var0[] = "A";
10232 signed char var1[] = "A";
10233 @end smallexample
10234
10235 You get during debugging
10236 @smallexample
10237 (gdb) print var0
10238 $1 = "A"
10239 (gdb) print var1
10240 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
10241 @end smallexample
10242
10243 @node Arrays
10244 @section Artificial Arrays
10245
10246 @cindex artificial array
10247 @cindex arrays
10248 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
10249 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
10250 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
10251 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
10252 program.
10253
10254 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
10255 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
10256 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
10257 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
10258 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
10259 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
10260 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
10261 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
10262 example. If a program says
10263
10264 @smallexample
10265 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
10266 @end smallexample
10267
10268 @noindent
10269 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
10270
10271 @smallexample
10272 p *array@@len
10273 @end smallexample
10274
10275 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
10276 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
10277 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
10278 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
10279 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
10280
10281 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
10282 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
10283 The value need not be in memory:
10284 @smallexample
10285 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
10286 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
10287 @end smallexample
10288
10289 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
10290 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
10291 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
10292 @smallexample
10293 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
10294 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
10295 @end smallexample
10296
10297 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
10298 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
10299 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
10300 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
10301 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
10302 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
10303 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
10304 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
10305 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
10306 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
10307
10308 @smallexample
10309 set $i = 0
10310 p dtab[$i++]->fv
10311 @key{RET}
10312 @key{RET}
10313 @dots{}
10314 @end smallexample
10315
10316 @node Output Formats
10317 @section Output Formats
10318
10319 @cindex formatted output
10320 @cindex output formats
10321 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
10322 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
10323 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
10324 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
10325 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
10326
10327 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
10328 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
10329 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
10330 letters supported are:
10331
10332 @table @code
10333 @item x
10334 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
10335 hexadecimal.
10336
10337 @item d
10338 Print as integer in signed decimal.
10339
10340 @item u
10341 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
10342
10343 @item o
10344 Print as integer in octal.
10345
10346 @item t
10347 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
10348 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
10349 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
10350 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
10351
10352 @item a
10353 @cindex unknown address, locating
10354 @cindex locate address
10355 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
10356 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
10357 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
10358
10359 @smallexample
10360 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
10361 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
10362 @end smallexample
10363
10364 @noindent
10365 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
10366 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
10367
10368 @item c
10369 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
10370 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
10371 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
10372 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
10373
10374 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
10375 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
10376 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
10377 data.
10378
10379 @item f
10380 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
10381 using typical floating point syntax.
10382
10383 @item s
10384 @cindex printing strings
10385 @cindex printing byte arrays
10386 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
10387 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
10388 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
10389 natural types.
10390
10391 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
10392 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
10393 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
10394 array.
10395
10396 @item z
10397 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
10398 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
10399 to the size of the integer type.
10400
10401 @item r
10402 @cindex raw printing
10403 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
10404 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
10405 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
10406 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
10407 pretty-printer which might exist.
10408 @end table
10409
10410 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
10411
10412 @smallexample
10413 p/x $pc
10414 @end smallexample
10415
10416 @noindent
10417 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
10418 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
10419
10420 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
10421 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
10422 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
10423
10424 @node Memory
10425 @section Examining Memory
10426
10427 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
10428 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
10429
10430 @cindex examining memory
10431 @table @code
10432 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
10433 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
10434 @itemx x @var{addr}
10435 @itemx x
10436 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
10437 @end table
10438
10439 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
10440 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
10441 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
10442 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
10443 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
10444
10445 @table @r
10446 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
10447 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
10448 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
10449 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
10450 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
10451 @c 4.1.2.
10452
10453 @item @var{f}, the display format
10454 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
10455 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
10456 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
10457 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
10458 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
10459
10460 @item @var{u}, the unit size
10461 The unit size is any of
10462
10463 @table @code
10464 @item b
10465 Bytes.
10466 @item h
10467 Halfwords (two bytes).
10468 @item w
10469 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
10470 @item g
10471 Giant words (eight bytes).
10472 @end table
10473
10474 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
10475 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
10476 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
10477 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
10478 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
10479 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
10480 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
10481 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
10482 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
10483 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
10484 be altered.
10485
10486 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
10487 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
10488 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
10489 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
10490 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
10491 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
10492 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
10493 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
10494 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
10495 a value from memory).
10496 @end table
10497
10498 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
10499 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
10500 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
10501 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
10502 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
10503
10504 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
10505 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
10506 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
10507
10508 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
10509 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
10510 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
10511 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
10512 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
10513
10514 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
10515 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
10516 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
10517 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
10518 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
10519 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
10520 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
10521 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
10522 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
10523
10524 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
10525 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
10526 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
10527 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
10528 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
10529 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
10530
10531 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
10532 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
10533 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
10534 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
10535 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
10536 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
10537 for successive uses of @code{x}.
10538
10539 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
10540 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
10541
10542 @smallexample
10543 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
10544 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
10545 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
10546 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
10547 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
10548 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
10549 @end smallexample
10550
10551 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
10552 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
10553 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
10554 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
10555 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
10556 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
10557 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
10558 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
10559 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
10560
10561 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
10562 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
10563 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
10564
10565 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
10566 @cindex addressable memory unit
10567 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
10568 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
10569 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
10570 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
10571 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
10572 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
10573 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
10574 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
10575 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
10576
10577 @cindex remote memory comparison
10578 @cindex target memory comparison
10579 @cindex verify remote memory image
10580 @cindex verify target memory image
10581 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
10582 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
10583 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
10584 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
10585 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
10586 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
10587
10588 @table @code
10589 @kindex compare-sections
10590 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
10591 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
10592 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
10593 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
10594 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
10595 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
10596
10597 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
10598 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
10599 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
10600 @end table
10601
10602 @node Auto Display
10603 @section Automatic Display
10604 @cindex automatic display
10605 @cindex display of expressions
10606
10607 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
10608 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
10609 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
10610 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
10611 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
10612 The automatic display looks like this:
10613
10614 @smallexample
10615 2: foo = 38
10616 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
10617 @end smallexample
10618
10619 @noindent
10620 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
10621 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
10622 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
10623 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
10624 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
10625 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
10626
10627 @table @code
10628 @kindex display
10629 @item display @var{expr}
10630 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
10631 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
10632
10633 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
10634
10635 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
10636 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
10637 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
10638 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
10639 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
10640
10641 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
10642 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
10643 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
10644 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
10645 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
10646 @end table
10647
10648 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
10649 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
10650 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10651
10652 @table @code
10653 @kindex delete display
10654 @kindex undisplay
10655 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
10656 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10657 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
10658 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
10659 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
10660 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
10661 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10662
10663 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10664 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10665
10666 @kindex disable display
10667 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10668 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10669 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10670 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10671 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10672 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10673 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10674 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10675
10676 @kindex enable display
10677 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10678 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10679 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10680 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10681 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10682 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10683 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10684
10685 @item display
10686 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10687 done when your program stops.
10688
10689 @kindex info display
10690 @item info display
10691 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10692 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10693 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10694 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10695 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10696 @end table
10697
10698 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10699 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10700 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10701 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10702 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10703 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10704 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10705 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10706 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10707 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10708 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10709
10710 @node Print Settings
10711 @section Print Settings
10712
10713 @cindex format options
10714 @cindex print settings
10715 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10716 and symbols are printed.
10717
10718 @noindent
10719 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10720
10721 @table @code
10722 @kindex set print
10723 @anchor{set print address}
10724 @item set print address
10725 @itemx set print address on
10726 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10727 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10728 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10729 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10730 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10731 @code{set print address on}:
10732
10733 @smallexample
10734 @group
10735 (@value{GDBP}) f
10736 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10737 at input.c:530
10738 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10739 @end group
10740 @end smallexample
10741
10742 @item set print address off
10743 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10744 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10745
10746 @smallexample
10747 @group
10748 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10749 (@value{GDBP}) f
10750 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10751 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10752 @end group
10753 @end smallexample
10754
10755 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10756 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10757 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10758 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10759
10760 @kindex show print
10761 @item show print address
10762 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10763 @end table
10764
10765 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10766 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10767 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10768 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10769 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10770 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10771 it prints a symbolic address:
10772
10773 @table @code
10774 @item set print symbol-filename on
10775 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10776 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10777 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10778 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10779
10780 @item set print symbol-filename off
10781 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10782 default.
10783
10784 @item show print symbol-filename
10785 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10786 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10787 @end table
10788
10789 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10790 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10791 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10792
10793 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10794 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10795
10796 @table @code
10797 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10798 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10799 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10800 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10801 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10802 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10803 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10804 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10805
10806 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10807 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10808 symbolic address.
10809 @end table
10810
10811 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10812 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10813 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10814 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10815 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10816 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10817 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10818 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10819
10820 @smallexample
10821 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10822 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10823 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10824 @end smallexample
10825
10826 @quotation
10827 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10828 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10829 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10830 @end quotation
10831
10832 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10833 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10834
10835 @anchor{set print symbol}
10836 @table @code
10837 @item set print symbol on
10838 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10839 one exists.
10840
10841 @item set print symbol off
10842 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10843 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10844 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10845
10846 @item show print symbol
10847 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10848 address.
10849 @end table
10850
10851 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10852
10853 @table @code
10854 @anchor{set print array}
10855 @item set print array
10856 @itemx set print array on
10857 @cindex pretty print arrays
10858 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10859 but uses more space. The default is off.
10860
10861 @item set print array off
10862 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10863
10864 @item show print array
10865 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10866 arrays.
10867
10868 @cindex print array indexes
10869 @anchor{set print array-indexes}
10870 @item set print array-indexes
10871 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10872 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10873 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10874 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10875
10876 @item set print array-indexes off
10877 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10878
10879 @item show print array-indexes
10880 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10881 arrays.
10882
10883 @anchor{set print elements}
10884 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10885 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10886 @cindex number of array elements to print
10887 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10888 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10889 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10890 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10891 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10892 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10893 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10894 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10895
10896 @item show print elements
10897 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10898 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10899
10900 @anchor{set print frame-arguments}
10901 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10902 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10903 @cindex printing frame argument values
10904 @cindex print all frame argument values
10905 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10906 @cindex do not print frame arguments
10907 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10908 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10909 values are:
10910
10911 @table @code
10912 @item all
10913 The values of all arguments are printed.
10914
10915 @item scalars
10916 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10917 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10918 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10919 only scalar arguments are shown:
10920
10921 @smallexample
10922 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10923 at frame-args.c:23
10924 @end smallexample
10925
10926 @item none
10927 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10928 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10929
10930 @smallexample
10931 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10932 at frame-args.c:23
10933 @end smallexample
10934
10935 @item presence
10936 Only the presence of arguments is indicated by @code{@dots{}}.
10937 The @code{@dots{}} are not printed for function without any arguments.
10938 None of the argument names and values are printed.
10939 In this case, the example above now becomes:
10940
10941 @smallexample
10942 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (@dots{}) at frame-args.c:23
10943 @end smallexample
10944
10945 @end table
10946
10947 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10948 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10949 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10950 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10951 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10952 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10953 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10954 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10955 to @code{scalars} (the default), @code{none} or @code{presence} avoids
10956 this computation, thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10957
10958 @item show print frame-arguments
10959 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10960
10961 @anchor{set print raw-frame-arguments}
10962 @item set print raw-frame-arguments on
10963 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10964
10965 @item set print raw-frame-arguments off
10966 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10967 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10968 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10969 This is the default.
10970
10971 @item show print raw-frame-arguments
10972 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10973
10974 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10975 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10976 @kindex set print entry-values
10977 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10978 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10979 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10980 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10981 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10982
10983 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10984 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10985 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10986 @code{no} setting.
10987
10988 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10989 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10990 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10991 this information.
10992
10993 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10994
10995 @table @code
10996 @item no
10997 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10998 point.
10999 @smallexample
11000 #0 equal (val=5)
11001 #0 different (val=6)
11002 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
11003 #0 born (val=10)
11004 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11005 @end smallexample
11006
11007 @item only
11008 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
11009 values are never printed.
11010 @smallexample
11011 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
11012 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
11013 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11014 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11015 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11016 @end smallexample
11017
11018 @item preferred
11019 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
11020 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
11021 value for such parameter.
11022 @smallexample
11023 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
11024 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
11025 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11026 #0 born (val=10)
11027 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11028 @end smallexample
11029
11030 @item if-needed
11031 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
11032 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
11033 parameter.
11034 @smallexample
11035 #0 equal (val=5)
11036 #0 different (val=6)
11037 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11038 #0 born (val=10)
11039 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11040 @end smallexample
11041
11042 @item both
11043 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
11044 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
11045 optimizations.
11046 @smallexample
11047 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
11048 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
11049 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
11050 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11051 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
11052 @end smallexample
11053
11054 @item compact
11055 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
11056 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
11057 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
11058 values are known and identical, print the shortened
11059 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
11060 @smallexample
11061 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
11062 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
11063 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
11064 #0 born (val=10)
11065 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11066 @end smallexample
11067
11068 @item default
11069 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
11070 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
11071 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
11072 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
11073 @smallexample
11074 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
11075 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
11076 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
11077 #0 born (val=10)
11078 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
11079 @end smallexample
11080 @end table
11081
11082 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
11083 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
11084
11085 @item show print entry-values
11086 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
11087 entry.
11088
11089 @anchor{set print frame-info}
11090 @item set print frame-info @var{value}
11091 @kindex set print frame-info
11092 @cindex printing frame information
11093 @cindex frame information, printing
11094 This command allows to control the information printed when
11095 the debugger prints a frame. See @ref{Frames}, @ref{Backtrace},
11096 for a general explanation about frames and frame information.
11097 Note that some other settings (such as @code{set print frame-arguments}
11098 and @code{set print address}) are also influencing if and how some frame
11099 information is displayed. In particular, the frame program counter is never
11100 printed if @code{set print address} is off.
11101
11102 The possible values for @code{set print frame-info} are:
11103 @table @code
11104 @item short-location
11105 Print the frame level, the program counter (if not at the
11106 beginning of the location source line), the function, the function
11107 arguments.
11108 @item location
11109 Same as @code{short-location} but also print the source file and source line
11110 number.
11111 @item location-and-address
11112 Same as @code{location} but print the program counter even if located at the
11113 beginning of the location source line.
11114 @item source-line
11115 Print the program counter (if not at the beginning of the location
11116 source line), the line number and the source line.
11117 @item source-and-location
11118 Print what @code{location} and @code{source-line} are printing.
11119 @item auto
11120 The information printed for a frame is decided automatically
11121 by the @value{GDBN} command that prints a frame.
11122 For example, @code{frame} prints the information printed by
11123 @code{source-and-location} while @code{stepi} will switch between
11124 @code{source-line} and @code{source-and-location} depending on the program
11125 counter.
11126 The default value is @code{auto}.
11127 @end table
11128
11129 @anchor{set print repeats}
11130 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
11131 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
11132 @cindex repeated array elements
11133 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
11134 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
11135 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
11136 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
11137 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
11138 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
11139 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
11140 is 10.
11141
11142 @item show print repeats
11143 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
11144 elements.
11145
11146 @anchor{set print max-depth}
11147 @item set print max-depth @var{depth}
11148 @item set print max-depth unlimited
11149 @cindex printing nested structures
11150 Set the threshold after which nested structures are replaced with
11151 ellipsis, this can make visualising deeply nested structures easier.
11152
11153 For example, given this C code
11154
11155 @smallexample
11156 typedef struct s1 @{ int a; @} s1;
11157 typedef struct s2 @{ s1 b; @} s2;
11158 typedef struct s3 @{ s2 c; @} s3;
11159 typedef struct s4 @{ s3 d; @} s4;
11160
11161 s4 var = @{ @{ @{ @{ 3 @} @} @} @};
11162 @end smallexample
11163
11164 The following table shows how different values of @var{depth} will
11165 effect how @code{var} is printed by @value{GDBN}:
11166
11167 @multitable @columnfractions .3 .7
11168 @headitem @var{depth} setting @tab Result of @samp{p var}
11169 @item unlimited
11170 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}@}@}}
11171 @item @code{0}
11172 @tab @code{$1 = @{...@}}
11173 @item @code{1}
11174 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{...@}@}}
11175 @item @code{2}
11176 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{...@}@}@}}
11177 @item @code{3}
11178 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{...@}@}@}@}}
11179 @item @code{4}
11180 @tab @code{$1 = @{d = @{c = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}@}@}}
11181 @end multitable
11182
11183 To see the contents of structures that have been hidden the user can
11184 either increase the print max-depth, or they can print the elements of
11185 the structure that are visible, for example
11186
11187 @smallexample
11188 (gdb) set print max-depth 2
11189 (gdb) p var
11190 $1 = @{d = @{c = @{...@}@}@}
11191 (gdb) p var.d
11192 $2 = @{c = @{b = @{...@}@}@}
11193 (gdb) p var.d.c
11194 $3 = @{b = @{a = 3@}@}
11195 @end smallexample
11196
11197 The pattern used to replace nested structures varies based on
11198 language, for most languages @code{@{...@}} is used, but Fortran uses
11199 @code{(...)}.
11200
11201 @item show print max-depth
11202 Display the current threshold after which nested structures are
11203 replaces with ellipsis.
11204
11205 @anchor{set print null-stop}
11206 @item set print null-stop
11207 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
11208 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
11209 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
11210 contain only short strings.
11211 The default is off.
11212
11213 @item show print null-stop
11214 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
11215 @sc{null} character.
11216
11217 @anchor{set print pretty}
11218 @item set print pretty on
11219 @cindex print structures in indented form
11220 @cindex indentation in structure display
11221 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
11222 per line, like this:
11223
11224 @smallexample
11225 @group
11226 $1 = @{
11227 next = 0x0,
11228 flags = @{
11229 sweet = 1,
11230 sour = 1
11231 @},
11232 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
11233 @}
11234 @end group
11235 @end smallexample
11236
11237 @item set print pretty off
11238 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
11239
11240 @smallexample
11241 @group
11242 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
11243 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
11244 @end group
11245 @end smallexample
11246
11247 @noindent
11248 This is the default format.
11249
11250 @item show print pretty
11251 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
11252
11253 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
11254 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
11255 @cindex octal escapes in strings
11256 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
11257 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
11258 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
11259 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
11260 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
11261
11262 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
11263 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
11264 international character sets, and is the default.
11265
11266 @item show print sevenbit-strings
11267 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
11268
11269 @anchor{set print union}
11270 @item set print union on
11271 @cindex unions in structures, printing
11272 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
11273 and other unions. This is the default setting.
11274
11275 @item set print union off
11276 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
11277 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
11278 instead.
11279
11280 @item show print union
11281 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
11282 structures and other unions.
11283
11284 For example, given the declarations
11285
11286 @smallexample
11287 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
11288 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
11289 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
11290 Bug_forms;
11291
11292 struct thing @{
11293 Species it;
11294 union @{
11295 Tree_forms tree;
11296 Bug_forms bug;
11297 @} form;
11298 @};
11299
11300 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
11301 @end smallexample
11302
11303 @noindent
11304 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
11305
11306 @smallexample
11307 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
11308 @end smallexample
11309
11310 @noindent
11311 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
11312
11313 @smallexample
11314 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
11315 @end smallexample
11316
11317 @noindent
11318 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
11319 and in Pascal.
11320 @end table
11321
11322 @need 1000
11323 @noindent
11324 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
11325
11326 @table @code
11327 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
11328 @item set print demangle
11329 @itemx set print demangle on
11330 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
11331 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
11332 linkage. The default is on.
11333
11334 @item show print demangle
11335 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
11336
11337 @item set print asm-demangle
11338 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
11339 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
11340 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
11341 The default is off.
11342
11343 @item show print asm-demangle
11344 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
11345 or demangled form.
11346
11347 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
11348 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
11349 @kindex set demangle-style
11350 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
11351 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to represent
11352 C@t{++} names. If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible
11353 formats. The default value is @var{auto}, which lets @value{GDBN} choose a
11354 decoding style by inspecting your program.
11355
11356 @item show demangle-style
11357 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
11358
11359 @anchor{set print object}
11360 @item set print object
11361 @itemx set print object on
11362 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
11363 @cindex display derived types
11364 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
11365 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
11366 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
11367 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
11368 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
11369 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
11370 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
11371
11372 @item set print object off
11373 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
11374 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
11375
11376 @item show print object
11377 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
11378
11379 @anchor{set print static-members}
11380 @item set print static-members
11381 @itemx set print static-members on
11382 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
11383 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
11384
11385 @item set print static-members off
11386 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
11387
11388 @item show print static-members
11389 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
11390
11391 @item set print pascal_static-members
11392 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
11393 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
11394 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
11395 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
11396
11397 @item set print pascal_static-members off
11398 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
11399
11400 @item show print pascal_static-members
11401 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
11402
11403 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
11404 @anchor{set print vtbl}
11405 @item set print vtbl
11406 @itemx set print vtbl on
11407 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
11408 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
11409 @cindex VTBL display
11410 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
11411 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
11412 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
11413
11414 @item set print vtbl off
11415 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
11416
11417 @item show print vtbl
11418 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
11419 @end table
11420
11421 @node Pretty Printing
11422 @section Pretty Printing
11423
11424 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
11425 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
11426 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
11427
11428 @menu
11429 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
11430 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
11431 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
11432 @end menu
11433
11434 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
11435 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
11436
11437 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
11438 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
11439 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
11440
11441 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
11442 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
11443 pretty-printers with their names.
11444 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
11445 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
11446 Each such subprinter has its own name.
11447 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
11448
11449 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
11450 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
11451 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
11452 do anything special.
11453
11454 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
11455
11456 @itemize @bullet
11457 @item
11458 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
11459 all inferiors.
11460
11461 @item
11462 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
11463 when debugging that program.
11464 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
11465
11466 @item
11467 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
11468 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
11469 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
11470 @end itemize
11471
11472 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
11473 pretty-printers are selected,
11474
11475 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
11476 for new types.
11477
11478 @node Pretty-Printer Example
11479 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
11480
11481 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
11482
11483 @smallexample
11484 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11485 $1 = @{
11486 static npos = 4294967295,
11487 _M_dataplus = @{
11488 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
11489 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
11490 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
11491 @},
11492 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
11493 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
11494 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
11495 @}
11496 @}
11497 @end smallexample
11498
11499 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
11500
11501 @smallexample
11502 (@value{GDBP}) print s
11503 $2 = "abcd"
11504 @end smallexample
11505
11506 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
11507 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
11508 @cindex pretty-printer commands
11509
11510 @table @code
11511 @kindex info pretty-printer
11512 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
11513 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
11514 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
11515
11516 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
11517 whose pretty-printers to list.
11518 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
11519 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
11520 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
11521 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
11522 looks up a printer from these three objects.
11523
11524 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
11525 to list.
11526
11527 @kindex disable pretty-printer
11528 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
11529 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
11530 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
11531
11532 @kindex enable pretty-printer
11533 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
11534 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
11535 @end table
11536
11537 Example:
11538
11539 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
11540 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
11541 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
11542 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
11543
11544 @smallexample
11545 (gdb) info pretty-printer
11546 library1.so:
11547 foo
11548 library2.so:
11549 bar
11550 bar1
11551 bar2
11552 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11553 library2.so:
11554 bar
11555 bar1
11556 bar2
11557 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
11558 1 printer disabled
11559 2 of 3 printers enabled
11560 (gdb) info pretty-printer
11561 library1.so:
11562 foo [disabled]
11563 library2.so:
11564 bar
11565 bar1
11566 bar2
11567 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar;bar1
11568 1 printer disabled
11569 1 of 3 printers enabled
11570 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11571 library1.so:
11572 foo [disabled]
11573 library2.so:
11574 bar
11575 bar1 [disabled]
11576 bar2
11577 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
11578 1 printer disabled
11579 0 of 3 printers enabled
11580 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
11581 library1.so:
11582 foo [disabled]
11583 library2.so:
11584 bar [disabled]
11585 bar1 [disabled]
11586 bar2
11587 @end smallexample
11588
11589 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
11590 as can each individual subprinter.
11591
11592 @node Value History
11593 @section Value History
11594
11595 @cindex value history
11596 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
11597 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
11598 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
11599 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
11600 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
11601 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
11602 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
11603 symbol table.
11604
11605 @cindex @code{$}
11606 @cindex @code{$$}
11607 @cindex history number
11608 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
11609 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
11610 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
11611 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
11612 history number.
11613
11614 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
11615 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
11616 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
11617 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
11618 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
11619 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
11620 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
11621
11622 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
11623 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
11624
11625 @smallexample
11626 p *$
11627 @end smallexample
11628
11629 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
11630 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
11631
11632 @smallexample
11633 p *$.next
11634 @end smallexample
11635
11636 @noindent
11637 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
11638 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
11639
11640 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
11641 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
11642
11643 @smallexample
11644 print x
11645 set x=5
11646 @end smallexample
11647
11648 @noindent
11649 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
11650 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
11651
11652 @table @code
11653 @kindex show values
11654 @item show values
11655 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
11656 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
11657 values} does not change the history.
11658
11659 @item show values @var{n}
11660 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
11661
11662 @item show values +
11663 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
11664 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
11665 @end table
11666
11667 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
11668 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
11669
11670 @node Convenience Vars
11671 @section Convenience Variables
11672
11673 @cindex convenience variables
11674 @cindex user-defined variables
11675 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
11676 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
11677 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
11678 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
11679 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
11680
11681 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
11682 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
11683 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
11684 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
11685 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
11686
11687 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
11688 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
11689 For example:
11690
11691 @smallexample
11692 set $foo = *object_ptr
11693 @end smallexample
11694
11695 @noindent
11696 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
11697 @code{object_ptr}.
11698
11699 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
11700 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
11701 value with another assignment at any time.
11702
11703 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
11704 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
11705 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
11706 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
11707
11708 @table @code
11709 @kindex show convenience
11710 @cindex show all user variables and functions
11711 @item show convenience
11712 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
11713 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
11714 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
11715
11716 @kindex init-if-undefined
11717 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
11718 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
11719 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
11720 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
11721 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
11722 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
11723 override default values used in a command script.
11724
11725 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
11726 any side-effects do not occur.
11727 @end table
11728
11729 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
11730 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
11731 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
11732
11733 @smallexample
11734 set $i = 0
11735 print bar[$i++]->contents
11736 @end smallexample
11737
11738 @noindent
11739 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
11740
11741 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
11742 values likely to be useful.
11743
11744 @table @code
11745 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
11746 @item $_
11747 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
11748 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
11749 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
11750 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
11751 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
11752 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
11753 to the type of @code{$__}.
11754
11755 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
11756 @item $__
11757 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
11758 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
11759 to match the format in which the data was printed.
11760
11761 @item $_exitcode
11762 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11763 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
11764 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
11765 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11766
11767 @item $_exitsignal
11768 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11769 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11770 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11771 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11772
11773 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11774 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11775 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11776 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11777 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11778
11779 @smallexample
11780 #include <signal.h>
11781
11782 int
11783 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11784 @{
11785 raise (SIGALRM);
11786 return 0;
11787 @}
11788 @end smallexample
11789
11790 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11791 or signalled would be:
11792
11793 @smallexample
11794 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11795 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11796 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11797 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11798 >echo The program has exited\n
11799 >else
11800 >echo The program has signalled\n
11801 >end
11802 >end
11803 (@value{GDBP}) run
11804 Starting program:
11805
11806 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11807 The program no longer exists.
11808 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11809 The program has signalled
11810 @end smallexample
11811
11812 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11813 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11814 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11815 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11816
11817 @smallexample
11818 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11819 The program has exited
11820 @end smallexample
11821
11822 @item $_exception
11823 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11824 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11825
11826 @item $_probe_argc
11827 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11828 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11829
11830 @item $_sdata
11831 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11832 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11833 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11834 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11835 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11836
11837 @item $_siginfo
11838 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11839 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11840 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11841 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11842 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11843
11844 @item $_tlb
11845 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11846 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11847 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11848 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11849 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11850 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11851
11852 @item $_inferior
11853 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11854 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11855
11856 @item $_thread
11857 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11858
11859 @item $_gthread
11860 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11861
11862 @item $_gdb_major
11863 @itemx $_gdb_minor
11864 @vindex $_gdb_major@r{, convenience variable}
11865 @vindex $_gdb_minor@r{, convenience variable}
11866 The major and minor version numbers of the running @value{GDBN}.
11867 Development snapshots and pretest versions have their minor version
11868 incremented by one; thus, @value{GDBN} pretest 9.11.90 will produce
11869 the value 12 for @code{$_gdb_minor}. These variables allow you to
11870 write scripts that work with different versions of @value{GDBN}
11871 without errors caused by features unavailable in some of those
11872 versions.
11873
11874 @item $_shell_exitcode
11875 @itemx $_shell_exitsignal
11876 @vindex $_shell_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
11877 @vindex $_shell_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11878 @cindex shell command, exit code
11879 @cindex shell command, exit signal
11880 @cindex exit status of shell commands
11881 @value{GDBN} commands such as @code{shell} and @code{|} are launching
11882 shell commands. When a launched command terminates, @value{GDBN}
11883 automatically maintains the variables @code{$_shell_exitcode}
11884 and @code{$_shell_exitsignal} according to the exit status of the last
11885 launched command. These variables are set and used similarly to
11886 the variables @code{$_exitcode} and @code{$_exitsignal}.
11887
11888 @end table
11889
11890 @node Convenience Funs
11891 @section Convenience Functions
11892
11893 @cindex convenience functions
11894 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11895 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11896 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11897 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11898 @value{GDBN}.
11899
11900 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11901 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11902
11903 @table @code
11904
11905 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11906 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11907 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11908 returns zero.
11909
11910 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11911 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11912 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11913 it is @code{void}:
11914
11915 @smallexample
11916 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11917 $1 = void
11918 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11919 $2 = 1
11920 (@value{GDBP}) run
11921 Starting program: ./a.out
11922 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11923 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11924 $3 = 0
11925 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11926 $4 = 0
11927 @end smallexample
11928
11929 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11930 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11931 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11932 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11933 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11934 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11935 anymore.
11936
11937 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11938 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11939
11940 @smallexample
11941 void
11942 foo (void)
11943 @{
11944 @}
11945 @end smallexample
11946
11947 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11948
11949 @smallexample
11950 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11951 $1 = void
11952 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11953 $2 = 1
11954 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11955 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11956 $3 = void
11957 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11958 $4 = 1
11959 @end smallexample
11960
11961 @end table
11962
11963 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11964 @code{Python} support.
11965
11966 @table @code
11967
11968 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11969 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11970 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11971 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11972 Otherwise it returns zero.
11973
11974 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11975 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11976 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11977 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11978 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11979 regular expression support.
11980
11981 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11982 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11983 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11984 Otherwise it returns zero.
11985
11986 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11987 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11988 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11989
11990 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11991 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11992 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11993 Otherwise it returns zero.
11994
11995 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11996 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11997 The default is 1.
11998
11999 Example:
12000
12001 @smallexample
12002 (gdb) backtrace
12003 #0 bottom_func ()
12004 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
12005 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
12006 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
12007 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
12008 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
12009 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
12010 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
12011 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
12012 $1 = 1
12013 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
12014 $1 = 1
12015 @end smallexample
12016
12017 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
12018 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
12019 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
12020 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
12021
12022 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
12023 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
12024 The default is 1.
12025
12026 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
12027 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
12028 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
12029 Otherwise it returns zero.
12030
12031 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
12032 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
12033 The default is 1.
12034
12035 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
12036 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
12037 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
12038 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
12039
12040 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
12041 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
12042 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
12043 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
12044
12045 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
12046 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
12047 The default is 1.
12048
12049 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
12050 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
12051 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
12052 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
12053
12054 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
12055 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
12056 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
12057
12058 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
12059 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
12060 an enumerated type:
12061
12062 @smallexample
12063 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
12064 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
12065 @end smallexample
12066
12067 @item $_cimag(@var{value})
12068 @itemx $_creal(@var{value})
12069 @findex $_cimag@r{, convenience function}
12070 @findex $_creal@r{, convenience function}
12071 Return the imaginary (@code{$_cimag}) or real (@code{$_creal}) part of
12072 the complex number @var{value}.
12073
12074 The type of the imaginary or real part depends on the type of the
12075 complex number, e.g., using @code{$_cimag} on a @code{float complex}
12076 will return an imaginary part of type @code{float}.
12077
12078 @end table
12079
12080 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
12081 convenience functions.
12082
12083 @table @code
12084 @item help function
12085 @kindex help function
12086 @cindex show all convenience functions
12087 Print a list of all convenience functions.
12088 @end table
12089
12090 @node Registers
12091 @section Registers
12092
12093 @cindex registers
12094 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
12095 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
12096 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
12097 your machine.
12098
12099 @table @code
12100 @kindex info registers
12101 @item info registers
12102 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
12103 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
12104
12105 @kindex info all-registers
12106 @cindex floating point registers
12107 @item info all-registers
12108 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
12109 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
12110
12111 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
12112 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
12113 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
12114 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
12115
12116 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
12117 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
12118 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
12119 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
12120 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
12121 @end table
12122
12123 @anchor{standard registers}
12124 @cindex stack pointer register
12125 @cindex program counter register
12126 @cindex process status register
12127 @cindex frame pointer register
12128 @cindex standard registers
12129 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
12130 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
12131 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
12132 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
12133 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
12134 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
12135 register that contains the processor status. For example,
12136 you could print the program counter in hex with
12137
12138 @smallexample
12139 p/x $pc
12140 @end smallexample
12141
12142 @noindent
12143 or print the instruction to be executed next with
12144
12145 @smallexample
12146 x/i $pc
12147 @end smallexample
12148
12149 @noindent
12150 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
12151 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
12152 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
12153 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
12154 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
12155 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
12156 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
12157
12158 @smallexample
12159 set $sp += 4
12160 @end smallexample
12161
12162 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
12163 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
12164 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
12165 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
12166 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
12167 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
12168 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
12169
12170 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
12171 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
12172 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
12173 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
12174 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
12175 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
12176 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
12177
12178 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
12179 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
12180 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
12181 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
12182 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
12183 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
12184 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
12185 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
12186 prints the data in both formats.
12187
12188 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
12189 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
12190 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
12191 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
12192 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
12193 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
12194 registers in @code{struct} notation:
12195
12196 @smallexample
12197 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
12198 $1 = @{
12199 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
12200 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
12201 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
12202 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
12203 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
12204 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
12205 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
12206 @}
12207 @end smallexample
12208
12209 @noindent
12210 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
12211 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
12212 value to a @code{struct} member:
12213
12214 @smallexample
12215 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
12216 @end smallexample
12217
12218 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
12219 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
12220 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
12221 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
12222 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
12223 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
12224
12225 @cindex caller-saved registers
12226 @cindex call-clobbered registers
12227 @cindex volatile registers
12228 @cindex <not saved> values
12229 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
12230 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
12231 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
12232 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
12233 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
12234 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
12235 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
12236 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
12237 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
12238 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
12239 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
12240 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
12241 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
12242 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
12243 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
12244 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
12245 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
12246 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
12247 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
12248 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
12249 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
12250 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
12251 represent the value the register had just before the call.
12252
12253 @node Floating Point Hardware
12254 @section Floating Point Hardware
12255 @cindex floating point
12256
12257 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
12258 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
12259
12260 @table @code
12261 @kindex info float
12262 @item info float
12263 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
12264 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
12265 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
12266 the ARM and x86 machines.
12267 @end table
12268
12269 @node Vector Unit
12270 @section Vector Unit
12271 @cindex vector unit
12272
12273 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
12274 more information about the status of the vector unit.
12275
12276 @table @code
12277 @kindex info vector
12278 @item info vector
12279 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
12280 layout vary depending on the hardware.
12281 @end table
12282
12283 @node OS Information
12284 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
12285 @cindex OS information
12286
12287 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
12288 you debug your program.
12289
12290 @cindex auxiliary vector
12291 @cindex vector, auxiliary
12292 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
12293 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
12294 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
12295 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
12296 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
12297 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
12298 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
12299 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
12300 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
12301 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
12302 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
12303
12304 @table @code
12305 @kindex info auxv
12306 @item info auxv
12307 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
12308 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
12309 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
12310 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
12311 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
12312 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
12313 an unrecognized tag.
12314 @end table
12315
12316 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
12317 information and show it to you. The types of information available
12318 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
12319 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
12320 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
12321 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
12322 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
12323
12324 @table @code
12325 @kindex info os
12326 @item info os @var{infotype}
12327
12328 Display OS information of the requested type.
12329
12330 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
12331
12332 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
12333 @table @code
12334 @kindex info os cpus
12335 @item cpus
12336 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
12337 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
12338 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
12339 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
12340 kernel initialization.
12341
12342 @kindex info os files
12343 @item files
12344 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
12345 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
12346 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
12347 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
12348
12349 @kindex info os modules
12350 @item modules
12351 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
12352 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
12353 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
12354 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
12355 in memory.
12356
12357 @kindex info os msg
12358 @item msg
12359 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
12360 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
12361 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
12362 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
12363 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
12364 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
12365 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
12366 the message queue was last changed.
12367
12368 @kindex info os processes
12369 @item processes
12370 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
12371 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
12372 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
12373 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
12374 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
12375 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
12376
12377 @kindex info os procgroups
12378 @item procgroups
12379 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
12380 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
12381 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
12382 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
12383 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
12384 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
12385 and the process group leader is listed first.
12386
12387 @kindex info os semaphores
12388 @item semaphores
12389 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
12390 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
12391 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
12392 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
12393 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
12394
12395 @kindex info os shm
12396 @item shm
12397 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
12398 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
12399 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
12400 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
12401 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
12402 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
12403 attached to, detach from, and changed.
12404
12405 @kindex info os sockets
12406 @item sockets
12407 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
12408 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
12409 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
12410 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
12411 connection.
12412
12413 @kindex info os threads
12414 @item threads
12415 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
12416 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
12417 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
12418 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
12419 process is not listed.
12420 @end table
12421
12422 @item info os
12423 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
12424 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
12425 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
12426 types, this command will report an error.
12427 @end table
12428
12429 @node Memory Region Attributes
12430 @section Memory Region Attributes
12431 @cindex memory region attributes
12432
12433 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
12434 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
12435 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
12436 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
12437 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
12438 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
12439 user can override the fetched regions.
12440
12441 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
12442 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
12443 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
12444 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
12445 all memory.
12446
12447 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
12448 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
12449
12450 @table @code
12451 @kindex mem
12452 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
12453 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
12454 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
12455 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
12456 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
12457 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
12458
12459 @item mem auto
12460 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
12461 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
12462
12463 @kindex delete mem
12464 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
12465 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
12466 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
12467
12468 @kindex disable mem
12469 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
12470 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
12471 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
12472 It may be enabled again later.
12473
12474 @kindex enable mem
12475 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
12476 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
12477
12478 @kindex info mem
12479 @item info mem
12480 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
12481 for each region:
12482
12483 @table @emph
12484 @item Memory Region Number
12485 @item Enabled or Disabled.
12486 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
12487 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
12488
12489 @item Lo Address
12490 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
12491
12492 @item Hi Address
12493 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
12494
12495 @item Attributes
12496 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
12497 @end table
12498 @end table
12499
12500
12501 @subsection Attributes
12502
12503 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
12504 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
12505 write accesses to a memory region.
12506
12507 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
12508 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
12509 etc.@: from accessing memory.
12510
12511 @table @code
12512 @item ro
12513 Memory is read only.
12514 @item wo
12515 Memory is write only.
12516 @item rw
12517 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
12518 @end table
12519
12520 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
12521 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
12522 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
12523 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
12524 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
12525
12526 @table @code
12527 @item 8
12528 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
12529 @item 16
12530 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
12531 @item 32
12532 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
12533 @item 64
12534 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
12535 @end table
12536
12537 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
12538 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
12539 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
12540 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
12541 @c
12542 @c @table @code
12543 @c @item hwbreak
12544 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
12545 @c @item swbreak (default)
12546 @c @end table
12547
12548 @subsubsection Data Cache
12549 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
12550 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
12551 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
12552 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
12553 registers.
12554
12555 @table @code
12556 @item cache
12557 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
12558 @item nocache
12559 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
12560 @end table
12561
12562 @subsection Memory Access Checking
12563 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
12564 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
12565 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
12566 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
12567
12568 @table @code
12569 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
12570 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
12571 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
12572 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
12573 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
12574 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
12575 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
12576 The default value is @code{on}.
12577 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
12578 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
12579 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
12580 @end table
12581
12582
12583 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
12584 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
12585 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
12586 @c
12587 @c @table @code
12588 @c @item verify
12589 @c @item noverify (default)
12590 @c @end table
12591
12592 @node Dump/Restore Files
12593 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
12594 @cindex dump/restore files
12595 @cindex append data to a file
12596 @cindex dump data to a file
12597 @cindex restore data from a file
12598
12599 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
12600 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
12601 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
12602 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
12603 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
12604 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
12605 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
12606
12607 @table @code
12608
12609 @kindex dump
12610 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
12611 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
12612 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
12613 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
12614
12615 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
12616 @table @code
12617 @item binary
12618 Raw binary form.
12619 @item ihex
12620 Intel hex format.
12621 @item srec
12622 Motorola S-record format.
12623 @item tekhex
12624 Tektronix Hex format.
12625 @item verilog
12626 Verilog Hex format.
12627 @end table
12628
12629 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
12630 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
12631 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
12632 form.
12633
12634 @kindex append
12635 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
12636 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
12637 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
12638 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
12639 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
12640
12641 @kindex restore
12642 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
12643 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
12644 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
12645 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
12646 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
12647
12648 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
12649 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
12650 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
12651 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
12652 from that location.
12653
12654 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
12655 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
12656 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
12657 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
12658
12659 @end table
12660
12661 @node Core File Generation
12662 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
12663 @cindex dump core from inferior
12664
12665 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
12666 image of a running process and its process status (register values
12667 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
12668 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
12669 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
12670 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
12671 the post-mortem debugging mode.
12672
12673 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
12674 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
12675 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
12676
12677 @table @code
12678 @kindex gcore
12679 @kindex generate-core-file
12680 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
12681 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
12682 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
12683 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
12684 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
12685 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
12686
12687 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
12688 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
12689
12690 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
12691 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
12692 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
12693 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
12694 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
12695
12696 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
12697 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
12698 @item set use-coredump-filter on
12699 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
12700 Enable or disable the use of the file
12701 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
12702 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
12703 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
12704 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
12705
12706 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
12707 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
12708 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
12709 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
12710 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
12711 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
12712 about the bits that can be set in the
12713 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
12714 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
12715
12716 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
12717 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
12718 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
12719 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
12720 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
12721 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
12722 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
12723 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
12724
12725 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
12726 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
12727 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
12728 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
12729 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
12730 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
12731 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
12732
12733 The default value is @code{off}.
12734 @end table
12735
12736 @node Character Sets
12737 @section Character Sets
12738 @cindex character sets
12739 @cindex charset
12740 @cindex translating between character sets
12741 @cindex host character set
12742 @cindex target character set
12743
12744 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
12745 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
12746 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
12747 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
12748 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
12749 @dfn{target character set}.
12750
12751 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
12752 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
12753 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
12754 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
12755 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
12756 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
12757 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
12758 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
12759 character and string literals in expressions.
12760
12761 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
12762 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
12763 target-charset} command, described below.
12764
12765 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
12766 support:
12767
12768 @table @code
12769 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
12770 @kindex set target-charset
12771 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
12772 list of supported target character sets, type
12773 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12774
12775 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
12776 @kindex set host-charset
12777 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
12778
12779 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
12780 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
12781 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
12782 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
12783 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
12784
12785 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
12786 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12787 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
12788
12789 @item set charset @var{charset}
12790 @kindex set charset
12791 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
12792 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
12793 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
12794 for both host and target.
12795
12796 @item show charset
12797 @kindex show charset
12798 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
12799
12800 @item show host-charset
12801 @kindex show host-charset
12802 Show the name of the current host character set.
12803
12804 @item show target-charset
12805 @kindex show target-charset
12806 Show the name of the current target character set.
12807
12808 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12809 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12810 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12811 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12812 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12813 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12814
12815 @item show target-wide-charset
12816 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12817 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12818 @end table
12819
12820 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12821 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12822 @file{charset-test.c}:
12823
12824 @smallexample
12825 #include <stdio.h>
12826
12827 char ascii_hello[]
12828 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12829 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12830 char ibm1047_hello[]
12831 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12832 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12833
12834 main ()
12835 @{
12836 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12837 @}
12838 @end smallexample
12839
12840 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12841 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12842 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12843
12844 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12845
12846 @smallexample
12847 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12848 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12849 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12850 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12851 @dots{}
12852 (@value{GDBP})
12853 @end smallexample
12854
12855 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12856 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12857 strings:
12858
12859 @smallexample
12860 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12861 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12862 (@value{GDBP})
12863 @end smallexample
12864
12865 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12866 initial character set:
12867 @smallexample
12868 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12869 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12870 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12871 (@value{GDBP})
12872 @end smallexample
12873
12874 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12875 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12876 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12877 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12878 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12879
12880 @smallexample
12881 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12882 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12883 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12884 $2 = 72 'H'
12885 (@value{GDBP})
12886 @end smallexample
12887
12888 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12889 literals you use in expressions:
12890
12891 @smallexample
12892 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12893 $3 = 43 '+'
12894 (@value{GDBP})
12895 @end smallexample
12896
12897 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12898 character.
12899
12900 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12901 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12902 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12903
12904 @smallexample
12905 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12906 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12907 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12908 $5 = 200 '\310'
12909 (@value{GDBP})
12910 @end smallexample
12911
12912 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12913 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12914
12915 @smallexample
12916 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12917 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12918 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12919 @end smallexample
12920
12921 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12922 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12923 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12924 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12925 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12926
12927 @smallexample
12928 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12929 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12930 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12931 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12932 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12933 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12934 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12935 $7 = 72 '\110'
12936 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12937 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12938 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12939 $9 = 200 'H'
12940 (@value{GDBP})
12941 @end smallexample
12942
12943 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12944 string literals you use in expressions:
12945
12946 @smallexample
12947 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12948 $10 = 78 '+'
12949 (@value{GDBP})
12950 @end smallexample
12951
12952 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12953 character.
12954
12955 @node Caching Target Data
12956 @section Caching Data of Targets
12957 @cindex caching data of targets
12958
12959 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12960 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12961 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12962 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12963 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12964 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12965 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12966 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12967 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12968 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12969 is executing.
12970 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12971 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12972 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12973 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12974 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12975 in the code segment.
12976 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12977 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12978
12979 @table @code
12980 @kindex set remotecache
12981 @item set remotecache on
12982 @itemx set remotecache off
12983 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12984 with old scripts.
12985
12986 @kindex show remotecache
12987 @item show remotecache
12988 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12989
12990 @kindex set stack-cache
12991 @item set stack-cache on
12992 @itemx set stack-cache off
12993 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12994 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12995
12996 @kindex show stack-cache
12997 @item show stack-cache
12998 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12999
13000 @kindex set code-cache
13001 @item set code-cache on
13002 @itemx set code-cache off
13003 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
13004 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
13005 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
13006
13007 @kindex show code-cache
13008 @item show code-cache
13009 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
13010 accesses.
13011
13012 @kindex info dcache
13013 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
13014 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
13015 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
13016 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
13017 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
13018 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
13019
13020 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
13021 printed in hex.
13022
13023 @item set dcache size @var{size}
13024 @cindex dcache size
13025 @kindex set dcache size
13026 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
13027
13028 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
13029 @cindex dcache line-size
13030 @kindex set dcache line-size
13031 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
13032 Must be a power of 2.
13033
13034 @item show dcache size
13035 @kindex show dcache size
13036 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
13037
13038 @item show dcache line-size
13039 @kindex show dcache line-size
13040 Show default size of dcache lines.
13041
13042 @end table
13043
13044 @node Searching Memory
13045 @section Search Memory
13046 @cindex searching memory
13047
13048 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
13049 @code{find} command.
13050
13051 @table @code
13052 @kindex find
13053 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
13054 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
13055 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
13056 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
13057 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
13058 @end table
13059
13060 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
13061 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
13062
13063 @table @r
13064 @item @var{s}, search query size
13065 The size of each search query value.
13066
13067 @table @code
13068 @item b
13069 bytes
13070 @item h
13071 halfwords (two bytes)
13072 @item w
13073 words (four bytes)
13074 @item g
13075 giant words (eight bytes)
13076 @end table
13077
13078 All values are interpreted in the current language.
13079 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
13080 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
13081 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
13082 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
13083
13084 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
13085 value's type in the current language.
13086 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
13087 pattern as a mixture of types.
13088 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
13089 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
13090 which is typically four bytes.
13091
13092 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
13093 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
13094 @end table
13095
13096 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
13097 (@code{"}).
13098 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
13099 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
13100
13101 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
13102 number of matches found.
13103
13104 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
13105 @samp{$_}.
13106 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
13107
13108 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
13109
13110 @smallexample
13111 void
13112 hello ()
13113 @{
13114 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
13115 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
13116 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
13117 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
13118 printf ("%s\n", hello);
13119 @}
13120 @end smallexample
13121
13122 @noindent
13123 you get during debugging:
13124
13125 @smallexample
13126 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
13127 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
13128 1 pattern found
13129 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
13130 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
13131 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
13132 2 patterns found.
13133 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
13134 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
13135 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
13136 2 patterns found.
13137 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
13138 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
13139 1 pattern found
13140 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
13141 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
13142 1 pattern found
13143 (gdb) print $numfound
13144 $1 = 1
13145 (gdb) print $_
13146 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
13147 @end smallexample
13148
13149 @node Value Sizes
13150 @section Value Sizes
13151
13152 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
13153 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
13154 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
13155 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
13156 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
13157
13158 @table @code
13159 @kindex set max-value-size
13160 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
13161 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
13162 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
13163 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
13164 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
13165
13166 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
13167 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
13168
13169 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
13170 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
13171 currently 16 bytes.
13172
13173 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
13174 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
13175 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
13176 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
13177 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
13178 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
13179 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
13180 size is less than @var{bytes}.
13181
13182 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
13183
13184 @kindex show max-value-size
13185 @item show max-value-size
13186 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
13187 allocate for the contents of a value.
13188 @end table
13189
13190 @node Optimized Code
13191 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
13192 @cindex optimized code, debugging
13193 @cindex debugging optimized code
13194
13195 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
13196 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
13197 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
13198 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
13199 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
13200 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
13201 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
13202
13203 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
13204 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
13205 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
13206 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
13207
13208 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
13209 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
13210 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
13211 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
13212 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
13213 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
13214
13215 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
13216 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
13217 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
13218 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
13219 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
13220
13221 @menu
13222 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
13223 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
13224 @end menu
13225
13226 @node Inline Functions
13227 @section Inline Functions
13228 @cindex inline functions, debugging
13229
13230 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
13231 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
13232 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
13233 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
13234 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
13235 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
13236 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
13237 @code{info frame} command.
13238
13239 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
13240 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
13241 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
13242 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
13243 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
13244 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
13245 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
13246 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
13247 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
13248 local variables in the caller.
13249
13250 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
13251 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
13252 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
13253 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
13254 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
13255 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
13256 instructions are executed.
13257
13258 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
13259 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
13260 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
13261 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
13262
13263 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
13264 function calls are the same as normal calls:
13265
13266 @itemize @bullet
13267 @item
13268 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
13269 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
13270 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
13271 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
13272 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
13273 or inside the inlined function instead.
13274
13275 @item
13276 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
13277 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
13278 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
13279 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
13280
13281 @end itemize
13282
13283 @node Tail Call Frames
13284 @section Tail Call Frames
13285 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
13286
13287 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
13288 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
13289 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
13290 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
13291 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
13292
13293 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
13294 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
13295 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
13296 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
13297 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
13298 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
13299 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
13300
13301 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
13302 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
13303 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
13304 this information.
13305
13306 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
13307 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
13308
13309 @smallexample
13310 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
13311 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
13312 (gdb) info frame
13313 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
13314 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
13315 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
13316 source language c++.
13317 Arglist at unknown address.
13318 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
13319 @end smallexample
13320
13321 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
13322 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
13323 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
13324 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
13325 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
13326 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
13327
13328 @table @code
13329 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
13330 @item set debug entry-values
13331 @kindex set debug entry-values
13332 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
13333 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
13334 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
13335 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
13336 result.
13337
13338 @item show debug entry-values
13339 @kindex show debug entry-values
13340 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
13341 values at function entry and tail calls.
13342 @end table
13343
13344 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
13345 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
13346 reference by variable @code{x}):
13347
13348 @smallexample
13349 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
13350 void (*x) (void) = c;
13351 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
13352 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
13353 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
13354
13355 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
13356 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
13357 a () at t.c:3
13358 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
13359 (gdb) bt
13360 #0 a () at t.c:3
13361 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
13362 @end smallexample
13363
13364 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
13365
13366 @smallexample
13367 int i;
13368 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
13369 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
13370 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
13371 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
13372 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
13373 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
13374 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
13375 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
13376
13377 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
13378 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
13379 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
13380 (gdb) bt
13381 #0 f () at t.c:2
13382 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
13383 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
13384 @end smallexample
13385
13386 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
13387 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
13388
13389 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
13390 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
13391 @set ARROW @click{}
13392 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
13393 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
13394 @end ifset
13395 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
13396 @set ARROW ->
13397 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
13398 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
13399 @end ifclear
13400
13401 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
13402 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
13403 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
13404
13405 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
13406 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
13407 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
13408 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
13409 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
13410 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
13411
13412 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
13413 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
13414 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
13415 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
13416 omitted.
13417
13418 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
13419 entry may fail:
13420
13421 @smallexample
13422 int v;
13423 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
13424 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
13425 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
13426 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
13427 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
13428 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
13429
13430 (gdb) bt
13431 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
13432 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
13433 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
13434 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
13435 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
13436 @end smallexample
13437
13438 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
13439 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
13440 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
13441 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
13442 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
13443
13444 @node Macros
13445 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
13446
13447 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
13448 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
13449 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
13450 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
13451 where it was defined.
13452
13453 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
13454 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
13455 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
13456 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
13457
13458 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
13459 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
13460 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
13461 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
13462 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
13463 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
13464 see @ref{List}.
13465
13466 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
13467 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
13468 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
13469
13470 @table @code
13471
13472 @kindex macro expand
13473 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
13474 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
13475 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
13476 @item macro expand @var{expression}
13477 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
13478 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
13479 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
13480 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
13481 it can be any string of tokens.
13482
13483 @kindex macro exp1
13484 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
13485 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
13486 @cindex expand macro once
13487 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
13488 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
13489 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
13490 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
13491 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
13492 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
13493 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
13494 can be any string of tokens.
13495
13496 @kindex info macro
13497 @cindex macro definition, showing
13498 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
13499 @cindex macros, from debug info
13500 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
13501 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
13502 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
13503 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
13504 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
13505 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
13506
13507 @kindex info macros
13508 @item info macros @var{location}
13509 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
13510 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
13511 command-line where those definitions were established.
13512
13513 @kindex macro define
13514 @cindex user-defined macros
13515 @cindex defining macros interactively
13516 @cindex macros, user-defined
13517 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
13518 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
13519 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
13520 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
13521 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
13522 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
13523 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
13524 @var{arglist}.
13525
13526 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
13527 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
13528 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
13529 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
13530 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
13531
13532 @kindex macro undef
13533 @item macro undef @var{macro}
13534 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
13535 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
13536 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
13537 in the program being debugged.
13538
13539 @kindex macro list
13540 @item macro list
13541 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
13542 @end table
13543
13544 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
13545 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
13546 show our source files:
13547
13548 @smallexample
13549 $ cat sample.c
13550 #include <stdio.h>
13551 #include "sample.h"
13552
13553 #define M 42
13554 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13555
13556 main ()
13557 @{
13558 #define N 28
13559 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13560 #undef N
13561 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13562 #define N 1729
13563 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
13564 @}
13565 $ cat sample.h
13566 #define Q <
13567 $
13568 @end smallexample
13569
13570 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
13571 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
13572 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
13573 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
13574 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
13575 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
13576 information.
13577
13578 @smallexample
13579 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
13580 $
13581 @end smallexample
13582
13583 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
13584
13585 @smallexample
13586 $ gdb -nw sample
13587 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
13588 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
13589 GDB is free software, @dots{}
13590 (@value{GDBP})
13591 @end smallexample
13592
13593 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
13594 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
13595 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
13596
13597 @smallexample
13598 (@value{GDBP}) list main
13599 3
13600 4 #define M 42
13601 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13602 6
13603 7 main ()
13604 8 @{
13605 9 #define N 28
13606 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13607 11 #undef N
13608 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13609 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
13610 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
13611 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
13612 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
13613 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
13614 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
13615 #define Q <
13616 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
13617 expands to: (42 + 1)
13618 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
13619 expands to: once (M + 1)
13620 (@value{GDBP})
13621 @end smallexample
13622
13623 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
13624 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
13625 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
13626 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
13627
13628 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
13629 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
13630
13631 @smallexample
13632 (@value{GDBP}) break main
13633 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
13634 (@value{GDBP}) run
13635 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
13636
13637 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
13638 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
13639 (@value{GDBP})
13640 @end smallexample
13641
13642 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
13643
13644 @smallexample
13645 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13646 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
13647 #define N 28
13648 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
13649 expands to: 28 < 42
13650 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13651 $1 = 1
13652 (@value{GDBP})
13653 @end smallexample
13654
13655 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
13656 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
13657 thereof) in force at each point:
13658
13659 @smallexample
13660 (@value{GDBP}) next
13661 Hello, world!
13662 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
13663 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13664 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
13665 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
13666 (@value{GDBP}) next
13667 We're so creative.
13668 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
13669 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
13670 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
13671 #define N 1729
13672 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
13673 expands to: 1729 < 42
13674 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
13675 $2 = 0
13676 (@value{GDBP})
13677 @end smallexample
13678
13679 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
13680 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
13681 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
13682 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
13683
13684 @smallexample
13685 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
13686 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
13687 -D__STDC__=1
13688 (@value{GDBP})
13689 @end smallexample
13690
13691
13692 @node Tracepoints
13693 @chapter Tracepoints
13694 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
13695 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
13696
13697 @cindex tracepoints
13698 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
13699 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
13700 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
13701 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
13702 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
13703 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
13704 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
13705
13706 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
13707 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
13708 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
13709 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
13710 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
13711 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
13712 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
13713 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
13714 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
13715 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
13716 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
13717
13718 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
13719 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
13720 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
13721 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
13722 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
13723 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
13724 Packets}.
13725
13726 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
13727 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
13728 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
13729
13730 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
13731
13732 @menu
13733 * Set Tracepoints::
13734 * Analyze Collected Data::
13735 * Tracepoint Variables::
13736 * Trace Files::
13737 @end menu
13738
13739 @node Set Tracepoints
13740 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
13741
13742 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
13743 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
13744 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
13745 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
13746 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
13747 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
13748 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
13749
13750 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
13751 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
13752 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
13753 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
13754 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
13755 tracepoint was hit.
13756
13757 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
13758 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
13759 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
13760 either.
13761
13762 @cindex fast tracepoints
13763 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
13764 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
13765 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
13766
13767 @cindex static tracepoints
13768 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
13769 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
13770 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
13771 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
13772 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
13773 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
13774 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
13775 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
13776 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
13777 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
13778 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
13779 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
13780 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
13781 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
13782 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
13783 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
13784 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
13785 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
13786 static tracepoint marker.
13787
13788 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
13789 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
13790
13791 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
13792 conditions and actions.
13793
13794 @menu
13795 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
13796 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
13797 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
13798 * Tracepoint Conditions::
13799 * Trace State Variables::
13800 * Tracepoint Actions::
13801 * Listing Tracepoints::
13802 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13803 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13804 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13805 @end menu
13806
13807 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13808 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13809
13810 @table @code
13811 @cindex set tracepoint
13812 @kindex trace
13813 @item trace @var{location}
13814 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13815 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13816 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13817 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13818 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13819 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13820 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13821 in tracing}).
13822 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13823 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13824 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13825 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13826 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13827 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13828 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13829 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13830 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13831 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13832 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13833 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13834
13835 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13836
13837 @smallexample
13838 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13839
13840 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13841
13842 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13843
13844 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13845
13846 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13847 @end smallexample
13848
13849 @noindent
13850 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13851
13852 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13853 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13854 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13855 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13856 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13857 information on tracepoint conditions.
13858
13859 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13860 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13861 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13862 @kindex ftrace
13863 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13864 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13865 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13866 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13867 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13868 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13869 message.
13870
13871 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13872 @code{trace}.
13873
13874 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13875 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13876 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13877 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13878 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13879 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13880 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13881 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13882
13883 @example
13884 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13885 @end example
13886
13887 @noindent
13888 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13889 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13890
13891 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13892 @cindex set static tracepoint
13893 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13894 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13895 @kindex strace
13896 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13897 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13898 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13899 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13900 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13901
13902 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13903 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13904 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13905 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13906 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13907 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13908 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13909 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13910 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13911 tracing engine:
13912
13913 @smallexample
13914 main ()
13915 @{
13916 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13917 @}
13918 @end smallexample
13919
13920 @noindent
13921 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13922 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13923
13924 @smallexample
13925 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13926 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13927 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13928 Data: "str %s"
13929 [etc...]
13930 @end smallexample
13931
13932 @noindent
13933 so you may probe the marker above with:
13934
13935 @smallexample
13936 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13937 @end smallexample
13938
13939 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13940 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13941 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13942 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13943 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13944 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13945 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13946 the @samp{Data:} field.
13947
13948 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13949 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13950 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13951
13952 @vindex $tpnum
13953 @cindex last tracepoint number
13954 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13955 @cindex tracepoint number
13956 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13957 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13958
13959 @kindex delete tracepoint
13960 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13961 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13962 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13963 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13964 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13965
13966 Examples:
13967
13968 @smallexample
13969 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13970
13971 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13972 @end smallexample
13973
13974 @noindent
13975 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13976 @end table
13977
13978 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13979 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13980
13981 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13982
13983 @table @code
13984 @kindex disable tracepoint
13985 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13986 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13987 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13988 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13989 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13990 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13991 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13992 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13993 next trace experiment.
13994
13995 @kindex enable tracepoint
13996 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13997 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13998 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13999 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
14000 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
14001 next time a trace experiment is run.
14002 @end table
14003
14004 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
14005 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
14006
14007 @table @code
14008 @kindex passcount
14009 @cindex tracepoint pass count
14010 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
14011 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
14012 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
14013 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
14014 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
14015 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
14016 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
14017 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
14018 user.
14019
14020 Examples:
14021
14022 @smallexample
14023 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
14024 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
14025
14026 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
14027 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
14028 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
14029 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
14030 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
14031 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
14032 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
14033 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
14034 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
14035 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
14036 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
14037 @end smallexample
14038 @end table
14039
14040 @node Tracepoint Conditions
14041 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
14042 @cindex conditional tracepoints
14043 @cindex tracepoint conditions
14044
14045 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
14046 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
14047 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
14048 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
14049 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
14050 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
14051 is true.
14052
14053 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
14054 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
14055 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
14056 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
14057 just as with breakpoints.
14058
14059 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
14060 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
14061 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
14062 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
14063 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
14064 accesses, and so forth.
14065
14066 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
14067 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
14068 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
14069 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
14070 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
14071 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
14072 search through.
14073
14074 @smallexample
14075 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
14076 @end smallexample
14077
14078 @node Trace State Variables
14079 @subsection Trace State Variables
14080 @cindex trace state variables
14081
14082 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
14083 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
14084 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
14085 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
14086 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
14087 integers.
14088
14089 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
14090 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
14091 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
14092 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
14093
14094 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
14095 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
14096 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
14097 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
14098 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
14099 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
14100 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
14101 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
14102 variable with the same name.
14103
14104 @table @code
14105
14106 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
14107 @kindex tvariable
14108 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
14109 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
14110 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
14111 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
14112 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
14113 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
14114 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
14115 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
14116 value. The default initial value is 0.
14117
14118 @item info tvariables
14119 @kindex info tvariables
14120 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
14121 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
14122 currently running.
14123
14124 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
14125 @kindex delete tvariable
14126 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
14127 are specified.
14128
14129 @end table
14130
14131 @node Tracepoint Actions
14132 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
14133
14134 @table @code
14135 @kindex actions
14136 @cindex tracepoint actions
14137 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
14138 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
14139 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
14140 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
14141 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
14142 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
14143 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
14144 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
14145 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
14146 @code{while-stepping}.
14147
14148 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
14149 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
14150 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
14151
14152 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
14153 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
14154 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
14155
14156 @smallexample
14157 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
14158
14159 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
14160
14161 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
14162 @end smallexample
14163
14164 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
14165 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
14166 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
14167 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
14168 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
14169 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
14170 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
14171 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
14172
14173 @smallexample
14174 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
14175 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14176 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
14177 > collect bar,baz
14178 > collect $regs
14179 > while-stepping 12
14180 > collect $pc, arr[i]
14181 > end
14182 end
14183 @end smallexample
14184
14185 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
14186 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
14187 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
14188 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
14189 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
14190 special arguments are supported:
14191
14192 @table @code
14193 @item $regs
14194 Collect all registers.
14195
14196 @item $args
14197 Collect all function arguments.
14198
14199 @item $locals
14200 Collect all local variables.
14201
14202 @item $_ret
14203 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
14204 of a backtrace.
14205
14206 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
14207 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
14208 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
14209 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
14210 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
14211 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
14212
14213 @item $_probe_argc
14214 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
14215 tracepoint is located.
14216 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
14217
14218 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
14219 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
14220 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
14221 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
14222
14223 @item $_sdata
14224 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
14225 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
14226 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
14227 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
14228 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
14229 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
14230 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
14231 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
14232 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
14233
14234 @smallexample
14235 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
14236 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
14237 @end smallexample
14238
14239 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
14240 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
14241 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
14242 @value{GDBN}.
14243 @end table
14244
14245 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
14246 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
14247 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
14248
14249 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
14250 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
14251 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
14252 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
14253 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
14254 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
14255 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
14256 @samp{mystr}.
14257
14258 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
14259 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
14260
14261 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
14262 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
14263 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
14264 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
14265 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
14266 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
14267 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
14268 action were used.
14269
14270 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
14271 @item while-stepping @var{n}
14272 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
14273 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
14274 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
14275 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
14276
14277 @smallexample
14278 > while-stepping 12
14279 > collect $regs, myglobal
14280 > end
14281 >
14282 @end smallexample
14283
14284 @noindent
14285 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
14286 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
14287 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
14288 @code{stepping}.
14289
14290 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
14291 @kindex set default-collect
14292 @cindex default collection action
14293 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
14294 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
14295 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
14296 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
14297 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
14298 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
14299
14300 @item show default-collect
14301 @kindex show default-collect
14302 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
14303 tracepoint hit.
14304
14305 @end table
14306
14307 @node Listing Tracepoints
14308 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
14309
14310 @table @code
14311 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
14312 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
14313 @cindex information about tracepoints
14314 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
14315 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
14316 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
14317 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
14318 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
14319 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
14320
14321 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
14322 tracing:
14323
14324 @itemize @bullet
14325 @item
14326 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
14327
14328 @item
14329 the state about installed on target of each location
14330 @end itemize
14331
14332 @smallexample
14333 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
14334 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
14335 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
14336 while-stepping 20
14337 collect globfoo, $regs
14338 end
14339 collect globfoo2
14340 end
14341 pass count 1200
14342 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
14343 collect $eip
14344 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
14345 installed on target
14346 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
14347 installed on target
14348 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
14349 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
14350 not installed on target
14351 (@value{GDBP})
14352 @end smallexample
14353
14354 @noindent
14355 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
14356 @end table
14357
14358 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
14359 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
14360
14361 @table @code
14362 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
14363 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
14364 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
14365 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
14366 program.
14367
14368 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
14369
14370 @table @emph
14371 @item Count
14372 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
14373 stable identifier.
14374 @item ID
14375 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
14376 @item Enabled or Disabled
14377 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
14378 that are not enabled.
14379 @item Address
14380 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
14381 @item What
14382 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
14383 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
14384 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
14385 will be left blank.
14386 @end table
14387
14388 @noindent
14389 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
14390
14391 @table @emph
14392 @item Data
14393 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
14394 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
14395 marker call.
14396 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
14397 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
14398 @end table
14399
14400 @smallexample
14401 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
14402 Cnt ID Enb Address What
14403 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
14404 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
14405 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
14406 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
14407 Data: str %s
14408 (@value{GDBP})
14409 @end smallexample
14410 @end table
14411
14412 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
14413 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
14414
14415 @table @code
14416 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
14417 @cindex start a new trace experiment
14418 @cindex collected data discarded
14419 @item tstart
14420 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
14421 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
14422 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
14423 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
14424 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
14425 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
14426 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
14427 information, and so forth.
14428
14429 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
14430 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
14431 @item tstop
14432 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
14433 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
14434 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
14435 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
14436 needs to be stopped quickly.
14437
14438 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
14439 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
14440 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
14441
14442 @kindex tstatus
14443 @cindex status of trace data collection
14444 @cindex trace experiment, status of
14445 @item tstatus
14446 This command displays the status of the current trace data
14447 collection.
14448 @end table
14449
14450 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
14451
14452 @smallexample
14453 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
14454 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14455 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
14456 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
14457 > while-stepping 11
14458 > collect $regs
14459 > end
14460 > end
14461 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14462 [time passes @dots{}]
14463 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
14464 @end smallexample
14465
14466 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
14467 @cindex disconnected tracing
14468 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
14469 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
14470 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
14471 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
14472 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
14473 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
14474 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
14475 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
14476
14477 @table @code
14478 @item set disconnected-tracing on
14479 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
14480 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
14481 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
14482 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
14483 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
14484 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
14485 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
14486
14487 @item show disconnected-tracing
14488 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
14489 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
14490
14491 @end table
14492
14493 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
14494 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
14495 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
14496 it will continue after reconnection.
14497
14498 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
14499 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
14500 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
14501 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
14502 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
14503 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
14504 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
14505 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
14506 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
14507 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
14508
14509 @cindex circular trace buffer
14510 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
14511 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
14512 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
14513 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
14514 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
14515 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
14516 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
14517 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
14518 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
14519 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
14520 the next run.
14521
14522 @table @code
14523 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
14524 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
14525 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
14526 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
14527 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
14528 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
14529 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
14530
14531 @item show circular-trace-buffer
14532 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
14533 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
14534 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
14535 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
14536 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
14537
14538 @end table
14539
14540 @table @code
14541 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
14542 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
14543 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
14544 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
14545 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
14546 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
14547 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
14548 likes. This is also the default.
14549
14550 @item show trace-buffer-size
14551 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
14552 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
14553 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
14554 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
14555 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
14556 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
14557 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
14558 @end table
14559
14560 @table @code
14561 @item set trace-user @var{text}
14562 @kindex set trace-user
14563
14564 @item show trace-user
14565 @kindex show trace-user
14566
14567 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
14568 @kindex set trace-notes
14569 Set the trace run's notes.
14570
14571 @item show trace-notes
14572 @kindex show trace-notes
14573 Show the trace run's notes.
14574
14575 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
14576 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
14577 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
14578 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
14579 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
14580
14581 @item show trace-stop-notes
14582 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
14583 Show the trace run's stop notes.
14584
14585 @end table
14586
14587 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
14588 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
14589
14590 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
14591 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
14592 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
14593 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
14594 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
14595 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
14596 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
14597 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
14598 mentioned here.
14599
14600 @itemize @bullet
14601
14602 @item
14603 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
14604 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
14605 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
14606 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
14607 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
14608 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
14609 cannot be collected either.
14610
14611 @item
14612 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
14613 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
14614 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
14615 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
14616 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
14617 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
14618 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
14619 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
14620 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
14621 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
14622
14623 @item
14624 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
14625 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
14626 in a misleading way.
14627
14628 @item
14629 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
14630 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
14631 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
14632 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
14633 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
14634 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
14635 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
14636 by @code{ptr}.
14637
14638 @item
14639 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
14640 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
14641 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
14642 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
14643 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
14644 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
14645 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
14646 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
14647 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
14648 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
14649 invalid address.
14650
14651 @item
14652 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
14653 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
14654 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
14655 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
14656 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
14657 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
14658 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
14659 it to zero.
14660
14661 @end itemize
14662
14663 @node Analyze Collected Data
14664 @section Using the Collected Data
14665
14666 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
14667 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
14668 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
14669 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
14670 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
14671 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
14672 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
14673 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
14674 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
14675 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
14676 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
14677 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
14678 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
14679 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
14680 the buffer will fail.
14681
14682 @menu
14683 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
14684 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
14685 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
14686 @end menu
14687
14688 @node tfind
14689 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
14690
14691 @kindex tfind
14692 @cindex select trace snapshot
14693 @cindex find trace snapshot
14694 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
14695 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
14696 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
14697 snapshot is selected.
14698
14699 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
14700
14701 @table @code
14702 @item tfind start
14703 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
14704 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
14705
14706 @item tfind none
14707 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
14708
14709 @item tfind end
14710 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
14711
14712 @item tfind
14713 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
14714 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
14715
14716 @item tfind -
14717 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
14718 retracing earlier steps.
14719
14720 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
14721 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
14722 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
14723 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
14724 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
14725
14726 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
14727 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
14728 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
14729 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
14730 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
14731
14732 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14733 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
14734 addresses (exclusive).
14735
14736 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
14737 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
14738 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
14739
14740 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
14741 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
14742 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
14743 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
14744 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
14745 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
14746 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
14747 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
14748 @end table
14749
14750 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
14751 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
14752 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
14753 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
14754 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
14755 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
14756 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
14757 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
14758 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
14759 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
14760 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
14761 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
14762 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
14763 tracepoint as the current one.
14764
14765 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
14766 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
14767 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
14768 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
14769 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
14770
14771 @smallexample
14772 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14773 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14774 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
14775 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
14776 > tfind
14777 > end
14778
14779 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
14780 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
14781 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
14782 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
14783 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
14784 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
14785 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
14786 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
14787 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
14788 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
14789 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
14790 @end smallexample
14791
14792 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
14793 the buffer:
14794
14795 @smallexample
14796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14797 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
14798 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
14799 > tfind line
14800 > end
14801
14802 Frame 0, X = 1
14803 Frame 7, X = 2
14804 Frame 13, X = 255
14805 @end smallexample
14806
14807 @node tdump
14808 @subsection @code{tdump}
14809 @kindex tdump
14810 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14811 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14812
14813 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14814 the current trace snapshot.
14815
14816 @smallexample
14817 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14818 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14819 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14820 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14821 > end
14822
14823 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14824
14825 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14826 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14827 at gdb_test.c:444
14828 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14829
14830 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14831 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14832 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14833 d1 0x18 24
14834 d2 0x80 128
14835 d3 0x33 51
14836 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14837 d5 0x22 34
14838 d6 0xe0 224
14839 d7 0x380035 3670069
14840 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14841 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14842 a2 0x100 256
14843 a3 0x322000 3284992
14844 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14845 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14846 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14847 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14848 ps 0x0 0
14849 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14850 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14851 fpstatus 0x0 0
14852 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14853 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14854 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14855 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14856 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14857 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14858 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14859 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14860 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14861
14862 (@value{GDBP})
14863 @end smallexample
14864
14865 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14866 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14867 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14868 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14869
14870 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14871 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14872 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14873 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14874 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14875 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14876 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14877 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14878 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14879 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14880
14881 @node save tracepoints
14882 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14883 @kindex save tracepoints
14884 @kindex save-tracepoints
14885 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14886
14887 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14888 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14889 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14890 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14891 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14892 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14893
14894 @node Tracepoint Variables
14895 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14896 @cindex tracepoint variables
14897 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14898
14899 @table @code
14900 @vindex $trace_frame
14901 @item (int) $trace_frame
14902 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14903 snapshot is selected.
14904
14905 @vindex $tracepoint
14906 @item (int) $tracepoint
14907 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14908
14909 @vindex $trace_line
14910 @item (int) $trace_line
14911 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14912
14913 @vindex $trace_file
14914 @item (char []) $trace_file
14915 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14916
14917 @vindex $trace_func
14918 @item (char []) $trace_func
14919 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14920 @end table
14921
14922 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14923 use @code{output} instead.
14924
14925 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14926 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14927 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14928 which are managed by the target.
14929
14930 @smallexample
14931 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14932
14933 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14934 > output $trace_file
14935 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14936 > tfind
14937 > end
14938 @end smallexample
14939
14940 @node Trace Files
14941 @section Using Trace Files
14942 @cindex trace files
14943
14944 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14945 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14946 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14947 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14948 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14949
14950 @table @code
14951
14952 @kindex tsave
14953 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14954 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14955 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14956 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14957 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14958 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14959 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14960 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14961 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14962 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14963 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14964 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14965 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14966 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14967 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14968
14969 @kindex target tfile
14970 @kindex tfile
14971 @kindex target ctf
14972 @kindex ctf
14973 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14974 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14975 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14976 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14977 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14978 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14979 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14980 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14981 the host.
14982
14983 @smallexample
14984 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14985 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14986 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14987 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14988 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14989 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14990 i = 0
14991 a = 0
14992 b = 1 '\001'
14993 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14994 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14995 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14996 $1 = 1
14997 @end smallexample
14998
14999 @end table
15000
15001 @node Overlays
15002 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
15003 @cindex overlays
15004
15005 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
15006 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
15007 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
15008 use overlays.
15009
15010 @menu
15011 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
15012 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
15013 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
15014 mapped by asking the inferior.
15015 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
15016 @end menu
15017
15018 @node How Overlays Work
15019 @section How Overlays Work
15020 @cindex mapped overlays
15021 @cindex unmapped overlays
15022 @cindex load address, overlay's
15023 @cindex mapped address
15024 @cindex overlay area
15025
15026 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
15027 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
15028 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
15029 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
15030 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
15031
15032 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
15033 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
15034 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
15035 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
15036 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
15037 largest overlay as well.
15038
15039 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
15040 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
15041 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
15042 there.
15043
15044 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
15045 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
15046 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
15047
15048 @smallexample
15049 @group
15050 Data Instruction Larger
15051 Address Space Address Space Address Space
15052 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
15053 | | | | | |
15054 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
15055 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
15056 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
15057 | and heap | | | | | |
15058 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
15059 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
15060 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
15061 | | | | | |
15062 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
15063 address | | | | | |
15064 | overlay | <-' | | |
15065 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
15066 | | <---. | | load address
15067 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
15068 | | | |
15069 +-----------+ | |
15070 +-----------+
15071 | |
15072 +-----------+
15073
15074 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
15075 @end group
15076 @end smallexample
15077
15078 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
15079 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
15080 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
15081 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
15082 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
15083 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
15084 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
15085 program and the overlay area.
15086
15087 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
15088 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
15089 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
15090 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
15091 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
15092 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
15093 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
15094
15095 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
15096 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
15097 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
15098
15099 @itemize @bullet
15100
15101 @item
15102 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
15103 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
15104 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
15105 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
15106
15107 @item
15108 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
15109 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
15110 your program's performance.
15111
15112 @item
15113 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
15114 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
15115 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
15116 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
15117 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
15118 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
15119 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
15120
15121 @item
15122 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
15123 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
15124 instruction and data spaces.
15125
15126 @end itemize
15127
15128 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
15129 improved in many ways:
15130
15131 @itemize @bullet
15132
15133 @item
15134 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
15135 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
15136 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
15137 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
15138 area in the usual way.
15139
15140 @item
15141 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
15142 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
15143
15144 @item
15145 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
15146 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
15147 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
15148 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
15149 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
15150 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
15151 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
15152
15153 @end itemize
15154
15155
15156 @node Overlay Commands
15157 @section Overlay Commands
15158
15159 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
15160 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
15161 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
15162 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
15163 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
15164 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
15165
15166 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
15167 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
15168
15169 @table @code
15170 @item overlay off
15171 @kindex overlay
15172 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
15173 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
15174 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
15175 overlay support is disabled.
15176
15177 @item overlay manual
15178 @cindex manual overlay debugging
15179 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
15180 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
15181 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
15182 commands described below.
15183
15184 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
15185 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
15186 @cindex map an overlay
15187 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
15188 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
15189 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
15190 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
15191 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
15192 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
15193
15194 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
15195 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
15196 @cindex unmap an overlay
15197 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
15198 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
15199 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
15200 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
15201
15202 @item overlay auto
15203 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
15204 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
15205 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
15206 Overlay Debugging}.
15207
15208 @item overlay load-target
15209 @itemx overlay load
15210 @cindex reloading the overlay table
15211 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
15212 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
15213 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
15214 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
15215 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
15216
15217 @item overlay list-overlays
15218 @itemx overlay list
15219 @cindex listing mapped overlays
15220 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
15221 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
15222
15223 @end table
15224
15225 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
15226 of the function the address falls in:
15227
15228 @smallexample
15229 (@value{GDBP}) print main
15230 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
15231 @end smallexample
15232 @noindent
15233 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
15234 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
15235 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
15236 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
15237
15238 @smallexample
15239 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
15240 No sections are mapped.
15241 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
15242 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
15243 @end smallexample
15244 @noindent
15245 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
15246 name normally:
15247
15248 @smallexample
15249 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
15250 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
15251 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
15252 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
15253 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
15254 @end smallexample
15255
15256 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
15257 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
15258 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
15259 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
15260 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
15261
15262 @itemize @bullet
15263 @item
15264 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
15265 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
15266 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
15267 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
15268 @item
15269 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
15270 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
15271 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
15272 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
15273 breakpoints properly.
15274 @end itemize
15275
15276
15277 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
15278 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
15279 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
15280
15281 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
15282 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
15283 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
15284 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
15285 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
15286 current state of the overlays.
15287
15288 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
15289 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
15290
15291 @table @asis
15292
15293 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
15294 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
15295
15296 @smallexample
15297 struct
15298 @{
15299 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
15300 unsigned long vma;
15301
15302 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
15303 unsigned long size;
15304
15305 /* The overlay's load address. */
15306 unsigned long lma;
15307
15308 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
15309 zero otherwise. */
15310 unsigned long mapped;
15311 @}
15312 @end smallexample
15313
15314 @item @code{_novlys}:
15315 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
15316 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
15317
15318 @end table
15319
15320 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
15321 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
15322 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
15323 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
15324 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
15325 currently mapped.
15326
15327 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
15328 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
15329 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
15330 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
15331 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
15332 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
15333 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
15334 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
15335 are not being executed.
15336
15337 @node Overlay Sample Program
15338 @section Overlay Sample Program
15339 @cindex overlay example program
15340
15341 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
15342 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
15343 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
15344 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
15345 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
15346 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
15347 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
15348
15349 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
15350 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
15351 suite. The program consists of the following files from
15352 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
15353
15354 @table @file
15355 @item overlays.c
15356 The main program file.
15357 @item ovlymgr.c
15358 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
15359 @item foo.c
15360 @itemx bar.c
15361 @itemx baz.c
15362 @itemx grbx.c
15363 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
15364 @item d10v.ld
15365 @itemx m32r.ld
15366 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
15367 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
15368 @end table
15369
15370 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
15371 cross-compiler like this:
15372
15373 @smallexample
15374 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
15375 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
15376 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
15377 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
15378 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
15379 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
15380 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
15381 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
15382 @end smallexample
15383
15384 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
15385 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
15386 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
15387
15388
15389 @node Languages
15390 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
15391 @cindex languages
15392
15393 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
15394 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
15395 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
15396 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
15397 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
15398 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
15399
15400 @cindex working language
15401 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
15402 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
15403 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
15404 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
15405 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
15406 language}.
15407
15408 @menu
15409 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
15410 * Show:: Displaying the language
15411 * Checks:: Type and range checks
15412 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
15413 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
15414 @end menu
15415
15416 @node Setting
15417 @section Switching Between Source Languages
15418
15419 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
15420 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
15421 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
15422 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
15423 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
15424 are printed, etc.
15425
15426 In addition to the working language, every source file that
15427 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
15428 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
15429 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
15430 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
15431 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
15432 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
15433 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
15434 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
15435 Displaying the Language}.
15436
15437 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
15438 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
15439 another language. In that case, make the
15440 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
15441 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
15442 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
15443
15444 @menu
15445 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
15446 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
15447 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
15448 @end menu
15449
15450 @node Filenames
15451 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
15452
15453 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
15454 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
15455
15456 @table @file
15457 @item .ada
15458 @itemx .ads
15459 @itemx .adb
15460 @itemx .a
15461 Ada source file.
15462
15463 @item .c
15464 C source file
15465
15466 @item .C
15467 @itemx .cc
15468 @itemx .cp
15469 @itemx .cpp
15470 @itemx .cxx
15471 @itemx .c++
15472 C@t{++} source file
15473
15474 @item .d
15475 D source file
15476
15477 @item .m
15478 Objective-C source file
15479
15480 @item .f
15481 @itemx .F
15482 Fortran source file
15483
15484 @item .mod
15485 Modula-2 source file
15486
15487 @item .s
15488 @itemx .S
15489 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
15490 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
15491 @end table
15492
15493 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
15494 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
15495
15496 @node Manually
15497 @subsection Setting the Working Language
15498
15499 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
15500 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
15501 your program.
15502
15503 @kindex set language
15504 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
15505 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
15506 a language, such as
15507 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
15508 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
15509
15510 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
15511 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
15512 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
15513 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
15514 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
15515 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
15516 command such as:
15517
15518 @smallexample
15519 print a = b + c
15520 @end smallexample
15521
15522 @noindent
15523 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
15524 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
15525 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
15526 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
15527
15528 @node Automatically
15529 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
15530
15531 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
15532 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
15533 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
15534 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
15535 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
15536 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
15537 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
15538 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
15539 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
15540
15541 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
15542 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
15543 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
15544 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
15545 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
15546
15547 @node Show
15548 @section Displaying the Language
15549
15550 The following commands help you find out which language is the
15551 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
15552
15553 @table @code
15554 @item show language
15555 @anchor{show language}
15556 @kindex show language
15557 Display the current working language. This is the
15558 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
15559 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
15560
15561 @item info frame
15562 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
15563 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
15564 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
15565 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
15566 information listed here.
15567
15568 @item info source
15569 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
15570 Display the source language of this source file.
15571 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
15572 information listed here.
15573 @end table
15574
15575 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
15576 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
15577 with a language explicitly:
15578
15579 @table @code
15580 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
15581 @kindex set extension-language
15582 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
15583 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
15584
15585 @item info extensions
15586 @kindex info extensions
15587 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
15588 @end table
15589
15590 @node Checks
15591 @section Type and Range Checking
15592
15593 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
15594 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
15595 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
15596 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
15597 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
15598 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
15599 errors when your program is running.
15600
15601 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
15602 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
15603 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
15604 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
15605
15606 @menu
15607 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
15608 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
15609 @end menu
15610
15611 @cindex type checking
15612 @cindex checks, type
15613 @node Type Checking
15614 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
15615
15616 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
15617 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
15618 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
15619 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
15620
15621 @smallexample
15622 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
15623
15624 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
15625 $1 = 2
15626 @exdent but
15627 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
15628 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
15629 @end smallexample
15630
15631 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
15632 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
15633
15634 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15635 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
15636 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
15637 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
15638 expressions like the second example above.
15639
15640 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
15641 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
15642 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
15643 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
15644 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
15645 little sense to evaluate anyway.
15646
15647 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
15648
15649 @kindex set check type
15650 @kindex show check type
15651 @table @code
15652 @item set check type on
15653 @itemx set check type off
15654 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
15655 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
15656 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
15657
15658 @item show check type
15659 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
15660 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
15661 @end table
15662
15663 @cindex range checking
15664 @cindex checks, range
15665 @node Range Checking
15666 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
15667
15668 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
15669 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
15670 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
15671 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
15672 not exceed the bounds of the array.
15673
15674 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
15675 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
15676 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
15677 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
15678
15679 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
15680 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
15681 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
15682 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
15683 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
15684 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
15685
15686 @smallexample
15687 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
15688 @end smallexample
15689
15690 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
15691 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
15692 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
15693
15694 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
15695
15696 @kindex set check range
15697 @kindex show check range
15698 @table @code
15699 @item set check range auto
15700 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
15701 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
15702 each language.
15703
15704 @item set check range on
15705 @itemx set check range off
15706 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
15707 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
15708 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
15709 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
15710
15711 @item set check range warn
15712 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
15713 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
15714 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
15715 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
15716 systems).
15717
15718 @item show range
15719 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
15720 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
15721 @end table
15722
15723 @node Supported Languages
15724 @section Supported Languages
15725
15726 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
15727 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
15728 @c This is false ...
15729 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
15730 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
15731 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
15732 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
15733 language.
15734
15735 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
15736 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
15737 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
15738 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
15739 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
15740 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
15741 language reference or tutorial.
15742
15743 @menu
15744 * C:: C and C@t{++}
15745 * D:: D
15746 * Go:: Go
15747 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
15748 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
15749 * Fortran:: Fortran
15750 * Pascal:: Pascal
15751 * Rust:: Rust
15752 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
15753 * Ada:: Ada
15754 @end menu
15755
15756 @node C
15757 @subsection C and C@t{++}
15758
15759 @cindex C and C@t{++}
15760 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
15761
15762 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
15763 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
15764 together.
15765
15766 @cindex C@t{++}
15767 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
15768 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
15769 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
15770 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
15771 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
15772 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
15773 compiler (@code{aCC}).
15774
15775 @menu
15776 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
15777 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
15778 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
15779 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
15780 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
15781 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
15782 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
15783 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
15784 @end menu
15785
15786 @node C Operators
15787 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
15788
15789 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
15790
15791 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15792 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15793 often defined on groups of types.
15794
15795 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
15796
15797 @itemize @bullet
15798
15799 @item
15800 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
15801 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
15802
15803 @item
15804 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15805 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15806
15807 @item
15808 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15809
15810 @item
15811 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15812
15813 @end itemize
15814
15815 @noindent
15816 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15817 in order of increasing precedence:
15818
15819 @table @code
15820 @item ,
15821 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15822 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15823 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15824
15825 @item =
15826 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15827 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15828
15829 @item @var{op}=
15830 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15831 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15832 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15833 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15834 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15835
15836 @item ?:
15837 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15838 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15839 should be of an integral type.
15840
15841 @item ||
15842 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15843
15844 @item &&
15845 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15846
15847 @item |
15848 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15849
15850 @item ^
15851 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15852
15853 @item &
15854 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15855
15856 @item ==@r{, }!=
15857 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15858 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15859
15860 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15861 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15862 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15863 and non-zero for true.
15864
15865 @item <<@r{, }>>
15866 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15867
15868 @item @@
15869 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15870
15871 @item +@r{, }-
15872 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15873 pointer types.
15874
15875 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15876 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15877 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15878 integral types.
15879
15880 @item ++@r{, }--
15881 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15882 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15883 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15884 operation takes place.
15885
15886 @item *
15887 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15888 @code{++}.
15889
15890 @item &
15891 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15892
15893 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15894 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15895 to examine the address
15896 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15897 stored.
15898
15899 @item -
15900 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15901 precedence as @code{++}.
15902
15903 @item !
15904 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15905 @code{++}.
15906
15907 @item ~
15908 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15909 @code{++}.
15910
15911
15912 @item .@r{, }->
15913 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15914 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15915 pointer based on the stored type information.
15916 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15917
15918 @item .*@r{, }->*
15919 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15920
15921 @item []
15922 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15923 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15924
15925 @item ()
15926 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15927
15928 @item ::
15929 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15930 and @code{class} types.
15931
15932 @item ::
15933 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15934 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15935 above.
15936 @end table
15937
15938 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15939 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15940 predefined meaning.
15941
15942 @node C Constants
15943 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15944
15945 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15946
15947 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15948 following ways:
15949
15950 @itemize @bullet
15951 @item
15952 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15953 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15954 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15955 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15956 @code{long} value.
15957
15958 @item
15959 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15960 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15961 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15962 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15963 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15964 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15965 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15966 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15967 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15968 constant.
15969
15970 @item
15971 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15972 integral equivalents.
15973
15974 @item
15975 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15976 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15977 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15978 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15979 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15980 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15981 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15982 @samp{\n} for newline.
15983
15984 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15985 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15986 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15987 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15988
15989 @item
15990 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15991 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15992 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15993 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15994 characters.
15995
15996 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15997 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15998 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15999
16000 @item
16001 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
16002 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
16003
16004 @item
16005 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
16006 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
16007 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
16008 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
16009 @end itemize
16010
16011 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
16012 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
16013
16014 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
16015 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
16016
16017 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
16018 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
16019 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
16020 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
16021 @quotation
16022 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
16023 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
16024 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
16025 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
16026 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
16027 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
16028 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
16029 code. @xref{Compilation}.
16030 @end quotation
16031
16032 @enumerate
16033
16034 @cindex member functions
16035 @item
16036 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
16037
16038 @smallexample
16039 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
16040 @end smallexample
16041
16042 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
16043 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
16044 @item
16045 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
16046 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
16047 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
16048 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
16049 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
16050
16051 @cindex call overloaded functions
16052 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
16053 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
16054 @item
16055 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
16056 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
16057 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
16058 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
16059 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
16060 default arguments.
16061
16062 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
16063 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
16064 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
16065 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
16066 number of function arguments.
16067
16068 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
16069 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
16070 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
16071
16072 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
16073 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
16074 @smallexample
16075 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
16076 @end smallexample
16077
16078 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
16079 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
16080
16081 @cindex reference declarations
16082 @item
16083 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
16084 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
16085 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
16086
16087 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
16088 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
16089 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
16090 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
16091 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
16092
16093 @item
16094 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
16095 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
16096 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
16097 necessary, for example in an expression like
16098 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
16099 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
16100 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
16101
16102 @item
16103 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
16104 specification.
16105 @end enumerate
16106
16107 @node C Defaults
16108 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
16109
16110 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
16111
16112 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
16113 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
16114 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16115 selects the working language.
16116
16117 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
16118 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
16119 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
16120 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
16121 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
16122 for further details.
16123
16124 @node C Checks
16125 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
16126
16127 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
16128
16129 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
16130 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
16131 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
16132 constants to pointers.
16133
16134 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
16135 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
16136 that is not itself an array.
16137
16138 @node Debugging C
16139 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
16140
16141 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
16142 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
16143 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
16144 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
16145
16146 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
16147 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
16148 ,Expressions}.
16149
16150 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
16151 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
16152
16153 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
16154
16155 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
16156 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
16157
16158 @table @code
16159 @cindex break in overloaded functions
16160 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
16161 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
16162 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
16163 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
16164 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
16165
16166 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
16167 @item rbreak @var{regex}
16168 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
16169 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
16170 classes.
16171 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
16172
16173 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
16174 @item catch throw
16175 @itemx catch rethrow
16176 @itemx catch catch
16177 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
16178 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
16179
16180 @cindex inheritance
16181 @item ptype @var{typename}
16182 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
16183 @var{typename}.
16184 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
16185
16186 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
16187 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
16188 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
16189 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
16190 multiple inheritance is in use.
16191
16192 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
16193 @item demangle @var{name}
16194 Demangle @var{name}.
16195 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
16196
16197 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
16198 @item set print demangle
16199 @itemx show print demangle
16200 @itemx set print asm-demangle
16201 @itemx show print asm-demangle
16202 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
16203 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
16204 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
16205
16206 @item set print object
16207 @itemx show print object
16208 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
16209 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
16210
16211 @item set print vtbl
16212 @itemx show print vtbl
16213 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
16214 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
16215 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
16216 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
16217
16218 @kindex set overload-resolution
16219 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
16220 @item set overload-resolution on
16221 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
16222 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
16223 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
16224 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
16225 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
16226 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
16227
16228 @item set overload-resolution off
16229 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
16230 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
16231 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
16232 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
16233 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
16234 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
16235 argument types.
16236
16237 @kindex show overload-resolution
16238 @item show overload-resolution
16239 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
16240
16241 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
16242 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
16243 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
16244 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
16245 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
16246 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
16247 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
16248
16249 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
16250
16251 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
16252 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
16253 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
16254 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
16255 for more detail.
16256
16257 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
16258 function that returns a std::string:
16259
16260 @smallexample
16261 std::string function(int);
16262 @end smallexample
16263
16264 @noindent
16265 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
16266 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
16267
16268 @smallexample
16269 function[abi:cxx11](int)
16270 @end smallexample
16271
16272 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
16273 tag. For example:
16274
16275 @smallexample
16276 (gdb) b function(int)
16277 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
16278 (gdb) info breakpoints
16279 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
16280 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
16281 at main.cc:10
16282 @end smallexample
16283
16284 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
16285 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
16286 name, like:
16287
16288 @smallexample
16289 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
16290 @end smallexample
16291 @end table
16292
16293 @node Decimal Floating Point
16294 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
16295 @cindex decimal floating point format
16296
16297 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
16298 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
16299 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
16300 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
16301
16302 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
16303 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
16304 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
16305 configured target.
16306
16307 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
16308 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
16309 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
16310
16311 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
16312 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
16313 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
16314
16315 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
16316 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
16317 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
16318
16319 @node D
16320 @subsection D
16321
16322 @cindex D
16323 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
16324 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
16325 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
16326
16327 @node Go
16328 @subsection Go
16329
16330 @cindex Go (programming language)
16331 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
16332 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
16333
16334 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
16335
16336 @table @code
16337 @cindex current Go package
16338 @item The current Go package
16339 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
16340 specifying global variables and functions.
16341
16342 For example, given the program:
16343
16344 @example
16345 package main
16346 var myglob = "Shall we?"
16347 func main () @{
16348 // ...
16349 @}
16350 @end example
16351
16352 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
16353
16354 @example
16355 (gdb) p myglob
16356 (gdb) p main.myglob
16357 @end example
16358
16359 @cindex builtin Go types
16360 @item Builtin Go types
16361 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
16362 as a string.
16363
16364 @cindex builtin Go functions
16365 @item Builtin Go functions
16366 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
16367 function and handles it internally.
16368
16369 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
16370 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
16371 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
16372 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
16373 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
16374 @end table
16375
16376 @node Objective-C
16377 @subsection Objective-C
16378
16379 @cindex Objective-C
16380 This section provides information about some commands and command
16381 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
16382 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
16383 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
16384
16385 @menu
16386 * Method Names in Commands::
16387 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
16388 @end menu
16389
16390 @node Method Names in Commands
16391 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
16392
16393 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
16394 names as line specifications:
16395
16396 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
16397 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
16398 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
16399 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
16400 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
16401 @itemize
16402 @item @code{clear}
16403 @item @code{break}
16404 @item @code{info line}
16405 @item @code{jump}
16406 @item @code{list}
16407 @end itemize
16408
16409 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
16410
16411 @smallexample
16412 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
16413 @end smallexample
16414
16415 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
16416 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
16417 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
16418 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
16419 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
16420 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
16421 debugged, enter:
16422
16423 @smallexample
16424 break -[Fruit create]
16425 @end smallexample
16426
16427 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
16428 enter:
16429
16430 @smallexample
16431 list +[NSText initialize]
16432 @end smallexample
16433
16434 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
16435 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
16436 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
16437 is also possible to specify just a method name:
16438
16439 @smallexample
16440 break create
16441 @end smallexample
16442
16443 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
16444 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
16445 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
16446 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
16447 none apply.
16448
16449 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
16450 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
16451
16452 @smallexample
16453 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
16454 @end smallexample
16455
16456 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
16457 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
16458 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
16459 @kindex print-object
16460 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
16461
16462 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
16463
16464 @smallexample
16465 print -[@var{object} hash]
16466 @end smallexample
16467
16468 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
16469 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
16470 @noindent
16471 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
16472 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
16473 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
16474 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
16475 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
16476 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
16477
16478 @node OpenCL C
16479 @subsection OpenCL C
16480
16481 @cindex OpenCL C
16482 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
16483
16484 @menu
16485 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
16486 * OpenCL C Expressions::
16487 * OpenCL C Operators::
16488 @end menu
16489
16490 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
16491 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
16492
16493 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
16494 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
16495 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
16496 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
16497 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
16498
16499 @node OpenCL C Expressions
16500 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
16501
16502 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
16503 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
16504 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
16505 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
16506
16507 @node OpenCL C Operators
16508 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
16509
16510 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
16511 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
16512 vector data types.
16513
16514 @node Fortran
16515 @subsection Fortran
16516 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
16517
16518 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
16519 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
16520
16521 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
16522 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
16523 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
16524 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
16525 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
16526 underscore.
16527
16528 @menu
16529 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
16530 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
16531 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
16532 @end menu
16533
16534 @node Fortran Operators
16535 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
16536
16537 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
16538
16539 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16540 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
16541 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
16542
16543 @table @code
16544 @item **
16545 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
16546 of the second one.
16547
16548 @item :
16549 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
16550 represent a section of array.
16551
16552 @item %
16553 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
16554 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
16555 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
16556 union type.
16557 @end table
16558
16559 @node Fortran Defaults
16560 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
16561
16562 @cindex Fortran Defaults
16563
16564 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
16565 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
16566 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
16567 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
16568
16569 @node Special Fortran Commands
16570 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
16571
16572 @cindex Special Fortran commands
16573
16574 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
16575 such as displaying common blocks.
16576
16577 @table @code
16578 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
16579 @kindex info common
16580 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
16581 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
16582 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
16583 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
16584 printed.
16585 @end table
16586
16587 @node Pascal
16588 @subsection Pascal
16589
16590 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
16591 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
16592 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
16593 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
16594 syntax.
16595
16596 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
16597 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
16598 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
16599
16600 @node Rust
16601 @subsection Rust
16602
16603 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
16604 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
16605 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
16606 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
16607
16608 @itemize @bullet
16609 @item
16610 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
16611 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
16612 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
16613
16614 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
16615 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
16616 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
16617 @samp{B}.
16618
16619 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
16620 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
16621
16622 @item
16623 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
16624 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
16625 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
16626 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
16627 @samp{K::x::y}.
16628
16629 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
16630 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
16631 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
16632 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
16633 scope.
16634
16635 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
16636 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
16637
16638 @item
16639 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
16640 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
16641
16642 @item
16643 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
16644
16645 @item
16646 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
16647 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
16648 never be destroyed.
16649
16650 @item
16651 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
16652 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
16653 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
16654
16655 @item
16656 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
16657 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
16658 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
16659 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
16660 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
16661 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
16662 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
16663 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
16664
16665 @item
16666 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
16667 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
16668 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
16669 @itemize @bullet
16670
16671 @item
16672 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
16673
16674 @item
16675 Operator overloading is not implemented.
16676
16677 @item
16678 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
16679 type names.
16680
16681 @item
16682 The type @code{Self} is not available.
16683
16684 @item
16685 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
16686 available in the crate.
16687 @end itemize
16688 @end itemize
16689
16690 @node Modula-2
16691 @subsection Modula-2
16692
16693 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
16694
16695 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
16696 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
16697 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
16698 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16699 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
16700 table.
16701
16702 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
16703 @menu
16704 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
16705 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
16706 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
16707 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
16708 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
16709 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
16710 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
16711 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16712 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16713 @end menu
16714
16715 @node M2 Operators
16716 @subsubsection Operators
16717 @cindex Modula-2 operators
16718
16719 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
16720 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
16721 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
16722 following definitions hold:
16723
16724 @itemize @bullet
16725
16726 @item
16727 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
16728 their subranges.
16729
16730 @item
16731 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
16732
16733 @item
16734 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
16735
16736 @item
16737 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
16738 @var{type}}.
16739
16740 @item
16741 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
16742
16743 @item
16744 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
16745
16746 @item
16747 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
16748 @end itemize
16749
16750 @noindent
16751 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
16752 increasing precedence:
16753
16754 @table @code
16755 @item ,
16756 Function argument or array index separator.
16757
16758 @item :=
16759 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
16760 @var{value}.
16761
16762 @item <@r{, }>
16763 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
16764 types.
16765
16766 @item <=@r{, }>=
16767 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
16768 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
16769 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
16770
16771 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
16772 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
16773 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
16774 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
16775 comment character.
16776
16777 @item IN
16778 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
16779 Same precedence as @code{<}.
16780
16781 @item OR
16782 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16783
16784 @item AND@r{, }&
16785 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
16786
16787 @item @@
16788 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
16789
16790 @item +@r{, }-
16791 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
16792 and difference on set types.
16793
16794 @item *
16795 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
16796 on set types.
16797
16798 @item /
16799 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
16800 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
16801
16802 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16803 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16804 precedence as @code{*}.
16805
16806 @item -
16807 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16808
16809 @item ^
16810 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16811
16812 @item NOT
16813 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16814 @code{^}.
16815
16816 @item .
16817 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16818 precedence as @code{^}.
16819
16820 @item []
16821 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16822
16823 @item ()
16824 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16825 as @code{^}.
16826
16827 @item ::@r{, }.
16828 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16829 @end table
16830
16831 @quotation
16832 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16833 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16834 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16835 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16836 @end quotation
16837
16838
16839 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16840 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16841 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16842
16843 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16844 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16845
16846 @table @var
16847
16848 @item a
16849 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16850
16851 @item c
16852 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16853
16854 @item i
16855 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16856
16857 @item m
16858 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16859 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16860 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16861
16862 @item n
16863 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16864
16865 @item r
16866 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16867
16868 @item t
16869 represents a type.
16870
16871 @item v
16872 represents a variable.
16873
16874 @item x
16875 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16876 explanation of the function for details.
16877 @end table
16878
16879 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16880
16881 @table @code
16882 @item ABS(@var{n})
16883 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16884
16885 @item CAP(@var{c})
16886 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16887 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16888
16889 @item CHR(@var{i})
16890 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16891
16892 @item DEC(@var{v})
16893 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16894
16895 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16896 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16897 new value.
16898
16899 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16900 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16901 set.
16902
16903 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16904 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16905
16906 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16907 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16908
16909 @item INC(@var{v})
16910 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16911
16912 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16913 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16914 new value.
16915
16916 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16917 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16918 there. Returns the new set.
16919
16920 @item MAX(@var{t})
16921 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16922
16923 @item MIN(@var{t})
16924 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16925
16926 @item ODD(@var{i})
16927 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16928
16929 @item ORD(@var{x})
16930 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16931 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16932 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16933 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16934
16935 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16936 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16937 variable or a type.
16938
16939 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16940 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16941
16942 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16943 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16944 variable or a type.
16945
16946 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16947 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16948 @end table
16949
16950 @quotation
16951 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16952 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16953 an error.
16954 @end quotation
16955
16956 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16957 @node M2 Constants
16958 @subsubsection Constants
16959
16960 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16961 ways:
16962
16963 @itemize @bullet
16964
16965 @item
16966 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16967 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16968 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16969 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16970
16971 @item
16972 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16973 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16974 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16975 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16976 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16977 digits.
16978
16979 @item
16980 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16981 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16982 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16983 followed by a @samp{C}.
16984
16985 @item
16986 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16987 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16988 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16989 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16990 sequences.
16991
16992 @item
16993 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16994
16995 @item
16996 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16997 @code{FALSE}.
16998
16999 @item
17000 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
17001
17002 @item
17003 Set constants are not yet supported.
17004 @end itemize
17005
17006 @node M2 Types
17007 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
17008 @cindex Modula-2 types
17009
17010 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
17011 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
17012 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
17013 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
17014 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
17015 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
17016
17017 The first example contains the following section of code:
17018
17019 @smallexample
17020 VAR
17021 s: SET OF CHAR ;
17022 r: [20..40] ;
17023 @end smallexample
17024
17025 @noindent
17026 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
17027 @code{r} and @code{s}.
17028
17029 @smallexample
17030 (@value{GDBP}) print s
17031 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
17032 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17033 SET OF CHAR
17034 (@value{GDBP}) print r
17035 21
17036 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
17037 [20..40]
17038 @end smallexample
17039
17040 @noindent
17041 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
17042
17043 @smallexample
17044 VAR
17045 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
17046 @end smallexample
17047
17048 @noindent
17049 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
17050
17051 @smallexample
17052 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17053 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
17054 @end smallexample
17055
17056 @noindent
17057 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
17058 expressions using the debugger.
17059
17060 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
17061 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
17062
17063 @smallexample
17064 VAR
17065 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
17066 @end smallexample
17067
17068 @smallexample
17069 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17070 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
17071 @end smallexample
17072
17073 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
17074 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
17075 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
17076 above.
17077
17078 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
17079
17080 @smallexample
17081 TYPE
17082 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
17083 t = [blue..yellow] ;
17084 VAR
17085 s: t ;
17086 BEGIN
17087 s := blue ;
17088 @end smallexample
17089
17090 @noindent
17091 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
17092 and value of a variable.
17093
17094 @smallexample
17095 (@value{GDBP}) print s
17096 $1 = blue
17097 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
17098 type = [blue..yellow]
17099 @end smallexample
17100
17101 @noindent
17102 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
17103 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
17104 their @code{C} counterparts.
17105
17106 @smallexample
17107 VAR
17108 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
17109 BEGIN
17110 s[1] := 1 ;
17111 @end smallexample
17112
17113 @smallexample
17114 (@value{GDBP}) print s
17115 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
17116 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17117 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
17118 @end smallexample
17119
17120 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
17121 pointer types as shown in this example:
17122
17123 @smallexample
17124 VAR
17125 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
17126 BEGIN
17127 NEW(s) ;
17128 s^[1] := 1 ;
17129 @end smallexample
17130
17131 @noindent
17132 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
17133
17134 @smallexample
17135 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17136 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
17137 @end smallexample
17138
17139 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
17140 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
17141 types:
17142
17143 @smallexample
17144 TYPE
17145 foo = RECORD
17146 f1: CARDINAL ;
17147 f2: CHAR ;
17148 f3: myarray ;
17149 END ;
17150
17151 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
17152 myrange = [-2..2] ;
17153 VAR
17154 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
17155 @end smallexample
17156
17157 @noindent
17158 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
17159 below.
17160
17161 @smallexample
17162 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
17163 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
17164 f1 : CARDINAL;
17165 f2 : CHAR;
17166 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
17167 END
17168 @end smallexample
17169
17170 @node M2 Defaults
17171 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
17172 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
17173
17174 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
17175 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
17176 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
17177 selected the working language.
17178
17179 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
17180 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
17181 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
17182 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
17183
17184 @node Deviations
17185 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
17186 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
17187
17188 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
17189 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
17190
17191 @itemize @bullet
17192 @item
17193 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
17194 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
17195 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
17196 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
17197 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
17198 returned a pointer.)
17199
17200 @item
17201 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
17202 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
17203 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
17204 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
17205
17206 @item
17207 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
17208 argument.
17209
17210 @item
17211 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
17212 @end itemize
17213
17214 @node M2 Checks
17215 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
17216 @cindex Modula-2 checks
17217
17218 @quotation
17219 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
17220 range checking.
17221 @end quotation
17222 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
17223
17224 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
17225
17226 @itemize @bullet
17227 @item
17228 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
17229 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
17230
17231 @item
17232 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
17233 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
17234 @end itemize
17235
17236 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
17237 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
17238
17239 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
17240 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
17241
17242 @node M2 Scope
17243 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
17244 @cindex scope
17245 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
17246 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
17247 @ifinfo
17248 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
17249 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
17250 @end ifinfo
17251 @ifnotinfo
17252 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
17253 @end ifnotinfo
17254
17255 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
17256 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
17257 similar syntax:
17258
17259 @smallexample
17260
17261 @var{module} . @var{id}
17262 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
17263 @end smallexample
17264
17265 @noindent
17266 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
17267 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
17268 identifier within your program, except another module.
17269
17270 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
17271 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
17272 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
17273 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
17274
17275 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
17276 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
17277 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
17278 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
17279 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
17280 @var{module}.
17281
17282 @node GDB/M2
17283 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
17284
17285 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
17286 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
17287 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
17288 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
17289 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
17290 analogue in Modula-2.
17291
17292 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
17293 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
17294 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
17295 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
17296 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
17297 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
17298
17299 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
17300 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
17301 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
17302
17303 @node Ada
17304 @subsection Ada
17305 @cindex Ada
17306
17307 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
17308 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
17309 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
17310 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
17311 to be difficult.
17312
17313
17314 @cindex expressions in Ada
17315 @menu
17316 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
17317 and semantics supported by Ada mode
17318 in @value{GDBN}.
17319 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
17320 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
17321 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
17322 subprograms.
17323 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
17324 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
17325 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
17326 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17327 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
17328 Profile
17329 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
17330 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
17331 @end menu
17332
17333 @node Ada Mode Intro
17334 @subsubsection Introduction
17335 @cindex Ada mode, general
17336
17337 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
17338 syntax, with some extensions.
17339 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
17340
17341 @itemize @bullet
17342 @item
17343 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
17344 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
17345 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
17346 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
17347
17348 @item
17349 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
17350 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
17351
17352 @item
17353 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
17354 @end itemize
17355
17356 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
17357 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
17358 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
17359 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
17360 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
17361
17362 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
17363 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
17364 was translated from an Ada source file.
17365
17366 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
17367 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
17368 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
17369 middle (to allow based literals).
17370
17371 @node Omissions from Ada
17372 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
17373 @cindex Ada, omissions from
17374
17375 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
17376
17377 @itemize @bullet
17378 @item
17379 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
17380
17381 @itemize @minus
17382 @item
17383 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
17384 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
17385
17386 @item
17387 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
17388
17389 @item
17390 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
17391
17392 @item
17393 @t{'Tag}.
17394
17395 @item
17396 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
17397 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
17398
17399 @item
17400 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
17401 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
17402
17403 @item
17404 @t{'Address}.
17405 @end itemize
17406
17407 @item
17408 The names in
17409 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
17410 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
17411 not currently available.
17412
17413 @item
17414 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
17415 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
17416 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
17417 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
17418 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
17419 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
17420 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
17421 indeterminate values.
17422
17423 @item
17424 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
17425 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
17426 are not implemented.
17427
17428 @item
17429 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
17430 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
17431 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
17432 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
17433 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
17434
17435 @smallexample
17436 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
17437 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
17438 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
17439 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
17440 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
17441 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
17442 @end smallexample
17443
17444 Changing a
17445 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
17446 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
17447 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
17448 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
17449 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
17450 declared to have a type such as:
17451
17452 @smallexample
17453 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
17454 Id : Integer;
17455 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
17456 end record;
17457 @end smallexample
17458
17459 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
17460 assignments:
17461
17462 @smallexample
17463 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
17464 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
17465 @end smallexample
17466
17467 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
17468 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
17469 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
17470 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
17471 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
17472 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
17473 redundant component associations, although which component values are
17474 assigned in such cases is not defined.
17475
17476 @item
17477 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
17478
17479 @item
17480 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
17481 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
17482 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
17483 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
17484 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
17485 the proper resolution.
17486
17487 @item
17488 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
17489
17490 @item
17491 Entry calls are not implemented.
17492
17493 @item
17494 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
17495 formats are not supported.
17496
17497 @item
17498 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
17499
17500 @item
17501 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
17502 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
17503 context.
17504 Should your program
17505 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
17506 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
17507 @end itemize
17508
17509 @node Additions to Ada
17510 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
17511 @cindex Ada, deviations from
17512
17513 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
17514 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
17515
17516 @itemize @bullet
17517 @item
17518 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
17519 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
17520 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
17521 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
17522 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
17523 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
17524 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
17525 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
17526
17527 @item
17528 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
17529 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
17530 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
17531
17532 @item
17533 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
17534 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
17535
17536 @item
17537 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
17538 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
17539 @end itemize
17540
17541 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
17542 additions specific to Ada:
17543
17544 @itemize @bullet
17545 @item
17546 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
17547 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
17548
17549 @smallexample
17550 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
17551 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
17552 @end smallexample
17553
17554 @item
17555 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
17556 the value of its right-hand operand.
17557 This allows, for example,
17558 complex conditional breaks:
17559
17560 @smallexample
17561 (@value{GDBP}) break f
17562 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
17563 @end smallexample
17564
17565 @item
17566 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
17567 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
17568 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
17569 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
17570 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
17571 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
17572 in strings. For example,
17573 @smallexample
17574 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
17575 @end smallexample
17576 @noindent
17577 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
17578 after each period.
17579
17580 @item
17581 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
17582 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
17583 to write
17584
17585 @smallexample
17586 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
17587 @end smallexample
17588
17589 @item
17590 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
17591 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
17592 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
17593 of 3 might print as
17594
17595 @smallexample
17596 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
17597 @end smallexample
17598
17599 @noindent
17600 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
17601 clause.
17602
17603 @item
17604 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
17605 multi-character subsequence of
17606 their names (an exact match gets preference).
17607 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
17608 in place of @t{a'length}.
17609
17610 @item
17611 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
17612 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
17613 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
17614 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
17615 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
17616 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
17617 For example,
17618 @smallexample
17619 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
17620 @end smallexample
17621
17622 @item
17623 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
17624 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
17625 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
17626 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
17627 object.
17628
17629 @end itemize
17630
17631 @node Overloading support for Ada
17632 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
17633 @cindex overloading, Ada
17634
17635 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
17636 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
17637 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
17638 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
17639 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
17640 functions to procedures elsewhere.
17641
17642 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
17643 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
17644 use, for instance:
17645
17646 @smallexample
17647 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
17648 Multiple matches for f
17649 [0] cancel
17650 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
17651 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
17652 >
17653 @end smallexample
17654
17655 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
17656 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
17657 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
17658
17659 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
17660 case:
17661
17662 @table @code
17663
17664 @kindex set ada print-signatures
17665 @item set ada print-signatures
17666 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
17667 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
17668 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17669
17670 @kindex show ada print-signatures
17671 @item show ada print-signatures
17672 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
17673 overloads selection menu.
17674 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
17675
17676 @end table
17677
17678 @node Stopping Before Main Program
17679 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
17680
17681 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
17682 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
17683 before reaching the main procedure.
17684 As defined in the Ada Reference
17685 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
17686 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
17687 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
17688 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
17689
17690 @node Ada Exceptions
17691 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
17692
17693 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
17694
17695 @table @code
17696 @kindex info exceptions
17697 @item info exceptions
17698 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
17699 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
17700 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
17701 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
17702 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
17703 @end table
17704
17705 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
17706 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
17707 argument.
17708
17709 @smallexample
17710 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
17711 All defined Ada exceptions:
17712 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17713 program_error: 0x613d20
17714 storage_error: 0x613ce0
17715 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
17716 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17717 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
17718 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
17719 constraint_error: 0x613da0
17720 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
17721 @end smallexample
17722
17723 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
17724 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
17725
17726 @node Ada Tasks
17727 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
17728 @cindex Ada, tasking
17729
17730 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
17731 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
17732
17733 @table @code
17734 @kindex info tasks
17735 @item info tasks
17736 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
17737
17738
17739 @smallexample
17740 @iftex
17741 @leftskip=0.5cm
17742 @end iftex
17743 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17744 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17745 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17746 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
17747 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
17748 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
17749
17750 @end smallexample
17751
17752 @noindent
17753 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
17754 task currently being inspected.
17755
17756 @table @asis
17757 @item ID
17758 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
17759
17760 @item TID
17761 The Ada task ID.
17762
17763 @item P-ID
17764 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
17765
17766 @item Pri
17767 The base priority of the task.
17768
17769 @item State
17770 Current state of the task.
17771
17772 @table @code
17773 @item Unactivated
17774 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
17775 executing.
17776
17777 @item Runnable
17778 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
17779 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
17780
17781 @item Terminated
17782 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
17783 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
17784 terminated themselves.
17785
17786 @item Child Activation Wait
17787 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
17788
17789 @item Accept Statement
17790 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
17791
17792 @item Waiting on entry call
17793 The task is waiting on an entry call.
17794
17795 @item Async Select Wait
17796 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
17797 select statement.
17798
17799 @item Delay Sleep
17800 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
17801 alternative open.
17802
17803 @item Child Termination Wait
17804 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17805 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17806 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17807
17808 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17809 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17810 finish terminating.
17811
17812 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17813 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17814 @end table
17815
17816 @item Name
17817 Name of the task in the program.
17818
17819 @end table
17820
17821 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17822 @item info task @var{taskno}
17823 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17824 the following example:
17825 @smallexample
17826 @iftex
17827 @leftskip=0.5cm
17828 @end iftex
17829 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17830 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17831 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17832 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17833 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17834 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17835 Name: "task_1"
17836 Thread: 0
17837 LWP: 0x1fac
17838 Parent: 1 ("main_task")
17839 Base Priority: 15
17840 State: Runnable
17841 @end smallexample
17842
17843 @item task
17844 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17845 @cindex current Ada task ID
17846 This command prints the ID and name of the current task.
17847
17848 @smallexample
17849 @iftex
17850 @leftskip=0.5cm
17851 @end iftex
17852 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17853 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17854 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17855 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable some_task
17856 (@value{GDBP}) task
17857 [Current task is 2 "some_task"]
17858 @end smallexample
17859
17860 @item task @var{taskno}
17861 @cindex Ada task switching
17862 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17863 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17864 from the current task to the given task.
17865
17866 @smallexample
17867 @iftex
17868 @leftskip=0.5cm
17869 @end iftex
17870 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17871 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17872 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17873 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable some_task
17874 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17875 [Switching to task 1 "main_task"]
17876 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17877 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17878 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17879 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17880 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17881 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17882 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17883 @end smallexample
17884
17885 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17886 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17887 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17888 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17889 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17890 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17891 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17892 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17893 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17894
17895 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17896 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17897 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17898 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17899 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17900
17901 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17902 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17903 program.
17904
17905 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17906 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17907 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17908
17909 For example,
17910
17911 @smallexample
17912 @iftex
17913 @leftskip=0.5cm
17914 @end iftex
17915 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17916 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17917 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17918 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17919 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17920 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17921 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17922 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17923 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17924 Continuing.
17925 task # 1 running
17926 task # 2 running
17927
17928 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17929 15 flush;
17930 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17931 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17932 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17933 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17934 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17935 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17936 @end smallexample
17937 @end table
17938
17939 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17940 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17941 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17942
17943 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17944 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17945 the platform being used.
17946 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17947 switching is not supported.
17948
17949 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17950 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17951 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17952 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17953 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17954 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17955
17956 @node Ravenscar Profile
17957 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17958 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17959
17960 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17961 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17962 requirements.
17963
17964 @table @code
17965 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17966 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17967 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17968 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17969 Profile. This is the default.
17970
17971 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17972 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17973 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17974 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17975 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17976 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17977 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17978
17979 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17980 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17981 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17982 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17983
17984 @end table
17985
17986 @node Ada Settings
17987 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17988 @cindex Ada settings
17989
17990 @table @code
17991 @kindex set varsize-limit
17992 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17993 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17994 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17995 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17996 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17997 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17998 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17999
18000 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
18001 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
18002 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
18003 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
18004 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
18005 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
18006 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
18007 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
18008 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
18009 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
18010 size is less than @var{size}.
18011
18012 @kindex show varsize-limit
18013 @item show varsize-limit
18014 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
18015 @end table
18016
18017 @node Ada Glitches
18018 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
18019 @cindex Ada, problems
18020
18021 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
18022 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
18023 @value{GDBN},
18024 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
18025 and the GNU Ada compiler.
18026
18027 @itemize @bullet
18028 @item
18029 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
18030 storage are invisible to the debugger.
18031
18032 @item
18033 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
18034 argument lists are treated as positional).
18035
18036 @item
18037 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
18038
18039 @item
18040 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
18041 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
18042 the host machine.
18043
18044 @item
18045 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
18046 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
18047 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
18048 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
18049 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
18050 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
18051 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
18052 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
18053 you can usually resolve the confusion
18054 by qualifying the problematic names with package
18055 @code{Standard} explicitly.
18056 @end itemize
18057
18058 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
18059 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
18060 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
18061 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
18062 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
18063 enabled.
18064
18065 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
18066 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
18067 @table @code
18068
18069 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
18070 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
18071 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
18072 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
18073 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
18074 This is the default.
18075
18076 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
18077 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
18078 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
18079 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
18080 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
18081 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
18082 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
18083
18084 @end table
18085
18086 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
18087 @cindex GNAT encoding
18088 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
18089 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
18090 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
18091 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
18092 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
18093 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
18094
18095 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
18096 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
18097 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
18098 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
18099 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
18100 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
18101 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
18102 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
18103
18104 @table @code
18105
18106 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
18107 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
18108 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
18109 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
18110
18111 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
18112 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
18113 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
18114
18115 @end table
18116
18117 @node Unsupported Languages
18118 @section Unsupported Languages
18119
18120 @cindex unsupported languages
18121 @cindex minimal language
18122 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
18123 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
18124 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
18125 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
18126 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
18127 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
18128
18129 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
18130 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
18131 language.
18132
18133 @node Symbols
18134 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
18135
18136 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
18137 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
18138 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
18139 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
18140 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
18141 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
18142 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
18143
18144 @cindex symbol names
18145 @cindex names of symbols
18146 @cindex quoting names
18147 @anchor{quoting names}
18148 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
18149 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
18150 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
18151 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
18152 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
18153 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
18154 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
18155 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
18156
18157 @smallexample
18158 p 'foo.c'::x
18159 @end smallexample
18160
18161 @noindent
18162 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
18163
18164 @table @code
18165 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
18166 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
18167 @kindex set case-sensitive
18168 @item set case-sensitive on
18169 @itemx set case-sensitive off
18170 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
18171 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
18172 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
18173 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
18174 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
18175 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
18176 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
18177 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
18178 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
18179 case-insensitive matches.
18180
18181 @kindex show case-sensitive
18182 @item show case-sensitive
18183 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
18184 lookups.
18185
18186 @kindex set print type methods
18187 @item set print type methods
18188 @itemx set print type methods on
18189 @itemx set print type methods off
18190 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
18191 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
18192 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
18193 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
18194 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
18195 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
18196
18197 @kindex show print type methods
18198 @item show print type methods
18199 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
18200 classes.
18201
18202 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
18203 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
18204 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
18205 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
18206 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
18207 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
18208 types defined in classes.
18209
18210 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
18211 @item show print type nested-type-limit
18212 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
18213 printing classes.
18214
18215 @kindex set print type typedefs
18216 @item set print type typedefs
18217 @itemx set print type typedefs on
18218 @itemx set print type typedefs off
18219
18220 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
18221 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
18222 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
18223 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
18224 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
18225 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
18226 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
18227 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
18228 types.
18229
18230 @kindex show print type typedefs
18231 @item show print type typedefs
18232 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
18233 printing classes.
18234
18235 @kindex info address
18236 @cindex address of a symbol
18237 @item info address @var{symbol}
18238 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
18239 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
18240 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
18241 is always stored.
18242
18243 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
18244 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
18245 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
18246
18247 @kindex info symbol
18248 @cindex symbol from address
18249 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
18250 @item info symbol @var{addr}
18251 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
18252 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
18253 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
18254
18255 @smallexample
18256 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
18257 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
18258 @end smallexample
18259
18260 @noindent
18261 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
18262 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
18263
18264 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
18265 library containing the symbol is also printed:
18266
18267 @smallexample
18268 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
18269 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
18270 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
18271 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
18272 @end smallexample
18273
18274 @kindex demangle
18275 @cindex demangle
18276 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
18277 Demangle @var{name}.
18278 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
18279 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
18280
18281 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
18282 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
18283
18284 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
18285 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
18286
18287 @kindex whatis
18288 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
18289 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
18290 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
18291 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
18292
18293 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
18294 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
18295 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
18296
18297 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
18298 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
18299 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
18300 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
18301 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
18302 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
18303 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
18304 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
18305 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
18306
18307 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
18308 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
18309 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
18310 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
18311 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
18312 unroll it.
18313
18314 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
18315 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
18316 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
18317
18318 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
18319 Available flags are:
18320
18321 @table @code
18322 @item r
18323 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
18324 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
18325 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
18326
18327 @item m
18328 Do not print methods defined in the class.
18329
18330 @item M
18331 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
18332 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
18333
18334 @item t
18335 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
18336 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
18337 names are substituted when printing other types.
18338
18339 @item T
18340 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
18341 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
18342
18343 @item o
18344 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
18345 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
18346
18347 For example, given the following declarations:
18348
18349 @smallexample
18350 struct tuv
18351 @{
18352 int a1;
18353 char *a2;
18354 int a3;
18355 @};
18356
18357 struct xyz
18358 @{
18359 int f1;
18360 char f2;
18361 void *f3;
18362 struct tuv f4;
18363 @};
18364
18365 union qwe
18366 @{
18367 struct tuv fff1;
18368 struct xyz fff2;
18369 @};
18370
18371 struct tyu
18372 @{
18373 int a1 : 1;
18374 int a2 : 3;
18375 int a3 : 23;
18376 char a4 : 2;
18377 int64_t a5;
18378 int a6 : 5;
18379 int64_t a7 : 3;
18380 @};
18381 @end smallexample
18382
18383 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
18384
18385 @smallexample
18386 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
18387 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
18388 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
18389 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18390 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
18391 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
18392
18393 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18394 @}
18395 @end smallexample
18396
18397 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
18398 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
18399 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
18400 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
18401 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
18402 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
18403 its fields.
18404
18405 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
18406
18407 @smallexample
18408 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
18409 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
18410 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
18411 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
18412 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18413 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
18414 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
18415
18416 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18417 @} fff1;
18418 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
18419 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
18420 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
18421 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
18422 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
18423 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
18424 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
18425 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18426 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
18427 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
18428
18429 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18430 @} f4;
18431
18432 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
18433 @} fff2;
18434
18435 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
18436 @}
18437 @end smallexample
18438
18439 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
18440 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
18441 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
18442 of these structures' fields.
18443
18444 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
18445 bitfields:
18446
18447 @smallexample
18448 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
18449 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
18450 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
18451 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
18452 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
18453 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
18454 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
18455 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
18456 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
18457 /* 16: 0 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
18458 /* 16: 5 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
18459 "/* XXX 7-byte padding */
18460
18461 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
18462 @}
18463 @end smallexample
18464
18465 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include the
18466 first bit of the bitfield.
18467 @end table
18468
18469 @kindex ptype
18470 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
18471 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
18472 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
18473 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
18474
18475 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
18476 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
18477 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
18478 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
18479 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
18480 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
18481 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
18482 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
18483
18484 For example, for this variable declaration:
18485
18486 @smallexample
18487 typedef double real_t;
18488 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
18489 typedef struct complex complex_t;
18490 complex_t var;
18491 real_t *real_pointer_var;
18492 @end smallexample
18493
18494 @noindent
18495 the two commands give this output:
18496
18497 @smallexample
18498 @group
18499 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
18500 type = complex_t
18501 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
18502 type = struct complex @{
18503 real_t real;
18504 double imag;
18505 @}
18506 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
18507 type = struct complex
18508 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
18509 type = struct complex
18510 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
18511 type = struct complex @{
18512 real_t real;
18513 double imag;
18514 @}
18515 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
18516 type = real_t *
18517 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
18518 type = double *
18519 @end group
18520 @end smallexample
18521
18522 @noindent
18523 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
18524 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
18525
18526 @cindex incomplete type
18527 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
18528 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
18529 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
18530 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
18531 given these declarations:
18532
18533 @smallexample
18534 struct foo;
18535 struct foo *fooptr;
18536 @end smallexample
18537
18538 @noindent
18539 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
18540
18541 @smallexample
18542 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
18543 $1 = <incomplete type>
18544 @end smallexample
18545
18546 @noindent
18547 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
18548 completely specified.
18549
18550 @cindex unknown type
18551 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
18552 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
18553 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
18554 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
18555 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
18556 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
18557 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
18558 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
18559
18560 @smallexample
18561 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
18562 type = <data variable, no debug info>
18563 @end smallexample
18564
18565 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
18566 of such variables.
18567
18568 @kindex info types
18569 @item info types [-q] [@var{regexp}]
18570 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
18571 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
18572 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
18573 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
18574 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
18575 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
18576 name is @code{value}.
18577
18578 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18579 to print the type description according to the
18580 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18581 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18582 language of the type, other values mean to use
18583 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18584
18585 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
18586 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
18587 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
18588
18589 The output from @samp{into types} is proceeded with a header line
18590 describing what types are being listed. The optional flag @samp{-q},
18591 which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables printing this header
18592 information.
18593
18594 @kindex info type-printers
18595 @item info type-printers
18596 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
18597 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
18598 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
18599 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
18600 type printers.
18601
18602 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
18603
18604 @kindex enable type-printer
18605 @kindex disable type-printer
18606 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
18607 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
18608 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
18609
18610 @kindex info scope
18611 @cindex local variables
18612 @item info scope @var{location}
18613 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
18614 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
18615 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
18616 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
18617 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
18618
18619 @smallexample
18620 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
18621 Scope for command_line_handler:
18622 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
18623 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
18624 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
18625 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
18626 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
18627 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
18628 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
18629 @end smallexample
18630
18631 @noindent
18632 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
18633 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
18634 collect}.
18635
18636 @kindex info source
18637 @item info source
18638 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
18639 the function containing the current point of execution:
18640 @itemize @bullet
18641 @item
18642 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
18643 @item
18644 the directory it was compiled in,
18645 @item
18646 its length, in lines,
18647 @item
18648 which programming language it is written in,
18649 @item
18650 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
18651 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
18652 @item
18653 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
18654 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
18655 @item
18656 whether the debugging information includes information about
18657 preprocessor macros.
18658 @end itemize
18659
18660
18661 @kindex info sources
18662 @item info sources
18663 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
18664 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
18665 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
18666
18667 @item info sources [-dirname | -basename] [--] [@var{regexp}]
18668 Like @samp{info sources}, but only print the names of the files
18669 matching the provided @var{regexp}.
18670 By default, the @var{regexp} is used to match anywhere in the filename.
18671 If @code{-dirname}, only files having a dirname matching @var{regexp} are shown.
18672 If @code{-basename}, only files having a basename matching @var{regexp}
18673 are shown.
18674 The matching is case-sensitive, except on operating systems that
18675 have case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows).
18676
18677 @kindex info functions
18678 @item info functions [-q] [-n]
18679 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
18680 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
18681 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
18682 number.
18683
18684 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18685 to print the function name and type according to the
18686 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18687 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18688 language of the function, other values mean to use
18689 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18690
18691 The @samp{-n} flag excludes @dfn{non-debugging symbols} from the
18692 results. A non-debugging symbol is a symbol that comes from the
18693 executable's symbol table, not from the debug information (for
18694 example, DWARF) associated with the executable.
18695
18696 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18697 printing header information and messages explaining why no functions
18698 have been printed.
18699
18700 @item info functions [-q] [-n] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18701 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types
18702 of the functions selected with the provided regexp(s).
18703
18704 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose names
18705 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18706 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
18707 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
18708 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
18709 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
18710 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
18711
18712 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the functions whose
18713 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18714 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18715 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18716 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18717 of special characters or quotes.
18718 Thus, @samp{info fun -t '^int ('} finds the functions that return
18719 an integer; @samp{info fun -t '(.*int.*'} finds the functions that
18720 have an argument type containing int; @samp{info fun -t '^int (' ^step}
18721 finds the functions whose names start with @code{step} and that return
18722 int.
18723
18724 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, a function
18725 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18726 @var{type_regexp}.
18727
18728
18729 @kindex info variables
18730 @item info variables [-q] [-n]
18731 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
18732 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
18733 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
18734 their respective source line numbers.
18735
18736 In programs using different languages, @value{GDBN} chooses the syntax
18737 to print the variable name and type according to the
18738 @samp{set language} value: using @samp{set language auto}
18739 (see @ref{Automatically, ,Set Language Automatically}) means to use the
18740 language of the variable, other values mean to use
18741 the manually specified language (see @ref{Manually, ,Set Language Manually}).
18742
18743 The @samp{-n} flag excludes non-debugging symbols from the results.
18744
18745 The optional flag @samp{-q}, which stands for @samp{quiet}, disables
18746 printing header information and messages explaining why no variables
18747 have been printed.
18748
18749 @item info variables [-q] [-n] [-t @var{type_regexp}] [@var{regexp}]
18750 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the variables selected
18751 with the provided regexp(s).
18752
18753 If @var{regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose names
18754 match the regular expression @var{regexp}.
18755
18756 If @var{type_regexp} is provided, print only the variables whose
18757 types, as printed by the @code{whatis} command, match
18758 the regular expression @var{type_regexp}.
18759 If @var{type_regexp} contains space(s), it should be enclosed in
18760 quote characters. If needed, use backslash to escape the meaning
18761 of special characters or quotes.
18762
18763 If both @var{regexp} and @var{type_regexp} are provided, an argument
18764 is printed only if its name matches @var{regexp} and its type matches
18765 @var{type_regexp}.
18766
18767 @kindex info classes
18768 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
18769 @item info classes
18770 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
18771 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
18772 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18773 expression.
18774
18775 @kindex info selectors
18776 @item info selectors
18777 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
18778 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
18779 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
18780 expression.
18781
18782 @ignore
18783 This was never implemented.
18784 @kindex info methods
18785 @item info methods
18786 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
18787 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
18788 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
18789 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
18790 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
18791 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
18792 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
18793 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
18794 @end ignore
18795
18796 @cindex opaque data types
18797 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
18798 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
18799 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
18800 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
18801 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
18802 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
18803 another source file. The default is on.
18804
18805 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
18806 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
18807
18808 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
18809 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
18810 is printed as follows:
18811 @smallexample
18812 @{<no data fields>@}
18813 @end smallexample
18814
18815 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
18816 @item show opaque-type-resolution
18817 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
18818
18819 @kindex set print symbol-loading
18820 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
18821 @item set print symbol-loading
18822 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
18823 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
18824 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
18825 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
18826 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
18827 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
18828 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
18829 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
18830 can be annoying.
18831 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
18832 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
18833 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
18834 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
18835
18836 @kindex show print symbol-loading
18837 @item show print symbol-loading
18838 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
18839 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
18840
18841 @kindex maint print symbols
18842 @cindex symbol dump
18843 @kindex maint print psymbols
18844 @cindex partial symbol dump
18845 @kindex maint print msymbols
18846 @cindex minimal symbol dump
18847 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18848 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18849 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18850 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18851 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
18852 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
18853 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
18854 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
18855 that objfile.
18856 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
18857 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
18858 @code{main}.
18859 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
18860 source file.
18861
18862 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
18863 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
18864 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
18865 tables.
18866 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
18867 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
18868 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
18869 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
18870 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
18871 ``ELF symbols''.
18872
18873 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
18874 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
18875
18876 @kindex maint info symtabs
18877 @kindex maint info psymtabs
18878 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
18879 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18880 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18881 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18882 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18883 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18884
18885 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
18886 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18887 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18888 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18889 structure in more detail. For example:
18890
18891 @smallexample
18892 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18893 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18894 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18895 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18896 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18897 readin no
18898 fullname (null)
18899 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18900 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18901 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18902 dependencies (none)
18903 @}
18904 @}
18905 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18906 (@value{GDBP})
18907 @end smallexample
18908 @noindent
18909 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18910 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18911 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18912 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18913 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18914
18915 @smallexample
18916 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18917 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18918 line 1574.
18919 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18920 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18921 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18922 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18923 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18924 dirname (null)
18925 fullname (null)
18926 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18927 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18928 debugformat DWARF 2
18929 @}
18930 @}
18931 (@value{GDBP})
18932 @end smallexample
18933
18934 @kindex maint info line-table
18935 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18936 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18937 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18938
18939 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18940 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18941 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18942
18943 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18944 @cindex symbol cache size
18945 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18946 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18947 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18948 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18949 with different sizes.
18950
18951 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18952 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18953 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18954
18955 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18956 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18957 @item maint print symbol-cache
18958 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18959 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18960
18961 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18962 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18963 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18964 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18965 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18966
18967 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18968 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18969 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18970 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18971 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18972 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18973
18974 @end table
18975
18976 @node Altering
18977 @chapter Altering Execution
18978
18979 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18980 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18981 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18982 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18983 program.
18984
18985 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18986 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18987 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18988
18989 @menu
18990 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18991 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18992 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18993 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18994 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18995 * Patching:: Patching your program
18996 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18997 @end menu
18998
18999 @node Assignment
19000 @section Assignment to Variables
19001
19002 @cindex assignment
19003 @cindex setting variables
19004 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
19005 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
19006
19007 @smallexample
19008 print x=4
19009 @end smallexample
19010
19011 @noindent
19012 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
19013 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
19014 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
19015 information on operators in supported languages.
19016
19017 @kindex set variable
19018 @cindex variables, setting
19019 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
19020 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
19021 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
19022 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
19023 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
19024
19025 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
19026 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
19027 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
19028 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
19029 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
19030 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
19031 command @code{set width}:
19032
19033 @smallexample
19034 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
19035 type = double
19036 (@value{GDBP}) p width
19037 $4 = 13
19038 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
19039 Invalid syntax in expression.
19040 @end smallexample
19041
19042 @noindent
19043 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
19044 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
19045
19046 @smallexample
19047 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
19048 @end smallexample
19049
19050 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
19051 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
19052 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
19053 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
19054 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
19055 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
19056
19057 @smallexample
19058 @group
19059 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
19060 type = double
19061 (@value{GDBP}) p g
19062 $1 = 1
19063 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
19064 (@value{GDBP}) p g
19065 $2 = 1
19066 (@value{GDBP}) r
19067 The program being debugged has been started already.
19068 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
19069 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
19070 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
19071 Invalid bfd target.
19072 (@value{GDBP}) show g
19073 The current BFD target is "=4".
19074 @end group
19075 @end smallexample
19076
19077 @noindent
19078 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
19079 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
19080 @code{g}, use
19081
19082 @smallexample
19083 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
19084 @end smallexample
19085
19086 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
19087 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
19088 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
19089 same length or shorter.
19090 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
19091 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
19092
19093 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
19094 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
19095 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
19096 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
19097 and representation in memory), and
19098
19099 @smallexample
19100 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
19101 @end smallexample
19102
19103 @noindent
19104 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
19105
19106 @node Jumping
19107 @section Continuing at a Different Address
19108
19109 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
19110 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
19111 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
19112
19113 @table @code
19114 @kindex jump
19115 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
19116 @item jump @var{location}
19117 @itemx j @var{location}
19118 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
19119 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
19120 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
19121 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
19122 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
19123
19124 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
19125 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
19126 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
19127 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
19128 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
19129 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
19130 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
19131 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
19132 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
19133 @end table
19134
19135 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
19136 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
19137 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
19138 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
19139 example,
19140
19141 @smallexample
19142 set $pc = 0x485
19143 @end smallexample
19144
19145 @noindent
19146 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
19147 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
19148 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
19149
19150 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
19151 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
19152 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
19153 detail.
19154
19155 @c @group
19156 @node Signaling
19157 @section Giving your Program a Signal
19158 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
19159
19160 @table @code
19161 @kindex signal
19162 @item signal @var{signal}
19163 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
19164 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
19165 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
19166 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
19167
19168 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
19169 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
19170 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
19171 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
19172 signal.
19173
19174 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
19175 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
19176 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
19177 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
19178 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
19179 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
19180 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
19181 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
19182
19183 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
19184 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
19185 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
19186 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
19187 passes the signal directly to your program.
19188
19189 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
19190 after executing the command.
19191
19192 @kindex queue-signal
19193 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
19194 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
19195 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
19196 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
19197 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
19198 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
19199 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
19200 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
19201 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
19202
19203 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
19204 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
19205 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
19206 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
19207 @code{continue} command.
19208
19209 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
19210 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
19211 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
19212 (@pxref{Signals}).
19213 @end table
19214 @c @end group
19215
19216 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
19217 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
19218
19219 @node Returning
19220 @section Returning from a Function
19221
19222 @table @code
19223 @cindex returning from a function
19224 @kindex return
19225 @item return
19226 @itemx return @var{expression}
19227 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
19228 command. If you give an
19229 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
19230 value.
19231 @end table
19232
19233 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
19234 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
19235 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
19236 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
19237
19238 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
19239 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
19240 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
19241 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
19242 of functions.
19243
19244 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
19245 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
19246 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
19247 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
19248 selected stack frame returns naturally.
19249
19250 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
19251 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
19252 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
19253 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
19254 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
19255 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
19256 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
19257 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
19258 assignment into the right register(s).
19259
19260 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
19261 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
19262 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
19263 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
19264 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
19265 into a @code{long long int}:
19266
19267 @smallexample
19268 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
19269 29 return 31;
19270 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
19271 Make func return now? (y or n) y
19272 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
19273 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
19274 (@value{GDBP})
19275 @end smallexample
19276
19277 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
19278 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
19279 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
19280 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
19281 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
19282 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
19283 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
19284 an appropriate cast explicitly:
19285
19286 @smallexample
19287 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
19288 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
19289 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
19290 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
19291 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
19292 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
19293 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
19294 (@value{GDBP})
19295 @end smallexample
19296
19297 @node Calling
19298 @section Calling Program Functions
19299
19300 @table @code
19301 @cindex calling functions
19302 @cindex inferior functions, calling
19303 @item print @var{expr}
19304 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
19305 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
19306 debugged.
19307
19308 @kindex call
19309 @item call @var{expr}
19310 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
19311 returned values.
19312
19313 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
19314 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
19315 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
19316 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
19317 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
19318 value history.
19319 @end table
19320
19321 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
19322 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
19323 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
19324 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
19325
19326 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
19327 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
19328 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
19329 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
19330 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
19331 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
19332 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
19333 in that case is controlled by the
19334 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
19335
19336 @table @code
19337 @item set unwindonsignal
19338 @kindex set unwindonsignal
19339 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
19340 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
19341 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
19342 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
19343 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
19344 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
19345 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
19346 received.
19347
19348 @item show unwindonsignal
19349 @kindex show unwindonsignal
19350 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
19351 @value{GDBN}.
19352
19353 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
19354 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
19355 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
19356 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
19357 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
19358 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
19359 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
19360 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
19361 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
19362 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
19363
19364 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
19365 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
19366 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
19367 @value{GDBN}.
19368
19369 @item set may-call-functions
19370 @kindex set may-call-functions
19371 @cindex disabling calling functions in the program
19372 @cindex calling functions in the program, disabling
19373 Set permission to call functions in the program.
19374 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to call functions in
19375 the program, such as with expressions in the @code{print} command. It
19376 defaults to @code{on}.
19377
19378 To call a function in the program, @value{GDBN} has to temporarily
19379 modify the state of the inferior. This has potentially undesired side
19380 effects. Also, having @value{GDBN} call nested functions is likely to
19381 be erroneous and may even crash the program being debugged. You can
19382 avoid such hazards by forbidding @value{GDBN} from calling functions
19383 in the program being debugged. If calling functions in the program
19384 is forbidden, GDB will throw an error when a command (such as printing
19385 an expression) starts a function call in the program.
19386
19387 @item show may-call-functions
19388 @kindex show may-call-functions
19389 Show permission to call functions in the program.
19390
19391 @end table
19392
19393 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
19394
19395 @cindex no debug info functions
19396 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
19397 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
19398 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
19399 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
19400 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
19401 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
19402
19403 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
19404 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
19405 declared return type. For example:
19406
19407 @smallexample
19408 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
19409 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
19410 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
19411 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
19412 @end smallexample
19413
19414 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
19415 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
19416 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
19417 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
19418
19419 @smallexample
19420 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
19421 @end smallexample
19422
19423 @noindent
19424 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
19425
19426 @smallexample
19427 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
19428 @end smallexample
19429
19430 @noindent
19431 these calls are equivalent:
19432
19433 @smallexample
19434 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
19435 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
19436 @end smallexample
19437
19438 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
19439 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
19440 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
19441 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
19442 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
19443 float parameters, and no debug info:
19444
19445 @smallexample
19446 float
19447 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
19448 float v1, v2;
19449 @{
19450 return v1 * v2;
19451 @}
19452 @end smallexample
19453
19454 @noindent
19455 you call it like this:
19456
19457 @smallexample
19458 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
19459 @end smallexample
19460
19461 @node Patching
19462 @section Patching Programs
19463
19464 @cindex patching binaries
19465 @cindex writing into executables
19466 @cindex writing into corefiles
19467
19468 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
19469 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
19470 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
19471 patching your program's binary.
19472
19473 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
19474 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
19475 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
19476 repairs.
19477
19478 @table @code
19479 @kindex set write
19480 @item set write on
19481 @itemx set write off
19482 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
19483 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
19484 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
19485
19486 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
19487 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
19488 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
19489
19490 @item show write
19491 @kindex show write
19492 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
19493 as well as reading.
19494 @end table
19495
19496 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
19497 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
19498 @cindex injecting code
19499 @cindex writing into executables
19500 @cindex compiling code
19501
19502 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
19503 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
19504 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
19505 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
19506
19507 @table @code
19508 @kindex compile code
19509 @item compile code @var{source-code}
19510 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
19511 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
19512 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
19513 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
19514 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
19515 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
19516 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
19517 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
19518 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
19519 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
19520 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
19521
19522 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
19523 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
19524 E.g.:
19525
19526 @smallexample
19527 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
19528 @end smallexample
19529
19530 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
19531 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
19532 from actual source code. E.g.:
19533
19534 @smallexample
19535 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
19536 @end smallexample
19537
19538 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
19539 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
19540 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
19541 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
19542 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
19543 editor.
19544
19545 @smallexample
19546 compile code
19547 >printf ("hello\n");
19548 >printf ("world\n");
19549 >end
19550 @end smallexample
19551
19552 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
19553 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
19554 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
19555 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
19556 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
19557 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
19558 inferior symbols otherwise.
19559
19560 @kindex compile file
19561 @item compile file @var{filename}
19562 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
19563 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
19564
19565 @smallexample
19566 compile file /home/user/example.c
19567 @end smallexample
19568 @end table
19569
19570 @table @code
19571 @item compile print [[@var{options}] --] @var{expr}
19572 @itemx compile print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f} @var{expr}
19573 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
19574 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
19575 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
19576 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
19577 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
19578 Formats}. The @code{compile print} command accepts the same options
19579 as the @code{print} command; see @ref{print options}.
19580
19581 @item compile print [[@var{options}] --]
19582 @itemx compile print [[@var{options}] --] /@var{f}
19583 @cindex reprint the last value
19584 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
19585 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
19586 command without any text following the command. This will start the
19587 multiple-line editor.
19588 @end table
19589
19590 @noindent
19591 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
19592
19593 @table @code
19594 @anchor{set debug compile}
19595 @item set debug compile
19596 @cindex compile command debugging info
19597 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
19598 injecting the code. The default is off.
19599
19600 @item show debug compile
19601 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
19602 compiling and injecting the code.
19603
19604 @anchor{set debug compile-cplus-types}
19605 @item set debug compile-cplus-types
19606 @cindex compile C@t{++} type conversion
19607 Turns on or off the display of C@t{++} type conversion debugging information.
19608 The default is off.
19609
19610 @item show debug compile-cplus-types
19611 Displays the current state of displaying debugging information for
19612 C@t{++} type conversion.
19613 @end table
19614
19615 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
19616
19617 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
19618 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
19619 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
19620 injecting process.
19621
19622 @noindent
19623 The options used, in increasing precedence:
19624
19625 @table @asis
19626 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
19627 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
19628 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
19629 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
19630
19631 @item compilation options recorded in the target
19632 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
19633 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
19634 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
19635 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
19636 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
19637 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
19638 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
19639
19640 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
19641 @end table
19642
19643 @noindent
19644 You can override compilation options using the following command:
19645
19646 @table @code
19647 @item set compile-args
19648 @cindex compile command options override
19649 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
19650 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
19651 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
19652 compilation.
19653
19654 @item show compile-args
19655 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
19656 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
19657 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
19658 @end table
19659
19660 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
19661
19662 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
19663 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
19664 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
19665
19666 @table @asis
19667 @item C code examples and caveats
19668 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
19669 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
19670 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
19671 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
19672 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
19673
19674 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
19675 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
19676 much like any other normal debugging session.
19677
19678 @smallexample
19679 void function1 (void)
19680 @{
19681 int i = 42;
19682 printf ("function 1\n");
19683 @}
19684
19685 void function2 (void)
19686 @{
19687 int j = 12;
19688 function1 ();
19689 @}
19690
19691 int main(void)
19692 @{
19693 int k = 6;
19694 int *p;
19695 function2 ();
19696 return 0;
19697 @}
19698 @end smallexample
19699
19700 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
19701 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
19702 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
19703
19704 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
19705 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
19706 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
19707 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
19708 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
19709
19710 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
19711 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
19712 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
19713 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
19714 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
19715 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
19716 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
19717 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
19718 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
19719 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
19720
19721 @smallexample
19722 compile code k = 3;
19723 @end smallexample
19724
19725 @noindent
19726 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
19727 something else in the example program changes it, or another
19728 @code{compile} command changes it.
19729
19730 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
19731 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
19732 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
19733 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
19734 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
19735
19736 @smallexample
19737 compile code j = 3;
19738 @end smallexample
19739
19740 @noindent
19741 will result in a compilation error message.
19742
19743 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
19744 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
19745 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
19746
19747 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
19748 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
19749 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
19750 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
19751
19752 @smallexample
19753 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
19754 @end smallexample
19755
19756 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
19757 command has completed:
19758
19759 @smallexample
19760 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
19761 @end smallexample
19762
19763 @noindent
19764 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
19765 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
19766 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
19767 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
19768 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
19769
19770 @smallexample
19771 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
19772 @end smallexample
19773
19774 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
19775 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
19776 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
19777 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
19778 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
19779 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
19780 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
19781 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
19782
19783 @smallexample
19784 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
19785 @end smallexample
19786
19787 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
19788 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
19789 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
19790 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
19791 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
19792 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
19793 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
19794
19795 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
19796 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
19797 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
19798 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
19799 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
19800 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
19801
19802 @smallexample
19803 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
19804 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19805 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
19806 Compilation failed.
19807 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
19808 42
19809 @end smallexample
19810
19811 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
19812 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
19813 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
19814 will print to the console.
19815 @end table
19816
19817 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
19818
19819 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
19820 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
19821 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
19822 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
19823 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
19824 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
19825 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
19826 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
19827
19828
19829 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
19830 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
19831 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
19832 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
19833 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
19834 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
19835 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
19836
19837 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
19838 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
19839 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
19840 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
19841 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
19842 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
19843 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
19844
19845 @table @code
19846 @item set compile-gcc
19847 @cindex compile command driver filename override
19848 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
19849 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
19850 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
19851 default.
19852
19853 @item show compile-gcc
19854 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
19855 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
19856 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
19857 @end table
19858
19859 @node GDB Files
19860 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
19861
19862 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
19863 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
19864 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
19865 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
19866
19867 @menu
19868 * Files:: Commands to specify files
19869 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
19870 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
19871 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
19872 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
19873 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
19874 * Data Files:: GDB data files
19875 @end menu
19876
19877 @node Files
19878 @section Commands to Specify Files
19879
19880 @cindex symbol table
19881 @cindex core dump file
19882
19883 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
19884 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
19885 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
19886 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
19887
19888 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
19889 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
19890 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
19891 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
19892 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
19893 new files are useful.
19894
19895 @table @code
19896 @cindex executable file
19897 @kindex file
19898 @item file @var{filename}
19899 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
19900 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
19901 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
19902 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
19903 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
19904 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
19905 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
19906 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
19907
19908 @cindex unlinked object files
19909 @cindex patching object files
19910 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
19911 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
19912 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
19913 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
19914 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
19915 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
19916 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
19917 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
19918
19919 @item file
19920 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19921 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19922
19923 @kindex exec-file
19924 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19925 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19926 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19927 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19928 discard information on the executable file.
19929
19930 @kindex symbol-file
19931 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19932 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19933 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19934 table and program to run from the same file.
19935
19936 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19937 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19938 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19939 enabled.
19940
19941 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19942 program's symbol table.
19943
19944 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19945 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19946 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19947 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19948 @value{GDBN}.
19949
19950 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19951 executing it once.
19952
19953 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19954 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19955 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19956 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19957 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19958 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19959 optimized code.
19960
19961 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19962 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19963 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19964 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19965 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19966
19967 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19968 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19969 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19970 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19971 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19972 Warnings and Messages}.)
19973
19974 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19975 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19976 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19977 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19978 in stabs format.
19979
19980 @kindex readnow
19981 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19982 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19983 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19984 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19985 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19986 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19987 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19988 entire symbol table available.
19989
19990 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19991 @cindex never read symbols
19992 @cindex symbols, never read
19993 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19994 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19995 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19996 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19997 @xref{--readnever}.
19998
19999 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
20000 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
20001 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
20002 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
20003 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
20004 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
20005 @c files.
20006
20007 @kindex core-file
20008 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
20009 @itemx core
20010 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
20011 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
20012 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
20013 executable file itself for other parts.
20014
20015 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
20016 to be used.
20017
20018 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
20019 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
20020 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
20021 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
20022 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
20023
20024 @kindex add-symbol-file
20025 @cindex dynamic linking
20026 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
20027 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
20028 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
20029 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
20030 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
20031 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
20032 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
20033 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
20034 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
20035 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
20036 can be given as an expression.
20037
20038 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
20039 address of each section, except those for which the address was
20040 specified explicitly.
20041
20042 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
20043 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
20044 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
20045 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
20046
20047 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
20048
20049 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
20050 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
20051 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
20052 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
20053 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
20054 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
20055 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
20056 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
20057 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
20058
20059 @itemize @bullet
20060 @item
20061 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
20062 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
20063 @item
20064 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
20065 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
20066 @item
20067 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
20068 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20069 @end itemize
20070
20071 @noindent
20072 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
20073 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
20074 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
20075 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
20076 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
20077 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
20078 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
20079 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
20080 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
20081 way.
20082
20083 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
20084
20085 @kindex remove-symbol-file
20086 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
20087 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
20088 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
20089 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
20090 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
20091
20092 @smallexample
20093 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
20094 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
20095 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
20096 (y or n) y
20097 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
20098 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
20099 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
20100 (gdb)
20101 @end smallexample
20102
20103
20104 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
20105
20106 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
20107 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
20108 @cindex load symbols from memory
20109 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
20110 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
20111 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
20112 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
20113 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
20114 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
20115 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
20116 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
20117 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
20118
20119 @kindex section
20120 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
20121 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
20122 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
20123 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
20124 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
20125 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
20126 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
20127 their addresses.
20128
20129 @kindex info files
20130 @kindex info target
20131 @item info files
20132 @itemx info target
20133 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
20134 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
20135 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
20136 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
20137 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
20138 current ones.
20139
20140 @kindex maint info sections
20141 @item maint info sections
20142 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
20143 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
20144 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
20145 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
20146 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
20147 may be arbitrarily combined):
20148
20149 @table @code
20150 @item ALLOBJ
20151 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
20152 @item @var{sections}
20153 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
20154 @item @var{section-flags}
20155 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
20156 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
20157 @table @code
20158 @item ALLOC
20159 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
20160 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
20161 @item LOAD
20162 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
20163 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
20164 @item RELOC
20165 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
20166 @item READONLY
20167 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
20168 @item CODE
20169 Section contains executable code only.
20170 @item DATA
20171 Section contains data only (no executable code).
20172 @item ROM
20173 Section will reside in ROM.
20174 @item CONSTRUCTOR
20175 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
20176 @item HAS_CONTENTS
20177 Section is not empty.
20178 @item NEVER_LOAD
20179 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
20180 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
20181 A notification to the linker that the section contains
20182 COFF shared library information.
20183 @item IS_COMMON
20184 Section contains common symbols.
20185 @end table
20186 @end table
20187 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
20188 @cindex read-only sections
20189 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
20190 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
20191 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
20192 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
20193 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
20194 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
20195 enhancement to debugging performance.
20196
20197 The default is off.
20198
20199 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
20200 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
20201 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
20202 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
20203
20204 @item show trust-readonly-sections
20205 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
20206 @end table
20207
20208 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
20209 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
20210 name and remembers it that way.
20211
20212 @cindex shared libraries
20213 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
20214 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
20215 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
20216 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
20217
20218 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
20219 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
20220
20221 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
20222 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
20223 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
20224 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
20225 debugging a core file).
20226
20227 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
20228 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
20229 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
20230
20231 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
20232 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
20233 particularly large or there are many of them.
20234
20235 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
20236 commands:
20237
20238 @table @code
20239 @kindex set auto-solib-add
20240 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
20241 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
20242 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
20243 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
20244 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
20245 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
20246 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
20247
20248 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
20249 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
20250 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
20251 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
20252 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
20253 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
20254 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
20255 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
20256 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
20257
20258 @kindex show auto-solib-add
20259 @item show auto-solib-add
20260 Display the current autoloading mode.
20261 @end table
20262
20263 @cindex load shared library
20264 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
20265 command:
20266
20267 @table @code
20268 @kindex info sharedlibrary
20269 @kindex info share
20270 @item info share @var{regex}
20271 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
20272 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
20273 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
20274 all shared libraries that are loaded.
20275
20276 @kindex info dll
20277 @item info dll @var{regex}
20278 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
20279
20280 @kindex sharedlibrary
20281 @kindex share
20282 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
20283 @itemx share @var{regex}
20284 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
20285 Unix regular expression.
20286 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
20287 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
20288 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
20289 loaded.
20290
20291 @item nosharedlibrary
20292 @kindex nosharedlibrary
20293 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
20294 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
20295 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
20296 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
20297 discarded.
20298 @end table
20299
20300 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
20301 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
20302 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
20303 Catchpoints}).
20304
20305 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
20306 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
20307 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
20308 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
20309
20310 @table @code
20311 @item set stop-on-solib-events
20312 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
20313 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
20314 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
20315 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
20316 shared library.
20317
20318 @item show stop-on-solib-events
20319 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
20320 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
20321 library events happen.
20322 @end table
20323
20324 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
20325 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
20326 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
20327 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
20328 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
20329 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
20330 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
20331 not.
20332
20333 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
20334 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
20335 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
20336 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
20337 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
20338
20339 @table @code
20340 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
20341 @cindex system root, alternate
20342 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
20343 @kindex set sysroot
20344 @item set sysroot @var{path}
20345 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
20346 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
20347 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
20348 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
20349 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
20350 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
20351 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
20352 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
20353 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
20354 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
20355 @var{path}.
20356
20357 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
20358 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
20359 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
20360 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
20361 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
20362 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
20363 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
20364 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
20365 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
20366 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
20367 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
20368 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
20369 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
20370 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
20371
20372 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
20373 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
20374 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
20375 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
20376 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
20377
20378 @smallexample
20379 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
20380 @end smallexample
20381
20382 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
20383 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
20384 system:
20385
20386 @smallexample
20387 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
20388 @end smallexample
20389
20390 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
20391 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
20392 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
20393 colons:
20394
20395 @smallexample
20396 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
20397 @end smallexample
20398
20399 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
20400 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
20401 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
20402 @samp{z}):
20403
20404 @smallexample
20405 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
20406 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
20407 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
20408 @end smallexample
20409
20410 @noindent
20411 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
20412 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
20413 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
20414
20415 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
20416 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
20417
20418 @smallexample
20419 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
20420 @end smallexample
20421
20422 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
20423 if you don't want or need to.
20424
20425 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
20426 sysroot}.
20427
20428 @cindex default system root
20429 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
20430 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
20431 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
20432 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20433 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
20434 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20435 location.
20436
20437 @kindex show sysroot
20438 @item show sysroot
20439 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
20440
20441 @kindex set solib-search-path
20442 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
20443 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
20444 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
20445 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
20446 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
20447 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
20448 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
20449 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
20450 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
20451 of shared library symbols.
20452
20453 @kindex show solib-search-path
20454 @item show solib-search-path
20455 Display the current shared library search path.
20456
20457 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
20458 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
20459 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
20460 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
20461 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
20462
20463 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
20464 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
20465 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
20466 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
20467 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
20468 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
20469 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
20470 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
20471 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
20472 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
20473 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
20474 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
20475 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
20476 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
20477 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
20478 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
20479 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
20480 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
20481 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
20482 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
20483 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
20484 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
20485
20486 @table @code
20487 @item unix
20488 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
20489 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
20490 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
20491 the forward slash.
20492
20493 @item dos-based
20494 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
20495 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
20496 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
20497 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
20498 considered directory separators.
20499
20500 @item auto
20501 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
20502 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
20503 This is the default.
20504 @end table
20505 @end table
20506
20507 @cindex file name canonicalization
20508 @cindex base name differences
20509 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
20510 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
20511 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
20512 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
20513 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
20514 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
20515 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
20516 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
20517 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
20518 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
20519 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
20520 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
20521 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
20522 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
20523 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
20524
20525 @table @code
20526 @item set basenames-may-differ
20527 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
20528 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
20529
20530 @item show basenames-may-differ
20531 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
20532 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
20533 @end table
20534
20535 @node File Caching
20536 @section File Caching
20537 @cindex caching of opened files
20538 @cindex caching of bfd objects
20539
20540 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
20541 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
20542 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
20543 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
20544
20545 @table @code
20546 @kindex maint info bfds
20547 @item maint info bfds
20548 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
20549 @value{GDBN}.
20550
20551 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
20552 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
20553 @kindex bfd caching
20554 @item maint set bfd-sharing
20555 @item maint show bfd-sharing
20556 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
20557 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
20558 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
20559 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
20560 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
20561 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
20562 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
20563
20564 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
20565 @kindex bfd caching
20566 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
20567 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
20568
20569 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
20570 @kindex bfd caching
20571 @item show debug bfd-cache
20572 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
20573 @end table
20574
20575 @node Separate Debug Files
20576 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
20577 @cindex separate debugging information files
20578 @cindex debugging information in separate files
20579 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
20580 @cindex debugging information directory, global
20581 @cindex global debugging information directories
20582 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
20583 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
20584
20585 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
20586 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
20587 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
20588 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
20589 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
20590 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
20591 install only when they need to debug a problem.
20592
20593 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
20594 file:
20595
20596 @itemize @bullet
20597 @item
20598 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
20599 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
20600 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
20601 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
20602 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
20603 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
20604 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
20605 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
20606
20607 @item
20608 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
20609 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
20610 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
20611 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
20612 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
20613 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld,
20614 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
20615 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
20616 below.
20617 @end itemize
20618
20619 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
20620 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
20621
20622 @itemize @bullet
20623 @item
20624 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
20625 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
20626 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the
20627 global debug directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to
20628 the leading directories of the executable's absolute file name. (On
20629 MS-Windows/MS-DOS, the drive letter of the executable's leading
20630 directories is converted to a one-letter subdirectory, i.e.@:
20631 @file{d:/usr/bin/} is converted to @file{/d/usr/bin/}, because Windows
20632 filesystems disallow colons in file names.)
20633
20634 @item
20635 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
20636 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
20637 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
20638 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
20639 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
20640 hex characters, not 10.)
20641 @end itemize
20642
20643 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
20644 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
20645 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
20646 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
20647 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
20648 debug information files, in the indicated order:
20649
20650 @itemize @minus
20651 @item
20652 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
20653 @item
20654 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
20655 @item
20656 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
20657 @item
20658 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
20659 @end itemize
20660
20661 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
20662 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
20663 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
20664 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
20665 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
20666
20667 @table @code
20668
20669 @kindex set debug-file-directory
20670 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
20671 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
20672 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
20673 concatenating them by a path separator.
20674
20675 @kindex show debug-file-directory
20676 @item show debug-file-directory
20677 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
20678 information files.
20679
20680 @end table
20681
20682 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
20683 @cindex debug link sections
20684 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
20685 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
20686
20687 @itemize
20688 @item
20689 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
20690 a zero byte,
20691 @item
20692 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
20693 boundary within the section, and
20694 @item
20695 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
20696 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
20697 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
20698 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
20699 @end itemize
20700
20701 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
20702 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
20703 described above.
20704
20705 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
20706 @cindex build ID sections
20707 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
20708 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
20709 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
20710 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
20711 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
20712 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
20713 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
20714 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
20715 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
20716
20717 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
20718 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
20719 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
20720 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
20721 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
20722 in an ordinary executable.
20723
20724 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
20725 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
20726 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
20727 following commands:
20728
20729 @smallexample
20730 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
20731 @kbd{strip -g foo}
20732 @end smallexample
20733
20734 @noindent
20735 These commands remove the debugging
20736 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
20737 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
20738 two files:
20739
20740 @itemize @bullet
20741 @item
20742 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
20743 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
20744
20745 @smallexample
20746 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
20747 @end smallexample
20748
20749 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
20750 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
20751 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
20752 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
20753
20754 @item
20755 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
20756 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
20757 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
20758 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
20759 @end itemize
20760
20761 @noindent
20762
20763 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
20764 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
20765 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
20766
20767 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
20768 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
20769 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
20770 @c different ways!
20771 @ifhtml
20772 @display
20773 @html
20774 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
20775 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
20776 @end html
20777 @end display
20778 @end ifhtml
20779 @ifnothtml
20780 @display
20781 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
20782 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
20783 @end display
20784 @end ifnothtml
20785
20786 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
20787 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
20788 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
20789 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
20790 CRC.
20791
20792 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
20793 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
20794 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
20795 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
20796 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
20797
20798 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
20799 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
20800 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
20801 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
20802 @code{0xffffffff}.
20803
20804 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
20805 @smallexample
20806 unsigned long
20807 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
20808 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
20809 @{
20810 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
20811 @{
20812 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
20813 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
20814 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
20815 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
20816 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
20817 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
20818 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
20819 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
20820 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
20821 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
20822 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
20823 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
20824 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
20825 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
20826 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
20827 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
20828 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
20829 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
20830 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
20831 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
20832 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
20833 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
20834 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
20835 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
20836 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
20837 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
20838 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
20839 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
20840 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
20841 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
20842 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
20843 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
20844 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
20845 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
20846 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
20847 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
20848 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
20849 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
20850 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
20851 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
20852 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
20853 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
20854 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
20855 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
20856 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
20857 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
20858 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
20859 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
20860 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
20861 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
20862 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
20863 0x2d02ef8d
20864 @};
20865 unsigned char *end;
20866
20867 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20868 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
20869 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
20870 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
20871 @}
20872 @end smallexample
20873
20874 @noindent
20875 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
20876
20877 @node MiniDebugInfo
20878 @section Debugging information in a special section
20879 @cindex separate debug sections
20880 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
20881
20882 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
20883 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
20884 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
20885 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
20886
20887 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
20888 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
20889 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
20890 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
20891 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
20892 debugging information might be included in the section.
20893
20894 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
20895 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
20896 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
20897
20898 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
20899 standard utilities:
20900
20901 @smallexample
20902 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
20903 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
20904 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20905 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
20906
20907 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
20908 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
20909 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
20910 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
20911 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
20912 | sort > funcsyms
20913
20914 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
20915 # table.
20916 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
20917
20918 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
20919 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
20920
20921 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
20922 # removing some unnecessary sections.
20923 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
20924 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20925
20926 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20927 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20928
20929 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20930 # original binary.
20931 xz mini_debuginfo
20932 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20933 @end smallexample
20934
20935 @node Index Files
20936 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20937 @cindex index files
20938 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20939
20940 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20941 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20942 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20943 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20944 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20945 startup.
20946
20947 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20948 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20949 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20950
20951 @smallexample
20952 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20953 @end smallexample
20954
20955 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20956
20957 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20958 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20959
20960 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20961 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20962 using @command{objcopy}.
20963
20964 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20965
20966 @table @code
20967 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20968 @kindex save gdb-index
20969 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20970 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20971 default creates it produces a single file
20972 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20973 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20974 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20975 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20976 given @var{directory}.
20977 @end table
20978
20979 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20980 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20981
20982 @smallexample
20983 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20984 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20985 @end smallexample
20986
20987 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20988
20989 @smallexample
20990 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20991 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20992 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20993 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20994 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20995 @end smallexample
20996
20997 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20998 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20999 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
21000 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
21001 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
21002 The default is @code{off}.
21003 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
21004 @xref{Index Section Format}.
21005
21006 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
21007 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
21008
21009 @smallexample
21010 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
21011 @end smallexample
21012
21013 Instead you must do, for example,
21014
21015 @smallexample
21016 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
21017 @end smallexample
21018
21019 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
21020 using DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, only the
21021 @code{-dwarf-5} index works for programs using Ada.
21022
21023 @subsection Automatic symbol index cache
21024
21025 @cindex automatic symbol index cache
21026 It is possible for @value{GDBN} to automatically save a copy of this index in a
21027 cache on disk and retrieve it from there when loading the same binary in the
21028 future. This feature can be turned on with @kbd{set index-cache on}. The
21029 following commands can be used to tweak the behavior of the index cache.
21030
21031 @table @code
21032
21033 @kindex set index-cache
21034 @item set index-cache on
21035 @itemx set index-cache off
21036 Enable or disable the use of the symbol index cache.
21037
21038 @item set index-cache directory @var{directory}
21039 @kindex show index-cache
21040 @itemx show index-cache directory
21041 Set/show the directory where index files will be saved.
21042
21043 The default value for this directory depends on the host platform. On
21044 most systems, the index is cached in the @file{gdb} subdirectory of
21045 the directory pointed to by the @env{XDG_CACHE_HOME} environment
21046 variable, if it is defined, else in the @file{.cache/gdb} subdirectory
21047 of your home directory. However, on some systems, the default may
21048 differ according to local convention.
21049
21050 There is no limit on the disk space used by index cache. It is perfectly safe
21051 to delete the content of that directory to free up disk space.
21052
21053 @item show index-cache stats
21054 Print the number of cache hits and misses since the launch of @value{GDBN}.
21055
21056 @end table
21057
21058 @node Symbol Errors
21059 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
21060
21061 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
21062 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
21063 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
21064 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
21065 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
21066 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
21067 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
21068 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
21069 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
21070 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
21071 Messages}).
21072
21073 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
21074
21075 @table @code
21076 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
21077
21078 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
21079 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
21080 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
21081 in its outer scope blocks.
21082
21083 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
21084 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
21085 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
21086 function.
21087
21088 @item block at @var{address} out of order
21089
21090 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
21091 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
21092 do so.
21093
21094 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
21095 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
21096 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
21097 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
21098 Messages}.)
21099
21100 @item bad block start address patched
21101
21102 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
21103 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
21104 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
21105
21106 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
21107 starting on the previous source line.
21108
21109 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
21110
21111 @cindex foo
21112 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
21113 larger than the size of the string table.
21114
21115 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
21116 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
21117 with this name.
21118
21119 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
21120
21121 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
21122 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
21123 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
21124
21125 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
21126 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
21127 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
21128 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
21129 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
21130 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
21131
21132 @item stub type has NULL name
21133
21134 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
21135
21136 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
21137 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
21138 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
21139 it.
21140
21141 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
21142
21143 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
21144
21145 @end table
21146
21147 @node Data Files
21148 @section GDB Data Files
21149
21150 @cindex prefix for data files
21151 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
21152 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
21153
21154 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
21155 is currently using.
21156
21157 @table @code
21158 @kindex set data-directory
21159 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
21160 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
21161 to @var{directory}.
21162
21163 @kindex show data-directory
21164 @item show data-directory
21165 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
21166 @end table
21167
21168 @cindex default data directory
21169 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
21170 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
21171 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
21172 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
21173 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
21174 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
21175 location.
21176
21177 The data directory may also be specified with the
21178 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
21179 @xref{Mode Options}.
21180
21181 @node Targets
21182 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
21183
21184 @cindex debugging target
21185 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
21186
21187 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
21188 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
21189 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
21190 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
21191 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
21192 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
21193 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
21194 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
21195
21196 @cindex target architecture
21197 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
21198 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
21199 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
21200 command.
21201
21202 @table @code
21203 @kindex set architecture
21204 @kindex show architecture
21205 @item set architecture @var{arch}
21206 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
21207 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
21208 supported architectures.
21209
21210 @item show architecture
21211 Show the current target architecture.
21212
21213 @item set processor
21214 @itemx processor
21215 @kindex set processor
21216 @kindex show processor
21217 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
21218 and @code{show architecture}.
21219 @end table
21220
21221 @menu
21222 * Active Targets:: Active targets
21223 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
21224 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
21225 @end menu
21226
21227 @node Active Targets
21228 @section Active Targets
21229
21230 @cindex stacking targets
21231 @cindex active targets
21232 @cindex multiple targets
21233
21234 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
21235 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
21236 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
21237 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
21238 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
21239 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
21240 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
21241 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
21242 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
21243
21244 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
21245 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
21246 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
21247 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
21248
21249 @node Target Commands
21250 @section Commands for Managing Targets
21251
21252 @table @code
21253 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
21254 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
21255 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
21256 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
21257 protocol of the target machine.
21258
21259 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
21260 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
21261 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
21262
21263 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
21264 after executing the command.
21265
21266 @kindex help target
21267 @item help target
21268 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
21269 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
21270 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
21271
21272 @item help target @var{name}
21273 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
21274 select it.
21275
21276 @kindex set gnutarget
21277 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
21278 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
21279 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
21280 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
21281 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
21282 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
21283
21284 @quotation
21285 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
21286 you must know the actual BFD name.
21287 @end quotation
21288
21289 @noindent
21290 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
21291
21292 @kindex show gnutarget
21293 @item show gnutarget
21294 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
21295 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
21296 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
21297 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
21298 @end table
21299
21300 @cindex common targets
21301 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
21302 configuration):
21303
21304 @table @code
21305 @kindex target
21306 @item target exec @var{program}
21307 @cindex executable file target
21308 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
21309 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
21310
21311 @item target core @var{filename}
21312 @cindex core dump file target
21313 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
21314 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
21315
21316 @item target remote @var{medium}
21317 @cindex remote target
21318 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
21319 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
21320 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
21321
21322 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
21323 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
21324
21325 @smallexample
21326 target remote /dev/ttya
21327 @end smallexample
21328
21329 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
21330 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
21331 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
21332 clobbered by the download.
21333
21334 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
21335 @cindex built-in simulator target
21336 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
21337 In general,
21338 @smallexample
21339 target sim
21340 load
21341 run
21342 @end smallexample
21343 @noindent
21344 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
21345 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
21346 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
21347 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
21348 Processors}.
21349
21350 @item target native
21351 @cindex native target
21352 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
21353 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
21354 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
21355 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
21356
21357 @end table
21358
21359 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
21360 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
21361
21362 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
21363 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
21364 various aspects of this process.
21365
21366 @table @code
21367
21368 @item set hash
21369 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
21370 @cindex hash mark while downloading
21371 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
21372 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
21373 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
21374 monitor.
21375
21376 @item show hash
21377 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
21378 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
21379
21380 @item set debug monitor
21381 @kindex set debug monitor
21382 @cindex display remote monitor communications
21383 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
21384 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
21385
21386 @item show debug monitor
21387 @kindex show debug monitor
21388 Show the current status of displaying communications between
21389 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
21390 @end table
21391
21392 @table @code
21393
21394 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
21395 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
21396 @anchor{load}
21397 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
21398 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
21399 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
21400 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
21401 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
21402 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
21403
21404 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
21405 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
21406 target is @dots{}}''
21407
21408 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
21409 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
21410 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
21411 specifies a fixed address.
21412 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
21413
21414 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
21415 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
21416 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
21417
21418 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
21419 load programs into flash memory.
21420
21421 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
21422 @end table
21423
21424 @table @code
21425
21426 @kindex flash-erase
21427 @item flash-erase
21428 @anchor{flash-erase}
21429
21430 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
21431
21432 @end table
21433
21434 @node Byte Order
21435 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
21436
21437 @cindex choosing target byte order
21438 @cindex target byte order
21439
21440 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
21441 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
21442 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
21443 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
21444 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
21445 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
21446
21447 @table @code
21448 @kindex set endian
21449 @item set endian big
21450 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
21451
21452 @item set endian little
21453 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
21454
21455 @item set endian auto
21456 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
21457 executable.
21458
21459 @item show endian
21460 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
21461
21462 @end table
21463
21464 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
21465 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
21466 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
21467 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
21468 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
21469 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
21470 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
21471 and @code{big} otherwise.
21472
21473 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
21474 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
21475 target system.
21476
21477
21478 @node Remote Debugging
21479 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
21480 @cindex remote debugging
21481
21482 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
21483 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
21484 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
21485 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
21486 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
21487
21488 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
21489 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
21490 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
21491 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
21492 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
21493 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
21494
21495 Other remote targets may be available in your
21496 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
21497
21498 @menu
21499 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
21500 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
21501 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
21502 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
21503 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
21504 @end menu
21505
21506 @node Connecting
21507 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
21508 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
21509 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
21510 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
21511 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
21512 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
21513 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
21514
21515 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
21516 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
21517 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
21518 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
21519
21520 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
21521
21522 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
21523 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
21524 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
21525 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
21526
21527 @table @asis
21528
21529 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
21530 @item Result of detach or program exit
21531 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
21532 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
21533 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
21534
21535 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
21536 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
21537 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
21538 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
21539
21540 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
21541 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
21542 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
21543 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
21544
21545 @item Specifying the program to debug
21546 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
21547 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
21548 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
21549 target.
21550
21551 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
21552 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
21553 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
21554
21555 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
21556 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
21557 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
21558 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
21559
21560 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
21561 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
21562 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
21563 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
21564 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
21565 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
21566 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
21567 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
21568 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
21569
21570 @item The @code{run} command
21571 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
21572 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
21573 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
21574 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
21575 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
21576
21577 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
21578 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
21579 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
21580 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
21581 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
21582
21583 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
21584 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
21585 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
21586 @code{target remote} mode.
21587
21588 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
21589 @item Attaching
21590 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
21591 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
21592 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
21593
21594 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
21595 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
21596 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
21597 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
21598 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
21599
21600 @end table
21601
21602 @anchor{Host and target files}
21603 @subsection Host and Target Files
21604 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
21605 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
21606
21607 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
21608 information for your program running on the target. This requires
21609 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
21610 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
21611 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
21612
21613 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
21614 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
21615 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
21616 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
21617 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
21618
21619 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
21620 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
21621 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
21622 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
21623 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
21624 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
21625 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
21626 target libraries.
21627
21628 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
21629 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
21630 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
21631 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
21632 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
21633 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
21634 programs.
21635
21636 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
21637 @cindex remote connection commands
21638 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, a
21639 local Unix domain socket, or
21640 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
21641 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
21642 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
21643 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
21644 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
21645 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
21646
21647 @table @code
21648
21649 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
21650 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
21651 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
21652 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
21653 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
21654
21655 @smallexample
21656 target remote /dev/ttyb
21657 @end smallexample
21658
21659 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
21660 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
21661 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
21662 @code{target} command.
21663
21664 @item target remote @var{local-socket}
21665 @itemx target extended-remote @var{local-socket}
21666 @cindex local socket, @code{target remote}
21667 @cindex Unix domain socket
21668 Use @var{local-socket} to communicate with the target. For example,
21669 to use a local Unix domain socket bound to the file system entry @file{/tmp/gdb-socket0}:
21670
21671 @smallexample
21672 target remote /tmp/gdb-socket0
21673 @end smallexample
21674
21675 Note that this command has the same form as the command to connect
21676 to a serial line. @value{GDBN} will automatically determine which
21677 kind of file you have specified and will make the appropriate kind
21678 of connection.
21679 This feature is not available if the host system does not support
21680 Unix domain sockets.
21681
21682 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
21683 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21684 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21685 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21686 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21687 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21688 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21689 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
21690 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21691 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21692 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21693 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21694 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21695 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21696 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
21697 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
21698 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
21699 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
21700 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
21701 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
21702 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
21703 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
21704
21705 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
21706 @code{manyfarms}:
21707
21708 @smallexample
21709 target remote manyfarms:2828
21710 @end smallexample
21711
21712 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
21713 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
21714 square bracket syntax:
21715
21716 @smallexample
21717 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
21718 @end smallexample
21719
21720 @noindent
21721 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
21722
21723 @smallexample
21724 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
21725 @end smallexample
21726
21727 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
21728 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
21729 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
21730 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
21731 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
21732 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
21733
21734 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
21735 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
21736 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
21737 port 1234 on your local machine:
21738
21739 @smallexample
21740 target remote :1234
21741 @end smallexample
21742 @noindent
21743
21744 Note that the colon is still required here.
21745
21746 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21747 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21748 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21749 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21750 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21751 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21752 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21753 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21754 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
21755 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
21756 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
21757 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
21758 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
21759
21760 @smallexample
21761 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
21762 @end smallexample
21763
21764 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
21765 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
21766 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
21767 cause havoc with your debugging session.
21768
21769 @item target remote | @var{command}
21770 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
21771 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
21772 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
21773 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
21774 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
21775 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
21776 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
21777 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
21778 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
21779
21780 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
21781 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
21782 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
21783
21784 @end table
21785
21786 @cindex interrupting remote programs
21787 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
21788 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
21789 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
21790 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
21791 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
21792 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
21793
21794 @smallexample
21795 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
21796 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
21797 @end smallexample
21798
21799 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
21800 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
21801 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
21802 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
21803
21804 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
21805 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
21806
21807 @table @code
21808 @kindex detach (remote)
21809 @item detach
21810 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
21811 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
21812 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
21813 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
21814 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
21815 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
21816 still connected to the target.
21817
21818 @kindex disconnect
21819 @item disconnect
21820 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
21821 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
21822 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
21823 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
21824 another target.
21825
21826 @cindex send command to remote monitor
21827 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
21828 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
21829 @kindex monitor
21830 @item monitor @var{cmd}
21831 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
21832 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
21833 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
21834 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
21835 and implement.
21836 @end table
21837
21838 @node File Transfer
21839 @section Sending files to a remote system
21840 @cindex remote target, file transfer
21841 @cindex file transfer
21842 @cindex sending files to remote systems
21843
21844 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
21845 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
21846 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
21847 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
21848 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
21849 the only way to upload or download files.
21850
21851 Not all remote targets support these commands.
21852
21853 @table @code
21854 @kindex remote put
21855 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
21856 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
21857 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
21858
21859 @kindex remote get
21860 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
21861 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
21862 on the host system.
21863
21864 @kindex remote delete
21865 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
21866 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
21867
21868 @end table
21869
21870 @node Server
21871 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
21872
21873 @kindex gdbserver
21874 @cindex remote connection without stubs
21875 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
21876 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
21877 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
21878 linking in the usual debugging stub.
21879
21880 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
21881 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
21882 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
21883 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
21884 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
21885 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
21886 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
21887 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
21888 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
21889 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
21890 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
21891 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
21892 choice for debugging.
21893
21894 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
21895 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
21896 protocol.
21897
21898 @quotation
21899 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
21900 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
21901 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
21902 target system with the same privileges as the user running
21903 @code{gdbserver}.
21904 @end quotation
21905
21906 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
21907 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
21908 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
21909 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
21910
21911 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
21912 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
21913 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
21914 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
21915 system does all the symbol handling.
21916
21917 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
21918 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
21919 syntax is:
21920
21921 @smallexample
21922 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
21923 @end smallexample
21924
21925 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
21926 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
21927 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
21928 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
21929 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
21930 @file{/dev/com1}:
21931
21932 @smallexample
21933 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
21934 @end smallexample
21935
21936 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
21937 with it.
21938
21939 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
21940
21941 @smallexample
21942 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
21943 @end smallexample
21944
21945 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
21946 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
21947 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
21948 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
21949 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
21950 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
21951 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
21952 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
21953 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
21954 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
21955 @code{target remote} command.
21956
21957 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
21958 with ssh:
21959
21960 @smallexample
21961 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
21962 @end smallexample
21963
21964 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
21965 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
21966 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
21967 You could elide it if you want to.
21968
21969 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
21970 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
21971 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
21972 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
21973
21974 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
21975 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
21976 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
21977 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
21978
21979 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21980 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21981
21982 @smallexample
21983 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21984 @end smallexample
21985
21986 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21987 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21988
21989 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21990 @value{GDBN} attach command
21991 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21992
21993 @pindex pidof
21994 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21995 @code{pidof} utility:
21996
21997 @smallexample
21998 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21999 @end smallexample
22000
22001 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
22002 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
22003 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
22004
22005 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
22006
22007 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
22008 port.
22009
22010 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
22011 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
22012 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
22013 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
22014 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
22015 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
22016 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
22017 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
22018
22019 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
22020 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
22021 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
22022
22023 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
22024 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
22025 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
22026 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
22027 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
22028 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
22029 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
22030 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
22031 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
22032 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
22033 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
22034 instance closes its port after the first connection.
22035
22036 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
22037 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
22038
22039 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
22040 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
22041 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
22042 program. For more information,
22043 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
22044
22045 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
22046 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
22047 status information about the debugging process.
22048 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
22049 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
22050 remote protocol debug output.
22051 @cindex @option{--debug-file}, @code{gdbserver} option
22052 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, send all debug output to a single file
22053 The @option{--debug-file=@var{filename}} option tells @code{gdbserver} to
22054 write any debug output to the given @var{filename}. These options are intended
22055 for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
22056
22057 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
22058 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
22059 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
22060 Possible options are:
22061
22062 @table @code
22063 @item none
22064 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
22065 @item all
22066 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
22067 @item timestamps
22068 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
22069 @end table
22070
22071 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
22072 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
22073
22074 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
22075 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
22076 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
22077 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
22078 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
22079
22080 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
22081 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
22082 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
22083 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
22084
22085 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
22086 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
22087 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
22088 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
22089
22090 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
22091 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
22092 environment:
22093
22094 @smallexample
22095 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
22096 @end smallexample
22097
22098 @cindex @option{--selftest}
22099 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
22100
22101 @smallexample
22102 $ gdbserver --selftest
22103 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
22104 @end smallexample
22105
22106 These tests are disabled in release.
22107 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
22108
22109 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
22110 @itemize
22111
22112 @item
22113 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
22114
22115 @item
22116 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
22117 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
22118 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
22119 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
22120 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
22121 @code{--with-sysroot}).
22122
22123 @item
22124 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22125 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
22126 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
22127 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
22128 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
22129 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
22130 program is already on the target.
22131
22132 @end itemize
22133
22134 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
22135 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
22136 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
22137
22138 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
22139 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
22140 Here are the available commands.
22141
22142 @table @code
22143 @item monitor help
22144 List the available monitor commands.
22145
22146 @item monitor set debug 0
22147 @itemx monitor set debug 1
22148 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
22149
22150 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
22151 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
22152 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
22153 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
22154
22155 @item monitor set debug-file filename
22156 @itemx monitor set debug-file
22157 Send any debug output to the given file, or to stderr.
22158
22159 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
22160 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
22161 Possible options are:
22162
22163 @table @code
22164 @item none
22165 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
22166 @item all
22167 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
22168 @item timestamps
22169 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
22170 @end table
22171
22172 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
22173 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
22174
22175 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
22176 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
22177 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
22178 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
22179 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
22180 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
22181
22182 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
22183 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
22184
22185 @item monitor exit
22186 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
22187 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
22188 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
22189 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
22190 of a multi-process mode debug session.
22191
22192 @end table
22193
22194 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
22195 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
22196
22197 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
22198 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
22199
22200 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
22201 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
22202 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
22203 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
22204 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
22205 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
22206 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
22207 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
22208 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
22209 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
22210 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
22211 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
22212
22213 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
22214
22215 @table @code
22216 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
22217
22218 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
22219 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
22220 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
22221
22222 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
22223
22224 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
22225 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
22226 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
22227 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
22228 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
22229 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
22230
22231 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
22232
22233 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
22234 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
22235 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
22236 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
22237 command for that. For example:
22238
22239 @smallexample
22240 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
22241 @end smallexample
22242
22243 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
22244 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
22245 @end table
22246
22247 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
22248 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
22249 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
22250 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
22251 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
22252 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
22253 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
22254 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
22255 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
22256 @code{gdbserver} like so:
22257
22258 @smallexample
22259 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
22260 @end smallexample
22261
22262 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
22263
22264 @smallexample
22265 $ gdb myprogram
22266 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
22267 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
22268 (@value{GDBP}) b main
22269 (@value{GDBP}) continue
22270 @end smallexample
22271
22272 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
22273 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
22274 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
22275 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
22276 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
22277 tracing.
22278
22279 @node Remote Configuration
22280 @section Remote Configuration
22281
22282 @kindex set remote
22283 @kindex show remote
22284 This section documents the configuration options available when
22285 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
22286 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
22287 system-call-allowed}.
22288
22289 @table @code
22290 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
22291 @cindex address size for remote targets
22292 @cindex bits in remote address
22293 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
22294 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
22295 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
22296 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
22297
22298 @item show remoteaddresssize
22299 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
22300
22301 @item set serial baud @var{n}
22302 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
22303 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
22304 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
22305 remote targets.
22306
22307 @item show serial baud
22308 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
22309
22310 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
22311 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
22312 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
22313
22314 @item show serial parity
22315 Show the current parity of the serial port.
22316
22317 @item set remotebreak
22318 @cindex interrupt remote programs
22319 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
22320 @anchor{set remotebreak}
22321 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
22322 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
22323 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
22324 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
22325 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
22326
22327 @item show remotebreak
22328 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
22329 interrupt the remote program.
22330
22331 @item set remoteflow on
22332 @itemx set remoteflow off
22333 @kindex set remoteflow
22334 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
22335 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
22336
22337 @item show remoteflow
22338 @kindex show remoteflow
22339 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
22340
22341 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
22342 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
22343 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
22344 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
22345 @code{ascii}.
22346
22347 @item show remotelogbase
22348 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
22349 protocol.
22350
22351 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
22352 @cindex record serial communications on file
22353 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
22354 default is not to record at all.
22355
22356 @item show remotelogfile
22357 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
22358 serial communications.
22359
22360 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
22361 @cindex timeout for serial communications
22362 @cindex remote timeout
22363 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
22364 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
22365
22366 @item show remotetimeout
22367 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
22368 responses.
22369
22370 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
22371 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
22372 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
22373 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
22374 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
22375 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
22376 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
22377 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
22378 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
22379 watchpoints or breakpoints.
22380
22381 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
22382 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
22383 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
22384 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
22385
22386 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
22387 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
22388 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
22389 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
22390 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
22391 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
22392 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
22393 length.
22394
22395 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
22396 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
22397 a remote hardware watchpoint.
22398
22399 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
22400 @itemx show remote exec-file
22401 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
22402 @cindex executable file, for remote target
22403 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
22404 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
22405 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
22406 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
22407
22408 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
22409 @cindex interrupt remote programs
22410 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
22411 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
22412 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
22413 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
22414 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
22415 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
22416 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
22417 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
22418
22419 @item show interrupt-sequence
22420 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
22421 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
22422 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
22423 also known as Magic SysRq g.
22424
22425 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
22426 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
22427 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
22428 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
22429 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
22430 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
22431
22432 @item show interrupt-on-connect
22433 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
22434 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
22435
22436 @kindex set tcp
22437 @kindex show tcp
22438 @item set tcp auto-retry on
22439 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
22440 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
22441 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
22442 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
22443 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
22444 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
22445 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
22446 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
22447
22448 @item set tcp auto-retry off
22449 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
22450
22451 @item show tcp auto-retry
22452 Show the current auto-retry setting.
22453
22454 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
22455 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
22456 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
22457 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
22458 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
22459 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
22460 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
22461 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
22462 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
22463 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
22464 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
22465
22466 @item show tcp connect-timeout
22467 Show the current connection timeout setting.
22468 @end table
22469
22470 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
22471 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
22472 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
22473 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
22474 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
22475 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
22476 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
22477 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
22478 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
22479
22480 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
22481 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
22482 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
22483 @value{GDBN} developers.
22484
22485 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
22486 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
22487 are:
22488
22489 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
22490 @item Command Name
22491 @tab Remote Packet
22492 @tab Related Features
22493
22494 @item @code{fetch-register}
22495 @tab @code{p}
22496 @tab @code{info registers}
22497
22498 @item @code{set-register}
22499 @tab @code{P}
22500 @tab @code{set}
22501
22502 @item @code{binary-download}
22503 @tab @code{X}
22504 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
22505
22506 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
22507 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
22508 @tab @code{info auxv}
22509
22510 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
22511 @tab @code{qSymbol}
22512 @tab Detecting multiple threads
22513
22514 @item @code{attach}
22515 @tab @code{vAttach}
22516 @tab @code{attach}
22517
22518 @item @code{verbose-resume}
22519 @tab @code{vCont}
22520 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
22521
22522 @item @code{run}
22523 @tab @code{vRun}
22524 @tab @code{run}
22525
22526 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
22527 @tab @code{Z0}
22528 @tab @code{break}
22529
22530 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
22531 @tab @code{Z1}
22532 @tab @code{hbreak}
22533
22534 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
22535 @tab @code{Z2}
22536 @tab @code{watch}
22537
22538 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
22539 @tab @code{Z3}
22540 @tab @code{rwatch}
22541
22542 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
22543 @tab @code{Z4}
22544 @tab @code{awatch}
22545
22546 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
22547 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
22548 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
22549
22550 @item @code{target-features}
22551 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
22552 @tab @code{set architecture}
22553
22554 @item @code{library-info}
22555 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
22556 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
22557
22558 @item @code{memory-map}
22559 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
22560 @tab @code{info mem}
22561
22562 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
22563 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
22564 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
22565
22566 @item @code{read-spu-object}
22567 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
22568 @tab @code{info spu}
22569
22570 @item @code{write-spu-object}
22571 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
22572 @tab @code{info spu}
22573
22574 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
22575 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
22576 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
22577
22578 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
22579 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
22580 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
22581
22582 @item @code{threads}
22583 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
22584 @tab @code{info threads}
22585
22586 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
22587 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
22588 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
22589
22590 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
22591 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
22592 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
22593
22594 @item @code{search-memory}
22595 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
22596 @tab @code{find}
22597
22598 @item @code{supported-packets}
22599 @tab @code{qSupported}
22600 @tab Remote communications parameters
22601
22602 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
22603 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
22604 @tab @code{catch syscall}
22605
22606 @item @code{pass-signals}
22607 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
22608 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
22609
22610 @item @code{program-signals}
22611 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
22612 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
22613
22614 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
22615 @tab @code{vFile:close}
22616 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22617
22618 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
22619 @tab @code{vFile:open}
22620 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22621
22622 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
22623 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
22624 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22625
22626 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
22627 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
22628 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
22629
22630 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
22631 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
22632 @tab @code{remote delete}
22633
22634 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
22635 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
22636 @tab Host I/O
22637
22638 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
22639 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
22640 @tab Host I/O
22641
22642 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
22643 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
22644 @tab Host I/O
22645
22646 @item @code{noack-packet}
22647 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
22648 @tab Packet acknowledgment
22649
22650 @item @code{osdata}
22651 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
22652 @tab @code{info os}
22653
22654 @item @code{query-attached}
22655 @tab @code{qAttached}
22656 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
22657
22658 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
22659 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
22660 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
22661
22662 @item @code{trace-status}
22663 @tab @code{qTStatus}
22664 @tab @code{tstatus}
22665
22666 @item @code{traceframe-info}
22667 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
22668 @tab Traceframe info
22669
22670 @item @code{install-in-trace}
22671 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
22672 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
22673
22674 @item @code{disable-randomization}
22675 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
22676 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
22677
22678 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
22679 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
22680 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
22681
22682 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
22683 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
22684 @tab @code{set environment}
22685
22686 @item @code{environment-unset}
22687 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
22688 @tab @code{unset environment}
22689
22690 @item @code{environment-reset}
22691 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
22692 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
22693
22694 @item @code{set-working-dir}
22695 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
22696 @tab @code{set cwd}
22697
22698 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
22699 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
22700 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
22701
22702 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
22703 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
22704 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
22705
22706 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
22707 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
22708 @tab @code{break}
22709
22710 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
22711 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
22712 @tab @code{hbreak}
22713
22714 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
22715 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
22716 @tab @code{fork}
22717
22718 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
22719 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
22720 @tab @code{vfork}
22721
22722 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
22723 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
22724 @tab @code{exec}
22725
22726 @item @code{thread-events}
22727 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
22728 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
22729
22730 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
22731 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
22732 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
22733
22734 @end multitable
22735
22736 @node Remote Stub
22737 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
22738
22739 @cindex debugging stub, example
22740 @cindex remote stub, example
22741 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
22742 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
22743 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
22744 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
22745 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
22746 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
22747 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
22748 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
22749
22750 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
22751 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
22752 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
22753 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
22754 program, you need:
22755
22756 @enumerate
22757 @item
22758 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
22759 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
22760 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
22761
22762 @item
22763 A C subroutine library to support your program's
22764 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
22765
22766 @item
22767 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
22768 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
22769 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
22770 documentation.
22771 @end enumerate
22772
22773 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
22774 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
22775 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
22776
22777 @table @emph
22778 @item On the host,
22779 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
22780 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
22781 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
22782
22783 @item On the target,
22784 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
22785 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
22786 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
22787
22788 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
22789 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
22790 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
22791 @end table
22792
22793 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
22794 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
22795 @sc{sparc} boards.
22796
22797 @cindex remote serial stub list
22798 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
22799
22800 @table @code
22801
22802 @item i386-stub.c
22803 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
22804 @cindex Intel
22805 @cindex i386
22806 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
22807
22808 @item m68k-stub.c
22809 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
22810 @cindex Motorola 680x0
22811 @cindex m680x0
22812 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
22813
22814 @item sh-stub.c
22815 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
22816 @cindex Renesas
22817 @cindex SH
22818 For Renesas SH architectures.
22819
22820 @item sparc-stub.c
22821 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
22822 @cindex Sparc
22823 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
22824
22825 @item sparcl-stub.c
22826 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
22827 @cindex Fujitsu
22828 @cindex SparcLite
22829 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
22830
22831 @end table
22832
22833 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
22834 recently added stubs.
22835
22836 @menu
22837 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
22838 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
22839 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
22840 @end menu
22841
22842 @node Stub Contents
22843 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
22844
22845 @cindex remote serial stub
22846 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
22847 subroutines:
22848
22849 @table @code
22850 @item set_debug_traps
22851 @findex set_debug_traps
22852 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
22853 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
22854 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
22855 program's startup code.
22856
22857 @item handle_exception
22858 @findex handle_exception
22859 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
22860 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
22861 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
22862 run when a trap is triggered.
22863
22864 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
22865 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
22866 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
22867 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
22868 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
22869 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
22870 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
22871 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
22872 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
22873 machine.
22874
22875 @item breakpoint
22876 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
22877 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
22878 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
22879 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
22880 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
22881 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
22882 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
22883 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
22884 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
22885 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
22886 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
22887
22888 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
22889 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
22890 start of your debugging session.
22891 @end table
22892
22893 @node Bootstrapping
22894 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
22895
22896 @cindex remote stub, support routines
22897 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
22898 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
22899 debugging target machine.
22900
22901 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
22902 serial port.
22903
22904 @table @code
22905 @item int getDebugChar()
22906 @findex getDebugChar
22907 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
22908 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
22909 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22910
22911 @item void putDebugChar(int)
22912 @findex putDebugChar
22913 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
22914 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
22915 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
22916 @end table
22917
22918 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
22919 @cindex interrupting remote targets
22920 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
22921 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
22922 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
22923 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
22924 remote system to stop.
22925
22926 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
22927 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
22928 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
22929 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
22930
22931 Other routines you need to supply are:
22932
22933 @table @code
22934 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
22935 @findex exceptionHandler
22936 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
22937 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
22938 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
22939 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
22940 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
22941 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
22942 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
22943 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
22944 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
22945 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
22946 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
22947 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
22948 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
22949
22950 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
22951 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
22952 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
22953 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
22954 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
22955
22956 @item void flush_i_cache()
22957 @findex flush_i_cache
22958 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
22959 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
22960 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
22961
22962 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
22963 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
22964 @end table
22965
22966 @noindent
22967 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
22968
22969 @table @code
22970 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
22971 @findex memset
22972 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
22973 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
22974 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
22975 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
22976 @end table
22977
22978 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
22979 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
22980 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
22981 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
22982
22983
22984 @node Debug Session
22985 @subsection Putting it All Together
22986
22987 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22988 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22989 steps.
22990
22991 @enumerate
22992 @item
22993 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22994 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22995 @display
22996 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22997 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22998 @end display
22999
23000 @item
23001 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
23002 procedure is called:
23003
23004 @smallexample
23005 set_debug_traps();
23006 breakpoint();
23007 @end smallexample
23008
23009 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
23010 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
23011 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
23012 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
23013 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
23014 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
23015 progress.
23016
23017 @item
23018 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
23019 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
23020
23021 @smallexample
23022 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
23023 @end smallexample
23024
23025 @noindent
23026 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
23027 function in your program, that function is called when
23028 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
23029 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
23030 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
23031
23032 @item
23033 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
23034 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
23035
23036 @item
23037 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
23038 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
23039
23040 @item
23041 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
23042 @c document that. FIXME.
23043 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
23044 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
23045
23046 @item
23047 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
23048 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
23049
23050 @end enumerate
23051
23052 @node Configurations
23053 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
23054
23055 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
23056 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
23057 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
23058
23059 There are three major categories of configurations: native
23060 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
23061 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
23062 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
23063 are quite different from each other.
23064
23065 @menu
23066 * Native::
23067 * Embedded OS::
23068 * Embedded Processors::
23069 * Architectures::
23070 @end menu
23071
23072 @node Native
23073 @section Native
23074
23075 This section describes details specific to particular native
23076 configurations.
23077
23078 @menu
23079 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
23080 * Process Information:: Process information
23081 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
23082 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
23083 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
23084 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
23085 * FreeBSD:: Features specific to FreeBSD
23086 @end menu
23087
23088 @node BSD libkvm Interface
23089 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
23090
23091 @cindex libkvm
23092 @cindex kernel memory image
23093 @cindex kernel crash dump
23094
23095 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
23096 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
23097 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
23098 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
23099 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
23100 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
23101 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
23102 @code{kvm} target:
23103
23104 @smallexample
23105 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
23106 @end smallexample
23107
23108 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
23109 argument:
23110
23111 @smallexample
23112 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
23113 @end smallexample
23114
23115 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
23116 available:
23117
23118 @table @code
23119 @kindex kvm
23120 @item kvm pcb
23121 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
23122
23123 @item kvm proc
23124 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
23125 modern FreeBSD systems.
23126 @end table
23127
23128 @node Process Information
23129 @subsection Process Information
23130 @cindex /proc
23131 @cindex examine process image
23132 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
23133
23134 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
23135 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
23136 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
23137 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
23138 to report information about the process running your program, or about
23139 any process running on your system.
23140
23141 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
23142 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
23143 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
23144 systems.
23145
23146 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
23147 information.
23148
23149 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
23150 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
23151 information available from a live process. Process information is
23152 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
23153 systems.
23154
23155 @table @code
23156 @kindex info proc
23157 @cindex process ID
23158 @item info proc
23159 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
23160 Summarize available information about a process. If a
23161 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
23162 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
23163 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
23164 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
23165 executable file's absolute file name.
23166
23167 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
23168 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
23169 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
23170 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
23171 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
23172 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
23173
23174 @item info proc cmdline
23175 @cindex info proc cmdline
23176 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
23177 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
23178
23179 @item info proc cwd
23180 @cindex info proc cwd
23181 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
23182 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
23183
23184 @item info proc exe
23185 @cindex info proc exe
23186 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
23187 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
23188
23189 @item info proc files
23190 @cindex info proc files
23191 Show the file descriptors open by the process. For each open file
23192 descriptor, @value{GDBN} shows its number, type (file, directory,
23193 character device, socket), file pointer offset, and the name of the
23194 resource open on the descriptor. The resource name can be a file name
23195 (for files, directories, and devices) or a protocol followed by socket
23196 address (for network connections). This command is supported on
23197 FreeBSD.
23198
23199 This example shows the open file descriptors for a process using a
23200 tty for standard input and output as well as two network sockets:
23201
23202 @smallexample
23203 (gdb) info proc files 22136
23204 process 22136
23205 Open files:
23206
23207 FD Type Offset Flags Name
23208 text file - r-------- /usr/bin/ssh
23209 ctty chr - rw------- /dev/pts/20
23210 cwd dir - r-------- /usr/home/john
23211 root dir - r-------- /
23212 0 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
23213 1 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
23214 2 chr 0x32933a4 rw------- /dev/pts/20
23215 3 socket 0x0 rw----n-- tcp4 10.0.1.2:53014 -> 10.0.1.10:22
23216 4 socket 0x0 rw------- unix stream:/tmp/ssh-FIt89oAzOn5f/agent.2456
23217 @end smallexample
23218
23219 @item info proc mappings
23220 @cindex memory address space mappings
23221 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in a process. On
23222 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
23223 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
23224 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
23225 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
23226
23227 @item info proc stat
23228 @itemx info proc status
23229 @cindex process detailed status information
23230 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
23231 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
23232 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
23233 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
23234 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
23235
23236 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
23237 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
23238
23239 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
23240 proc status}.
23241
23242 @item info proc all
23243 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
23244 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
23245
23246 @ignore
23247 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
23248 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
23249 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
23250 @kindex info proc times
23251 @item info proc times
23252 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
23253 its children.
23254
23255 @kindex info proc id
23256 @item info proc id
23257 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
23258 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
23259 @end ignore
23260
23261 @item set procfs-trace
23262 @kindex set procfs-trace
23263 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
23264 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
23265
23266 @item show procfs-trace
23267 @kindex show procfs-trace
23268 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
23269
23270 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
23271 @kindex set procfs-file
23272 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
23273 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
23274 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
23275 standard output.
23276
23277 @item show procfs-file
23278 @kindex show procfs-file
23279 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
23280
23281 @item proc-trace-entry
23282 @itemx proc-trace-exit
23283 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
23284 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
23285 @kindex proc-trace-entry
23286 @kindex proc-trace-exit
23287 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
23288 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
23289 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
23290 from the @code{syscall} interface.
23291
23292 @item info pidlist
23293 @kindex info pidlist
23294 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
23295 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
23296 processes and all the threads within each process.
23297
23298 @item info meminfo
23299 @kindex info meminfo
23300 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
23301 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
23302 @end table
23303
23304 @node DJGPP Native
23305 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
23306 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
23307 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
23308 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
23309
23310 @cindex DPMI
23311 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
23312 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
23313 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
23314 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
23315
23316 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
23317 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
23318 subsection describes those commands.
23319
23320 @table @code
23321 @kindex info dos
23322 @item info dos
23323 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
23324 information about the target system and important OS structures.
23325
23326 @kindex sysinfo
23327 @cindex MS-DOS system info
23328 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
23329 @item info dos sysinfo
23330 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
23331 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
23332 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
23333
23334 @cindex GDT
23335 @cindex LDT
23336 @cindex IDT
23337 @cindex segment descriptor tables
23338 @cindex descriptor tables display
23339 @item info dos gdt
23340 @itemx info dos ldt
23341 @itemx info dos idt
23342 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
23343 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
23344 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
23345 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
23346 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
23347 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
23348 rights.
23349
23350 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
23351 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
23352 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
23353 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
23354 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
23355
23356 @cindex garbled pointers
23357 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
23358 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
23359 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
23360 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
23361 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
23362 debugged program's data segment:
23363
23364 @smallexample
23365 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
23366 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
23367 @end smallexample
23368
23369 @noindent
23370 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
23371 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
23372
23373 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
23374 @item info dos pde
23375 @itemx info dos pte
23376 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
23377 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
23378 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
23379 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
23380 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
23381 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
23382 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
23383 that is currently in use.
23384
23385 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
23386 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
23387 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
23388 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
23389 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
23390 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
23391 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
23392
23393 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
23394 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
23395 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
23396 controller.
23397
23398 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
23399
23400 @cindex physical address from linear address
23401 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
23402 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
23403 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
23404 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
23405 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
23406 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
23407 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
23408
23409 @smallexample
23410 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
23411 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
23412 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
23413 @end smallexample
23414
23415 @noindent
23416 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
23417 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
23418 attributes of that page.
23419
23420 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
23421 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
23422 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
23423 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
23424 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
23425 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
23426
23427 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
23428 transfer buffer:
23429
23430 @smallexample
23431 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
23432 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
23433 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
23434 @end smallexample
23435
23436 @noindent
23437 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
23438 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
23439 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
23440 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
23441 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
23442
23443 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
23444 @end table
23445
23446 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
23447 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
23448 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
23449 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
23450
23451 @table @code
23452 @kindex set com1base
23453 @kindex set com1irq
23454 @kindex set com2base
23455 @kindex set com2irq
23456 @kindex set com3base
23457 @kindex set com3irq
23458 @kindex set com4base
23459 @kindex set com4irq
23460 @item set com1base @var{addr}
23461 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
23462 port.
23463
23464 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
23465 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
23466 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
23467
23468 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
23469 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
23470 other 3 COM ports.
23471
23472 @kindex show com1base
23473 @kindex show com1irq
23474 @kindex show com2base
23475 @kindex show com2irq
23476 @kindex show com3base
23477 @kindex show com3irq
23478 @kindex show com4base
23479 @kindex show com4irq
23480 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
23481 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
23482 lines used by the COM ports.
23483
23484 @item info serial
23485 @kindex info serial
23486 @cindex DOS serial port status
23487 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
23488 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
23489 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
23490 counts of various errors encountered so far.
23491 @end table
23492
23493
23494 @node Cygwin Native
23495 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
23496 @cindex MS Windows debugging
23497 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
23498 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
23499
23500 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
23501 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
23502
23503 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
23504 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
23505 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
23506 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
23507 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
23508 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
23509 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
23510 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
23511
23512 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
23513 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
23514 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
23515
23516 @table @code
23517 @kindex info w32
23518 @item info w32
23519 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
23520 information about the target system and important OS structures.
23521
23522 @item info w32 selector
23523 This command displays information returned by
23524 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
23525 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
23526 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
23527 Without argument, this command displays information
23528 about the six segment registers.
23529
23530 @item info w32 thread-information-block
23531 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
23532 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
23533 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
23534
23535 @kindex signal-event
23536 @item signal-event @var{id}
23537 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
23538 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
23539
23540 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
23541 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
23542 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
23543 (for x86_64 versions):
23544
23545 @itemize @minus
23546 @item
23547 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
23548 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
23549 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
23550
23551 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
23552 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
23553 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
23554 to attach.
23555
23556 @item
23557 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
23558 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
23559 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
23560 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
23561 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
23562 @end itemize
23563
23564 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
23565 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
23566 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
23567 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
23568 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
23569 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
23570 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
23571 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
23572 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
23573 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
23574 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
23575
23576 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
23577 @item show cygwin-exceptions
23578 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
23579 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
23580
23581 @kindex set new-console
23582 @item set new-console @var{mode}
23583 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
23584 be started in a new console on next start.
23585 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
23586 be started in the same console as the debugger.
23587
23588 @kindex show new-console
23589 @item show new-console
23590 Displays whether a new console is used
23591 when the debuggee is started.
23592
23593 @kindex set new-group
23594 @item set new-group @var{mode}
23595 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
23596 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
23597 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
23598 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
23599
23600 @kindex show new-group
23601 @item show new-group
23602 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
23603
23604 @kindex set debugevents
23605 @item set debugevents
23606 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
23607 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
23608 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
23609 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
23610 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
23611
23612 @kindex set debugexec
23613 @item set debugexec
23614 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
23615 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
23616
23617 @kindex set debugexceptions
23618 @item set debugexceptions
23619 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
23620 debuggee seen by the debugger.
23621
23622 @kindex set debugmemory
23623 @item set debugmemory
23624 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
23625 and writes by the debugger.
23626
23627 @kindex set shell
23628 @item set shell
23629 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
23630 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
23631
23632 @kindex show shell
23633 @item show shell
23634 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
23635
23636 @end table
23637
23638 @menu
23639 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
23640 @end menu
23641
23642 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
23643 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
23644 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
23645 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
23646
23647 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
23648 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
23649 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
23650 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
23651 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
23652 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
23653 ``minimal symbols''.
23654
23655 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
23656 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
23657 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
23658 program run once to completion.
23659
23660 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
23661
23662 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
23663 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
23664 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
23665 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
23666 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
23667 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
23668 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
23669 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
23670 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
23671
23672 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
23673 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
23674 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
23675 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
23676 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
23677 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
23678
23679 @smallexample
23680 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
23681 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
23682
23683 Non-debugging symbols:
23684 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
23685 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
23686 @end smallexample
23687
23688 @smallexample
23689 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
23690 All functions matching regular expression "!":
23691
23692 Non-debugging symbols:
23693 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
23694 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
23695 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
23696 [etc...]
23697 @end smallexample
23698
23699 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
23700
23701 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
23702 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
23703 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
23704 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
23705 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
23706 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
23707 a function within a DLL without a running program.
23708
23709 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
23710 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
23711 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
23712 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
23713 problem:
23714
23715 @smallexample
23716 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
23717 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
23718 @end smallexample
23719
23720 @smallexample
23721 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
23722 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
23723 @end smallexample
23724
23725 And two possible solutions:
23726
23727 @smallexample
23728 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
23729 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23730 @end smallexample
23731
23732 @smallexample
23733 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
23734 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
23735 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
23736 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
23737 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
23738 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
23739 @end smallexample
23740
23741 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
23742 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
23743 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
23744 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
23745 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
23746
23747 @smallexample
23748 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
23749 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
23750 @end smallexample
23751
23752 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
23753 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
23754 safe.
23755
23756 @node Hurd Native
23757 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
23758 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
23759
23760 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
23761 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
23762
23763 @table @code
23764 @item set signals
23765 @itemx set sigs
23766 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
23767 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23768 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
23769 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
23770 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
23771 @code{signals}.
23772
23773 @item show signals
23774 @itemx show sigs
23775 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
23776 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
23777 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
23778
23779 @item set signal-thread
23780 @itemx set sigthread
23781 @kindex set signal-thread
23782 @kindex set sigthread
23783 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
23784 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
23785 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
23786 signal-thread}.
23787
23788 @item show signal-thread
23789 @itemx show sigthread
23790 @kindex show signal-thread
23791 @kindex show sigthread
23792 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
23793 delivered a signal.
23794
23795 @item set stopped
23796 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23797 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
23798 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
23799 continued by delivering a signal to it.
23800
23801 @item show stopped
23802 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
23803 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
23804 stopped.
23805
23806 @item set exceptions
23807 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23808 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
23809 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
23810 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
23811 trapping on.
23812
23813 @item show exceptions
23814 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
23815 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
23816
23817 @item set task pause
23818 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
23819 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23820 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23821 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
23822 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
23823 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
23824 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
23825 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
23826 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
23827
23828 @item show task pause
23829 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
23830 Show the current state of task suspension.
23831
23832 @item set task detach-suspend-count
23833 @cindex task suspend count
23834 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23835 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
23836 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
23837
23838 @item show task detach-suspend-count
23839 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
23840
23841 @item set task exception-port
23842 @itemx set task excp
23843 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23844 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
23845 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
23846 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
23847
23848 @item set noninvasive
23849 @cindex noninvasive task options
23850 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
23851 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
23852 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
23853 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
23854
23855 @item info send-rights
23856 @itemx info receive-rights
23857 @itemx info port-rights
23858 @itemx info port-sets
23859 @itemx info dead-names
23860 @itemx info ports
23861 @itemx info psets
23862 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23863 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23864 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23865 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23866 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23867 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
23868 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
23869 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
23870 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
23871
23872 @item set thread pause
23873 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
23874 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23875 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
23876 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
23877 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
23878 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
23879 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
23880 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
23881 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
23882 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
23883 only the current thread.
23884
23885 @item show thread pause
23886 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
23887 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
23888
23889 @item set thread run
23890 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23891
23892 @item show thread run
23893 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
23894
23895 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
23896 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23897 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23898 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
23899 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
23900 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
23901 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
23902
23903 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
23904 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
23905 detaching.
23906
23907 @item set thread exception-port
23908 @itemx set thread excp
23909 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
23910 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
23911 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
23912
23913 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
23914 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
23915 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
23916 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
23917
23918 @item set thread default
23919 @itemx show thread default
23920 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
23921 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
23922 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
23923 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
23924 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
23925 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
23926 the non-default commands.
23927 @end table
23928
23929 @node Darwin
23930 @subsection Darwin
23931 @cindex Darwin
23932
23933 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
23934
23935 @table @code
23936 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
23937 @kindex set debug darwin
23938 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
23939 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
23940
23941 @item show debug darwin
23942 @kindex show debug darwin
23943 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
23944
23945 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
23946 @kindex set debug mach-o
23947 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
23948 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
23949 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
23950 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
23951 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
23952 usage.
23953
23954 @item show debug mach-o
23955 @kindex show debug mach-o
23956 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
23957
23958 @item set mach-exceptions on
23959 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
23960 @kindex set mach-exceptions
23961 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
23962 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
23963 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
23964 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
23965
23966 @item show mach-exceptions
23967 @kindex show mach-exceptions
23968 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
23969 @end table
23970
23971 @node FreeBSD
23972 @subsection FreeBSD
23973 @cindex FreeBSD
23974
23975 When the ABI of a system call is changed in the FreeBSD kernel, this
23976 is implemented by leaving a compatibility system call using the old
23977 ABI at the existing number and allocating a new system call number for
23978 the version using the new ABI. As a convenience, when a system call
23979 is caught by name (@pxref{catch syscall}), compatibility system calls
23980 are also caught.
23981
23982 For example, FreeBSD 12 introduced a new variant of the @code{kevent}
23983 system call and catching the @code{kevent} system call by name catches
23984 both variants:
23985
23986 @smallexample
23987 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall kevent
23988 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'freebsd11_kevent' [363] 'kevent' [560])
23989 (@value{GDBP})
23990 @end smallexample
23991
23992
23993 @node Embedded OS
23994 @section Embedded Operating Systems
23995
23996 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
23997 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
23998 architectures.
23999
24000 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
24001 various real-time operating systems.
24002
24003 @node Embedded Processors
24004 @section Embedded Processors
24005
24006 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
24007 configurations.
24008
24009 @cindex send command to simulator
24010 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
24011 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
24012
24013 @table @code
24014 @item sim @var{command}
24015 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
24016 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
24017 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
24018 acceptable commands.
24019 @end table
24020
24021
24022 @menu
24023 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
24024 * ARM:: ARM
24025 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
24026 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
24027 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
24028 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
24029 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
24030 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
24031 * CRIS:: CRIS
24032 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
24033 @end menu
24034
24035 @node ARC
24036 @subsection Synopsys ARC
24037 @cindex Synopsys ARC
24038 @cindex ARC specific commands
24039 @cindex ARC600
24040 @cindex ARC700
24041 @cindex ARC EM
24042 @cindex ARC HS
24043
24044 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
24045
24046 @table @code
24047 @item set debug arc
24048 @kindex set debug arc
24049 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
24050 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
24051
24052 @item show debug arc
24053 @kindex show debug arc
24054 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
24055
24056 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
24057 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
24058 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
24059
24060 @end table
24061
24062 @node ARM
24063 @subsection ARM
24064
24065 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
24066
24067 @table @code
24068 @item set arm disassembler
24069 @kindex set arm
24070 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
24071 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
24072
24073 @item show arm disassembler
24074 @kindex show arm
24075 Show the current disassembly style.
24076
24077 @item set arm apcs32
24078 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
24079 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
24080
24081 @item show arm apcs32
24082 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
24083
24084 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
24085 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
24086 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
24087
24088 @table @code
24089 @item auto
24090 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
24091 @item softfpa
24092 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
24093 processors.
24094 @item fpa
24095 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
24096 @item softvfp
24097 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
24098 @item vfp
24099 VFP co-processor.
24100 @end table
24101
24102 @item show arm fpu
24103 Show the current type of the FPU.
24104
24105 @item set arm abi
24106 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
24107
24108 @item show arm abi
24109 Show the currently used ABI.
24110
24111 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
24112 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
24113 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
24114 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
24115 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
24116 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
24117 register).
24118
24119 @item show arm fallback-mode
24120 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
24121
24122 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
24123 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
24124 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
24125 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
24126 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
24127
24128 @item show arm force-mode
24129 Show the current forced instruction mode.
24130
24131 @item set debug arm
24132 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
24133 target support subsystem.
24134
24135 @item show debug arm
24136 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
24137 @end table
24138
24139 @table @code
24140 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
24141 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
24142
24143 @table @code
24144 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
24145 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
24146 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
24147 The default value is @code{all}.
24148
24149 @table @code
24150 @item none
24151 @item demon
24152 @item angel
24153 @item redboot
24154 @item all
24155 @end table
24156 @end table
24157 @end table
24158
24159 @node M68K
24160 @subsection M68k
24161
24162 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
24163
24164 @node MicroBlaze
24165 @subsection MicroBlaze
24166 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
24167 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
24168
24169 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
24170 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
24171 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
24172 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
24173 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
24174 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
24175 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
24176 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
24177 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
24178 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
24179 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
24180
24181 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
24182
24183 @table @code
24184 @item target remote :1234
24185 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
24186 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
24187
24188 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
24189 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
24190 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
24191
24192 @item load
24193 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
24194
24195 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
24196 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
24197
24198 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
24199 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
24200 @end table
24201
24202 @node MIPS Embedded
24203 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
24204
24205 @noindent
24206 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
24207
24208 @table @code
24209 @item set mipsfpu double
24210 @itemx set mipsfpu single
24211 @itemx set mipsfpu none
24212 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
24213 @itemx show mipsfpu
24214 @kindex set mipsfpu
24215 @kindex show mipsfpu
24216 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
24217 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
24218 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
24219 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
24220 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
24221 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
24222 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
24223 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
24224 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
24225 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
24226 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
24227 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
24228 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
24229
24230 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
24231 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
24232 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
24233
24234 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
24235 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
24236 @end table
24237
24238 @node OpenRISC 1000
24239 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
24240 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
24241
24242 @noindent
24243 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
24244 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
24245 FPGA's.
24246
24247 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
24248 a target:
24249
24250 @table @code
24251
24252 @kindex target sim
24253 @item target sim
24254
24255 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
24256 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
24257 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
24258 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
24259
24260 Example: @code{target sim}
24261
24262 @item set debug or1k
24263 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
24264 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
24265
24266 @item show debug or1k
24267 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
24268 @end table
24269
24270 @node PowerPC Embedded
24271 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
24272
24273 @cindex DVC register
24274 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
24275 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
24276
24277 @smallexample
24278 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
24279 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
24280 @end smallexample
24281
24282 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
24283 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
24284 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
24285 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
24286 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
24287 or newer.
24288
24289 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
24290 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
24291 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
24292 watching variables of scalar types.
24293
24294 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
24295 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
24296
24297 @smallexample
24298 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
24299 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
24300 @end smallexample
24301
24302 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
24303 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
24304
24305 @cindex ranged breakpoint
24306 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
24307 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
24308 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
24309 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
24310 use the @code{break-range} command.
24311
24312 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
24313
24314 @table @code
24315 @kindex break-range
24316 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
24317 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
24318 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
24319 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
24320 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
24321 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
24322 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
24323 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
24324 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
24325
24326 @kindex set powerpc
24327 @item set powerpc soft-float
24328 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
24329 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
24330 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
24331 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
24332
24333 @item set powerpc vector-abi
24334 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
24335 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
24336 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
24337 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
24338 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
24339 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
24340 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
24341
24342 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
24343 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
24344 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
24345 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
24346 address of its first byte.
24347
24348 @end table
24349
24350 @node AVR
24351 @subsection Atmel AVR
24352 @cindex AVR
24353
24354 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
24355 following AVR-specific commands:
24356
24357 @table @code
24358 @item info io_registers
24359 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
24360 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
24361 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
24362 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
24363 @end table
24364
24365 @node CRIS
24366 @subsection CRIS
24367 @cindex CRIS
24368
24369 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
24370 following CRIS-specific commands:
24371
24372 @table @code
24373 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
24374 @cindex CRIS version
24375 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
24376 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
24377 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
24378
24379 @item show cris-version
24380 Show the current CRIS version.
24381
24382 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
24383 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
24384 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
24385 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
24386 @code{R59}.
24387
24388 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
24389 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
24390
24391 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
24392 @cindex CRIS mode
24393 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
24394 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
24395 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
24396
24397 @item show cris-mode
24398 Show the current CRIS mode.
24399 @end table
24400
24401 @node Super-H
24402 @subsection Renesas Super-H
24403 @cindex Super-H
24404
24405 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
24406 commands:
24407
24408 @table @code
24409 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
24410 @kindex set sh calling-convention
24411 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
24412 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
24413 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
24414 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
24415 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
24416 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
24417 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
24418 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
24419 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
24420 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
24421
24422 @item show sh calling-convention
24423 @kindex show sh calling-convention
24424 Show the current calling convention setting.
24425
24426 @end table
24427
24428
24429 @node Architectures
24430 @section Architectures
24431
24432 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
24433 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
24434
24435 @menu
24436 * AArch64::
24437 * i386::
24438 * Alpha::
24439 * MIPS::
24440 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
24441 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
24442 * PowerPC::
24443 * Nios II::
24444 * Sparc64::
24445 * S12Z::
24446 @end menu
24447
24448 @node AArch64
24449 @subsection AArch64
24450 @cindex AArch64 support
24451
24452 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
24453 following special commands:
24454
24455 @table @code
24456 @item set debug aarch64
24457 @kindex set debug aarch64
24458 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
24459 messages are to be displayed.
24460
24461 @item show debug aarch64
24462 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
24463
24464 @end table
24465
24466 @subsubsection AArch64 SVE.
24467 @cindex AArch64 SVE.
24468
24469 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, if the Scalable Vector
24470 Extension (SVE) is present, then @value{GDBN} will provide the vector registers
24471 @code{$z0} through @code{$z31}, vector predicate registers @code{$p0} through
24472 @code{$p15}, and the @code{$ffr} register. In addition, the pseudo register
24473 @code{$vg} will be provided. This is the vector granule for the current thread
24474 and represents the number of 64-bit chunks in an SVE @code{z} register.
24475
24476 If the vector length changes, then the @code{$vg} register will be updated,
24477 but the lengths of the @code{z} and @code{p} registers will not change. This
24478 is a known limitation of @value{GDBN} and does not affect the execution of the
24479 target process.
24480
24481 @subsubsection AArch64 Pointer Authentication.
24482 @cindex AArch64 Pointer Authentication.
24483
24484 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, and the program is
24485 using the v8.3-A feature Pointer Authentication (PAC), then whenever the link
24486 register @code{$lr} is pointing to an PAC function its value will be masked.
24487 When GDB prints a backtrace, any addresses that required unmasking will be
24488 postfixed with the marker [PAC]. When using the MI, this is printed as part
24489 of the @code{addr_flags} field.
24490
24491 @node i386
24492 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
24493
24494 @table @code
24495 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
24496 @kindex set struct-convention
24497 @cindex struct return convention
24498 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
24499 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
24500 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
24501 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
24502 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
24503 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
24504 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
24505 be returned in a register.
24506
24507 @item show struct-convention
24508 @kindex show struct-convention
24509 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
24510 from functions.
24511 @end table
24512
24513
24514 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
24515 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
24516
24517 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
24518 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
24519 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
24520 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
24521 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
24522 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
24523 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
24524
24525 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
24526 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
24527 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
24528 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
24529 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
24530 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
24531
24532 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
24533 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
24534 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
24535
24536 @smallexample
24537 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
24538 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
24539 @end smallexample
24540
24541 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
24542 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
24543 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
24544 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
24545 the pointer.
24546
24547 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
24548 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
24549 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
24550 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
24551 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
24552
24553 @table @code
24554 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
24555 @kindex show mpx bound
24556 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
24557
24558 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
24559 @kindex set mpx bound
24560 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
24561 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
24562 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
24563 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
24564 @end table
24565
24566 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
24567 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
24568 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
24569 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
24570
24571 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
24572 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
24573 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
24574 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
24575 function.
24576
24577 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
24578 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
24579 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
24580 continuing the execution. For example:
24581
24582 @smallexample
24583 $ break *upper
24584 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
24585 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
24586 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
24587 $ print $bnd0
24588 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
24589 @end smallexample
24590
24591 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
24592 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
24593 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
24594
24595 @node Alpha
24596 @subsection Alpha
24597
24598 See the following section.
24599
24600 @node MIPS
24601 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
24602
24603 @cindex stack on Alpha
24604 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
24605 @cindex Alpha stack
24606 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
24607 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
24608 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
24609 find the beginning of a function.
24610
24611 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
24612 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
24613 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
24614 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
24615 commands:
24616
24617 @table @code
24618 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
24619 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
24620 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
24621 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
24622 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
24623 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
24624 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
24625 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
24626
24627 @item show heuristic-fence-post
24628 Display the current limit.
24629 @end table
24630
24631 @noindent
24632 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
24633 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
24634
24635 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
24636 programs:
24637
24638 @table @code
24639 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
24640 @kindex set mips abi
24641 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
24642 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
24643 values of @var{arg} are:
24644
24645 @table @samp
24646 @item auto
24647 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
24648 default).
24649 @item o32
24650 @item o64
24651 @item n32
24652 @item n64
24653 @item eabi32
24654 @item eabi64
24655 @end table
24656
24657 @item show mips abi
24658 @kindex show mips abi
24659 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
24660
24661 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
24662 @kindex set mips compression
24663 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
24664 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
24665 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
24666 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
24667 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
24668 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
24669 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
24670 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
24671 provided by the executable.
24672
24673 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
24674 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
24675 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
24676 identified as such.
24677
24678 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
24679 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
24680 implicitly from an executable.
24681
24682 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
24683 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
24684 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
24685 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
24686 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
24687
24688 @item show mips compression
24689 @kindex show mips compression
24690 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
24691 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
24692
24693 @item set mipsfpu
24694 @itemx show mipsfpu
24695 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
24696
24697 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
24698 @kindex set mips mask-address
24699 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
24700 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
24701 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
24702 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
24703 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
24704
24705 @item show mips mask-address
24706 @kindex show mips mask-address
24707 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
24708 not.
24709
24710 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24711 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24712 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
24713 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
24714 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
24715 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
24716
24717 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24718 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
24719 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
24720
24721 @item set debug mips
24722 @kindex set debug mips
24723 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
24724 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24725
24726 @item show debug mips
24727 @kindex show debug mips
24728 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
24729 @end table
24730
24731
24732 @node HPPA
24733 @subsection HPPA
24734 @cindex HPPA support
24735
24736 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
24737 following special commands:
24738
24739 @table @code
24740 @item set debug hppa
24741 @kindex set debug hppa
24742 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
24743 messages are to be displayed.
24744
24745 @item show debug hppa
24746 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
24747
24748 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
24749 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
24750 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
24751 given @var{address}.
24752
24753 @end table
24754
24755
24756 @node SPU
24757 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
24758 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
24759 @cindex SPU
24760
24761 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
24762 it provides the following special commands:
24763
24764 @table @code
24765 @item info spu event
24766 @kindex info spu
24767 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
24768 and pending event status.
24769
24770 @item info spu signal
24771 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
24772 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
24773 notification channels.
24774
24775 @item info spu mailbox
24776 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
24777 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
24778 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
24779
24780 @item info spu dma
24781 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24782 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24783 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24784
24785 @item info spu proxydma
24786 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
24787 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
24788 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
24789
24790 @end table
24791
24792 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
24793 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
24794 special commands:
24795
24796 @table @code
24797 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
24798 @kindex set spu
24799 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
24800 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
24801 function. The default is @code{off}.
24802
24803 @item show spu stop-on-load
24804 @kindex show spu
24805 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
24806
24807 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
24808 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
24809 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
24810 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
24811 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
24812 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
24813
24814 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
24815 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
24816
24817 @end table
24818
24819 @node PowerPC
24820 @subsection PowerPC
24821 @cindex PowerPC architecture
24822
24823 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
24824 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
24825 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
24826 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
24827 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
24828
24829 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
24830 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
24831 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
24832
24833 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
24834 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
24835
24836 @node Nios II
24837 @subsection Nios II
24838 @cindex Nios II architecture
24839
24840 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
24841 it provides the following special commands:
24842
24843 @table @code
24844
24845 @item set debug nios2
24846 @kindex set debug nios2
24847 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
24848 target code in @value{GDBN}.
24849
24850 @item show debug nios2
24851 @kindex show debug nios2
24852 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
24853 @end table
24854
24855 @node Sparc64
24856 @subsection Sparc64
24857 @cindex Sparc64 support
24858 @cindex Application Data Integrity
24859 @subsubsection ADI Support
24860
24861 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
24862 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
24863 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
24864 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
24865 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
24866 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
24867 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
24868 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
24869 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
24870 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
24871 signal.
24872
24873 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
24874 ADI-enabled.
24875
24876 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
24877 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
24878
24879
24880 @table @code
24881 @kindex adi examine
24882 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
24883
24884 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
24885 cacheline.
24886
24887 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
24888 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
24889 block size, to display.
24890
24891 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24892 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
24893
24894 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
24895
24896 @smallexample
24897 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24898 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
24899 @end smallexample
24900
24901 @kindex adi assign
24902 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
24903
24904 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
24905 to an address.
24906
24907 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
24908 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
24909 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
24910
24911 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
24912 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
24913
24914 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
24915
24916 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
24917 variable "shmaddr":
24918
24919 @smallexample
24920 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
24921 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
24922 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
24923 @end smallexample
24924
24925 @end table
24926
24927 @node S12Z
24928 @subsection S12Z
24929 @cindex S12Z support
24930
24931 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the S12Z architecture,
24932 it provides the following special command:
24933
24934 @table @code
24935 @item maint info bdccsr
24936 @kindex maint info bdccsr@r{, S12Z}
24937 This command displays the current value of the microprocessor's
24938 BDCCSR register.
24939 @end table
24940
24941
24942 @node Controlling GDB
24943 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
24944
24945 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
24946 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
24947 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
24948 described here.
24949
24950 @menu
24951 * Prompt:: Prompt
24952 * Editing:: Command editing
24953 * Command History:: Command history
24954 * Screen Size:: Screen size
24955 * Output Styling:: Output styling
24956 * Numbers:: Numbers
24957 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
24958 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
24959 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
24960 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
24961 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
24962 @end menu
24963
24964 @node Prompt
24965 @section Prompt
24966
24967 @cindex prompt
24968
24969 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
24970 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
24971 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
24972 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
24973 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
24974 which one you are talking to.
24975
24976 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
24977 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
24978 or a prompt that does not.
24979
24980 @table @code
24981 @kindex set prompt
24982 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
24983 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
24984
24985 @kindex show prompt
24986 @item show prompt
24987 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
24988 @end table
24989
24990 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
24991 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
24992 are:
24993
24994 @table @code
24995 @kindex set extended-prompt
24996 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
24997 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
24998 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
24999 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
25000 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
25001 is displayed.
25002
25003 For example:
25004
25005 @smallexample
25006 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
25007 @end smallexample
25008
25009 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
25010 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
25011
25012 @kindex show extended-prompt
25013 @item show extended-prompt
25014 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
25015 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
25016 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
25017 @end table
25018
25019 @node Editing
25020 @section Command Editing
25021 @cindex readline
25022 @cindex command line editing
25023
25024 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
25025 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
25026 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
25027 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
25028 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
25029 debugging sessions.
25030
25031 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
25032 command @code{set}.
25033
25034 @table @code
25035 @kindex set editing
25036 @cindex editing
25037 @item set editing
25038 @itemx set editing on
25039 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
25040
25041 @item set editing off
25042 Disable command line editing.
25043
25044 @kindex show editing
25045 @item show editing
25046 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
25047 @end table
25048
25049 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25050 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
25051 @end ifset
25052 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25053 @xref{Command Line Editing},
25054 @end ifclear
25055 for more details about the Readline
25056 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
25057 encouraged to read that chapter.
25058
25059 @node Command History
25060 @section Command History
25061 @cindex command history
25062
25063 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
25064 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
25065 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
25066 history facility.
25067
25068 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
25069 package, to provide the history facility.
25070 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25071 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
25072 @end ifset
25073 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25074 @xref{Using History Interactively},
25075 @end ifclear
25076 for the detailed description of the History library.
25077
25078 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
25079 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
25080 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
25081 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
25082 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
25083 pressed on a line by itself.
25084
25085 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
25086 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
25087 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
25088 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
25089
25090 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
25091 history.
25092
25093 @table @code
25094 @cindex history substitution
25095 @cindex history file
25096 @kindex set history filename
25097 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
25098 @item set history filename @var{fname}
25099 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
25100 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
25101 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
25102 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
25103 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
25104 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
25105 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
25106 is not set.
25107
25108 @cindex save command history
25109 @kindex set history save
25110 @item set history save
25111 @itemx set history save on
25112 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
25113 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
25114
25115 @item set history save off
25116 Stop recording command history in a file.
25117
25118 @cindex history size
25119 @kindex set history size
25120 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
25121 @item set history size @var{size}
25122 @itemx set history size unlimited
25123 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
25124 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
25125 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
25126 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
25127 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
25128 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
25129
25130 @cindex remove duplicate history
25131 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
25132 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
25133 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
25134 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
25135 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
25136 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
25137 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
25138 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
25139 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
25140
25141 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
25142 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
25143
25144 @end table
25145
25146 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
25147 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
25148 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
25149 @end ifset
25150 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
25151 @xref{Event Designators},
25152 @end ifclear
25153 for more details.
25154
25155 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
25156 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
25157 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
25158 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
25159 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
25160 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
25161 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
25162 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
25163
25164 The commands to control history expansion are:
25165
25166 @table @code
25167 @item set history expansion on
25168 @itemx set history expansion
25169 @kindex set history expansion
25170 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
25171
25172 @item set history expansion off
25173 Disable history expansion.
25174
25175 @c @group
25176 @kindex show history
25177 @item show history
25178 @itemx show history filename
25179 @itemx show history save
25180 @itemx show history size
25181 @itemx show history expansion
25182 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
25183 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
25184 @c @end group
25185 @end table
25186
25187 @table @code
25188 @kindex show commands
25189 @cindex show last commands
25190 @cindex display command history
25191 @item show commands
25192 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
25193
25194 @item show commands @var{n}
25195 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
25196
25197 @item show commands +
25198 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
25199 @end table
25200
25201 @node Screen Size
25202 @section Screen Size
25203 @cindex size of screen
25204 @cindex screen size
25205 @cindex pagination
25206 @cindex page size
25207 @cindex pauses in output
25208
25209 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
25210 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
25211 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
25212 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
25213 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
25214 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
25215 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
25216 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
25217 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
25218 following line.
25219
25220 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
25221 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
25222 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
25223 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
25224 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
25225 width} commands:
25226
25227 @table @code
25228 @kindex set height
25229 @kindex set width
25230 @kindex show width
25231 @kindex show height
25232 @item set height @var{lpp}
25233 @itemx set height unlimited
25234 @itemx show height
25235 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
25236 @itemx set width unlimited
25237 @itemx show width
25238 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
25239 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
25240 commands display the current settings.
25241
25242 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
25243 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
25244 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
25245 buffer.
25246
25247 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
25248 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
25249
25250 @item set pagination on
25251 @itemx set pagination off
25252 @kindex set pagination
25253 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
25254 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
25255 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
25256 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
25257
25258 @item show pagination
25259 @kindex show pagination
25260 Show the current pagination mode.
25261 @end table
25262
25263 @node Output Styling
25264 @section Output Styling
25265 @cindex styling
25266 @cindex colors
25267
25268 @kindex set style
25269 @kindex show style
25270 @value{GDBN} can style its output on a capable terminal. This is
25271 enabled by default on most systems, but disabled by default when in
25272 batch mode (@pxref{Mode Options}). Various style settings are available;
25273 and styles can also be disabled entirely.
25274
25275 @table @code
25276 @item set style enabled @samp{on|off}
25277 Enable or disable all styling. The default is host-dependent, with
25278 most hosts defaulting to @samp{on}.
25279
25280 @item show style enabled
25281 Show the current state of styling.
25282
25283 @item set style sources @samp{on|off}
25284 Enable or disable source code styling. This affects whether source
25285 code, such as the output of the @code{list} command, is styled. Note
25286 that source styling only works if styling in general is enabled, and
25287 if @value{GDBN} was linked with the GNU Source Highlight library. The
25288 default is @samp{on}.
25289
25290 @item show style sources
25291 Show the current state of source code styling.
25292 @end table
25293
25294 Subcommands of @code{set style} control specific forms of styling.
25295 These subcommands all follow the same pattern: each style-able object
25296 can be styled with a foreground color, a background color, and an
25297 intensity.
25298
25299 For example, the style of file names can be controlled using the
25300 @code{set style filename} group of commands:
25301
25302 @table @code
25303 @item set style filename background @var{color}
25304 Set the background to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
25305 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
25306 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
25307 and@samp{white}.
25308
25309 @item set style filename foreground @var{color}
25310 Set the foreground to @var{color}. Valid colors are @samp{none}
25311 (meaning the terminal's default color), @samp{black}, @samp{red},
25312 @samp{green}, @samp{yellow}, @samp{blue}, @samp{magenta}, @samp{cyan},
25313 and@samp{white}.
25314
25315 @item set style filename intensity @var{value}
25316 Set the intensity to @var{value}. Valid intensities are @samp{normal}
25317 (the default), @samp{bold}, and @samp{dim}.
25318 @end table
25319
25320 The @code{show style} command and its subcommands are styling
25321 a style name in their output using its own style.
25322 So, use @command{show style} to see the complete list of styles,
25323 their characteristics and the visual aspect of each style.
25324
25325 The style-able objects are:
25326 @table @code
25327 @item filename
25328 Control the styling of file names. By default, this style's
25329 foreground color is green.
25330
25331 @item function
25332 Control the styling of function names. These are managed with the
25333 @code{set style function} family of commands. By default, this
25334 style's foreground color is yellow.
25335
25336 @item variable
25337 Control the styling of variable names. These are managed with the
25338 @code{set style variable} family of commands. By default, this style's
25339 foreground color is cyan.
25340
25341 @item address
25342 Control the styling of addresses. These are managed with the
25343 @code{set style address} family of commands. By default, this style's
25344 foreground color is blue.
25345
25346 @item title
25347 Control the styling of titles. These are managed with the
25348 @code{set style title} family of commands. By default, this style's
25349 intensity is bold. Commands are using the title style to improve
25350 the readibility of large output. For example, the commands
25351 @command{apropos} and @command{help} are using the title style
25352 for the command names.
25353
25354 @item highlight
25355 Control the styling of highlightings. These are managed with the
25356 @code{set style highlight} family of commands. By default, this style's
25357 foreground color is red. Commands are using the highlight style to draw
25358 the user attention to some specific parts of their output. For example,
25359 the command @command{apropos -v REGEXP} uses the highlight style to
25360 mark the documentation parts matching @var{regexp}.
25361
25362 @end table
25363
25364 @node Numbers
25365 @section Numbers
25366 @cindex number representation
25367 @cindex entering numbers
25368
25369 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
25370 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
25371 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
25372 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
25373 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
25374 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
25375 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
25376 both input and output with the commands described below.
25377
25378 @table @code
25379 @kindex set input-radix
25380 @item set input-radix @var{base}
25381 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
25382 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
25383 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
25384 example, any of
25385
25386 @smallexample
25387 set input-radix 012
25388 set input-radix 10.
25389 set input-radix 0xa
25390 @end smallexample
25391
25392 @noindent
25393 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
25394 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
25395 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
25396 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
25397 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
25398 change the radix.
25399
25400 @kindex set output-radix
25401 @item set output-radix @var{base}
25402 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
25403 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
25404 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
25405
25406 @kindex show input-radix
25407 @item show input-radix
25408 Display the current default base for numeric input.
25409
25410 @kindex show output-radix
25411 @item show output-radix
25412 Display the current default base for numeric display.
25413
25414 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
25415 @itemx show radix
25416 @kindex set radix
25417 @kindex show radix
25418 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
25419 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
25420 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
25421 default value of 10.
25422
25423 @end table
25424
25425 @node ABI
25426 @section Configuring the Current ABI
25427
25428 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
25429 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
25430 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
25431 current ABI.
25432
25433 @cindex OS ABI
25434 @kindex set osabi
25435 @kindex show osabi
25436 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
25437
25438 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
25439 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
25440 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
25441 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
25442 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
25443 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
25444 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
25445 platform provides.
25446
25447 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
25448 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
25449 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
25450 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
25451
25452 @table @code
25453 @item show osabi
25454 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
25455
25456 @item set osabi
25457 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
25458
25459 @item set osabi @var{abi}
25460 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
25461 @end table
25462
25463 @cindex float promotion
25464
25465 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
25466 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
25467 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
25468 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
25469 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
25470 @code{double} and then passed.
25471
25472 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
25473 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
25474 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
25475
25476 @table @code
25477 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
25478 @item set coerce-float-to-double
25479 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
25480 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
25481 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
25482
25483 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
25484 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
25485 functions.
25486
25487 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
25488 @item show coerce-float-to-double
25489 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
25490 @end table
25491
25492 @kindex set cp-abi
25493 @kindex show cp-abi
25494 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
25495 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
25496 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
25497 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
25498 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
25499 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
25500 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
25501 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
25502 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
25503 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
25504 ``auto''.
25505
25506 @table @code
25507 @item show cp-abi
25508 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
25509
25510 @item set cp-abi
25511 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
25512
25513 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
25514 @itemx set cp-abi auto
25515 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
25516 @end table
25517
25518 @node Auto-loading
25519 @section Automatically loading associated files
25520 @cindex auto-loading
25521
25522 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
25523 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
25524 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
25525 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
25526 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
25527 sources).
25528
25529 @menu
25530 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
25531 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
25532
25533 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
25534 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
25535 @end menu
25536
25537 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
25538 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
25539 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25540
25541 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
25542 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
25543 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25544
25545 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
25546 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
25547
25548 @table @code
25549 @anchor{set auto-load off}
25550 @kindex set auto-load off
25551 @item set auto-load off
25552 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
25553 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
25554 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
25555 @smallexample
25556 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
25557 @end smallexample
25558
25559 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
25560 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
25561 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
25562 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
25563 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
25564 @code{set auto-load no}.
25565
25566 @anchor{show auto-load}
25567 @kindex show auto-load
25568 @item show auto-load
25569 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
25570 or disabled.
25571
25572 @smallexample
25573 (gdb) show auto-load
25574 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
25575 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
25576 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
25577 is on.
25578 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
25579 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
25580 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
25581 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
25582 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
25583 @end smallexample
25584
25585 @anchor{info auto-load}
25586 @kindex info auto-load
25587 @item info auto-load
25588 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
25589 not.
25590
25591 @smallexample
25592 (gdb) info auto-load
25593 gdb-scripts:
25594 Loaded Script
25595 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
25596 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
25597 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
25598 loaded.
25599 python-scripts:
25600 Loaded Script
25601 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
25602 @end smallexample
25603 @end table
25604
25605 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
25606
25607 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
25608 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
25609 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
25610 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
25611 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
25612 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
25613 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
25614 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
25615 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
25616 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
25617 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
25618 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
25619 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
25620 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
25621 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
25622 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
25623 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
25624 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
25625 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
25626 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
25627 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
25628 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
25629 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
25630 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
25631 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
25632 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
25633 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25634 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
25635 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25636 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
25637 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
25638 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
25639 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
25640 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
25641 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
25642 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
25643 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
25644 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
25645 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
25646 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
25647 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
25648 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
25649 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
25650 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
25651 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
25652 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
25653 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
25654 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
25655 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
25656 @end multitable
25657
25658 @node Init File in the Current Directory
25659 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
25660 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
25661
25662 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
25663 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
25664 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
25665
25666 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
25667 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25668
25669 @table @code
25670 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
25671 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
25672 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
25673 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
25674 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
25675
25676 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
25677 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
25678 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
25679 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
25680 current directory is enabled or disabled.
25681
25682 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
25683 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
25684 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
25685 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
25686 current directory have been auto-loaded.
25687 @end table
25688
25689 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
25690 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
25691 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
25692
25693 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
25694
25695 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
25696 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
25697
25698 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
25699 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
25700 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
25701 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
25702 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
25703 library.
25704
25705 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
25706 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25707
25708 @table @code
25709 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
25710 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
25711 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
25712 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
25713
25714 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
25715 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
25716 @item show auto-load libthread-db
25717 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
25718 enabled or disabled.
25719
25720 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
25721 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
25722 @item info auto-load libthread-db
25723 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
25724 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
25725 @end table
25726
25727 @node Auto-loading safe path
25728 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
25729 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
25730
25731 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
25732 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
25733 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
25734 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
25735 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
25736
25737 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
25738 get loaded:
25739
25740 @smallexample
25741 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
25742 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
25743 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
25744 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
25745 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
25746 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
25747 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
25748 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
25749 @end smallexample
25750
25751 @noindent
25752 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
25753 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
25754
25755 @smallexample
25756 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
25757 @end smallexample
25758
25759 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
25760
25761 @table @code
25762 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
25763 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
25764 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25765 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
25766 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
25767 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
25768 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
25769 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
25770 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
25771 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
25772
25773 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25774 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25775 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25776
25777 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
25778 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
25779 @item show auto-load safe-path
25780 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
25781 scripts.
25782
25783 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
25784 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
25785 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
25786 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
25787 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
25788 by the host platform path separator in use.
25789 @end table
25790
25791 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
25792 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
25793 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
25794 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
25795 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
25796
25797 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
25798 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
25799 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
25800 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
25801 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
25802 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
25803 init file in the current directory
25804 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
25805
25806 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
25807 example, you could use one of the following ways:
25808
25809 @table @asis
25810 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
25811 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
25812 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
25813 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
25814
25815 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
25816 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
25817 @value{GDBN} session.
25818
25819 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
25820 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25821 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
25822 from trusted sources.
25823
25824 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
25825 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
25826 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
25827 trusted sources.
25828 @end table
25829
25830 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
25831 also suppresses any such warning messages:
25832
25833 @table @asis
25834 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
25835 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
25836
25837 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
25838 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
25839 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
25840 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
25841 @end table
25842
25843 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
25844 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
25845 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
25846 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
25847 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
25848 recommended to be entered.
25849
25850 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
25851 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
25852 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
25853
25854 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
25855 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
25856 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
25857 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
25858 be printed.
25859
25860 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
25861 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
25862 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
25863
25864 @smallexample
25865 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
25866 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
25867 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
25868 for objfile "/tmp/true".
25869 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
25870 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
25871 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
25872 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
25873 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
25874 @end smallexample
25875
25876 @table @code
25877 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
25878 @kindex set debug auto-load
25879 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
25880 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
25881
25882 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
25883 @kindex show debug auto-load
25884 @item show debug auto-load
25885 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
25886 on or off.
25887 @end table
25888
25889 @node Messages/Warnings
25890 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
25891
25892 @cindex verbose operation
25893 @cindex optional warnings
25894 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
25895 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
25896 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
25897 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
25898
25899 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
25900 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
25901 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
25902
25903 @table @code
25904 @kindex set verbose
25905 @item set verbose on
25906 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25907
25908 @item set verbose off
25909 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
25910
25911 @kindex show verbose
25912 @item show verbose
25913 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
25914 @end table
25915
25916 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
25917 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
25918 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
25919 Symbol Files}).
25920
25921 @table @code
25922
25923 @kindex set complaints
25924 @item set complaints @var{limit}
25925 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
25926 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
25927 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
25928 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
25929
25930 @kindex show complaints
25931 @item show complaints
25932 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
25933
25934 @end table
25935
25936 @anchor{confirmation requests}
25937 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
25938 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
25939 you try to run a program which is already running:
25940
25941 @smallexample
25942 (@value{GDBP}) run
25943 The program being debugged has been started already.
25944 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
25945 @end smallexample
25946
25947 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
25948 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
25949
25950 @table @code
25951
25952 @kindex set confirm
25953 @cindex flinching
25954 @cindex confirmation
25955 @cindex stupid questions
25956 @item set confirm off
25957 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
25958 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
25959 automatically disables confirmation requests.
25960
25961 @item set confirm on
25962 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
25963
25964 @kindex show confirm
25965 @item show confirm
25966 Displays state of confirmation requests.
25967
25968 @end table
25969
25970 @cindex command tracing
25971 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
25972 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
25973 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
25974 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
25975
25976 @table @code
25977 @kindex set trace-commands
25978 @cindex command scripts, debugging
25979 @item set trace-commands on
25980 Enable command tracing.
25981 @item set trace-commands off
25982 Disable command tracing.
25983 @item show trace-commands
25984 Display the current state of command tracing.
25985 @end table
25986
25987 @node Debugging Output
25988 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
25989 @cindex optional debugging messages
25990
25991 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
25992 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
25993 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
25994 section documents those commands.
25995
25996 @table @code
25997 @kindex set exec-done-display
25998 @item set exec-done-display
25999 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
26000 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
26001 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
26002 @kindex show exec-done-display
26003 @item show exec-done-display
26004 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
26005 notification.
26006 @kindex set debug
26007 @cindex ARM AArch64
26008 @item set debug aarch64
26009 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
26010 The default is off.
26011 @kindex show debug
26012 @item show debug aarch64
26013 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
26014 ARM AArch64.
26015 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
26016 @cindex architecture debugging info
26017 @item set debug arch
26018 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
26019 @item show debug arch
26020 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
26021 @item set debug aix-solib
26022 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
26023 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
26024 support module. The default is off.
26025 @item show debug aix-thread
26026 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
26027 @item set debug aix-thread
26028 @cindex AIX threads
26029 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
26030 module.
26031 @item show debug aix-thread
26032 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
26033 @item set debug check-physname
26034 @cindex physname
26035 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
26036 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
26037 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
26038 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
26039 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
26040 both ways and display any discrepancies.
26041 @item show debug check-physname
26042 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
26043 @item set debug coff-pe-read
26044 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
26045 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
26046 exported symbols. The default is off.
26047 @item show debug coff-pe-read
26048 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
26049 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
26050 @item set debug dwarf-die
26051 @cindex DWARF DIEs
26052 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
26053 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
26054 A value of zero turns off the display.
26055 @item show debug dwarf-die
26056 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
26057 @item set debug dwarf-line
26058 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
26059 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
26060 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
26061 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26062 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26063 @item show debug dwarf-line
26064 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
26065 @item set debug dwarf-read
26066 @cindex DWARF Reading
26067 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
26068 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
26069 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26070 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26071 @item show debug dwarf-read
26072 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
26073 @item set debug displaced
26074 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
26075 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
26076 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
26077 @item show debug displaced
26078 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
26079 related to displaced stepping.
26080 @item set debug event
26081 @cindex event debugging info
26082 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
26083 default is off.
26084 @item show debug event
26085 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
26086 info.
26087 @item set debug expression
26088 @cindex expression debugging info
26089 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
26090 expression parsing. The default is off.
26091 @item show debug expression
26092 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
26093 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
26094 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
26095 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
26096 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
26097 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
26098 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
26099 @item set debug fbsd-nat
26100 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
26101 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
26102 @item show debug fbsd-nat
26103 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
26104 @item set debug frame
26105 @cindex frame debugging info
26106 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
26107 default is off.
26108 @item show debug frame
26109 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
26110 info.
26111 @item set debug gnu-nat
26112 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
26113 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
26114 @item show debug gnu-nat
26115 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
26116 @item set debug infrun
26117 @cindex inferior debugging info
26118 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
26119 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
26120 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
26121 @item show debug infrun
26122 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
26123 @item set debug jit
26124 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
26125 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
26126 @item show debug jit
26127 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
26128 @item set debug lin-lwp
26129 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
26130 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
26131 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
26132 @item show debug lin-lwp
26133 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
26134 @item set debug linux-namespaces
26135 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
26136 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
26137 @item show debug linux-namespaces
26138 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
26139 @item set debug mach-o
26140 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
26141 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
26142 processing. The default is off.
26143 @item show debug mach-o
26144 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
26145 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
26146 @item set debug notification
26147 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
26148 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
26149 The default is off.
26150 @item show debug notification
26151 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
26152 @item set debug observer
26153 @cindex observer debugging info
26154 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
26155 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
26156 @item show debug observer
26157 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
26158 @item set debug overload
26159 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
26160 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
26161 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
26162 is off.
26163 @item show debug overload
26164 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
26165 debugging info.
26166 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
26167 @cindex debug expression parser
26168 @item set debug parser
26169 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
26170 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
26171 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
26172 details. The default is off.
26173 @item show debug parser
26174 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
26175 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
26176 @cindex serial connections, debugging
26177 @cindex debug remote protocol
26178 @cindex remote protocol debugging
26179 @cindex display remote packets
26180 @item set debug remote
26181 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
26182 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
26183 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
26184 @item show debug remote
26185 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
26186
26187 @item set debug separate-debug-file
26188 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
26189 @item show debug separate-debug-file
26190 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
26191
26192 @item set debug serial
26193 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
26194 default is off.
26195 @item show debug serial
26196 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
26197 info.
26198 @item set debug solib-frv
26199 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
26200 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
26201 @item show debug solib-frv
26202 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
26203 messages.
26204 @item set debug symbol-lookup
26205 @cindex symbol lookup
26206 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
26207 The default is 0 (off).
26208 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26209 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26210 @item show debug symbol-lookup
26211 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
26212 @item set debug symfile
26213 @cindex symbol file functions
26214 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
26215 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
26216 @item show debug symfile
26217 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
26218 @item set debug symtab-create
26219 @cindex symbol table creation
26220 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
26221 The default is 0 (off).
26222 A value of 1 provides basic information.
26223 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
26224 @item show debug symtab-create
26225 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
26226 @item set debug target
26227 @cindex target debugging info
26228 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
26229 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
26230 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
26231 value of large memory transfers.
26232 @item show debug target
26233 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
26234 info.
26235 @item set debug timestamp
26236 @cindex timestampping debugging info
26237 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
26238 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
26239 message.
26240 @item show debug timestamp
26241 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
26242 debugging info.
26243 @item set debug varobj
26244 @cindex variable object debugging info
26245 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
26246 info. The default is off.
26247 @item show debug varobj
26248 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
26249 debugging info.
26250 @item set debug xml
26251 @cindex XML parser debugging
26252 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
26253 @item show debug xml
26254 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
26255 @end table
26256
26257 @node Other Misc Settings
26258 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
26259 @cindex miscellaneous settings
26260
26261 @table @code
26262 @kindex set interactive-mode
26263 @item set interactive-mode
26264 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
26265 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
26266 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
26267 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
26268 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
26269 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
26270 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
26271 is, non-interactively otherwise.
26272
26273 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
26274 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
26275 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
26276 inside a cygwin window.
26277
26278 @kindex show interactive-mode
26279 @item show interactive-mode
26280 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
26281 @end table
26282
26283 @node Extending GDB
26284 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
26285 @cindex extending GDB
26286
26287 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
26288 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
26289 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
26290 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
26291 being debugged.
26292
26293 @menu
26294 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
26295 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
26296 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
26297 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
26298 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
26299 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
26300 @end menu
26301
26302 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
26303 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
26304 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
26305 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
26306 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
26307 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
26308
26309 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
26310 setting:
26311
26312 @table @code
26313 @kindex set script-extension
26314 @kindex show script-extension
26315 @item set script-extension off
26316 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
26317
26318 @item set script-extension soft
26319 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
26320 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
26321 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
26322 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
26323
26324 @item set script-extension strict
26325 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
26326 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
26327 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
26328
26329 @item show script-extension
26330 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
26331
26332 @end table
26333
26334 @node Sequences
26335 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
26336
26337 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
26338 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
26339 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
26340 files.
26341
26342 @menu
26343 * Define:: How to define your own commands
26344 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
26345 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
26346 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
26347 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
26348 @end menu
26349
26350 @node Define
26351 @subsection User-defined Commands
26352
26353 @cindex user-defined command
26354 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
26355 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
26356 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
26357 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
26358 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
26359 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
26360
26361 @smallexample
26362 define adder
26363 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
26364 end
26365 @end smallexample
26366
26367 @noindent
26368 To execute the command use:
26369
26370 @smallexample
26371 adder 1 2 3
26372 @end smallexample
26373
26374 @noindent
26375 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
26376 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
26377 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
26378 functions calls.
26379
26380 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
26381 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
26382 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
26383 been passed.
26384
26385 @smallexample
26386 define adder
26387 if $argc == 2
26388 print $arg0 + $arg1
26389 end
26390 if $argc == 3
26391 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
26392 end
26393 end
26394 @end smallexample
26395
26396 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
26397 to process a variable number of arguments:
26398
26399 @smallexample
26400 define adder
26401 set $i = 0
26402 set $sum = 0
26403 while $i < $argc
26404 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
26405 set $i = $i + 1
26406 end
26407 print $sum
26408 end
26409 @end smallexample
26410
26411 @table @code
26412
26413 @kindex define
26414 @item define @var{commandname}
26415 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
26416 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
26417 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
26418 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
26419 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
26420 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
26421
26422 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
26423 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
26424 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
26425
26426 @kindex document
26427 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
26428 @item document @var{commandname}
26429 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
26430 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
26431 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
26432 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
26433 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
26434 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
26435
26436 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
26437 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
26438 does not change the documentation.
26439
26440 @kindex dont-repeat
26441 @cindex don't repeat command
26442 @item dont-repeat
26443 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
26444 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
26445 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
26446
26447 @kindex help user-defined
26448 @item help user-defined
26449 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
26450 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
26451 included (if any).
26452
26453 @kindex show user
26454 @item show user
26455 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
26456 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
26457 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
26458 definitions for all user-defined commands.
26459 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
26460
26461 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
26462 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
26463 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
26464 @item show max-user-call-depth
26465 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
26466 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
26467 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
26468 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
26469 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
26470 @end table
26471
26472 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
26473 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
26474
26475 When user-defined commands are executed, the
26476 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
26477 stops execution of the user-defined command.
26478
26479 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
26480 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
26481 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
26482 messages when used in a user-defined command.
26483
26484 @node Hooks
26485 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
26486 @cindex command hooks
26487 @cindex hooks, for commands
26488 @cindex hooks, pre-command
26489
26490 @kindex hook
26491 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
26492 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
26493 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
26494 before that command.
26495
26496 @cindex hooks, post-command
26497 @kindex hookpost
26498 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
26499 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
26500 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
26501 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
26502 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
26503
26504 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
26505 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
26506
26507 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
26508 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
26509
26510 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
26511 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
26512 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
26513 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
26514 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
26515
26516 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
26517 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
26518 you could define:
26519
26520 @smallexample
26521 define hook-stop
26522 handle SIGALRM nopass
26523 end
26524
26525 define hook-run
26526 handle SIGALRM pass
26527 end
26528
26529 define hook-continue
26530 handle SIGALRM pass
26531 end
26532 @end smallexample
26533
26534 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
26535 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
26536 you could define:
26537
26538 @smallexample
26539 define hook-echo
26540 echo <<<---
26541 end
26542
26543 define hookpost-echo
26544 echo --->>>\n
26545 end
26546
26547 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
26548 <<<---Hello World--->>>
26549 (@value{GDBP})
26550
26551 @end smallexample
26552
26553 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
26554 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
26555 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
26556 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
26557 @c or not?
26558 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
26559 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
26560 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
26561
26562 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
26563 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
26564 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
26565
26566 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
26567 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
26568
26569 @node Command Files
26570 @subsection Command Files
26571
26572 @cindex command files
26573 @cindex scripting commands
26574 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
26575 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
26576 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
26577 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
26578 terminal.
26579
26580 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
26581 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
26582 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
26583 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
26584 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
26585
26586 @table @code
26587 @kindex source
26588 @cindex execute commands from a file
26589 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
26590 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
26591 @end table
26592
26593 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
26594 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
26595 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
26596 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
26597 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
26598
26599 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
26600 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
26601 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
26602 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
26603 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
26604 is not relevant to scripts.
26605
26606 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
26607 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
26608 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
26609 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
26610 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
26611 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
26612 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
26613 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
26614 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
26615 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
26616 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
26617 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
26618 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
26619 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
26620
26621 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
26622 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
26623 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
26624
26625 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
26626 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
26627 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
26628 when called from command files.
26629
26630 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
26631 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
26632 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
26633 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
26634 the next command.
26635
26636 @smallexample
26637 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
26638 @end smallexample
26639
26640 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
26641 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
26642 would be directed to @file{log}.
26643
26644 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
26645 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
26646 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
26647 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
26648 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
26649 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
26650 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
26651 conditionally, etc.
26652
26653 @table @code
26654 @kindex if
26655 @kindex else
26656 @item if
26657 @itemx else
26658 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
26659 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
26660 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
26661 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
26662 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
26663 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
26664 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
26665
26666 @kindex while
26667 @item while
26668 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
26669 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
26670 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
26671 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
26672 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
26673 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
26674
26675 @kindex loop_break
26676 @item loop_break
26677 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
26678 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
26679 line.
26680
26681 @kindex loop_continue
26682 @item loop_continue
26683 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
26684 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
26685 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
26686 the controlling expression.
26687
26688 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
26689 @item end
26690 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
26691 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
26692 @end table
26693
26694
26695 @node Output
26696 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
26697
26698 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
26699 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
26700 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
26701 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
26702 want.
26703
26704 @table @code
26705 @kindex echo
26706 @item echo @var{text}
26707 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
26708 @c because it is not in ANSI.
26709 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
26710 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
26711 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
26712 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
26713 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
26714 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
26715 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
26716 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
26717 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
26718
26719 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
26720 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
26721
26722 @smallexample
26723 echo This is some text\n\
26724 which is continued\n\
26725 onto several lines.\n
26726 @end smallexample
26727
26728 produces the same output as
26729
26730 @smallexample
26731 echo This is some text\n
26732 echo which is continued\n
26733 echo onto several lines.\n
26734 @end smallexample
26735
26736 @kindex output
26737 @item output @var{expression}
26738 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
26739 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
26740 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
26741 on expressions.
26742
26743 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
26744 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
26745 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
26746 Formats}, for more information.
26747
26748 @kindex printf
26749 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26750 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26751 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
26752 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
26753 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
26754 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
26755 executing the code below:
26756
26757 @smallexample
26758 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
26759 @end smallexample
26760
26761 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
26762 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
26763 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
26764 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
26765 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
26766 printed.
26767
26768 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
26769
26770 @smallexample
26771 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
26772 @end smallexample
26773
26774 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
26775 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
26776 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
26777
26778 @itemize @bullet
26779 @item
26780 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
26781
26782 @item
26783 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
26784 width.
26785
26786 @item
26787 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
26788 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
26789
26790 @item
26791 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
26792 supported.
26793
26794 @item
26795 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
26796
26797 @item
26798 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
26799 @end itemize
26800
26801 @noindent
26802 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
26803 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
26804 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
26805 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
26806
26807 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
26808 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
26809 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
26810 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
26811 supported.
26812
26813 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
26814 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
26815 together with a floating point specifier.
26816 letters:
26817
26818 @itemize @bullet
26819 @item
26820 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
26821
26822 @item
26823 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
26824
26825 @item
26826 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
26827 @end itemize
26828
26829 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
26830 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
26831 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
26832
26833 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
26834 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
26835
26836 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
26837 @smallexample
26838 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
26839 @end smallexample
26840
26841 @anchor{eval}
26842 @kindex eval
26843 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
26844 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
26845 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
26846
26847 @end table
26848
26849 @node Auto-loading sequences
26850 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
26851 @cindex native script auto-loading
26852
26853 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26854 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
26855 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
26856 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
26857
26858 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26859 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26860
26861 @table @code
26862 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
26863 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
26864 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
26865 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
26866
26867 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
26868 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
26869 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
26870 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
26871 disabled.
26872
26873 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
26874 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
26875 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
26876 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
26877 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
26878 auto-loaded.
26879 @end table
26880
26881 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
26882 matching names are printed.
26883
26884 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
26885 @include python.texi
26886
26887 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
26888 @include guile.texi
26889
26890 @node Auto-loading extensions
26891 @section Auto-loading extensions
26892 @cindex auto-loading extensions
26893
26894 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
26895 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
26896 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
26897 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
26898 section of modern file formats like ELF.
26899
26900 @menu
26901 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26902 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
26903 * Which flavor to choose?::
26904 @end menu
26905
26906 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
26907 debugging commands and features.
26908
26909 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
26910 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
26911 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
26912 for more information.
26913 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
26914 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
26915
26916 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
26917 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26918
26919 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
26920 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
26921 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26922 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26923 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26924
26925 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
26926 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
26927 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
26928 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
26929
26930 @table @code
26931 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
26932 GDB's own command language
26933 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
26934 Python
26935 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
26936 Guile
26937 @end table
26938
26939 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
26940 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
26941 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
26942 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
26943 script in the specified extension language.
26944
26945 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
26946 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
26947
26948 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
26949 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
26950
26951 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
26952 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
26953 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
26954 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
26955 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
26956 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
26957
26958 @table @code
26959 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
26960 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
26961 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
26962 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
26963 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
26964 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
26965
26966 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
26967 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
26968
26969 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
26970 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
26971 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
26972 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
26973
26974 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
26975 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
26976 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
26977 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
26978 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
26979 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
26980 platform.
26981
26982 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
26983 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
26984 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
26985
26986 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
26987 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
26988 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
26989 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
26990
26991 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
26992 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
26993 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
26994 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
26995 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
26996 @end table
26997
26998 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
26999 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
27000 @var{objfile} is opened.
27001 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
27002 is evaluated more than once.
27003
27004 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
27005 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
27006 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
27007
27008 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
27009 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
27010 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
27011 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
27012 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
27013 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
27014 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
27015
27016 The following entries are supported:
27017
27018 @table @code
27019 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
27020 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
27021 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
27022 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
27023 @end table
27024
27025 @subsubsection Script File Entries
27026
27027 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
27028 in the current directory and then along the source search path
27029 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
27030 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
27031 directory is not relevant to scripts.
27032
27033 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
27034 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
27035
27036 @example
27037 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
27038 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
27039 asm("\
27040 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
27041 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
27042 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
27043 .popsection \n\
27044 ");
27045 @end example
27046
27047 @noindent
27048 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
27049 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
27050
27051 @example
27052 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
27053 @end example
27054
27055 The script name may include directories if desired.
27056
27057 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
27058 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27059
27060 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
27061 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
27062 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
27063 will remove duplicates.
27064
27065 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
27066
27067 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
27068 itself instead of loading it from a file.
27069 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
27070 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
27071 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
27072 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
27073 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
27074 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
27075 on its name.
27076
27077 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
27078 testsuite.
27079
27080 @example
27081 #include "symcat.h"
27082 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
27083 asm(
27084 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
27085 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
27086 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
27087 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
27088 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
27089 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
27090 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
27091 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
27092 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
27093 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
27094 ".byte 0\n"
27095 ".popsection\n"
27096 );
27097 @end example
27098
27099 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
27100 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
27101 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
27102 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
27103
27104 @node Which flavor to choose?
27105 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
27106
27107 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
27108 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
27109
27110 @noindent
27111 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
27112
27113 @itemize @bullet
27114 @item
27115 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
27116
27117 @item
27118 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
27119
27120 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
27121 in the source search path.
27122 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
27123 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
27124
27125 @item
27126 Doesn't require source code additions.
27127 @end itemize
27128
27129 @noindent
27130 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
27131
27132 @itemize @bullet
27133 @item
27134 Works with static linking.
27135
27136 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
27137 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
27138 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
27139 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
27140 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
27141
27142 @item
27143 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
27144
27145 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
27146 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
27147
27148 @item
27149 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
27150
27151 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
27152 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
27153 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
27154 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
27155 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
27156 top of the source tree to the source search path.
27157 @end itemize
27158
27159 @node Multiple Extension Languages
27160 @section Multiple Extension Languages
27161
27162 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
27163 and generally do not interfere with each other.
27164 There are some things to be aware of, however.
27165
27166 @subsection Python comes first
27167
27168 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
27169 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
27170 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
27171 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
27172 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
27173 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
27174 pretty-printed form of a value).
27175 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
27176 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
27177 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
27178
27179 @node Aliases
27180 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
27181 @cindex aliases for commands
27182
27183 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
27184 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
27185 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
27186 that involves less typing.
27187
27188 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
27189 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
27190 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
27191
27192 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
27193 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
27194 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
27195
27196 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
27197
27198 @table @code
27199
27200 @kindex alias
27201 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
27202
27203 @end table
27204
27205 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
27206 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
27207 underscores.
27208
27209 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
27210 that is being aliased.
27211
27212 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
27213 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
27214 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
27215
27216 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
27217 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
27218
27219 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
27220 of a command so that there is less to type.
27221 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
27222 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
27223 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
27224 The following will accomplish this.
27225
27226 @smallexample
27227 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
27228 @end smallexample
27229
27230 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
27231 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
27232 for it with the @samp{document} command.
27233 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
27234
27235 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
27236 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
27237 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
27238 of a command.
27239
27240 @smallexample
27241 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
27242 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
27243 (gdb) set p elms 20
27244 (gdb) show p elms
27245 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
27246 @end smallexample
27247
27248 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
27249 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
27250 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
27251
27252 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
27253 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
27254
27255 @smallexample
27256 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
27257 @end smallexample
27258
27259 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
27260 alias for a more complex command.
27261 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
27262
27263 @smallexample
27264 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
27265 (gdb) spe 20
27266 @end smallexample
27267
27268 @node Interpreters
27269 @chapter Command Interpreters
27270 @cindex command interpreters
27271
27272 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
27273 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
27274 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
27275
27276 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
27277 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
27278 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
27279 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
27280
27281 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
27282 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
27283 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
27284 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
27285
27286 @table @code
27287 @item console
27288 @cindex console interpreter
27289 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
27290 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
27291 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
27292
27293 @item mi
27294 @cindex mi interpreter
27295 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi3}). Used primarily
27296 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
27297 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
27298 Interface}.
27299
27300 @item mi3
27301 @cindex mi3 interpreter
27302 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 9.1.
27303
27304 @item mi2
27305 @cindex mi2 interpreter
27306 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 6.0.
27307
27308 @item mi1
27309 @cindex mi1 interpreter
27310 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface introduced in @value{GDBN} 5.1.
27311
27312 @end table
27313
27314 @cindex invoke another interpreter
27315
27316 @kindex interpreter-exec
27317 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
27318 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
27319 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
27320
27321 @smallexample
27322 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
27323 @end smallexample
27324
27325 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
27326 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
27327
27328 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
27329 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
27330 permanently.
27331
27332 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
27333
27334 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
27335 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
27336 device (usually a tty).
27337
27338 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
27339 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
27340 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
27341 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
27342 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
27343 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
27344 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
27345 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
27346 the separate MI interpreter.
27347
27348 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
27349 @code{new-ui} command:
27350
27351 @kindex new-ui
27352 @cindex new user interface
27353 @smallexample
27354 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
27355 @end smallexample
27356
27357 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
27358 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
27359 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
27360 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
27361 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
27362 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
27363
27364 @smallexample
27365 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
27366 @end smallexample
27367
27368 @noindent
27369 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
27370
27371 @node TUI
27372 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
27373 @cindex TUI
27374 @cindex Text User Interface
27375
27376 @menu
27377 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
27378 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
27379 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
27380 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
27381 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
27382 @end menu
27383
27384 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
27385 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
27386 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
27387 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
27388 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
27389 is available.
27390
27391 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
27392 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
27393 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
27394 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
27395 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
27396 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
27397
27398 @node TUI Overview
27399 @section TUI Overview
27400
27401 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
27402
27403 @table @emph
27404 @item command
27405 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
27406 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
27407 managed using readline.
27408
27409 @item source
27410 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
27411 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
27412
27413 @item assembly
27414 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
27415
27416 @item register
27417 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
27418 when their values change.
27419 @end table
27420
27421 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
27422 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
27423 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
27424 indicates the breakpoint type:
27425
27426 @table @code
27427 @item B
27428 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
27429
27430 @item b
27431 Breakpoint which was never hit.
27432
27433 @item H
27434 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
27435
27436 @item h
27437 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
27438 @end table
27439
27440 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
27441
27442 @table @code
27443 @item +
27444 Breakpoint is enabled.
27445
27446 @item -
27447 Breakpoint is disabled.
27448 @end table
27449
27450 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
27451 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
27452 changes.
27453
27454 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
27455 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
27456 layouts:
27457
27458 @itemize @bullet
27459 @item
27460 source only,
27461
27462 @item
27463 assembly only,
27464
27465 @item
27466 source and assembly,
27467
27468 @item
27469 source and registers, or
27470
27471 @item
27472 assembly and registers.
27473 @end itemize
27474
27475 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
27476
27477 @table @emph
27478 @item target
27479 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
27480 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
27481
27482 @item process
27483 Gives the current process or thread number.
27484 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
27485
27486 @item function
27487 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
27488 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
27489 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
27490 the string @code{??} is displayed.
27491
27492 @item line
27493 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
27494 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
27495
27496 @item pc
27497 Indicates the current program counter address.
27498 @end table
27499
27500 @node TUI Keys
27501 @section TUI Key Bindings
27502 @cindex TUI key bindings
27503
27504 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
27505 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
27506 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
27507 @end ifset
27508 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
27509 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
27510 @end ifclear
27511 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
27512 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
27513
27514 @table @kbd
27515 @kindex C-x C-a
27516 @item C-x C-a
27517 @kindex C-x a
27518 @itemx C-x a
27519 @kindex C-x A
27520 @itemx C-x A
27521 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
27522 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
27523 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
27524 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
27525 The screen is then refreshed.
27526
27527 @kindex C-x 1
27528 @item C-x 1
27529 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
27530 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
27531 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
27532
27533 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
27534
27535 @kindex C-x 2
27536 @item C-x 2
27537 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
27538 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
27539 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
27540 previous layout and the new one.
27541
27542 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
27543
27544 @kindex C-x o
27545 @item C-x o
27546 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
27547 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
27548 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
27549
27550 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
27551
27552 @kindex C-x s
27553 @item C-x s
27554 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
27555 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
27556 @end table
27557
27558 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
27559
27560 @table @asis
27561 @kindex PgUp
27562 @item @key{PgUp}
27563 Scroll the active window one page up.
27564
27565 @kindex PgDn
27566 @item @key{PgDn}
27567 Scroll the active window one page down.
27568
27569 @kindex Up
27570 @item @key{Up}
27571 Scroll the active window one line up.
27572
27573 @kindex Down
27574 @item @key{Down}
27575 Scroll the active window one line down.
27576
27577 @kindex Left
27578 @item @key{Left}
27579 Scroll the active window one column left.
27580
27581 @kindex Right
27582 @item @key{Right}
27583 Scroll the active window one column right.
27584
27585 @kindex C-L
27586 @item @kbd{C-L}
27587 Refresh the screen.
27588 @end table
27589
27590 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
27591 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
27592 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
27593 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
27594 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
27595
27596 @node TUI Single Key Mode
27597 @section TUI Single Key Mode
27598 @cindex TUI single key mode
27599
27600 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
27601 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
27602 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
27603
27604 @table @kbd
27605 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27606 @item c
27607 continue
27608
27609 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27610 @item d
27611 down
27612
27613 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27614 @item f
27615 finish
27616
27617 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27618 @item n
27619 next
27620
27621 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27622 @item o
27623 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
27624
27625 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27626 @item q
27627 exit the SingleKey mode.
27628
27629 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27630 @item r
27631 run
27632
27633 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27634 @item s
27635 step
27636
27637 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27638 @item i
27639 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
27640
27641 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27642 @item u
27643 up
27644
27645 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27646 @item v
27647 info locals
27648
27649 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
27650 @item w
27651 where
27652 @end table
27653
27654 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
27655 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
27656 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
27657 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
27658 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
27659 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
27660
27661
27662 @node TUI Commands
27663 @section TUI-specific Commands
27664 @cindex TUI commands
27665
27666 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
27667 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
27668 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
27669 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
27670
27671 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
27672 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
27673 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
27674 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
27675 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
27676
27677 @table @code
27678 @item tui enable
27679 @kindex tui enable
27680 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
27681 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
27682 otherwise a default layout is used.
27683
27684 @item tui disable
27685 @kindex tui disable
27686 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
27687
27688 @item info win
27689 @kindex info win
27690 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
27691
27692 @item layout @var{name}
27693 @kindex layout
27694 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
27695 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
27696 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
27697
27698 @table @code
27699 @item next
27700 Display the next layout.
27701
27702 @item prev
27703 Display the previous layout.
27704
27705 @item src
27706 Display the source and command windows.
27707
27708 @item asm
27709 Display the assembly and command windows.
27710
27711 @item split
27712 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
27713
27714 @item regs
27715 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
27716 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
27717 register, assembler, and command windows.
27718 @end table
27719
27720 @item focus @var{name}
27721 @kindex focus
27722 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
27723 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
27724
27725 @table @code
27726 @item next
27727 Make the next window active for scrolling.
27728
27729 @item prev
27730 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
27731
27732 @item src
27733 Make the source window active for scrolling.
27734
27735 @item asm
27736 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
27737
27738 @item regs
27739 Make the register window active for scrolling.
27740
27741 @item cmd
27742 Make the command window active for scrolling.
27743 @end table
27744
27745 @item refresh
27746 @kindex refresh
27747 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
27748
27749 @item tui reg @var{group}
27750 @kindex tui reg
27751 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
27752 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
27753 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
27754 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
27755 following groups are available on most targets:
27756 @table @code
27757 @item next
27758 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
27759 through all of the available register groups.
27760
27761 @item prev
27762 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
27763 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
27764 @var{next}.
27765
27766 @item general
27767 Display the general registers.
27768 @item float
27769 Display the floating point registers.
27770 @item system
27771 Display the system registers.
27772 @item vector
27773 Display the vector registers.
27774 @item all
27775 Display all registers.
27776 @end table
27777
27778 @item update
27779 @kindex update
27780 Update the source window and the current execution point.
27781
27782 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
27783 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
27784 @kindex winheight
27785 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
27786 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
27787 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
27788 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
27789 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
27790 @end table
27791
27792 @node TUI Configuration
27793 @section TUI Configuration Variables
27794 @cindex TUI configuration variables
27795
27796 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
27797
27798 @table @code
27799 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
27800 @kindex set tui border-kind
27801 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
27802 The possible values are the following:
27803 @table @code
27804 @item space
27805 Use a space character to draw the border.
27806
27807 @item ascii
27808 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
27809
27810 @item acs
27811 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
27812 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
27813 @end table
27814
27815 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
27816 @kindex set tui border-mode
27817 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
27818 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
27819 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
27820 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
27821 @table @code
27822 @item normal
27823 Use normal attributes to display the border.
27824
27825 @item standout
27826 Use standout mode.
27827
27828 @item reverse
27829 Use reverse video mode.
27830
27831 @item half
27832 Use half bright mode.
27833
27834 @item half-standout
27835 Use half bright and standout mode.
27836
27837 @item bold
27838 Use extra bright or bold mode.
27839
27840 @item bold-standout
27841 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
27842 @end table
27843
27844 @item set tui tab-width @var{nchars}
27845 @kindex set tui tab-width
27846 @kindex tabset
27847 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
27848 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
27849 assembly windows.
27850 @end table
27851
27852 @node Emacs
27853 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
27854
27855 @cindex Emacs
27856 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
27857 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
27858 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
27859 @value{GDBN}.
27860
27861 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
27862 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
27863 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
27864 created Emacs buffer.
27865 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
27866
27867 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
27868 things:
27869
27870 @itemize @bullet
27871 @item
27872 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
27873 the GUD buffer.
27874
27875 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
27876 and output done by the program you are debugging.
27877
27878 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
27879 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
27880 in this way.
27881
27882 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
27883 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
27884 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
27885 stop.
27886
27887 @item
27888 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
27889
27890 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
27891 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
27892 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
27893 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
27894 and the source.
27895
27896 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
27897 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
27898 @end itemize
27899
27900 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
27901 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
27902 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
27903 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
27904
27905 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
27906 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
27907 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
27908 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
27909 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
27910 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
27911 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
27912 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
27913 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
27914
27915 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
27916 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
27917 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
27918 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
27919
27920 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
27921 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
27922 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
27923 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
27924 one you want.
27925
27926 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
27927 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
27928
27929 @table @kbd
27930 @item C-h m
27931 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
27932
27933 @item C-c C-s
27934 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
27935 update the display window to show the current file and location.
27936
27937 @item C-c C-n
27938 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
27939 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
27940 to show the current file and location.
27941
27942 @item C-c C-i
27943 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
27944 display window accordingly.
27945
27946 @item C-c C-f
27947 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
27948 @code{finish} command.
27949
27950 @item C-c C-r
27951 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
27952 command.
27953
27954 @item C-c <
27955 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
27956 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
27957 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
27958
27959 @item C-c >
27960 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
27961 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
27962 @end table
27963
27964 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
27965 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
27966
27967 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
27968 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
27969 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
27970 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
27971 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
27972 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
27973 speedbar displays watch expressions.
27974
27975 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
27976 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
27977 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
27978 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
27979 frame.
27980
27981 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
27982 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
27983 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
27984 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
27985 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
27986 to correspond properly with the code.
27987
27988 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
27989 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
27990 Emacs Manual}).
27991
27992 @node GDB/MI
27993 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
27994
27995 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
27996
27997 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
27998 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
27999 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
28000 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
28001 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
28002 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
28003
28004 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
28005 in the form of a reference manual.
28006
28007 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
28008 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
28009 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
28010
28011 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
28012
28013 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
28014 This chapter uses the following notation:
28015
28016 @itemize @bullet
28017 @item
28018 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
28019
28020 @item
28021 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
28022 it may or may not be given.
28023
28024 @item
28025 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
28026 may repeat zero or more times.
28027
28028 @item
28029 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
28030 may repeat one or more times.
28031
28032 @item
28033 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
28034 @end itemize
28035
28036 @ignore
28037 @heading Dependencies
28038 @end ignore
28039
28040 @menu
28041 * GDB/MI General Design::
28042 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
28043 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
28044 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
28045 * GDB/MI Output Records::
28046 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
28047 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
28048 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
28049 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28050 * GDB/MI Program Context::
28051 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
28052 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
28053 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
28054 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
28055 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
28056 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
28057 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
28058 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
28059 * GDB/MI File Commands::
28060 @ignore
28061 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
28062 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
28063 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
28064 @end ignore
28065 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
28066 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
28067 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
28068 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
28069 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
28070 @end menu
28071
28072 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28073 @node GDB/MI General Design
28074 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
28075 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
28076
28077 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
28078 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
28079 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
28080 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
28081 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
28082 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
28083 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
28084 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
28085 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
28086 a command and reported as part of that command response.
28087
28088 The important examples of notifications are:
28089 @itemize @bullet
28090
28091 @item
28092 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
28093 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
28094 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
28095 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
28096 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
28097 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
28098 command itself was successfully executed.
28099
28100 @item
28101 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
28102 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
28103 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
28104 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
28105 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
28106 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
28107
28108 @item
28109 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
28110 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
28111 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
28112 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
28113 orthogonal frontend design.
28114
28115 @end itemize
28116
28117 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
28118 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
28119 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
28120 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
28121 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
28122 the user interface.
28123
28124
28125 @menu
28126 * Context management::
28127 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
28128 * Thread groups::
28129 @end menu
28130
28131 @node Context management
28132 @subsection Context management
28133
28134 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
28135
28136 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
28137 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
28138 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
28139 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
28140 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
28141 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
28142 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
28143 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
28144 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
28145
28146 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
28147 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
28148 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
28149 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
28150 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
28151 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
28152 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
28153 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
28154 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
28155 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
28156 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
28157
28158 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
28159 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
28160 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
28161 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
28162 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
28163 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
28164 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
28165 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
28166 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
28167 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
28168
28169 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
28170 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
28171 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
28172 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
28173 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
28174 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
28175 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
28176 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
28177 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
28178 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
28179 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
28180 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
28181 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
28182 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
28183 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
28184 @samp{--frame} options.
28185
28186 @subsubsection Language
28187
28188 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
28189 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
28190 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
28191 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
28192 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
28193 For instance:
28194
28195 @smallexample
28196 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
28197 ^done,value="4"
28198 (gdb)
28199 @end smallexample
28200
28201 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
28202 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
28203 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
28204
28205 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
28206 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
28207
28208 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
28209 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
28210 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
28211 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
28212 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
28213 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
28214 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
28215 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
28216 @code{-list-target-features} command.
28217
28218 @table @code
28219 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
28220 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
28221 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
28222
28223 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
28224 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
28225 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
28226
28227 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
28228 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
28229 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
28230 MI commands even while the target is running.
28231
28232 @item -gdb-show mi-async
28233 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
28234 @end table
28235
28236 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
28237 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
28238 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
28239 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
28240 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
28241 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
28242
28243 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
28244 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
28245 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
28246 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
28247 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
28248 are running.
28249
28250 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
28251 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
28252 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
28253 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
28254 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
28255 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
28256 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
28257 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
28258 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
28259 @samp{--thread} option).
28260
28261 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
28262 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
28263 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
28264 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
28265
28266 @node Thread groups
28267 @subsection Thread groups
28268 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
28269 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
28270 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
28271 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
28272 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
28273
28274 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
28275 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
28276 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
28277 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
28278 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
28279 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
28280 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
28281 into processes.
28282
28283 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
28284 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
28285 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
28286 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
28287 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
28288 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
28289 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
28290 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
28291 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
28292 the members of specific thread group.
28293
28294 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
28295 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
28296 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
28297 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
28298 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
28299 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
28300 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
28301 after attaching to that thread group.
28302
28303 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
28304 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
28305 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
28306 such thread groups.
28307
28308 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28309 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
28310 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
28311
28312 @menu
28313 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
28314 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
28315 @end menu
28316
28317 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
28318 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
28319
28320 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
28321 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
28322 @table @code
28323 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
28324 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
28325
28326 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
28327 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
28328 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
28329
28330 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
28331 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
28332 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
28333
28334 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
28335 "any sequence of digits"
28336
28337 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
28338 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
28339
28340 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
28341 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
28342
28343 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
28344 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
28345
28346 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
28347 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
28348 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
28349
28350 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
28351 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
28352
28353 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
28354 @code{CR | CR-LF}
28355 @end table
28356
28357 @noindent
28358 Notes:
28359
28360 @itemize @bullet
28361 @item
28362 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
28363 output is described below.
28364
28365 @item
28366 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
28367 finishes.
28368
28369 @item
28370 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
28371 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
28372 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
28373 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
28374 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
28375 @end itemize
28376
28377 Pragmatics:
28378
28379 @itemize @bullet
28380 @item
28381 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
28382
28383 @item
28384 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
28385 @end itemize
28386
28387 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
28388 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
28389
28390 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
28391 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
28392 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
28393 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
28394 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
28395 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
28396
28397 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
28398 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
28399 @var{token}.
28400
28401 @table @code
28402 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
28403 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
28404
28405 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
28406 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
28407
28408 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
28409 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
28410
28411 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
28412 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
28413
28414 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
28415 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
28416
28417 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
28418 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
28419
28420 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
28421 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
28422
28423 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
28424 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
28425
28426 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
28427 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
28428
28429 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
28430 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
28431 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
28432
28433 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
28434 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
28435
28436 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
28437 @code{ @var{string} }
28438
28439 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
28440 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
28441
28442 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
28443 @code{@var{c-string}}
28444
28445 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
28446 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
28447
28448 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
28449 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
28450 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
28451
28452 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
28453 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
28454
28455 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
28456 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
28457
28458 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
28459 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
28460
28461 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
28462 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
28463
28464 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
28465 @code{CR | CR-LF}
28466
28467 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
28468 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
28469 @end table
28470
28471 @noindent
28472 Notes:
28473
28474 @itemize @bullet
28475 @item
28476 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
28477
28478 @item
28479 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
28480 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
28481 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
28482 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
28483 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
28484 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
28485 prior command.
28486
28487 @item
28488 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28489 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
28490 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
28491 prefixed by @samp{+}.
28492
28493 @item
28494 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28495 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
28496 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
28497 @samp{*}.
28498
28499 @item
28500 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28501 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
28502 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
28503 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
28504
28505 @item
28506 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28507 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
28508 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
28509 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
28510
28511 @item
28512 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28513 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
28514 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
28515
28516 @item
28517 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28518 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
28519 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
28520 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
28521
28522 @item
28523 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
28524 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
28525 @var{values}.
28526
28527
28528 @end itemize
28529
28530 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
28531 details about the various output records.
28532
28533 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28534 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
28535 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
28536
28537 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
28538 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
28539
28540 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
28541 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
28542 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
28543 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
28544 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
28545 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
28546
28547 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
28548 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
28549 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
28550
28551 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28552 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
28553 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
28554 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
28555
28556 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
28557 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
28558
28559 Since @sc{gdb/mi} is used by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}, changes
28560 to the MI interface may break existing usage. This section describes how the
28561 protocol changes and how to request previous version of the protocol when it
28562 does.
28563
28564 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
28565 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
28566 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
28567 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
28568
28569 @itemize @bullet
28570 @item
28571 New MI commands may be added.
28572
28573 @item
28574 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
28575
28576 @item
28577 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
28578 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
28579
28580 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
28581 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
28582
28583 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
28584 @c resolve inconsistencies.
28585 @end itemize
28586
28587 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
28588 will be increased by one. The new versions of the MI protocol are not compatible
28589 with the old versions. Old versions of MI remain available, allowing front ends
28590 to keep using them until they are modified to use the latest MI version.
28591
28592 Since @code{--interpreter=mi} always points to the latest MI version, it is
28593 recommended that front ends request a specific version of MI when launching
28594 @value{GDBN} (e.g. @code{--interpreter=mi2}) to make sure they get an
28595 interpreter with the MI version they expect.
28596
28597 The following table gives a summary of the the released versions of the MI
28598 interface: the version number, the version of GDB in which it first appeared
28599 and the breaking changes compared to the previous version.
28600
28601 @multitable @columnfractions .05 .05 .9
28602 @headitem MI version @tab GDB version @tab Breaking changes
28603
28604 @item
28605 @center 1
28606 @tab
28607 @center 5.1
28608 @tab
28609 None
28610
28611 @item
28612 @center 2
28613 @tab
28614 @center 6.0
28615 @tab
28616
28617 @itemize
28618 @item
28619 The @code{-environment-pwd}, @code{-environment-directory} and
28620 @code{-environment-path} commands now returns values using the MI output
28621 syntax, rather than CLI output syntax.
28622
28623 @item
28624 @code{-var-list-children}'s @code{children} result field is now a list, rather
28625 than a tuple.
28626
28627 @item
28628 @code{-var-update}'s @code{changelist} result field is now a list, rather than
28629 a tuple.
28630 @end itemize
28631
28632 @item
28633 @center 3
28634 @tab
28635 @center 9.1
28636 @tab
28637
28638 @itemize
28639 @item
28640 The output of information about multi-location breakpoints has changed in the
28641 responses to the @code{-break-insert} and @code{-break-info} commands, as well
28642 as in the @code{=breakpoint-created} and @code{=breakpoint-modified} events.
28643 The multiple locations are now placed in a @code{locations} field, whose value
28644 is a list.
28645 @end itemize
28646
28647 @end multitable
28648
28649 If your front end cannot yet migrate to a more recent version of the
28650 MI protocol, you can nevertheless selectively enable specific features
28651 available in those recent MI versions, using the following commands:
28652
28653 @table @code
28654
28655 @item -fix-multi-location-breakpoint-output
28656 Use the output for multi-location breakpoints which was introduced by
28657 MI 3, even when using MI versions 2 or 1. This command has no
28658 effect when using MI version 3 or later.
28659
28660 @end table
28661
28662 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
28663 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
28664 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
28665 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
28666 @cindex mailing lists
28667
28668 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28669 @node GDB/MI Output Records
28670 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
28671
28672 @menu
28673 * GDB/MI Result Records::
28674 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
28675 * GDB/MI Async Records::
28676 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
28677 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
28678 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
28679 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
28680 @end menu
28681
28682 @node GDB/MI Result Records
28683 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
28684
28685 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28686 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
28687 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
28688 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
28689
28690 @table @code
28691 @findex ^done
28692 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
28693 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
28694 values.
28695
28696 @item "^running"
28697 @findex ^running
28698 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
28699 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
28700 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
28701 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
28702 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
28703 which threads are resumed.
28704
28705 @item "^connected"
28706 @findex ^connected
28707 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
28708
28709 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
28710 @findex ^error
28711 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
28712 the corresponding error message.
28713
28714 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
28715 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
28716 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
28717
28718 @table @samp
28719 @item "undefined-command"
28720 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
28721 @end table
28722
28723 @item "^exit"
28724 @findex ^exit
28725 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
28726
28727 @end table
28728
28729 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
28730 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
28731
28732 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
28733 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28734 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
28735 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
28736 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
28737
28738 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
28739 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
28740 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
28741 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
28742 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
28743
28744 @table @code
28745 @item "~" @var{string-output}
28746 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
28747 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
28748
28749 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
28750 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
28751 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
28752 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
28753
28754 @item "&" @var{string-output}
28755 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
28756 internals.
28757 @end table
28758
28759 @node GDB/MI Async Records
28760 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
28761
28762 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
28763 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
28764 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
28765 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
28766 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
28767 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
28768
28769 The following is the list of possible async records:
28770
28771 @table @code
28772
28773 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
28774 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
28775 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
28776 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
28777 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
28778 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
28779 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
28780 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
28781 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
28782 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
28783 it run freely.
28784
28785 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
28786 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
28787 following values:
28788
28789 @table @code
28790 @item breakpoint-hit
28791 A breakpoint was reached.
28792 @item watchpoint-trigger
28793 A watchpoint was triggered.
28794 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
28795 A read watchpoint was triggered.
28796 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
28797 An access watchpoint was triggered.
28798 @item function-finished
28799 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28800 @item location-reached
28801 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
28802 @item watchpoint-scope
28803 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
28804 @item end-stepping-range
28805 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
28806 similar CLI command was accomplished.
28807 @item exited-signalled
28808 The inferior exited because of a signal.
28809 @item exited
28810 The inferior exited.
28811 @item exited-normally
28812 The inferior exited normally.
28813 @item signal-received
28814 A signal was received by the inferior.
28815 @item solib-event
28816 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
28817 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
28818 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
28819 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
28820 @item fork
28821 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
28822 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28823 @item vfork
28824 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
28825 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28826 @item syscall-entry
28827 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
28828 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28829 @item syscall-return
28830 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
28831 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28832 @item exec
28833 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
28834 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
28835 @end table
28836
28837 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
28838 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
28839 Depending on whether all-stop
28840 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
28841 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
28842 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
28843 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
28844 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
28845 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
28846 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
28847 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
28848 if such information is not available.
28849
28850 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
28851 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
28852 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
28853 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
28854 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
28855 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
28856 cannot be used in any way.
28857
28858 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
28859 A thread group became associated with a running program,
28860 either because the program was just started or the thread group
28861 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
28862 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
28863 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
28864
28865 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
28866 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
28867 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
28868 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
28869 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
28870 only when the inferior exited with some code.
28871
28872 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28873 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
28874 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
28875 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
28876 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
28877
28878 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
28879 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
28880 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
28881 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
28882 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
28883 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
28884 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
28885 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
28886 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
28887
28888 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
28889 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
28890
28891 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
28892 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
28893 that thread.
28894
28895 @item =library-loaded,...
28896 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
28897 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
28898 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
28899 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
28900 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
28901 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
28902 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
28903 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
28904 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
28905 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
28906 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
28907 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
28908 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
28909 to this library.
28910
28911 @item =library-unloaded,...
28912 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
28913 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
28914 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
28915 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
28916 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
28917 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
28918 thread groups.
28919
28920 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
28921 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
28922 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
28923 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
28924 frame is @var{tpnum}.
28925
28926 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
28927 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
28928 initial value @var{initial}.
28929
28930 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
28931 @itemx =tsv-deleted
28932 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
28933 trace state variables are deleted.
28934
28935 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
28936 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
28937 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
28938 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
28939 value of trace state variable is known.
28940
28941 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
28942 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
28943 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
28944 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
28945 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
28946 user.
28947
28948 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
28949 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
28950 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
28951
28952 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
28953 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
28954
28955 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
28956 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
28957 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
28958 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
28959 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
28960
28961 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
28962 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
28963 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
28964 for existing method and format values.
28965
28966 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
28967 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
28968 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
28969 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
28970 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
28971 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
28972
28973 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
28974 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
28975 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
28976 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
28977 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
28978 executable code.
28979 @end table
28980
28981 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
28982 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
28983
28984 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
28985 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
28986 following fields:
28987
28988 @table @code
28989 @item number
28990 The breakpoint number.
28991
28992 @item type
28993 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
28994 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
28995
28996 @item catch-type
28997 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
28998 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
28999
29000 @item disp
29001 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
29002 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
29003 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
29004
29005 @item enabled
29006 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
29007 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
29008 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
29009
29010 @item addr
29011 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
29012 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
29013 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
29014 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
29015 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
29016
29017 @item addr_flags
29018 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
29019 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
29020 particular CPU.
29021
29022 @item func
29023 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
29024 If not known, this field is not present.
29025
29026 @item filename
29027 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
29028 If not known, this field is not present.
29029
29030 @item fullname
29031 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
29032 known. If not known, this field is not present.
29033
29034 @item line
29035 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
29036 If not known, this field is not present.
29037
29038 @item at
29039 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
29040 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
29041 by a symbol name.
29042
29043 @item pending
29044 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
29045 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
29046
29047 @item evaluated-by
29048 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
29049 @samp{target}.
29050
29051 @item thread
29052 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
29053 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
29054
29055 @item task
29056 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
29057 field will hold the task identifier.
29058
29059 @item cond
29060 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
29061
29062 @item ignore
29063 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
29064
29065 @item enable
29066 The enable count of the breakpoint.
29067
29068 @item traceframe-usage
29069 FIXME.
29070
29071 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
29072 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
29073
29074 @item mask
29075 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
29076
29077 @item pass
29078 A tracepoint's pass count.
29079
29080 @item original-location
29081 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
29082 This field is optional.
29083
29084 @item times
29085 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
29086
29087 @item installed
29088 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
29089 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
29090 is not.
29091
29092 @item what
29093 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
29094
29095 @item locations
29096 This field is present if the breakpoint has multiple locations. It is also
29097 exceptionally present if the breakpoint is enabled and has a single, disabled
29098 location.
29099
29100 The value is a list of locations. The format of a location is decribed below.
29101
29102 @end table
29103
29104 A location in a multi-location breakpoint is represented as a tuple with the
29105 following fields:
29106
29107 @table @code
29108
29109 @item number
29110 The location number as a dotted pair, like @samp{1.2}. The first digit is the
29111 number of the parent breakpoint. The second digit is the number of the
29112 location within that breakpoint.
29113
29114 @item enabled
29115 This indicates whether the location is enabled, in which case the
29116 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
29117 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
29118
29119 @item addr
29120 The address of this location as an hexidecimal number.
29121
29122 @item addr_flags
29123 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
29124 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
29125 particular CPU.
29126
29127 @item func
29128 If known, the function in which the location appears.
29129 If not known, this field is not present.
29130
29131 @item file
29132 The name of the source file which contains this location, if known.
29133 If not known, this field is not present.
29134
29135 @item fullname
29136 The full file name of the source file which contains this location, if
29137 known. If not known, this field is not present.
29138
29139 @item line
29140 The line number at which this location appears, if known.
29141 If not known, this field is not present.
29142
29143 @item thread-groups
29144 The thread groups this location is in.
29145
29146 @end table
29147
29148 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
29149 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
29150
29151 @smallexample
29152 -> -break-insert main
29153 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29154 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29155 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
29156 times="0"@}
29157 <- (gdb)
29158 @end smallexample
29159
29160 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
29161 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
29162
29163 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
29164 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
29165 fields:
29166
29167 @table @code
29168 @item level
29169 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
29170 zero. This field is always present.
29171
29172 @item func
29173 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
29174 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
29175
29176 @item addr
29177 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
29178
29179 @item addr_flags
29180 Optional field containing any flags related to the address. These flags are
29181 architecture-dependent; see @ref{Architectures} for their meaning for a
29182 particular CPU.
29183
29184 @item file
29185 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
29186 address. This field may be absent.
29187
29188 @item line
29189 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
29190 may be absent.
29191
29192 @item from
29193 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
29194 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
29195
29196 @end table
29197
29198 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
29199 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
29200
29201 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
29202 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
29203 stated otherwise.
29204
29205 @table @code
29206 @item id
29207 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
29208
29209 @item target-id
29210 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
29211
29212 @item details
29213 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
29214 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
29215 frontend. This field is optional.
29216
29217 @item name
29218 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
29219 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
29220 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
29221 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
29222 field is omitted.
29223
29224 @item state
29225 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
29226 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
29227
29228 @item frame
29229 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
29230 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
29231 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
29232
29233 @item core
29234 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
29235 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
29236 @end table
29237
29238 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
29239 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
29240
29241 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
29242 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
29243 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
29244 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
29245 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
29246 the @code{exception-message} field.
29247
29248 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29249 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
29250 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
29251 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
29252
29253 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
29254 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
29255 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
29256 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
29257
29258 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
29259 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
29260
29261 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
29262
29263 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
29264 information of the breakpoint.
29265
29266 @smallexample
29267 -> -break-insert main
29268 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29269 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
29270 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
29271 times="0"@}
29272 <- (gdb)
29273 @end smallexample
29274
29275 @subheading Program Execution
29276
29277 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
29278 reason that execution stopped.
29279
29280 @smallexample
29281 -> -exec-run
29282 <- ^running
29283 <- (gdb)
29284 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
29285 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
29286 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
29287 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",
29288 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29289 <- (gdb)
29290 -> -exec-continue
29291 <- ^running
29292 <- (gdb)
29293 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29294 <- (gdb)
29295 @end smallexample
29296
29297 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
29298
29299 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
29300
29301 @smallexample
29302 -> (gdb)
29303 <- -gdb-exit
29304 <- ^exit
29305 @end smallexample
29306
29307 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
29308 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
29309 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
29310 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
29311 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
29312 fails to exit in reasonable time.
29313
29314 @subheading A Bad Command
29315
29316 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
29317
29318 @smallexample
29319 -> -rubbish
29320 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
29321 <- (gdb)
29322 @end smallexample
29323
29324
29325 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29326 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
29327 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
29328
29329 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
29330 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
29331
29332 @subheading Motivation
29333
29334 The motivation for this collection of commands.
29335
29336 @subheading Introduction
29337
29338 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
29339
29340 @subheading Commands
29341
29342 For each command in the block, the following is described:
29343
29344 @subsubheading Synopsis
29345
29346 @smallexample
29347 -command @var{args}@dots{}
29348 @end smallexample
29349
29350 @subsubheading Result
29351
29352 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29353
29354 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
29355
29356 @subsubheading Example
29357
29358 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
29359 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
29360
29361
29362 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29363 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
29364 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
29365
29366 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
29367 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
29368 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
29369 breakpoints.
29370
29371 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
29372 @findex -break-after
29373
29374 @subsubheading Synopsis
29375
29376 @smallexample
29377 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
29378 @end smallexample
29379
29380 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
29381 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
29382 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
29383 @samp{-break-list} command below.
29384
29385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29386
29387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
29388
29389 @subsubheading Example
29390
29391 @smallexample
29392 (gdb)
29393 -break-insert main
29394 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29395 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
29396 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29397 times="0"@}
29398 (gdb)
29399 -break-after 1 3
29400 ~
29401 ^done
29402 (gdb)
29403 -break-list
29404 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29405 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29406 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29407 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29408 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29409 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29410 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29411 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29412 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29413 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
29414 (gdb)
29415 @end smallexample
29416
29417 @ignore
29418 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
29419 @findex -break-catch
29420 @end ignore
29421
29422 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
29423 @findex -break-commands
29424
29425 @subsubheading Synopsis
29426
29427 @smallexample
29428 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
29429 @end smallexample
29430
29431 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
29432 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
29433 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
29434 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
29435 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
29436 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
29437
29438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29439
29440 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
29441
29442 @subsubheading Example
29443
29444 @smallexample
29445 (gdb)
29446 -break-insert main
29447 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
29448 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
29449 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29450 times="0"@}
29451 (gdb)
29452 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
29453 ^done
29454 (gdb)
29455 @end smallexample
29456
29457 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
29458 @findex -break-condition
29459
29460 @subsubheading Synopsis
29461
29462 @smallexample
29463 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
29464 @end smallexample
29465
29466 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
29467 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
29468 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
29469 command below).
29470
29471 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29472
29473 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
29474
29475 @subsubheading Example
29476
29477 @smallexample
29478 (gdb)
29479 -break-condition 1 1
29480 ^done
29481 (gdb)
29482 -break-list
29483 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29484 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29485 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29486 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29487 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29488 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29489 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29490 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29491 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29492 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
29493 (gdb)
29494 @end smallexample
29495
29496 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
29497 @findex -break-delete
29498
29499 @subsubheading Synopsis
29500
29501 @smallexample
29502 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
29503 @end smallexample
29504
29505 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
29506 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
29507
29508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29509
29510 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
29511
29512 @subsubheading Example
29513
29514 @smallexample
29515 (gdb)
29516 -break-delete 1
29517 ^done
29518 (gdb)
29519 -break-list
29520 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
29521 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29522 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29523 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29524 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29525 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29526 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29527 body=[]@}
29528 (gdb)
29529 @end smallexample
29530
29531 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
29532 @findex -break-disable
29533
29534 @subsubheading Synopsis
29535
29536 @smallexample
29537 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
29538 @end smallexample
29539
29540 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
29541 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
29542
29543 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29544
29545 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
29546
29547 @subsubheading Example
29548
29549 @smallexample
29550 (gdb)
29551 -break-disable 2
29552 ^done
29553 (gdb)
29554 -break-list
29555 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29556 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29557 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29558 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29559 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29560 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29561 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29562 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
29563 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29564 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29565 (gdb)
29566 @end smallexample
29567
29568 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
29569 @findex -break-enable
29570
29571 @subsubheading Synopsis
29572
29573 @smallexample
29574 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
29575 @end smallexample
29576
29577 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
29578
29579 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29580
29581 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
29582
29583 @subsubheading Example
29584
29585 @smallexample
29586 (gdb)
29587 -break-enable 2
29588 ^done
29589 (gdb)
29590 -break-list
29591 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
29592 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29593 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29594 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29595 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29596 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29597 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29598 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29599 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29600 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29601 (gdb)
29602 @end smallexample
29603
29604 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
29605 @findex -break-info
29606
29607 @subsubheading Synopsis
29608
29609 @smallexample
29610 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
29611 @end smallexample
29612
29613 @c REDUNDANT???
29614 Get information about a single breakpoint.
29615
29616 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
29617 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
29618 table.
29619
29620 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29621
29622 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
29623
29624 @subsubheading Example
29625 N.A.
29626
29627 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
29628 @findex -break-insert
29629 @anchor{-break-insert}
29630
29631 @subsubheading Synopsis
29632
29633 @smallexample
29634 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
29635 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
29636 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
29637 @end smallexample
29638
29639 @noindent
29640 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
29641
29642 @table @var
29643 @item linespec location
29644 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
29645
29646 @item explicit location
29647 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
29648 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
29649 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
29650
29651 @table @samp
29652 @item --source @var{filename}
29653 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
29654 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
29655
29656 @item --function @var{function}
29657 The name of a function or method.
29658
29659 @item --label @var{label}
29660 The name of a label.
29661
29662 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
29663 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
29664 @end table
29665
29666 @item address location
29667 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
29668 @end table
29669
29670 @noindent
29671 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
29672
29673 @table @samp
29674 @item -t
29675 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
29676 @item -h
29677 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
29678 @item -f
29679 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
29680 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
29681 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
29682 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
29683 cannot be parsed.
29684 @item -d
29685 Create a disabled breakpoint.
29686 @item -a
29687 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
29688 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
29689 @item -c @var{condition}
29690 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29691 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
29692 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
29693 @item -p @var{thread-id}
29694 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
29695 @var{thread-id}.
29696 @end table
29697
29698 @subsubheading Result
29699
29700 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
29701 resulting breakpoint.
29702
29703 Note: this format is open to change.
29704 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
29705
29706 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29707
29708 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
29709 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
29710
29711 @subsubheading Example
29712
29713 @smallexample
29714 (gdb)
29715 -break-insert main
29716 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
29717 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
29718 times="0"@}
29719 (gdb)
29720 -break-insert -t foo
29721 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
29722 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29723 times="0"@}
29724 (gdb)
29725 -break-list
29726 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29727 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29728 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29729 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29730 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29731 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29732 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29733 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29734 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
29735 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
29736 times="0"@},
29737 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
29738 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
29739 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29740 times="0"@}]@}
29741 (gdb)
29742 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
29743 @c ~int foo(int, int);
29744 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
29745 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
29746 @c times="0"@}
29747 @c (gdb)
29748 @end smallexample
29749
29750 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
29751 @findex -dprintf-insert
29752
29753 @subsubheading Synopsis
29754
29755 @smallexample
29756 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
29757 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
29758 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
29759 [ @var{argument} ]
29760 @end smallexample
29761
29762 @noindent
29763 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
29764 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
29765
29766 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
29767
29768 @table @samp
29769 @item -t
29770 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
29771 @item -f
29772 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
29773 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
29774 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
29775 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
29776 cannot be parsed.
29777 @item -d
29778 Create a disabled breakpoint.
29779 @item -c @var{condition}
29780 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
29781 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
29782 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
29783 to @var{ignore-count}.
29784 @item -p @var{thread-id}
29785 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
29786 @var{thread-id}.
29787 @end table
29788
29789 @subsubheading Result
29790
29791 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
29792 resulting breakpoint.
29793
29794 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
29795
29796 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29797
29798 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
29799
29800 @subsubheading Example
29801
29802 @smallexample
29803 (gdb)
29804 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
29805 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29806 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29807 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
29808 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
29809 original-location="foo"@}
29810 (gdb)
29811 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
29812 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29813 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
29814 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
29815 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
29816 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
29817 (gdb)
29818 @end smallexample
29819
29820 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
29821 @findex -break-list
29822
29823 @subsubheading Synopsis
29824
29825 @smallexample
29826 -break-list
29827 @end smallexample
29828
29829 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
29830
29831 @table @samp
29832 @item Number
29833 number of the breakpoint
29834 @item Type
29835 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
29836 @item Disposition
29837 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
29838 or @samp{nokeep}
29839 @item Enabled
29840 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
29841 @item Address
29842 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
29843 @item What
29844 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
29845 name, line number
29846 @item Thread-groups
29847 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
29848 @item Times
29849 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
29850 @end table
29851
29852 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
29853 @code{body} field is an empty list.
29854
29855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29856
29857 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
29858
29859 @subsubheading Example
29860
29861 @smallexample
29862 (gdb)
29863 -break-list
29864 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29865 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29866 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29867 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29868 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29869 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29870 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29871 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29872 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
29873 times="0"@},
29874 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
29875 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
29876 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
29877 (gdb)
29878 @end smallexample
29879
29880 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
29881
29882 @smallexample
29883 (gdb)
29884 -break-list
29885 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
29886 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29887 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29888 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
29889 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
29890 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
29891 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
29892 body=[]@}
29893 (gdb)
29894 @end smallexample
29895
29896 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
29897 @findex -break-passcount
29898
29899 @subsubheading Synopsis
29900
29901 @smallexample
29902 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
29903 @end smallexample
29904
29905 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
29906 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
29907 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
29908 command @samp{passcount}.
29909
29910 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
29911 @findex -break-watch
29912
29913 @subsubheading Synopsis
29914
29915 @smallexample
29916 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
29917 @end smallexample
29918
29919 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
29920 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
29921 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
29922 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
29923 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
29924 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
29925 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
29926 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
29927
29928 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
29929 breakpoints inserted.
29930
29931 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29932
29933 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
29934 @samp{rwatch}.
29935
29936 @subsubheading Example
29937
29938 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
29939
29940 @smallexample
29941 (gdb)
29942 -break-watch x
29943 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
29944 (gdb)
29945 -exec-continue
29946 ^running
29947 (gdb)
29948 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
29949 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
29950 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29951 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29952 (gdb)
29953 @end smallexample
29954
29955 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
29956 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
29957 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
29958
29959 @smallexample
29960 (gdb)
29961 -break-watch C
29962 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
29963 (gdb)
29964 -exec-continue
29965 ^running
29966 (gdb)
29967 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
29968 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
29969 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29970 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29971 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
29972 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29973 (gdb)
29974 -exec-continue
29975 ^running
29976 (gdb)
29977 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
29978 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
29979 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29980 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29981 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
29982 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
29983 (gdb)
29984 @end smallexample
29985
29986 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
29987 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
29988 deleted.
29989
29990 @smallexample
29991 (gdb)
29992 -break-watch C
29993 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
29994 (gdb)
29995 -break-list
29996 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
29997 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
29998 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
29999 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30000 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30001 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30002 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30003 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30004 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30005 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30006 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
30007 times="1"@},
30008 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
30009 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
30010 (gdb)
30011 -exec-continue
30012 ^running
30013 (gdb)
30014 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
30015 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
30016 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
30017 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30018 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13",
30019 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30020 (gdb)
30021 -break-list
30022 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
30023 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30024 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30025 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30026 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30027 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30028 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30029 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30030 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30031 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30032 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
30033 times="1"@},
30034 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
30035 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
30036 (gdb)
30037 -exec-continue
30038 ^running
30039 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
30040 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
30041 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
30042 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30043 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
30044 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30045 (gdb)
30046 -break-list
30047 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
30048 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
30049 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
30050 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
30051 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
30052 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
30053 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
30054 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30055 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30056 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30057 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
30058 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
30059 (gdb)
30060 @end smallexample
30061
30062
30063 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30064 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30065 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
30066
30067 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
30068 catchpoints.
30069
30070 @menu
30071 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
30072 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
30073 * C++ Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
30074 @end menu
30075
30076 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30077 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
30078
30079 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
30080 @findex -catch-load
30081
30082 @subsubheading Synopsis
30083
30084 @smallexample
30085 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
30086 @end smallexample
30087
30088 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
30089 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
30090 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
30091 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
30092 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
30093
30094
30095 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30096
30097 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
30098
30099 @subsubheading Example
30100
30101 @smallexample
30102 -catch-load -t foo.so
30103 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
30104 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
30105 (gdb)
30106 @end smallexample
30107
30108
30109 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
30110 @findex -catch-unload
30111
30112 @subsubheading Synopsis
30113
30114 @smallexample
30115 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
30116 @end smallexample
30117
30118 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
30119 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
30120 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
30121 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
30122 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
30123
30124 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30125
30126 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
30127
30128 @subsubheading Example
30129
30130 @smallexample
30131 -catch-unload -d bar.so
30132 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
30133 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
30134 (gdb)
30135 @end smallexample
30136
30137 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30138 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
30139
30140 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
30141 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
30142
30143 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
30144 @findex -catch-assert
30145
30146 @subsubheading Synopsis
30147
30148 @smallexample
30149 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
30150 @end smallexample
30151
30152 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
30153
30154 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30155
30156 @table @samp
30157 @item -c @var{condition}
30158 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30159 @item -d
30160 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30161 @item -t
30162 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30163 @end table
30164
30165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30166
30167 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
30168
30169 @subsubheading Example
30170
30171 @smallexample
30172 -catch-assert
30173 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30174 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
30175 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
30176 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
30177 (gdb)
30178 @end smallexample
30179
30180 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
30181 @findex -catch-exception
30182
30183 @subsubheading Synopsis
30184
30185 @smallexample
30186 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
30187 [ -t ] [ -u ]
30188 @end smallexample
30189
30190 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
30191 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
30192 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
30193 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
30194 catchpoints.
30195
30196 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30197
30198 @table @samp
30199 @item -c @var{condition}
30200 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30201 @item -d
30202 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30203 @item -e @var{exception-name}
30204 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
30205 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
30206 @item -t
30207 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30208 @item -u
30209 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
30210 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
30211 @end table
30212
30213 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30214
30215 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
30216 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
30217
30218 @subsubheading Example
30219
30220 @smallexample
30221 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
30222 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30223 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
30224 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
30225 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
30226 (gdb)
30227 @end smallexample
30228
30229 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
30230 @findex -catch-handlers
30231
30232 @subsubheading Synopsis
30233
30234 @smallexample
30235 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
30236 [ -t ]
30237 @end smallexample
30238
30239 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
30240 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
30241 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
30242 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
30243 catchpoints.
30244
30245 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
30246
30247 @table @samp
30248 @item -c @var{condition}
30249 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
30250 @item -d
30251 Create a disabled catchpoint.
30252 @item -e @var{exception-name}
30253 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
30254 @item -t
30255 Create a temporary catchpoint.
30256 @end table
30257
30258 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30259
30260 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
30261
30262 @subsubheading Example
30263
30264 @smallexample
30265 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
30266 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
30267 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
30268 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
30269 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
30270 (gdb)
30271 @end smallexample
30272
30273 @node C++ Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
30274 @subsection C@t{++} Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
30275
30276 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
30277 that stop the execution when C@t{++} exceptions are being throw, rethrown,
30278 or caught.
30279
30280 @subheading The @code{-catch-throw} Command
30281 @findex -catch-throw
30282
30283 @subsubheading Synopsis
30284
30285 @smallexample
30286 -catch-throw [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
30287 @end smallexample
30288
30289 Stop when the debuggee throws a C@t{++} exception. If @var{regexp} is
30290 given, then only exceptions whose type matches the regular expression
30291 will be caught.
30292
30293 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
30294 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after stopping once for
30295 the event.
30296
30297 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30298
30299 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch throw}
30300 and @samp{tcatch throw} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
30301
30302 @subsubheading Example
30303
30304 @smallexample
30305 -catch-throw -r exception_type
30306 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30307 what="exception throw",catch-type="throw",
30308 thread-groups=["i1"],
30309 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
30310 (gdb)
30311 -exec-run
30312 ^running
30313 (gdb)
30314 ~"\n"
30315 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception thrown), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
30316 in __cxa_throw () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
30317 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
30318 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_throw",
30319 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
30320 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
30321 (gdb)
30322 @end smallexample
30323
30324 @subheading The @code{-catch-rethrow} Command
30325 @findex -catch-rethrow
30326
30327 @subsubheading Synopsis
30328
30329 @smallexample
30330 -catch-rethrow [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
30331 @end smallexample
30332
30333 Stop when a C@t{++} exception is re-thrown. If @var{regexp} is given,
30334 then only exceptions whose type matches the regular expression will be
30335 caught.
30336
30337 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
30338 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after the first event is
30339 caught.
30340
30341 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30342
30343 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch rethrow}
30344 and @samp{tcatch rethrow} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
30345
30346 @subsubheading Example
30347
30348 @smallexample
30349 -catch-rethrow -r exception_type
30350 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30351 what="exception rethrow",catch-type="rethrow",
30352 thread-groups=["i1"],
30353 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
30354 (gdb)
30355 -exec-run
30356 ^running
30357 (gdb)
30358 ~"\n"
30359 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception rethrown), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
30360 in __cxa_rethrow () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
30361 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
30362 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_rethrow",
30363 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
30364 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
30365 (gdb)
30366 @end smallexample
30367
30368 @subheading The @code{-catch-catch} Command
30369 @findex -catch-catch
30370
30371 @subsubheading Synopsis
30372
30373 @smallexample
30374 -catch-catch [ -t ] [ -r @var{regexp}]
30375 @end smallexample
30376
30377 Stop when the debuggee catches a C@t{++} exception. If @var{regexp}
30378 is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the regular
30379 expression will be caught.
30380
30381 If @samp{-t} is given, then the catchpoint is enabled only for one
30382 stop, the catchpoint is automatically deleted after the first event is
30383 caught.
30384
30385 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30386
30387 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch catch}
30388 and @samp{tcatch catch} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
30389
30390 @subsubheading Example
30391
30392 @smallexample
30393 -catch-catch -r exception_type
30394 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
30395 what="exception catch",catch-type="catch",
30396 thread-groups=["i1"],
30397 regexp="exception_type",times="0"@}
30398 (gdb)
30399 -exec-run
30400 ^running
30401 (gdb)
30402 ~"\n"
30403 ~"Catchpoint 1 (exception caught), 0x00007ffff7ae00ed
30404 in __cxa_begin_catch () from /lib64/libstdc++.so.6\n"
30405 *stopped,bkptno="1",reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",
30406 frame=@{addr="0x00007ffff7ae00ed",func="__cxa_begin_catch",
30407 args=[],from="/lib64/libstdc++.so.6",arch="i386:x86-64"@},
30408 thread-id="1",stopped-threads="all",core="6"
30409 (gdb)
30410 @end smallexample
30411
30412 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30413 @node GDB/MI Program Context
30414 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
30415
30416 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
30417 @findex -exec-arguments
30418
30419
30420 @subsubheading Synopsis
30421
30422 @smallexample
30423 -exec-arguments @var{args}
30424 @end smallexample
30425
30426 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
30427 @samp{-exec-run}.
30428
30429 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30430
30431 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
30432
30433 @subsubheading Example
30434
30435 @smallexample
30436 (gdb)
30437 -exec-arguments -v word
30438 ^done
30439 (gdb)
30440 @end smallexample
30441
30442
30443 @ignore
30444 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
30445 @findex -exec-show-arguments
30446
30447 @subsubheading Synopsis
30448
30449 @smallexample
30450 -exec-show-arguments
30451 @end smallexample
30452
30453 Print the arguments of the program.
30454
30455 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30456
30457 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
30458
30459 @subsubheading Example
30460 N.A.
30461 @end ignore
30462
30463
30464 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
30465 @findex -environment-cd
30466
30467 @subsubheading Synopsis
30468
30469 @smallexample
30470 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
30471 @end smallexample
30472
30473 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
30474
30475 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30476
30477 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
30478
30479 @subsubheading Example
30480
30481 @smallexample
30482 (gdb)
30483 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
30484 ^done
30485 (gdb)
30486 @end smallexample
30487
30488
30489 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
30490 @findex -environment-directory
30491
30492 @subsubheading Synopsis
30493
30494 @smallexample
30495 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
30496 @end smallexample
30497
30498 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
30499 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
30500 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
30501 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
30502 occurs as normal.
30503 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
30504 multiple directories in a single command
30505 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
30506 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
30507 If blanks are needed as
30508 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
30509 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
30510 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
30511 character must not be used
30512 in any directory name.
30513 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
30514
30515 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30516
30517 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
30518
30519 @subsubheading Example
30520
30521 @smallexample
30522 (gdb)
30523 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
30524 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
30525 (gdb)
30526 -environment-directory ""
30527 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
30528 (gdb)
30529 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
30530 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
30531 (gdb)
30532 -environment-directory -r
30533 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
30534 (gdb)
30535 @end smallexample
30536
30537
30538 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
30539 @findex -environment-path
30540
30541 @subsubheading Synopsis
30542
30543 @smallexample
30544 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
30545 @end smallexample
30546
30547 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
30548 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
30549 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
30550 supplied in addition to the
30551 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
30552 occurs as normal.
30553 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
30554 multiple directories in a single command
30555 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
30556 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
30557 If blanks are needed as
30558 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
30559 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
30560 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
30561 character must not be used
30562 in any directory name.
30563 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
30564
30565
30566 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30567
30568 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
30569
30570 @subsubheading Example
30571
30572 @smallexample
30573 (gdb)
30574 -environment-path
30575 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
30576 (gdb)
30577 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
30578 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
30579 (gdb)
30580 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
30581 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
30582 (gdb)
30583 @end smallexample
30584
30585
30586 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
30587 @findex -environment-pwd
30588
30589 @subsubheading Synopsis
30590
30591 @smallexample
30592 -environment-pwd
30593 @end smallexample
30594
30595 Show the current working directory.
30596
30597 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30598
30599 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
30600
30601 @subsubheading Example
30602
30603 @smallexample
30604 (gdb)
30605 -environment-pwd
30606 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
30607 (gdb)
30608 @end smallexample
30609
30610 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30611 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
30612 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
30613
30614
30615 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
30616 @findex -thread-info
30617
30618 @subsubheading Synopsis
30619
30620 @smallexample
30621 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
30622 @end smallexample
30623
30624 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
30625 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
30626 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
30627 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
30628 current thread.
30629
30630 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30631
30632 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
30633 about all threads.
30634
30635 @subsubheading Result
30636
30637 The result contains the following attributes:
30638
30639 @table @samp
30640 @item threads
30641 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
30642 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
30643
30644 @item current-thread-id
30645 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
30646 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
30647 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
30648 the command.
30649
30650 @end table
30651
30652 @subsubheading Example
30653
30654 @smallexample
30655 -thread-info
30656 ^done,threads=[
30657 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
30658 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
30659 args=[]@},state="running"@},
30660 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
30661 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
30662 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
30663 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30664 state="running"@}],
30665 current-thread-id="1"
30666 (gdb)
30667 @end smallexample
30668
30669 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
30670 @findex -thread-list-ids
30671
30672 @subsubheading Synopsis
30673
30674 @smallexample
30675 -thread-list-ids
30676 @end smallexample
30677
30678 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
30679 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
30680 threads.
30681
30682 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
30683 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
30684
30685 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30686
30687 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
30688
30689 @subsubheading Example
30690
30691 @smallexample
30692 (gdb)
30693 -thread-list-ids
30694 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
30695 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
30696 (gdb)
30697 @end smallexample
30698
30699
30700 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
30701 @findex -thread-select
30702
30703 @subsubheading Synopsis
30704
30705 @smallexample
30706 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
30707 @end smallexample
30708
30709 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
30710 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
30711 topmost frame for that thread.
30712
30713 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
30714 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
30715
30716 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30717
30718 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
30719
30720 @subsubheading Example
30721
30722 @smallexample
30723 (gdb)
30724 -exec-next
30725 ^running
30726 (gdb)
30727 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
30728 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
30729 (gdb)
30730 -thread-list-ids
30731 ^done,
30732 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
30733 number-of-threads="3"
30734 (gdb)
30735 -thread-select 3
30736 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
30737 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
30738 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
30739 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30740 (gdb)
30741 @end smallexample
30742
30743 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30744 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
30745 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
30746
30747 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
30748 @findex -ada-task-info
30749
30750 @subsubheading Synopsis
30751
30752 @smallexample
30753 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
30754 @end smallexample
30755
30756 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
30757 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
30758
30759 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30760
30761 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
30762 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
30763
30764 @subsubheading Result
30765
30766 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
30767 defined for each Ada task:
30768
30769 @table @samp
30770 @item current
30771 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
30772
30773 @item id
30774 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
30775
30776 @item task-id
30777 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
30778
30779 @item thread-id
30780 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
30781 task.
30782
30783 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
30784 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
30785 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
30786
30787 @item parent-id
30788 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
30789 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
30790
30791 @item priority
30792 The base priority of the task.
30793
30794 @item state
30795 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
30796 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
30797
30798 @item name
30799 The name of the task.
30800
30801 @end table
30802
30803 @subsubheading Example
30804
30805 @smallexample
30806 -ada-task-info
30807 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
30808 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
30809 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
30810 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
30811 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
30812 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
30813 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
30814 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
30815 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
30816 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
30817 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
30818 (gdb)
30819 @end smallexample
30820
30821 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30822 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
30823 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
30824
30825 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
30826 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
30827 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
30828 other cases.
30829
30830 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
30831 @findex -exec-continue
30832
30833 @subsubheading Synopsis
30834
30835 @smallexample
30836 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
30837 @end smallexample
30838
30839 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
30840 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
30841 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
30842 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
30843 @itemize @bullet
30844 @item
30845 breakpoints or watchpoints
30846 @item
30847 signals or exceptions
30848 @item
30849 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
30850 @item
30851 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
30852 @end itemize
30853 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
30854 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
30855 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
30856 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
30857 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
30858 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
30859
30860 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30861
30862 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
30863
30864 @subsubheading Example
30865
30866 @smallexample
30867 -exec-continue
30868 ^running
30869 (gdb)
30870 @@Hello world
30871 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
30872 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
30873 line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30874 (gdb)
30875 @end smallexample
30876
30877
30878 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
30879 @findex -exec-finish
30880
30881 @subsubheading Synopsis
30882
30883 @smallexample
30884 -exec-finish [--reverse]
30885 @end smallexample
30886
30887 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
30888 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
30889 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
30890 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
30891 function was called.
30892
30893 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30894
30895 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
30896
30897 @subsubheading Example
30898
30899 Function returning @code{void}.
30900
30901 @smallexample
30902 -exec-finish
30903 ^running
30904 (gdb)
30905 @@hello from foo
30906 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
30907 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30908 (gdb)
30909 @end smallexample
30910
30911 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
30912 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
30913 value itself.
30914
30915 @smallexample
30916 -exec-finish
30917 ^running
30918 (gdb)
30919 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
30920 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
30921 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
30922 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
30923 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
30924 (gdb)
30925 @end smallexample
30926
30927
30928 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
30929 @findex -exec-interrupt
30930
30931 @subsubheading Synopsis
30932
30933 @smallexample
30934 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
30935 @end smallexample
30936
30937 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
30938 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
30939 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
30940 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
30941 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
30942
30943 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
30944 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
30945 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
30946 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
30947
30948 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
30949 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
30950 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
30951 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
30952
30953 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30954
30955 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
30956
30957 @subsubheading Example
30958
30959 @smallexample
30960 (gdb)
30961 111-exec-continue
30962 111^running
30963
30964 (gdb)
30965 222-exec-interrupt
30966 222^done
30967 (gdb)
30968 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
30969 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
30970 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
30971 (gdb)
30972
30973 (gdb)
30974 -exec-interrupt
30975 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
30976 (gdb)
30977 @end smallexample
30978
30979 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
30980 @findex -exec-jump
30981
30982 @subsubheading Synopsis
30983
30984 @smallexample
30985 -exec-jump @var{location}
30986 @end smallexample
30987
30988 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
30989 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
30990 different forms of @var{location}.
30991
30992 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30993
30994 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
30995
30996 @subsubheading Example
30997
30998 @smallexample
30999 -exec-jump foo.c:10
31000 *running,thread-id="all"
31001 ^running
31002 @end smallexample
31003
31004
31005 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
31006 @findex -exec-next
31007
31008 @subsubheading Synopsis
31009
31010 @smallexample
31011 -exec-next [--reverse]
31012 @end smallexample
31013
31014 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
31015 of the next source line is reached.
31016
31017 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
31018 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
31019 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
31020 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
31021 source line where the function was called.
31022
31023
31024 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31025
31026 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
31027
31028 @subsubheading Example
31029
31030 @smallexample
31031 -exec-next
31032 ^running
31033 (gdb)
31034 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
31035 (gdb)
31036 @end smallexample
31037
31038
31039 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
31040 @findex -exec-next-instruction
31041
31042 @subsubheading Synopsis
31043
31044 @smallexample
31045 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
31046 @end smallexample
31047
31048 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
31049 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
31050 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
31051 printed as well.
31052
31053 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
31054 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
31055 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
31056 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
31057 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
31058
31059 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31060
31061 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
31062
31063 @subsubheading Example
31064
31065 @smallexample
31066 (gdb)
31067 -exec-next-instruction
31068 ^running
31069
31070 (gdb)
31071 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31072 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
31073 (gdb)
31074 @end smallexample
31075
31076
31077 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
31078 @findex -exec-return
31079
31080 @subsubheading Synopsis
31081
31082 @smallexample
31083 -exec-return
31084 @end smallexample
31085
31086 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
31087 Displays the new current frame.
31088
31089 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31090
31091 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
31092
31093 @subsubheading Example
31094
31095 @smallexample
31096 (gdb)
31097 200-break-insert callee4
31098 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
31099 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
31100 (gdb)
31101 000-exec-run
31102 000^running
31103 (gdb)
31104 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
31105 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
31106 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31107 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
31108 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31109 (gdb)
31110 205-break-delete
31111 205^done
31112 (gdb)
31113 111-exec-return
31114 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
31115 args=[@{name="strarg",
31116 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
31117 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31118 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18",
31119 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31120 (gdb)
31121 @end smallexample
31122
31123
31124 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
31125 @findex -exec-run
31126
31127 @subsubheading Synopsis
31128
31129 @smallexample
31130 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
31131 @end smallexample
31132
31133 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
31134 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
31135 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
31136 the program has exited exceptionally.
31137
31138 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
31139 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
31140 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
31141 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
31142 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
31143
31144 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
31145 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
31146 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
31147 (@pxref{Starting}).
31148
31149 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31150
31151 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
31152
31153 @subsubheading Examples
31154
31155 @smallexample
31156 (gdb)
31157 -break-insert main
31158 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
31159 (gdb)
31160 -exec-run
31161 ^running
31162 (gdb)
31163 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
31164 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
31165 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31166 (gdb)
31167 @end smallexample
31168
31169 @noindent
31170 Program exited normally:
31171
31172 @smallexample
31173 (gdb)
31174 -exec-run
31175 ^running
31176 (gdb)
31177 x = 55
31178 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
31179 (gdb)
31180 @end smallexample
31181
31182 @noindent
31183 Program exited exceptionally:
31184
31185 @smallexample
31186 (gdb)
31187 -exec-run
31188 ^running
31189 (gdb)
31190 x = 55
31191 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
31192 (gdb)
31193 @end smallexample
31194
31195 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
31196 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
31197
31198 @smallexample
31199 (gdb)
31200 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
31201 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
31202 @end smallexample
31203
31204
31205 @c @subheading -exec-signal
31206
31207
31208 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
31209 @findex -exec-step
31210
31211 @subsubheading Synopsis
31212
31213 @smallexample
31214 -exec-step [--reverse]
31215 @end smallexample
31216
31217 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
31218 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
31219 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
31220 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
31221 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
31222 previously executed source line.
31223
31224 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31225
31226 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
31227
31228 @subsubheading Example
31229
31230 Stepping into a function:
31231
31232 @smallexample
31233 -exec-step
31234 ^running
31235 (gdb)
31236 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31237 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
31238 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
31239 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31240 (gdb)
31241 @end smallexample
31242
31243 Regular stepping:
31244
31245 @smallexample
31246 -exec-step
31247 ^running
31248 (gdb)
31249 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
31250 (gdb)
31251 @end smallexample
31252
31253
31254 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
31255 @findex -exec-step-instruction
31256
31257 @subsubheading Synopsis
31258
31259 @smallexample
31260 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
31261 @end smallexample
31262
31263 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
31264 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
31265 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
31266 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
31267 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
31268 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
31269 as well.
31270
31271 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31272
31273 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
31274
31275 @subsubheading Example
31276
31277 @smallexample
31278 (gdb)
31279 -exec-step-instruction
31280 ^running
31281
31282 (gdb)
31283 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31284 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
31285 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31286 (gdb)
31287 -exec-step-instruction
31288 ^running
31289
31290 (gdb)
31291 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
31292 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
31293 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31294 (gdb)
31295 @end smallexample
31296
31297
31298 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
31299 @findex -exec-until
31300
31301 @subsubheading Synopsis
31302
31303 @smallexample
31304 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
31305 @end smallexample
31306
31307 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
31308 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
31309 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
31310 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
31311
31312 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31313
31314 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
31315
31316 @subsubheading Example
31317
31318 @smallexample
31319 (gdb)
31320 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
31321 ^running
31322 (gdb)
31323 x = 55
31324 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
31325 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6",
31326 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31327 (gdb)
31328 @end smallexample
31329
31330 @ignore
31331 @subheading -file-clear
31332 Is this going away????
31333 @end ignore
31334
31335 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31336 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
31337 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
31338
31339 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
31340 @findex -enable-frame-filters
31341
31342 @smallexample
31343 -enable-frame-filters
31344 @end smallexample
31345
31346 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
31347 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
31348 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
31349 request that this functionality be enabled.
31350
31351 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31352
31353 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31354 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31355
31356 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
31357 @findex -stack-info-frame
31358
31359 @subsubheading Synopsis
31360
31361 @smallexample
31362 -stack-info-frame
31363 @end smallexample
31364
31365 Get info on the selected frame.
31366
31367 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31368
31369 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
31370 (without arguments).
31371
31372 @subsubheading Example
31373
31374 @smallexample
31375 (gdb)
31376 -stack-info-frame
31377 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
31378 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31379 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
31380 arch="i386:x86_64"@}
31381 (gdb)
31382 @end smallexample
31383
31384 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
31385 @findex -stack-info-depth
31386
31387 @subsubheading Synopsis
31388
31389 @smallexample
31390 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
31391 @end smallexample
31392
31393 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
31394 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
31395
31396 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31397
31398 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
31399
31400 @subsubheading Example
31401
31402 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
31403
31404 @smallexample
31405 (gdb)
31406 -stack-info-depth
31407 ^done,depth="12"
31408 (gdb)
31409 -stack-info-depth 4
31410 ^done,depth="4"
31411 (gdb)
31412 -stack-info-depth 12
31413 ^done,depth="12"
31414 (gdb)
31415 -stack-info-depth 11
31416 ^done,depth="11"
31417 (gdb)
31418 -stack-info-depth 13
31419 ^done,depth="12"
31420 (gdb)
31421 @end smallexample
31422
31423 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
31424 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
31425 @findex -stack-list-arguments
31426
31427 @subsubheading Synopsis
31428
31429 @smallexample
31430 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
31431 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
31432 @end smallexample
31433
31434 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
31435 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
31436 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
31437 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
31438 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
31439 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
31440 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
31441 which case only existing frames will be returned.
31442
31443 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31444 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31445 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31446 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31447 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
31448 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
31449
31450 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
31451 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
31452 are still displayed, however.
31453
31454 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
31455 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
31456
31457 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31458
31459 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
31460 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
31461 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
31462
31463 @subsubheading Example
31464
31465 @smallexample
31466 (gdb)
31467 -stack-list-frames
31468 ^done,
31469 stack=[
31470 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
31471 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31472 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
31473 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31474 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
31475 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31476 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17",
31477 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31478 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
31479 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31480 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22",
31481 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31482 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
31483 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31484 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27",
31485 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31486 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
31487 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31488 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32",
31489 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
31490 (gdb)
31491 -stack-list-arguments 0
31492 ^done,
31493 stack-args=[
31494 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
31495 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
31496 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
31497 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
31498 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
31499 (gdb)
31500 -stack-list-arguments 1
31501 ^done,
31502 stack-args=[
31503 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
31504 frame=@{level="1",
31505 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
31506 frame=@{level="2",args=[
31507 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31508 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
31509 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
31510 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31511 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
31512 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
31513 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
31514 (gdb)
31515 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
31516 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
31517 (gdb)
31518 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
31519 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
31520 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
31521 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
31522 (gdb)
31523 @end smallexample
31524
31525 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
31526
31527
31528 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
31529 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
31530 @findex -stack-list-frames
31531
31532 @subsubheading Synopsis
31533
31534 @smallexample
31535 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
31536 @end smallexample
31537
31538 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
31539 following info:
31540
31541 @table @samp
31542 @item @var{level}
31543 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
31544 @item @var{addr}
31545 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
31546 @item @var{func}
31547 Function name.
31548 @item @var{file}
31549 File name of the source file where the function lives.
31550 @item @var{fullname}
31551 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
31552 @item @var{line}
31553 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
31554 @item @var{from}
31555 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
31556 if the frame's function is not known.
31557 @item @var{arch}
31558 Frame's architecture.
31559 @end table
31560
31561 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
31562 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
31563 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
31564 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
31565 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
31566 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
31567 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
31568 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
31569 Python frame filters will not be executed.
31570
31571 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31572
31573 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
31574
31575 @subsubheading Example
31576
31577 Full stack backtrace:
31578
31579 @smallexample
31580 (gdb)
31581 -stack-list-frames
31582 ^done,stack=
31583 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
31584 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11",
31585 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31586 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31587 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31588 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31589 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31590 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31591 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31592 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31593 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31594 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31595 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31596 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31597 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31598 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31599 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31600 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31601 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31602 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31603 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31604 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31605 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31606 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31607 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31608 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31609 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31610 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31611 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31612 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31613 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31614 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31615 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31616 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
31617 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4",
31618 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
31619 (gdb)
31620 @end smallexample
31621
31622 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
31623
31624 @smallexample
31625 (gdb)
31626 -stack-list-frames 3 5
31627 ^done,stack=
31628 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31629 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31630 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31631 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31632 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31633 arch="i386:x86_64"@},
31634 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31635 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31636 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
31637 (gdb)
31638 @end smallexample
31639
31640 Show a single frame:
31641
31642 @smallexample
31643 (gdb)
31644 -stack-list-frames 3 3
31645 ^done,stack=
31646 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
31647 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14",
31648 arch="i386:x86_64"@}]
31649 (gdb)
31650 @end smallexample
31651
31652
31653 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
31654 @findex -stack-list-locals
31655 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
31656
31657 @subsubheading Synopsis
31658
31659 @smallexample
31660 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
31661 @end smallexample
31662
31663 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
31664 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31665 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31666 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31667 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31668 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
31669 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
31670 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
31671 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
31672 Python frame filters will not be executed.
31673
31674 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
31675 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
31676 variables are still displayed, however.
31677
31678 This command is deprecated in favor of the
31679 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
31680
31681 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31682
31683 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
31684
31685 @subsubheading Example
31686
31687 @smallexample
31688 (gdb)
31689 -stack-list-locals 0
31690 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
31691 (gdb)
31692 -stack-list-locals --all-values
31693 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
31694 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
31695 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
31696 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
31697 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
31698 (gdb)
31699 @end smallexample
31700
31701 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
31702 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
31703 @findex -stack-list-variables
31704
31705 @subsubheading Synopsis
31706
31707 @smallexample
31708 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
31709 @end smallexample
31710
31711 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
31712 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
31713 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
31714 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
31715 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
31716 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
31717 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
31718
31719 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
31720 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
31721 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
31722
31723 @subsubheading Example
31724
31725 @smallexample
31726 (gdb)
31727 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
31728 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
31729 (gdb)
31730 @end smallexample
31731
31732
31733 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
31734 @findex -stack-select-frame
31735
31736 @subsubheading Synopsis
31737
31738 @smallexample
31739 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
31740 @end smallexample
31741
31742 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
31743 the stack.
31744
31745 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
31746 option to every command.
31747
31748 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31749
31750 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
31751 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
31752
31753 @subsubheading Example
31754
31755 @smallexample
31756 (gdb)
31757 -stack-select-frame 2
31758 ^done
31759 (gdb)
31760 @end smallexample
31761
31762 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31763 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
31764 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
31765
31766 @ignore
31767
31768 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
31769
31770 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
31771 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
31772 used by @code{Insight}.
31773
31774 The two main reasons for that are:
31775
31776 @enumerate 1
31777 @item
31778 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
31779
31780 @item
31781 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
31782 now).
31783 @end enumerate
31784
31785 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
31786 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
31787 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
31788 hints about their use.
31789
31790 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
31791 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
31792 least, the following operations:
31793
31794 @itemize @bullet
31795 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
31796 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
31797 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
31798 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
31799 @end itemize
31800
31801 @end ignore
31802
31803 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
31804
31805 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
31806
31807 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
31808 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
31809 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
31810 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
31811 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
31812 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
31813 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
31814 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
31815 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
31816 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
31817 object, or to change display format.
31818
31819 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
31820 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
31821 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
31822 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
31823 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
31824 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
31825 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
31826 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
31827 child will be created.
31828
31829 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
31830 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
31831 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
31832 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
31833 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
31834
31835 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
31836 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
31837 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
31838 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
31839 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
31840 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
31841 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
31842 variables that frontend has created.
31843
31844 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
31845 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
31846 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
31847 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
31848 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
31849 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
31850 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
31851 implicitly updated.
31852
31853 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
31854 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
31855 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
31856 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
31857 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
31858 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
31859 frame. Consider this example:
31860
31861 @smallexample
31862 void do_work(...)
31863 @{
31864 struct work_state state;
31865
31866 if (...)
31867 do_work(...);
31868 @}
31869 @end smallexample
31870
31871 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
31872 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
31873 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
31874 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
31875 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
31876
31877 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
31878 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
31879 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
31880 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
31881 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
31882 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
31883
31884 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
31885 access this functionality:
31886
31887 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
31888 @item @strong{Operation}
31889 @tab @strong{Description}
31890
31891 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
31892 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
31893 @item @code{-var-create}
31894 @tab create a variable object
31895 @item @code{-var-delete}
31896 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
31897 @item @code{-var-set-format}
31898 @tab set the display format of this variable
31899 @item @code{-var-show-format}
31900 @tab show the display format of this variable
31901 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
31902 @tab tells how many children this object has
31903 @item @code{-var-list-children}
31904 @tab return a list of the object's children
31905 @item @code{-var-info-type}
31906 @tab show the type of this variable object
31907 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
31908 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
31909 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
31910 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
31911 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
31912 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
31913 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
31914 @tab get the value of this variable
31915 @item @code{-var-assign}
31916 @tab set the value of this variable
31917 @item @code{-var-update}
31918 @tab update the variable and its children
31919 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
31920 @tab set frozeness attribute
31921 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
31922 @tab set range of children to display on update
31923 @end multitable
31924
31925 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
31926 how it can be used.
31927
31928 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
31929
31930 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
31931 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
31932
31933 @smallexample
31934 -enable-pretty-printing
31935 @end smallexample
31936
31937 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
31938 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
31939 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
31940 request that this functionality be enabled.
31941
31942 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
31943
31944 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
31945 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
31946
31947 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
31948 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
31949
31950 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
31951 @findex -var-create
31952
31953 @subsubheading Synopsis
31954
31955 @smallexample
31956 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
31957 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
31958 @end smallexample
31959
31960 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
31961 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
31962 register.
31963
31964 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
31965 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
31966 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
31967 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
31968 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
31969
31970 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
31971 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
31972 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
31973 object must be created.
31974
31975 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
31976 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
31977
31978 @itemize @bullet
31979 @item
31980 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
31981
31982 @item
31983 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
31984
31985 @item
31986 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
31987 @end itemize
31988
31989 @cindex dynamic varobj
31990 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
31991 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
31992 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
31993 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
31994 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
31995 compatibility for existing clients.
31996
31997 @subsubheading Result
31998
31999 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
32000 are:
32001
32002 @table @samp
32003 @item name
32004 The name of the varobj.
32005
32006 @item numchild
32007 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
32008 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
32009 @samp{has_more} attribute.
32010
32011 @item value
32012 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
32013 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
32014 will not be interesting.
32015
32016 @item type
32017 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
32018 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
32019 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
32020 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
32021 @emph{declared} one.
32022
32023 @item thread-id
32024 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
32025 thread's global identifier.
32026
32027 @item has_more
32028 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
32029 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
32030
32031 @item dynamic
32032 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32033 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32034 then this attribute will not be present.
32035
32036 @item displayhint
32037 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32038 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32039 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32040 @end table
32041
32042 Typical output will look like this:
32043
32044 @smallexample
32045 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
32046 has_more="@var{has_more}"
32047 @end smallexample
32048
32049
32050 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
32051 @findex -var-delete
32052
32053 @subsubheading Synopsis
32054
32055 @smallexample
32056 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
32057 @end smallexample
32058
32059 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
32060 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
32061
32062 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
32063
32064
32065 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
32066 @findex -var-set-format
32067
32068 @subsubheading Synopsis
32069
32070 @smallexample
32071 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
32072 @end smallexample
32073
32074 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
32075 @var{format-spec}.
32076
32077 @anchor{-var-set-format}
32078 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
32079
32080 @smallexample
32081 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
32082 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
32083 @end smallexample
32084
32085 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
32086 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
32087 for pointers, etc.).
32088
32089 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
32090 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
32091 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
32092 zero-hexadecimal format.
32093
32094 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
32095 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
32096
32097 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
32098 @findex -var-show-format
32099
32100 @subsubheading Synopsis
32101
32102 @smallexample
32103 -var-show-format @var{name}
32104 @end smallexample
32105
32106 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
32107
32108 @smallexample
32109 @var{format} @expansion{}
32110 @var{format-spec}
32111 @end smallexample
32112
32113
32114 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
32115 @findex -var-info-num-children
32116
32117 @subsubheading Synopsis
32118
32119 @smallexample
32120 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
32121 @end smallexample
32122
32123 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
32124
32125 @smallexample
32126 numchild=@var{n}
32127 @end smallexample
32128
32129 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
32130 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
32131 be available.
32132
32133
32134 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
32135 @findex -var-list-children
32136
32137 @subsubheading Synopsis
32138
32139 @smallexample
32140 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
32141 @end smallexample
32142 @anchor{-var-list-children}
32143
32144 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
32145 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
32146 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
32147 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
32148 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
32149 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
32150 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
32151 and unions.
32152
32153 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
32154 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
32155 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
32156 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
32157 reported.
32158
32159 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
32160 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
32161 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
32162 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
32163 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
32164 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
32165 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
32166 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
32167 the visible items.
32168
32169 For each child the following results are returned:
32170
32171 @table @var
32172
32173 @item name
32174 Name of the variable object created for this child.
32175
32176 @item exp
32177 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
32178 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
32179
32180 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
32181 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
32182
32183 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
32184 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
32185 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
32186 type and value are not present.
32187
32188 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
32189 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
32190 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
32191
32192 @item numchild
32193 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
32194 0.
32195
32196 @item type
32197 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
32198 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
32199 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
32200 @emph{declared} one.
32201
32202 @item value
32203 If values were requested, this is the value.
32204
32205 @item thread-id
32206 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
32207 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
32208
32209 @item frozen
32210 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
32211
32212 @item displayhint
32213 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32214 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32215 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32216
32217 @item dynamic
32218 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32219 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32220 then this attribute will not be present.
32221
32222 @end table
32223
32224 The result may have its own attributes:
32225
32226 @table @samp
32227 @item displayhint
32228 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
32229 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
32230 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
32231
32232 @item has_more
32233 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
32234 remaining after the end of the selected range.
32235 @end table
32236
32237 @subsubheading Example
32238
32239 @smallexample
32240 (gdb)
32241 -var-list-children n
32242 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
32243 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
32244 (gdb)
32245 -var-list-children --all-values n
32246 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
32247 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
32248 @end smallexample
32249
32250
32251 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
32252 @findex -var-info-type
32253
32254 @subsubheading Synopsis
32255
32256 @smallexample
32257 -var-info-type @var{name}
32258 @end smallexample
32259
32260 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
32261 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
32262 @value{GDBN} CLI:
32263
32264 @smallexample
32265 type=@var{typename}
32266 @end smallexample
32267
32268
32269 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
32270 @findex -var-info-expression
32271
32272 @subsubheading Synopsis
32273
32274 @smallexample
32275 -var-info-expression @var{name}
32276 @end smallexample
32277
32278 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
32279 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
32280 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
32281
32282 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
32283 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
32284
32285 @smallexample
32286 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
32287 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
32288 @end smallexample
32289
32290 @noindent
32291 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
32292 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
32293
32294 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
32295 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
32296 is of limited use.
32297
32298 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
32299 @findex -var-info-path-expression
32300
32301 @subsubheading Synopsis
32302
32303 @smallexample
32304 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
32305 @end smallexample
32306
32307 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
32308 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
32309 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
32310 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
32311 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
32312 watchpoint from a variable object.
32313
32314 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
32315 and will give an error when invoked on one.
32316
32317 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
32318 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
32319 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
32320 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
32321 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
32322 @smallexample
32323 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
32324 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
32325 @end smallexample
32326
32327 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
32328 @findex -var-show-attributes
32329
32330 @subsubheading Synopsis
32331
32332 @smallexample
32333 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
32334 @end smallexample
32335
32336 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
32337
32338 @smallexample
32339 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
32340 @end smallexample
32341
32342 @noindent
32343 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
32344
32345 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
32346 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
32347
32348 @subsubheading Synopsis
32349
32350 @smallexample
32351 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
32352 @end smallexample
32353
32354 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
32355 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
32356 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
32357 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
32358 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
32359 the current display format will be used. The current display format
32360 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
32361
32362 @smallexample
32363 value=@var{value}
32364 @end smallexample
32365
32366 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
32367 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
32368
32369 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
32370 @findex -var-assign
32371
32372 @subsubheading Synopsis
32373
32374 @smallexample
32375 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
32376 @end smallexample
32377
32378 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
32379 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
32380 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
32381 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
32382
32383 @subsubheading Example
32384
32385 @smallexample
32386 (gdb)
32387 -var-assign var1 3
32388 ^done,value="3"
32389 (gdb)
32390 -var-update *
32391 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
32392 (gdb)
32393 @end smallexample
32394
32395 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
32396 @findex -var-update
32397
32398 @subsubheading Synopsis
32399
32400 @smallexample
32401 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
32402 @end smallexample
32403
32404 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
32405 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
32406 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
32407 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
32408 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
32409 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
32410 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
32411 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
32412 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
32413 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
32414 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
32415 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
32416 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
32417
32418 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
32419 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
32420 diagnostic.
32421
32422 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
32423 only the selected range of children will be reported.
32424
32425 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
32426 @samp{changelist}.
32427
32428 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
32429
32430 @table @samp
32431 @item name
32432 The name of the varobj.
32433
32434 @item value
32435 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
32436 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
32437
32438 @item in_scope
32439 @anchor{-var-update}
32440 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
32441
32442 @table @code
32443 @item "true"
32444 The variable object's current value is valid.
32445
32446 @item "false"
32447 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
32448 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
32449 scope.
32450
32451 @item "invalid"
32452 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
32453 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
32454 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
32455 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
32456 objects.
32457 @end table
32458
32459 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
32460 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
32461
32462 @item type_changed
32463 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
32464 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
32465 be @samp{false}.
32466
32467 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
32468 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
32469 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
32470 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
32471 unset.
32472
32473 @item new_type
32474 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
32475 hold the new type.
32476
32477 @item new_num_children
32478 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
32479 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
32480
32481 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
32482 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
32483 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
32484 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
32485 children which may be available.
32486
32487 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
32488 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
32489 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
32490 only happen at the end of the update range).
32491
32492 @item displayhint
32493 The display hint, if any.
32494
32495 @item has_more
32496 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
32497 available outside the varobj's update range.
32498
32499 @item dynamic
32500 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
32501 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
32502 then this attribute will not be present.
32503
32504 @item new_children
32505 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
32506 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
32507 be listed in this attribute.
32508 @end table
32509
32510 @subsubheading Example
32511
32512 @smallexample
32513 (gdb)
32514 -var-assign var1 3
32515 ^done,value="3"
32516 (gdb)
32517 -var-update --all-values var1
32518 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
32519 type_changed="false"@}]
32520 (gdb)
32521 @end smallexample
32522
32523 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
32524 @findex -var-set-frozen
32525 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
32526
32527 @subsubheading Synopsis
32528
32529 @smallexample
32530 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
32531 @end smallexample
32532
32533 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
32534 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
32535 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
32536 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
32537 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
32538 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
32539 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
32540 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
32541 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
32542 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
32543 @code{-var-update} does.
32544
32545 @subsubheading Example
32546
32547 @smallexample
32548 (gdb)
32549 -var-set-frozen V 1
32550 ^done
32551 (gdb)
32552 @end smallexample
32553
32554 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
32555 @findex -var-set-update-range
32556 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
32557
32558 @subsubheading Synopsis
32559
32560 @smallexample
32561 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
32562 @end smallexample
32563
32564 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
32565 @code{-var-update}.
32566
32567 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
32568 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
32569 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
32570 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
32571
32572 @subsubheading Example
32573
32574 @smallexample
32575 (gdb)
32576 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
32577 ^done
32578 @end smallexample
32579
32580 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
32581 @findex -var-set-visualizer
32582 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
32583
32584 @subsubheading Synopsis
32585
32586 @smallexample
32587 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
32588 @end smallexample
32589
32590 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
32591
32592 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
32593 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
32594
32595 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
32596 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
32597 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
32598 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
32599 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
32600 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
32601 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
32602
32603 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
32604 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
32605 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
32606 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
32607
32608 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
32609 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
32610 can be used to check this.
32611
32612 @subsubheading Example
32613
32614 Resetting the visualizer:
32615
32616 @smallexample
32617 (gdb)
32618 -var-set-visualizer V None
32619 ^done
32620 @end smallexample
32621
32622 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
32623
32624 @smallexample
32625 (gdb)
32626 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
32627 ^done
32628 @end smallexample
32629
32630 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
32631 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
32632
32633 @smallexample
32634 (gdb)
32635 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
32636 ^done
32637 @end smallexample
32638
32639 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32640 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
32641 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
32642
32643 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
32644 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
32645 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
32646 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
32647
32648 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
32649 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
32650
32651 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
32652 @c @subheading -data-assign
32653 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
32654 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
32655 @c set variable
32656 @c @subsubheading Example
32657 @c N.A.
32658
32659 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
32660 @findex -data-disassemble
32661
32662 @subsubheading Synopsis
32663
32664 @smallexample
32665 -data-disassemble
32666 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
32667 | [ -a @var{addr} ]
32668 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
32669 -- @var{mode}
32670 @end smallexample
32671
32672 @noindent
32673 Where:
32674
32675 @table @samp
32676 @item @var{start-addr}
32677 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
32678 @item @var{end-addr}
32679 is the end address
32680 @item @var{addr}
32681 is an address anywhere within (or the name of) the function to
32682 disassemble. If an address is specified, the whole function
32683 surrounding that address will be disassembled. If a name is
32684 specified, the whole function with that name will be disassembled.
32685 @item @var{filename}
32686 is the name of the file to disassemble
32687 @item @var{linenum}
32688 is the line number to disassemble around
32689 @item @var{lines}
32690 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
32691 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
32692 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
32693 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
32694 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
32695 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
32696 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
32697 are displayed.
32698 @item @var{mode}
32699 is one of:
32700 @itemize @bullet
32701 @item 0 disassembly only
32702 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
32703 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
32704 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
32705 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
32706 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
32707 @end itemize
32708
32709 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
32710 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
32711 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
32712 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
32713 @end table
32714
32715 @subsubheading Result
32716
32717 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
32718 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
32719 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
32720
32721 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
32722 following fields:
32723
32724 @table @code
32725 @item address
32726 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
32727
32728 @item func-name
32729 The name of the function this instruction is within.
32730
32731 @item offset
32732 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
32733
32734 @item inst
32735 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
32736
32737 @item opcodes
32738 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
32739 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
32740
32741 @end table
32742
32743 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
32744 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
32745
32746 @table @code
32747 @item line
32748 The line number within @samp{file}.
32749
32750 @item file
32751 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
32752 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
32753 used.
32754
32755 @item fullname
32756 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
32757 using the source file search path
32758 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
32759 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
32760
32761 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
32762 present in the debug information.
32763
32764 @item line_asm_insn
32765 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
32766 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
32767 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
32768 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
32769 @samp{opcodes}.
32770
32771 @end table
32772
32773 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
32774 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
32775 adjust its format.
32776
32777 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32778
32779 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
32780
32781 @subsubheading Example
32782
32783 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
32784
32785 @smallexample
32786 (gdb)
32787 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
32788 ^done,
32789 asm_insns=[
32790 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32791 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32792 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32793 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32794 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
32795 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
32796 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
32797 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32798 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
32799 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
32800 (gdb)
32801 @end smallexample
32802
32803 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
32804 @code{main}.
32805
32806 @smallexample
32807 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
32808 ^done,asm_insns=[
32809 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
32810 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
32811 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32812 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32813 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32814 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
32815 [@dots{}]
32816 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
32817 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
32818 (gdb)
32819 @end smallexample
32820
32821 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
32822
32823 @smallexample
32824 (gdb)
32825 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
32826 ^done,asm_insns=[
32827 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
32828 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
32829 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
32830 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32831 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32832 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
32833 (gdb)
32834 @end smallexample
32835
32836 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
32837
32838 @smallexample
32839 (gdb)
32840 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
32841 ^done,asm_insns=[
32842 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
32843 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32844 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32845 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
32846 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
32847 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
32848 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32849 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
32850 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
32851 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
32852 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
32853 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
32854 (gdb)
32855 @end smallexample
32856
32857
32858 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
32859 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
32860
32861 @subsubheading Synopsis
32862
32863 @smallexample
32864 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
32865 @end smallexample
32866
32867 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
32868 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
32869 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
32870
32871 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32872
32873 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
32874 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
32875 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
32876
32877 @subsubheading Example
32878
32879 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
32880 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
32881 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
32882 output.
32883
32884 @smallexample
32885 211-data-evaluate-expression A
32886 211^done,value="1"
32887 (gdb)
32888 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
32889 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
32890 (gdb)
32891 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
32892 411^done,value="4"
32893 (gdb)
32894 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
32895 511^done,value="4"
32896 (gdb)
32897 @end smallexample
32898
32899
32900 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
32901 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
32902
32903 @subsubheading Synopsis
32904
32905 @smallexample
32906 -data-list-changed-registers
32907 @end smallexample
32908
32909 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
32910
32911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32912
32913 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
32914 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
32915
32916 @subsubheading Example
32917
32918 On a PPC MBX board:
32919
32920 @smallexample
32921 (gdb)
32922 -exec-continue
32923 ^running
32924
32925 (gdb)
32926 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
32927 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
32928 line="5",arch="powerpc"@}
32929 (gdb)
32930 -data-list-changed-registers
32931 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
32932 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
32933 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
32934 (gdb)
32935 @end smallexample
32936
32937
32938 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
32939 @findex -data-list-register-names
32940
32941 @subsubheading Synopsis
32942
32943 @smallexample
32944 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
32945 @end smallexample
32946
32947 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
32948 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
32949 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
32950 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
32951 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
32952 include empty register names.
32953
32954 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32955
32956 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
32957 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
32958 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
32959
32960 @subsubheading Example
32961
32962 For the PPC MBX board:
32963 @smallexample
32964 (gdb)
32965 -data-list-register-names
32966 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
32967 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
32968 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
32969 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
32970 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
32971 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
32972 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
32973 (gdb)
32974 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
32975 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
32976 (gdb)
32977 @end smallexample
32978
32979 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
32980 @findex -data-list-register-values
32981
32982 @subsubheading Synopsis
32983
32984 @smallexample
32985 -data-list-register-values
32986 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
32987 @end smallexample
32988
32989 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
32990 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
32991 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
32992 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
32993 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
32994 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
32995
32996 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
32997
32998 @table @code
32999 @item x
33000 Hexadecimal
33001 @item o
33002 Octal
33003 @item t
33004 Binary
33005 @item d
33006 Decimal
33007 @item r
33008 Raw
33009 @item N
33010 Natural
33011 @end table
33012
33013 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33014
33015 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
33016 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
33017
33018 @subsubheading Example
33019
33020 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
33021 don't appear in the actual output):
33022
33023 @smallexample
33024 (gdb)
33025 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
33026 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
33027 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
33028 (gdb)
33029 -data-list-register-values x
33030 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
33031 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
33032 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
33033 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
33034 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
33035 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
33036 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
33037 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
33038 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
33039 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
33040 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
33041 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
33042 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
33043 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
33044 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
33045 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
33046 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
33047 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
33048 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
33049 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
33050 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
33051 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
33052 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
33053 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
33054 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
33055 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
33056 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
33057 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
33058 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
33059 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
33060 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
33061 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
33062 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
33063 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
33064 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
33065 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
33066 (gdb)
33067 @end smallexample
33068
33069
33070 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
33071 @findex -data-read-memory
33072
33073 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
33074
33075 @subsubheading Synopsis
33076
33077 @smallexample
33078 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
33079 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
33080 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
33081 @end smallexample
33082
33083 @noindent
33084 where:
33085
33086 @table @samp
33087 @item @var{address}
33088 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
33089 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
33090 quoted using the C convention.
33091
33092 @item @var{word-format}
33093 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
33094 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
33095 ,Output Formats}).
33096
33097 @item @var{word-size}
33098 The size of each memory word in bytes.
33099
33100 @item @var{nr-rows}
33101 The number of rows in the output table.
33102
33103 @item @var{nr-cols}
33104 The number of columns in the output table.
33105
33106 @item @var{aschar}
33107 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
33108 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
33109 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
33110 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
33111
33112 @item @var{byte-offset}
33113 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
33114 @end table
33115
33116 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
33117 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
33118 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
33119 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
33120 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
33121 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
33122 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
33123 @samp{addr}.
33124
33125 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
33126 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
33127 @samp{prev-page}.
33128
33129 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33130
33131 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
33132 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
33133
33134 @subsubheading Example
33135
33136 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
33137 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
33138 word. Display each word in hex.
33139
33140 @smallexample
33141 (gdb)
33142 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
33143 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
33144 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
33145 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
33146 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
33147 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
33148 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
33149 (gdb)
33150 @end smallexample
33151
33152 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
33153 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
33154
33155 @smallexample
33156 (gdb)
33157 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
33158 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
33159 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
33160 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
33161 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
33162 (gdb)
33163 @end smallexample
33164
33165 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
33166 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
33167 used as the non-printable character.
33168
33169 @smallexample
33170 (gdb)
33171 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
33172 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
33173 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
33174 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
33175 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33176 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33177 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33178 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
33179 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
33180 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
33181 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
33182 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
33183 (gdb)
33184 @end smallexample
33185
33186 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
33187 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
33188
33189 @subsubheading Synopsis
33190
33191 @smallexample
33192 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
33193 @var{address} @var{count}
33194 @end smallexample
33195
33196 @noindent
33197 where:
33198
33199 @table @samp
33200 @item @var{address}
33201 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
33202 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
33203 quoted using the C convention.
33204
33205 @item @var{count}
33206 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
33207 literal.
33208
33209 @item @var{offset}
33210 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
33211 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
33212 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
33213 arithmetics itself.
33214
33215 @end table
33216
33217 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
33218 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
33219 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
33220 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
33221 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
33222 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
33223
33224 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
33225 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
33226 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
33227 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
33228 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
33229 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
33230 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
33231 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
33232
33233 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
33234 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
33235 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
33236 and has the following fields:
33237
33238 @table @code
33239 @item begin
33240 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
33241
33242 @item end
33243 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
33244
33245 @item offset
33246 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
33247 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
33248
33249 @item contents
33250 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
33251
33252 @end table
33253
33254
33255
33256 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33257
33258 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
33259
33260 @subsubheading Example
33261
33262 @smallexample
33263 (gdb)
33264 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
33265 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
33266 end="0xbffff15e",
33267 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
33268 (gdb)
33269 @end smallexample
33270
33271
33272 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
33273 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
33274
33275 @subsubheading Synopsis
33276
33277 @smallexample
33278 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
33279 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
33280 @end smallexample
33281
33282 @noindent
33283 where:
33284
33285 @table @samp
33286 @item @var{address}
33287 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
33288 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
33289 be quoted using the C convention.
33290
33291 @item @var{contents}
33292 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
33293 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
33294
33295 @item @var{count}
33296 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
33297 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
33298 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
33299 @var{count} memory units.
33300
33301 @end table
33302
33303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33304
33305 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33306
33307 @subsubheading Example
33308
33309 @smallexample
33310 (gdb)
33311 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
33312 ^done
33313 (gdb)
33314 @end smallexample
33315
33316 @smallexample
33317 (gdb)
33318 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
33319 ^done
33320 (gdb)
33321 @end smallexample
33322
33323 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33324 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
33325 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
33326
33327 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
33328 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
33329
33330 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
33331 @findex -trace-find
33332
33333 @subsubheading Synopsis
33334
33335 @smallexample
33336 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
33337 @end smallexample
33338
33339 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
33340 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
33341 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
33342
33343 @table @samp
33344
33345 @item none
33346 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
33347
33348 @item frame-number
33349 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
33350 that index.
33351
33352 @item tracepoint-number
33353 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
33354 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
33355
33356 @item pc
33357 An address is required as parameter. Finds
33358 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
33359 address.
33360
33361 @item pc-inside-range
33362 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
33363 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
33364 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
33365
33366 @item pc-outside-range
33367 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
33368 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
33369 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
33370
33371 @item line
33372 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
33373 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
33374 the specified location.
33375
33376 @end table
33377
33378 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
33379 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
33380
33381 @table @samp
33382 @item found
33383 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
33384 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
33385
33386 @item traceframe
33387 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
33388 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
33389
33390 @item tracepoint
33391 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
33392 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
33393
33394 @item frame
33395 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
33396 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
33397 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
33398
33399 @end table
33400
33401 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33402
33403 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
33404
33405 @subheading -trace-define-variable
33406 @findex -trace-define-variable
33407
33408 @subsubheading Synopsis
33409
33410 @smallexample
33411 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
33412 @end smallexample
33413
33414 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
33415 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
33416 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
33417 with the @samp{$} character.
33418
33419 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33420
33421 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
33422
33423 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
33424 @findex -trace-frame-collected
33425
33426 @subsubheading Synopsis
33427
33428 @smallexample
33429 -trace-frame-collected
33430 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
33431 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
33432 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
33433 [--memory-contents]
33434 @end smallexample
33435
33436 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
33437 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
33438 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
33439 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
33440 See the output description table below for more details.
33441
33442 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
33443 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
33444 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
33445 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
33446 memory range and which is a computed expression.
33447
33448 For instance, if the actions were
33449 @smallexample
33450 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
33451 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
33452 @end smallexample
33453
33454 @noindent
33455 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
33456 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
33457 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
33458 objects would be computed expressions.
33459
33460 An example output would be:
33461
33462 @smallexample
33463 (gdb)
33464 -trace-frame-collected
33465 ^done,
33466 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
33467 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
33468 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
33469 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
33470 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
33471 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
33472 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
33473 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
33474 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
33475 ...
33476 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
33477 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
33478 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
33479 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
33480 (gdb)
33481 @end smallexample
33482
33483 Where:
33484
33485 @table @code
33486 @item explicit-variables
33487 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
33488 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
33489 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
33490 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
33491 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
33492 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
33493 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
33494 arrays, structures and unions.
33495
33496 @item computed-expressions
33497 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
33498 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
33499 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
33500 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
33501
33502 @item registers
33503 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
33504 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
33505 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
33506 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
33507 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
33508
33509 @item tvars
33510 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
33511 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
33512 current value are returned.
33513
33514 @item memory
33515 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
33516 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
33517 collected memory range and has the following fields:
33518
33519 @table @code
33520 @item address
33521 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
33522
33523 @item length
33524 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
33525
33526 @item contents
33527 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
33528 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
33529
33530 @end table
33531
33532 @end table
33533
33534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33535
33536 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33537
33538 @subsubheading Example
33539
33540 @subheading -trace-list-variables
33541 @findex -trace-list-variables
33542
33543 @subsubheading Synopsis
33544
33545 @smallexample
33546 -trace-list-variables
33547 @end smallexample
33548
33549 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
33550 table has the following fields:
33551
33552 @table @samp
33553 @item name
33554 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
33555
33556 @item initial
33557 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
33558 field is always present.
33559
33560 @item current
33561 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
33562 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
33563 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
33564 presently running.
33565
33566 @end table
33567
33568 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33569
33570 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
33571
33572 @subsubheading Example
33573
33574 @smallexample
33575 (gdb)
33576 -trace-list-variables
33577 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
33578 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33579 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
33580 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
33581 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
33582 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
33583 (gdb)
33584 @end smallexample
33585
33586 @subheading -trace-save
33587 @findex -trace-save
33588
33589 @subsubheading Synopsis
33590
33591 @smallexample
33592 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
33593 @end smallexample
33594
33595 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
33596 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
33597 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
33598 to perform the save.
33599
33600 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
33601 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
33602 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
33603
33604 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33605
33606 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
33607
33608
33609 @subheading -trace-start
33610 @findex -trace-start
33611
33612 @subsubheading Synopsis
33613
33614 @smallexample
33615 -trace-start
33616 @end smallexample
33617
33618 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
33619 have any fields.
33620
33621 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33622
33623 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
33624
33625 @subheading -trace-status
33626 @findex -trace-status
33627
33628 @subsubheading Synopsis
33629
33630 @smallexample
33631 -trace-status
33632 @end smallexample
33633
33634 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
33635 the following fields:
33636
33637 @table @samp
33638
33639 @item supported
33640 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
33641 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
33642 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
33643 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
33644 started. This field is always present.
33645
33646 @item running
33647 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
33648 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
33649 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
33650
33651 @item stop-reason
33652 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
33653 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
33654 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
33655 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
33656 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
33657 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
33658 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
33659 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
33660 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
33661
33662 @item stopping-tracepoint
33663 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
33664 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
33665 @samp{passcount}.
33666
33667 @item frames
33668 @itemx frames-created
33669 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
33670 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
33671 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
33672 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
33673
33674 @item buffer-size
33675 @itemx buffer-free
33676 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
33677 remaining space. These fields are optional.
33678
33679 @item circular
33680 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
33681 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
33682 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
33683 and may fill up.
33684
33685 @item disconnected
33686 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
33687 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
33688 that the trace run will stop.
33689
33690 @item trace-file
33691 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
33692 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
33693
33694 @end table
33695
33696 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33697
33698 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
33699
33700 @subheading -trace-stop
33701 @findex -trace-stop
33702
33703 @subsubheading Synopsis
33704
33705 @smallexample
33706 -trace-stop
33707 @end smallexample
33708
33709 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
33710 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
33711 @samp{running} fields are not output.
33712
33713 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33714
33715 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
33716
33717
33718 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33719 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
33720 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
33721
33722
33723 @ignore
33724 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
33725 @findex -symbol-info-address
33726
33727 @subsubheading Synopsis
33728
33729 @smallexample
33730 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
33731 @end smallexample
33732
33733 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
33734
33735 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33736
33737 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
33738
33739 @subsubheading Example
33740 N.A.
33741
33742
33743 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
33744 @findex -symbol-info-file
33745
33746 @subsubheading Synopsis
33747
33748 @smallexample
33749 -symbol-info-file
33750 @end smallexample
33751
33752 Show the file for the symbol.
33753
33754 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33755
33756 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
33757 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
33758
33759 @subsubheading Example
33760 N.A.
33761
33762
33763 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
33764 @findex -symbol-info-function
33765
33766 @subsubheading Synopsis
33767
33768 @smallexample
33769 -symbol-info-function
33770 @end smallexample
33771
33772 Show which function the symbol lives in.
33773
33774 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33775
33776 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
33777
33778 @subsubheading Example
33779 N.A.
33780
33781
33782 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
33783 @findex -symbol-info-line
33784
33785 @subsubheading Synopsis
33786
33787 @smallexample
33788 -symbol-info-line
33789 @end smallexample
33790
33791 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
33792
33793 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33794
33795 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
33796 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
33797
33798 @subsubheading Example
33799 N.A.
33800
33801
33802 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
33803 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
33804
33805 @subsubheading Synopsis
33806
33807 @smallexample
33808 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
33809 @end smallexample
33810
33811 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
33812
33813 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33814
33815 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
33816
33817 @subsubheading Example
33818 N.A.
33819
33820
33821 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
33822 @findex -symbol-list-functions
33823
33824 @subsubheading Synopsis
33825
33826 @smallexample
33827 -symbol-list-functions
33828 @end smallexample
33829
33830 List the functions in the executable.
33831
33832 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33833
33834 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
33835 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33836
33837 @subsubheading Example
33838 N.A.
33839 @end ignore
33840
33841
33842 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
33843 @findex -symbol-list-lines
33844
33845 @subsubheading Synopsis
33846
33847 @smallexample
33848 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
33849 @end smallexample
33850
33851 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
33852 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
33853 ascending PC order.
33854
33855 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33856
33857 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33858
33859 @subsubheading Example
33860 @smallexample
33861 (gdb)
33862 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
33863 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
33864 (gdb)
33865 @end smallexample
33866
33867
33868 @ignore
33869 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
33870 @findex -symbol-list-types
33871
33872 @subsubheading Synopsis
33873
33874 @smallexample
33875 -symbol-list-types
33876 @end smallexample
33877
33878 List all the type names.
33879
33880 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33881
33882 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
33883 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33884
33885 @subsubheading Example
33886 N.A.
33887
33888
33889 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
33890 @findex -symbol-list-variables
33891
33892 @subsubheading Synopsis
33893
33894 @smallexample
33895 -symbol-list-variables
33896 @end smallexample
33897
33898 List all the global and static variable names.
33899
33900 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33901
33902 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
33903
33904 @subsubheading Example
33905 N.A.
33906
33907
33908 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
33909 @findex -symbol-locate
33910
33911 @subsubheading Synopsis
33912
33913 @smallexample
33914 -symbol-locate
33915 @end smallexample
33916
33917 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33918
33919 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
33920
33921 @subsubheading Example
33922 N.A.
33923
33924
33925 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
33926 @findex -symbol-type
33927
33928 @subsubheading Synopsis
33929
33930 @smallexample
33931 -symbol-type @var{variable}
33932 @end smallexample
33933
33934 Show type of @var{variable}.
33935
33936 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33937
33938 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
33939 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
33940
33941 @subsubheading Example
33942 N.A.
33943 @end ignore
33944
33945
33946 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33947 @node GDB/MI File Commands
33948 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
33949
33950 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
33951 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
33952
33953 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
33954 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
33955
33956 @subsubheading Synopsis
33957
33958 @smallexample
33959 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
33960 @end smallexample
33961
33962 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
33963 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
33964 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
33965 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
33966 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
33967 notification.
33968
33969 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33970
33971 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
33972
33973 @subsubheading Example
33974
33975 @smallexample
33976 (gdb)
33977 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
33978 ^done
33979 (gdb)
33980 @end smallexample
33981
33982
33983 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
33984 @findex -file-exec-file
33985
33986 @subsubheading Synopsis
33987
33988 @smallexample
33989 -file-exec-file @var{file}
33990 @end smallexample
33991
33992 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
33993 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
33994 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
33995 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
33996 notification.
33997
33998 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33999
34000 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
34001
34002 @subsubheading Example
34003
34004 @smallexample
34005 (gdb)
34006 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
34007 ^done
34008 (gdb)
34009 @end smallexample
34010
34011
34012 @ignore
34013 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
34014 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
34015
34016 @subsubheading Synopsis
34017
34018 @smallexample
34019 -file-list-exec-sections
34020 @end smallexample
34021
34022 List the sections of the current executable file.
34023
34024 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34025
34026 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
34027 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
34028 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
34029
34030 @subsubheading Example
34031 N.A.
34032 @end ignore
34033
34034
34035 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
34036 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
34037
34038 @subsubheading Synopsis
34039
34040 @smallexample
34041 -file-list-exec-source-file
34042 @end smallexample
34043
34044 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
34045 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
34046 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
34047 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
34048
34049 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34050
34051 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
34052
34053 @subsubheading Example
34054
34055 @smallexample
34056 (gdb)
34057 123-file-list-exec-source-file
34058 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
34059 (gdb)
34060 @end smallexample
34061
34062
34063 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
34064 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
34065
34066 @subsubheading Synopsis
34067
34068 @smallexample
34069 -file-list-exec-source-files
34070 @end smallexample
34071
34072 List the source files for the current executable.
34073
34074 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
34075 name) of a source file.
34076
34077 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34078
34079 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
34080 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
34081
34082 @subsubheading Example
34083 @smallexample
34084 (gdb)
34085 -file-list-exec-source-files
34086 ^done,files=[
34087 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
34088 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
34089 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
34090 (gdb)
34091 @end smallexample
34092
34093 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
34094 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
34095
34096 @subsubheading Synopsis
34097
34098 @smallexample
34099 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
34100 @end smallexample
34101
34102 List the shared libraries in the program.
34103 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
34104 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
34105
34106 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34107
34108 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
34109 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
34110 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
34111 library. Each range has the following fields:
34112
34113 @table @samp
34114 @item from
34115 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
34116 @item to
34117 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
34118 @end table
34119
34120 @subsubheading Example
34121 @smallexample
34122 (gdb)
34123 -file-list-exec-source-files
34124 ^done,shared-libraries=[
34125 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
34126 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
34127 (gdb)
34128 @end smallexample
34129
34130
34131 @ignore
34132 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
34133 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
34134
34135 @subsubheading Synopsis
34136
34137 @smallexample
34138 -file-list-symbol-files
34139 @end smallexample
34140
34141 List symbol files.
34142
34143 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34144
34145 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
34146
34147 @subsubheading Example
34148 N.A.
34149 @end ignore
34150
34151
34152 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
34153 @findex -file-symbol-file
34154
34155 @subsubheading Synopsis
34156
34157 @smallexample
34158 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
34159 @end smallexample
34160
34161 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
34162 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
34163 produced, except for a completion notification.
34164
34165 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34166
34167 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
34168
34169 @subsubheading Example
34170
34171 @smallexample
34172 (gdb)
34173 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
34174 ^done
34175 (gdb)
34176 @end smallexample
34177
34178 @ignore
34179 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34180 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
34181 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
34182
34183 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
34184
34185 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
34186
34187 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
34188
34189 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
34190
34191 @c @subheading -overlay-map
34192
34193 @c @subheading -overlay-off
34194
34195 @c @subheading -overlay-on
34196
34197 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
34198
34199 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34200 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
34201 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
34202
34203 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
34204
34205 @c @subheading -signal-handle
34206
34207 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
34208
34209 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
34210 @end ignore
34211
34212
34213 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34214 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
34215 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
34216
34217
34218 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
34219 @findex -target-attach
34220
34221 @subsubheading Synopsis
34222
34223 @smallexample
34224 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
34225 @end smallexample
34226
34227 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
34228 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
34229 group, the id previously returned by
34230 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
34231
34232 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34233
34234 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
34235
34236 @subsubheading Example
34237 @smallexample
34238 (gdb)
34239 -target-attach 34
34240 =thread-created,id="1"
34241 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
34242 ^done
34243 (gdb)
34244 @end smallexample
34245
34246 @ignore
34247 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
34248 @findex -target-compare-sections
34249
34250 @subsubheading Synopsis
34251
34252 @smallexample
34253 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
34254 @end smallexample
34255
34256 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
34257 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
34258
34259 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34260
34261 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
34262
34263 @subsubheading Example
34264 N.A.
34265 @end ignore
34266
34267
34268 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
34269 @findex -target-detach
34270
34271 @subsubheading Synopsis
34272
34273 @smallexample
34274 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
34275 @end smallexample
34276
34277 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
34278 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
34279 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
34280
34281 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34282
34283 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
34284
34285 @subsubheading Example
34286
34287 @smallexample
34288 (gdb)
34289 -target-detach
34290 ^done
34291 (gdb)
34292 @end smallexample
34293
34294
34295 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
34296 @findex -target-disconnect
34297
34298 @subsubheading Synopsis
34299
34300 @smallexample
34301 -target-disconnect
34302 @end smallexample
34303
34304 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
34305 generally not resumed.
34306
34307 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34308
34309 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
34310
34311 @subsubheading Example
34312
34313 @smallexample
34314 (gdb)
34315 -target-disconnect
34316 ^done
34317 (gdb)
34318 @end smallexample
34319
34320
34321 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
34322 @findex -target-download
34323
34324 @subsubheading Synopsis
34325
34326 @smallexample
34327 -target-download
34328 @end smallexample
34329
34330 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
34331 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
34332
34333 @table @samp
34334 @item section
34335 The name of the section.
34336 @item section-sent
34337 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
34338 @item section-size
34339 The size of the section.
34340 @item total-sent
34341 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
34342 @item total-size
34343 The size of the overall executable to download.
34344 @end table
34345
34346 @noindent
34347 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
34348 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
34349
34350 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
34351 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
34352
34353 @table @samp
34354 @item section
34355 The name of the section.
34356 @item section-size
34357 The size of the section.
34358 @item total-size
34359 The size of the overall executable to download.
34360 @end table
34361
34362 @noindent
34363 At the end, a summary is printed.
34364
34365 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34366
34367 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
34368
34369 @subsubheading Example
34370
34371 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
34372 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
34373
34374 @smallexample
34375 (gdb)
34376 -target-download
34377 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
34378 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
34379 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
34380 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
34381 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
34382 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
34383 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
34384 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
34385 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
34386 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
34387 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
34388 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
34389 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
34390 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
34391 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
34392 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
34393 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
34394 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
34395 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
34396 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
34397 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
34398 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
34399 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
34400 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
34401 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
34402 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
34403 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
34404 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
34405 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
34406 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
34407 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
34408 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
34409 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
34410 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
34411 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
34412 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
34413 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
34414 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
34415 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
34416 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
34417 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
34418 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
34419 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
34420 write-rate="429"
34421 (gdb)
34422 @end smallexample
34423
34424
34425 @ignore
34426 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
34427 @findex -target-exec-status
34428
34429 @subsubheading Synopsis
34430
34431 @smallexample
34432 -target-exec-status
34433 @end smallexample
34434
34435 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
34436 not, for instance).
34437
34438 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34439
34440 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
34441
34442 @subsubheading Example
34443 N.A.
34444
34445
34446 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
34447 @findex -target-list-available-targets
34448
34449 @subsubheading Synopsis
34450
34451 @smallexample
34452 -target-list-available-targets
34453 @end smallexample
34454
34455 List the possible targets to connect to.
34456
34457 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34458
34459 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
34460
34461 @subsubheading Example
34462 N.A.
34463
34464
34465 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
34466 @findex -target-list-current-targets
34467
34468 @subsubheading Synopsis
34469
34470 @smallexample
34471 -target-list-current-targets
34472 @end smallexample
34473
34474 Describe the current target.
34475
34476 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34477
34478 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
34479 other things).
34480
34481 @subsubheading Example
34482 N.A.
34483
34484
34485 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
34486 @findex -target-list-parameters
34487
34488 @subsubheading Synopsis
34489
34490 @smallexample
34491 -target-list-parameters
34492 @end smallexample
34493
34494 @c ????
34495 @end ignore
34496
34497 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34498
34499 No equivalent.
34500
34501 @subsubheading Example
34502 N.A.
34503
34504 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
34505 @findex -target-flash-erase
34506
34507 @subsubheading Synopsis
34508
34509 @smallexample
34510 -target-flash-erase
34511 @end smallexample
34512
34513 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
34514
34515 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
34516
34517 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
34518 addresses and memory region sizes.
34519
34520 @smallexample
34521 (gdb)
34522 -target-flash-erase
34523 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
34524 (gdb)
34525 @end smallexample
34526
34527 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
34528 @findex -target-select
34529
34530 @subsubheading Synopsis
34531
34532 @smallexample
34533 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
34534 @end smallexample
34535
34536 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
34537
34538 @table @samp
34539 @item @var{type}
34540 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
34541 @item @var{parameters}
34542 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
34543 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
34544 @end table
34545
34546 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
34547 which the target program is, in the following form:
34548
34549 @smallexample
34550 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
34551 args=[@var{arg list}]
34552 @end smallexample
34553
34554 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34555
34556 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
34557
34558 @subsubheading Example
34559
34560 @smallexample
34561 (gdb)
34562 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
34563 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
34564 (gdb)
34565 @end smallexample
34566
34567 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34568 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
34569 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
34570
34571
34572 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
34573 @findex -target-file-put
34574
34575 @subsubheading Synopsis
34576
34577 @smallexample
34578 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
34579 @end smallexample
34580
34581 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
34582 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
34583
34584 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34585
34586 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
34587
34588 @subsubheading Example
34589
34590 @smallexample
34591 (gdb)
34592 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
34593 ^done
34594 (gdb)
34595 @end smallexample
34596
34597
34598 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
34599 @findex -target-file-get
34600
34601 @subsubheading Synopsis
34602
34603 @smallexample
34604 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
34605 @end smallexample
34606
34607 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
34608 on the host system.
34609
34610 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34611
34612 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
34613
34614 @subsubheading Example
34615
34616 @smallexample
34617 (gdb)
34618 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
34619 ^done
34620 (gdb)
34621 @end smallexample
34622
34623
34624 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
34625 @findex -target-file-delete
34626
34627 @subsubheading Synopsis
34628
34629 @smallexample
34630 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
34631 @end smallexample
34632
34633 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
34634
34635 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34636
34637 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
34638
34639 @subsubheading Example
34640
34641 @smallexample
34642 (gdb)
34643 -target-file-delete remotefile
34644 ^done
34645 (gdb)
34646 @end smallexample
34647
34648
34649 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34650 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
34651 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
34652
34653 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
34654 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
34655
34656 @subsubheading Synopsis
34657
34658 @smallexample
34659 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
34660 @end smallexample
34661
34662 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
34663 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
34664 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
34665
34666 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34667
34668 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
34669
34670 @subsubheading Result
34671
34672 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
34673 defined for each exception:
34674
34675 @table @samp
34676 @item name
34677 The name of the exception.
34678
34679 @item address
34680 The address of the exception.
34681
34682 @end table
34683
34684 @subsubheading Example
34685
34686 @smallexample
34687 -info-ada-exceptions aint
34688 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
34689 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
34690 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
34691 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
34692 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
34693 @end smallexample
34694
34695 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
34696
34697 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
34698 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
34699 Catchpoint Commands}.
34700
34701
34702 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34703 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
34704 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
34705
34706 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
34707 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
34708 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
34709 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
34710
34711 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
34712 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
34713 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
34714
34715 @subsubheading Synopsis
34716
34717 @smallexample
34718 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
34719 @end smallexample
34720
34721 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
34722
34723 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
34724 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
34725 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
34726 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
34727 dash.
34728
34729 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34730
34731 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
34732
34733 @subsubheading Result
34734
34735 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
34736
34737 @table @samp
34738 @item exists
34739 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
34740 @code{"false"} otherwise.
34741
34742 @end table
34743
34744 @subsubheading Example
34745
34746 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
34747
34748 @smallexample
34749 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
34750 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
34751 @end smallexample
34752
34753 @noindent
34754 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
34755 to the debugger:
34756
34757 @smallexample
34758 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
34759 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
34760 @end smallexample
34761
34762 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
34763 @findex -list-features
34764 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
34765
34766 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
34767 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
34768 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
34769 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
34770 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
34771 startup.
34772
34773 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
34774 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
34775 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
34776 is given below.
34777
34778 Example output:
34779
34780 @smallexample
34781 (gdb) -list-features
34782 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
34783 @end smallexample
34784
34785 The current list of features is:
34786
34787 @ftable @samp
34788 @item frozen-varobjs
34789 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
34790 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
34791 of @code{-varobj-create}.
34792 @item pending-breakpoints
34793 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
34794 command.
34795 @item python
34796 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
34797 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
34798 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
34799 @item thread-info
34800 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
34801 @item data-read-memory-bytes
34802 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
34803 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
34804 @item breakpoint-notifications
34805 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
34806 CLI will be announced via async records.
34807 @item ada-task-info
34808 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
34809 @item language-option
34810 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
34811 option (@pxref{Context management}).
34812 @item info-gdb-mi-command
34813 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
34814 @item undefined-command-error-code
34815 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
34816 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
34817 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
34818 @item exec-run-start-option
34819 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
34820 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
34821 @item data-disassemble-a-option
34822 Indicates that the @code{-data-disassemble} command supports the @option{-a}
34823 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Data Manipulation}).
34824 @end ftable
34825
34826 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
34827 @findex -list-target-features
34828
34829 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
34830 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
34831 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
34832 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
34833 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
34834 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
34835 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
34836 Example output:
34837
34838 @smallexample
34839 (gdb) -list-target-features
34840 ^done,result=["async"]
34841 @end smallexample
34842
34843 The current list of features is:
34844
34845 @table @samp
34846 @item async
34847 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
34848 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
34849 while the target is running.
34850
34851 @item reverse
34852 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
34853 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
34854
34855 @end table
34856
34857 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
34858 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
34859 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
34860
34861 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
34862
34863 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
34864 @findex -gdb-exit
34865
34866 @subsubheading Synopsis
34867
34868 @smallexample
34869 -gdb-exit
34870 @end smallexample
34871
34872 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
34873
34874 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34875
34876 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
34877
34878 @subsubheading Example
34879
34880 @smallexample
34881 (gdb)
34882 -gdb-exit
34883 ^exit
34884 @end smallexample
34885
34886
34887 @ignore
34888 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
34889 @findex -exec-abort
34890
34891 @subsubheading Synopsis
34892
34893 @smallexample
34894 -exec-abort
34895 @end smallexample
34896
34897 Kill the inferior running program.
34898
34899 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34900
34901 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
34902
34903 @subsubheading Example
34904 N.A.
34905 @end ignore
34906
34907
34908 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
34909 @findex -gdb-set
34910
34911 @subsubheading Synopsis
34912
34913 @smallexample
34914 -gdb-set
34915 @end smallexample
34916
34917 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
34918 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
34919
34920 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34921
34922 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
34923
34924 @subsubheading Example
34925
34926 @smallexample
34927 (gdb)
34928 -gdb-set $foo=3
34929 ^done
34930 (gdb)
34931 @end smallexample
34932
34933
34934 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
34935 @findex -gdb-show
34936
34937 @subsubheading Synopsis
34938
34939 @smallexample
34940 -gdb-show
34941 @end smallexample
34942
34943 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
34944
34945 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34946
34947 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
34948
34949 @subsubheading Example
34950
34951 @smallexample
34952 (gdb)
34953 -gdb-show annotate
34954 ^done,value="0"
34955 (gdb)
34956 @end smallexample
34957
34958 @c @subheading -gdb-source
34959
34960
34961 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
34962 @findex -gdb-version
34963
34964 @subsubheading Synopsis
34965
34966 @smallexample
34967 -gdb-version
34968 @end smallexample
34969
34970 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
34971
34972 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
34973
34974 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
34975 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
34976
34977 @subsubheading Example
34978
34979 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
34980 @c box in TeX.
34981 @smallexample
34982 (gdb)
34983 -gdb-version
34984 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
34985 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
34986 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
34987 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
34988 ~ certain conditions.
34989 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
34990 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
34991 ~ details.
34992 ~This GDB was configured as
34993 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
34994 ^done
34995 (gdb)
34996 @end smallexample
34997
34998 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
34999 @findex -list-thread-groups
35000
35001 @subheading Synopsis
35002
35003 @smallexample
35004 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
35005 @end smallexample
35006
35007 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
35008 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
35009 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
35010 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
35011 top-level thread groups.
35012
35013 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
35014 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
35015 available on the target.
35016
35017 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
35018 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
35019 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
35020 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
35021 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
35022 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
35023 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
35024 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
35025
35026 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
35027 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
35028 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
35029 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
35030 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
35031 @samp{threads} field.
35032
35033 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
35034 the following caveats:
35035
35036 @itemize @bullet
35037 @item
35038 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
35039 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
35040 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
35041
35042 @item
35043 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
35044 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
35045 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
35046 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
35047 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
35048 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
35049
35050 @end itemize
35051
35052 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
35053 have the following fields:
35054
35055 @table @code
35056 @item id
35057 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
35058 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
35059 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
35060
35061 @item type
35062 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
35063 valid type.
35064
35065 @item pid
35066 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
35067 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
35068
35069 @item exit-code
35070 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
35071 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
35072 only if the process is not running.
35073
35074 @item num_children
35075 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
35076 absent for an available thread group.
35077
35078 @item threads
35079 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
35080 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
35081 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
35082
35083 @item cores
35084 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
35085 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
35086 such information is not available.
35087
35088 @item executable
35089 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
35090 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
35091 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
35092
35093 @end table
35094
35095 @subheading Example
35096
35097 @smallexample
35098 @value{GDBP}
35099 -list-thread-groups
35100 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
35101 -list-thread-groups 17
35102 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
35103 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
35104 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
35105 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
35106 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158",arch="i386:x86_64"@},state="running"@}]]
35107 -list-thread-groups --available
35108 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
35109 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
35110 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
35111 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
35112 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
35113 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
35114 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
35115 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
35116 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
35117 @end smallexample
35118
35119 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
35120 @findex -info-os
35121
35122 @subsubheading Synopsis
35123
35124 @smallexample
35125 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
35126 @end smallexample
35127
35128 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
35129 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
35130 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
35131 of data of that type.
35132
35133 The types of information available depend on the target operating
35134 system.
35135
35136 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
35137
35138 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
35139
35140 @subsubheading Example
35141
35142 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
35143 like this:
35144
35145 @smallexample
35146 @value{GDBP}
35147 -info-os
35148 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
35149 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
35150 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
35151 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
35152 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
35153 col2="CPUs"@},
35154 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
35155 col2="File descriptors"@},
35156 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
35157 col2="Kernel modules"@},
35158 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
35159 col2="Message queues"@},
35160 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
35161 col2="Processes"@},
35162 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
35163 col2="Process groups"@},
35164 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
35165 col2="Semaphores"@},
35166 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
35167 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
35168 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
35169 col2="Sockets"@},
35170 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
35171 col2="Threads"@}]
35172 @value{GDBP}
35173 -info-os processes
35174 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
35175 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
35176 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
35177 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
35178 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
35179 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
35180 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
35181 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
35182 ...
35183 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
35184 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
35185 (gdb)
35186 @end smallexample
35187
35188 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
35189 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
35190 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
35191 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
35192 @code{info os} omits it.)
35193
35194 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
35195 @findex -add-inferior
35196
35197 @subheading Synopsis
35198
35199 @smallexample
35200 -add-inferior
35201 @end smallexample
35202
35203 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
35204 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
35205 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
35206 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
35207 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
35208 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
35209
35210 @subheading Example
35211
35212 @smallexample
35213 @value{GDBP}
35214 -add-inferior
35215 ^done,inferior="i3"
35216 @end smallexample
35217
35218 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
35219 @findex -interpreter-exec
35220
35221 @subheading Synopsis
35222
35223 @smallexample
35224 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
35225 @end smallexample
35226 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
35227
35228 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
35229
35230 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35231
35232 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
35233
35234 @subheading Example
35235
35236 @smallexample
35237 (gdb)
35238 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
35239 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
35240 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
35241 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
35242 ^done
35243 (gdb)
35244 @end smallexample
35245
35246 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
35247 @findex -inferior-tty-set
35248
35249 @subheading Synopsis
35250
35251 @smallexample
35252 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
35253 @end smallexample
35254
35255 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
35256
35257 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35258
35259 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
35260
35261 @subheading Example
35262
35263 @smallexample
35264 (gdb)
35265 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
35266 ^done
35267 (gdb)
35268 @end smallexample
35269
35270 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
35271 @findex -inferior-tty-show
35272
35273 @subheading Synopsis
35274
35275 @smallexample
35276 -inferior-tty-show
35277 @end smallexample
35278
35279 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
35280
35281 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35282
35283 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
35284
35285 @subheading Example
35286
35287 @smallexample
35288 (gdb)
35289 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
35290 ^done
35291 (gdb)
35292 -inferior-tty-show
35293 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
35294 (gdb)
35295 @end smallexample
35296
35297 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
35298 @findex -enable-timings
35299
35300 @subheading Synopsis
35301
35302 @smallexample
35303 -enable-timings [yes | no]
35304 @end smallexample
35305
35306 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
35307 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
35308 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
35309 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
35310
35311 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35312
35313 No equivalent.
35314
35315 @subheading Example
35316
35317 @smallexample
35318 (gdb)
35319 -enable-timings
35320 ^done
35321 (gdb)
35322 -break-insert main
35323 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
35324 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
35325 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
35326 times="0"@},
35327 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
35328 (gdb)
35329 -enable-timings no
35330 ^done
35331 (gdb)
35332 -exec-run
35333 ^running
35334 (gdb)
35335 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
35336 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
35337 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
35338 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",arch="i386:x86_64"@}
35339 (gdb)
35340 @end smallexample
35341
35342 @subheading The @code{-complete} Command
35343 @findex -complete
35344
35345 @subheading Synopsis
35346
35347 @smallexample
35348 -complete @var{command}
35349 @end smallexample
35350
35351 Show a list of completions for partially typed CLI @var{command}.
35352
35353 This command is intended for @sc{gdb/mi} frontends that cannot use two separate
35354 CLI and MI channels --- for example: because of lack of PTYs like on Windows or
35355 because @value{GDBN} is used remotely via a SSH connection.
35356
35357 @subheading Result
35358
35359 The result consists of two or three fields:
35360
35361 @table @samp
35362 @item completion
35363 This field contains the completed @var{command}. If @var{command}
35364 has no known completions, this field is omitted.
35365
35366 @item matches
35367 This field contains a (possibly empty) array of matches. It is always present.
35368
35369 @item max_completions_reached
35370 This field contains @code{1} if number of known completions is above
35371 @code{max-completions} limit (@pxref{Completion}), otherwise it contains
35372 @code{0}. It is always present.
35373
35374 @end table
35375
35376 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
35377
35378 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{complete}.
35379
35380 @subheading Example
35381
35382 @smallexample
35383 (gdb)
35384 -complete br
35385 ^done,completion="break",
35386 matches=["break","break-range"],
35387 max_completions_reached="0"
35388 (gdb)
35389 -complete "b ma"
35390 ^done,completion="b ma",
35391 matches=["b madvise","b main"],max_completions_reached="0"
35392 (gdb)
35393 -complete "b push_b"
35394 ^done,completion="b push_back(",
35395 matches=[
35396 "b A::push_back(void*)",
35397 "b std::string::push_back(char)",
35398 "b std::vector<int, std::allocator<int> >::push_back(int&&)"],
35399 max_completions_reached="0"
35400 (gdb)
35401 -complete "nonexist"
35402 ^done,matches=[],max_completions_reached="0"
35403 (gdb)
35404
35405 @end smallexample
35406
35407 @node Annotations
35408 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
35409
35410 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
35411 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
35412 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
35413 relatively high level.
35414
35415 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
35416 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
35417
35418 @ignore
35419 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
35420 @end ignore
35421
35422 @menu
35423 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
35424 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
35425 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
35426 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
35427 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
35428 * Annotations for Running::
35429 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
35430 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
35431 @end menu
35432
35433 @node Annotations Overview
35434 @section What is an Annotation?
35435 @cindex annotations
35436
35437 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
35438 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
35439 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
35440 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
35441 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
35442 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
35443 cannot contain newline characters.
35444
35445 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
35446 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
35447 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
35448 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
35449 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
35450 means those three characters as output.
35451
35452 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
35453 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
35454 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
35455 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
35456 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
35457 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
35458 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
35459 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
35460 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
35461
35462 @table @code
35463 @kindex set annotate
35464 @item set annotate @var{level}
35465 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
35466 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
35467
35468 @item show annotate
35469 @kindex show annotate
35470 Show the current annotation level.
35471 @end table
35472
35473 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
35474
35475 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
35476
35477 @smallexample
35478 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
35479 GNU gdb 6.0
35480 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
35481 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
35482 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
35483 under certain conditions.
35484 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
35485 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
35486 for details.
35487 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
35488
35489 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
35490 (@value{GDBP})
35491 ^Z^Zprompt
35492 @kbd{quit}
35493
35494 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
35495 $
35496 @end smallexample
35497
35498 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
35499 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
35500 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
35501 output from @value{GDBN}.
35502
35503 @node Server Prefix
35504 @section The Server Prefix
35505 @cindex server prefix
35506
35507 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
35508 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
35509 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
35510 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
35511 a transparent manner.
35512
35513 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
35514 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
35515 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
35516 @code{print} command.
35517
35518 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
35519 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
35520
35521 @node Prompting
35522 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
35523
35524 @cindex annotations for prompts
35525 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
35526 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
35527 over, etc.
35528
35529 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
35530 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
35531 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
35532 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
35533 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
35534 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
35535 features the following annotations:
35536
35537 @smallexample
35538 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
35539 ^Z^Zprompt
35540 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
35541 @end smallexample
35542
35543 The input types are
35544
35545 @table @code
35546 @findex pre-prompt annotation
35547 @findex prompt annotation
35548 @findex post-prompt annotation
35549 @item prompt
35550 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
35551
35552 @findex pre-commands annotation
35553 @findex commands annotation
35554 @findex post-commands annotation
35555 @item commands
35556 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
35557 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
35558
35559 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
35560 @findex overload-choice annotation
35561 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
35562 @item overload-choice
35563 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
35564
35565 @findex pre-query annotation
35566 @findex query annotation
35567 @findex post-query annotation
35568 @item query
35569 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
35570
35571 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
35572 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
35573 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
35574 @item prompt-for-continue
35575 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
35576 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
35577 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
35578 presence of annotations.
35579 @end table
35580
35581 @node Errors
35582 @section Errors
35583 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
35584
35585 @findex quit annotation
35586 @smallexample
35587 ^Z^Zquit
35588 @end smallexample
35589
35590 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
35591
35592 @findex error annotation
35593 @smallexample
35594 ^Z^Zerror
35595 @end smallexample
35596
35597 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
35598
35599 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
35600 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
35601 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
35602 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
35603 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
35604 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
35605 to the top level.
35606
35607 @findex error-begin annotation
35608 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
35609
35610 @smallexample
35611 ^Z^Zerror-begin
35612 @end smallexample
35613
35614 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
35615 message.
35616
35617 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
35618 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
35619 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
35620
35621 @node Invalidation
35622 @section Invalidation Notices
35623
35624 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
35625 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
35626 changed.
35627
35628 @table @code
35629 @findex frames-invalid annotation
35630 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
35631
35632 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
35633 have changed.
35634
35635 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
35636 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
35637
35638 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
35639 deleted a breakpoint.
35640 @end table
35641
35642 @node Annotations for Running
35643 @section Running the Program
35644 @cindex annotations for running programs
35645
35646 @findex starting annotation
35647 @findex stopping annotation
35648 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
35649 @code{step} or @code{continue},
35650
35651 @smallexample
35652 ^Z^Zstarting
35653 @end smallexample
35654
35655 is output. When the program stops,
35656
35657 @smallexample
35658 ^Z^Zstopped
35659 @end smallexample
35660
35661 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
35662 annotations describe how the program stopped.
35663
35664 @table @code
35665 @findex exited annotation
35666 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
35667 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
35668 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
35669
35670 @findex signalled annotation
35671 @findex signal-name annotation
35672 @findex signal-name-end annotation
35673 @findex signal-string annotation
35674 @findex signal-string-end annotation
35675 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
35676 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
35677 annotation continues:
35678
35679 @smallexample
35680 @var{intro-text}
35681 ^Z^Zsignal-name
35682 @var{name}
35683 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
35684 @var{middle-text}
35685 ^Z^Zsignal-string
35686 @var{string}
35687 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
35688 @var{end-text}
35689 @end smallexample
35690
35691 @noindent
35692 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
35693 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
35694 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
35695 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
35696 user's benefit and have no particular format.
35697
35698 @findex signal annotation
35699 @item ^Z^Zsignal
35700 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
35701 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
35702 terminated with it.
35703
35704 @findex breakpoint annotation
35705 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
35706 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
35707
35708 @findex watchpoint annotation
35709 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
35710 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
35711 @end table
35712
35713 @node Source Annotations
35714 @section Displaying Source
35715 @cindex annotations for source display
35716
35717 @findex source annotation
35718 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
35719
35720 @smallexample
35721 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
35722 @end smallexample
35723
35724 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
35725 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
35726 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
35727 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
35728 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
35729 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
35730 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
35731 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
35732 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
35733 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
35734 depend on the language).
35735
35736 @node JIT Interface
35737 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
35738 @cindex just-in-time compilation
35739 @cindex JIT compilation interface
35740
35741 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
35742 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
35743 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
35744 performance while maintaining platform independence.
35745
35746 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
35747 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
35748 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
35749 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
35750 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
35751 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
35752
35753 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
35754 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
35755 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
35756 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
35757 LLVM JIT.
35758
35759 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
35760 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
35761 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
35762 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
35763 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
35764 out about additional code.
35765
35766 @menu
35767 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
35768 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
35769 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
35770 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
35771 @end menu
35772
35773 @node Declarations
35774 @section JIT Declarations
35775
35776 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
35777 implement the interface:
35778
35779 @smallexample
35780 typedef enum
35781 @{
35782 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
35783 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
35784 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
35785 @} jit_actions_t;
35786
35787 struct jit_code_entry
35788 @{
35789 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
35790 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
35791 const char *symfile_addr;
35792 uint64_t symfile_size;
35793 @};
35794
35795 struct jit_descriptor
35796 @{
35797 uint32_t version;
35798 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
35799 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
35800 uint32_t action_flag;
35801 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
35802 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
35803 @};
35804
35805 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
35806 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
35807
35808 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
35809 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
35810 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
35811 @end smallexample
35812
35813 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
35814 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
35815 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
35816
35817 @node Registering Code
35818 @section Registering Code
35819
35820 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
35821
35822 @itemize @bullet
35823 @item
35824 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
35825 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
35826
35827 @item
35828 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
35829 file.
35830
35831 @item
35832 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
35833
35834 @item
35835 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
35836
35837 @item
35838 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
35839 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
35840 @end itemize
35841
35842 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
35843 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
35844 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
35845 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
35846
35847 @node Unregistering Code
35848 @section Unregistering Code
35849
35850 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
35851
35852 @itemize @bullet
35853 @item
35854 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
35855
35856 @item
35857 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
35858
35859 @item
35860 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
35861 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
35862 @end itemize
35863
35864 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
35865 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
35866
35867 @node Custom Debug Info
35868 @section Custom Debug Info
35869 @cindex custom JIT debug info
35870 @cindex JIT debug info reader
35871
35872 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
35873 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
35874 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
35875 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
35876 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
35877 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
35878 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
35879 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
35880 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
35881
35882 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
35883 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
35884 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
35885 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
35886 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
35887 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
35888 compiler.
35889
35890 @menu
35891 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
35892 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
35893 @end menu
35894
35895 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
35896 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
35897 @kindex jit-reader-load
35898 @kindex jit-reader-unload
35899
35900 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
35901 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
35902
35903 @table @code
35904 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
35905 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
35906 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
35907 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
35908 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
35909 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
35910 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
35911
35912 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
35913 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
35914 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
35915 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
35916 @code{jit-reader-load}.
35917
35918 @item jit-reader-unload
35919 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
35920
35921 @end table
35922
35923 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
35924 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
35925 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
35926
35927 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
35928 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
35929
35930 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
35931 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
35932 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
35933 the system include directory.
35934
35935 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
35936 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
35937 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
35938
35939 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
35940 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
35941
35942 @findex gdb_init_reader
35943 @smallexample
35944 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
35945 @end smallexample
35946
35947 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
35948
35949 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
35950 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
35951 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
35952 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
35953 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
35954 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
35955
35956 @smallexample
35957 struct gdb_reader_funcs
35958 @{
35959 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
35960 int reader_version;
35961
35962 /* For use by the reader. */
35963 void *priv_data;
35964
35965 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
35966 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
35967 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
35968 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
35969 @};
35970 @end smallexample
35971
35972 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
35973 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
35974
35975 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
35976 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
35977 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
35978 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
35979 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
35980 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
35981 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
35982 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
35983 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
35984 target's address space.
35985
35986 @node In-Process Agent
35987 @chapter In-Process Agent
35988 @cindex debugging agent
35989 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
35990 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
35991 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
35992 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
35993 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
35994 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
35995 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
35996 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
35997 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
35998 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
35999 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
36000 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
36001 behavior without interrupting it.
36002
36003 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
36004 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
36005 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
36006 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
36007 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
36008 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
36009 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
36010 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
36011 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
36012
36013 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
36014 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
36015 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
36016 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
36017
36018 @anchor{Control Agent}
36019 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
36020 debugging with the following commands:
36021
36022 @table @code
36023 @kindex set agent on
36024 @item set agent on
36025 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
36026 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
36027 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
36028 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
36029 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
36030 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
36031
36032 @kindex set agent off
36033 @item set agent off
36034 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
36035 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
36036
36037 @kindex show agent
36038 @item show agent
36039 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
36040 the in-process agent.
36041 @end table
36042
36043 @menu
36044 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
36045 @end menu
36046
36047 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
36048 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
36049 @cindex in-process agent protocol
36050
36051 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
36052 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
36053 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
36054 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
36055 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
36056 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
36057 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
36058 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
36059 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
36060
36061 @menu
36062 * IPA Protocol Objects::
36063 * IPA Protocol Commands::
36064 @end menu
36065
36066 @node IPA Protocol Objects
36067 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
36068 @cindex ipa protocol objects
36069
36070 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
36071 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
36072
36073 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
36074 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
36075 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
36076 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
36077
36078 @enumerate
36079 @item
36080 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
36081 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
36082 @item
36083 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
36084 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
36085 the other one.
36086 @end enumerate
36087
36088 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
36089
36090 @enumerate
36091 @item
36092 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
36093 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
36094 @anchor{agent expression object}
36095 @item
36096 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
36097 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
36098 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
36099 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
36100 @item
36101 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
36102 @anchor{tracepoint object}
36103
36104 @end enumerate
36105
36106 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
36107 object:
36108
36109 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
36110 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
36111 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
36112 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
36113 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
36114 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
36115 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36116 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
36117 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
36118 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
36119 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
36120 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
36121 memory address for collecting.
36122 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
36123 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36124 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
36125 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36126 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
36127 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
36128 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
36129 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
36130 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
36131 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
36132 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
36133 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
36134 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
36135 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
36136 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
36137 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
36138 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
36139 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
36140 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
36141 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
36142 @ref{agent expression object}
36143 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
36144 @ref{agent expression object}
36145 @item actions @tab variable
36146 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
36147 @end multitable
36148
36149 @node IPA Protocol Commands
36150 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
36151 @cindex ipa protocol commands
36152
36153 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
36154 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
36155
36156 @table @samp
36157
36158 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
36159 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
36160 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
36161 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
36162 in IPA finally.
36163
36164 Replies:
36165 @table @samp
36166 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
36167 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
36168 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
36169 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
36170 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
36171 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
36172 @item E @var{NN}
36173 for an error
36174
36175 @end table
36176
36177 @item close
36178 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
36179 is about to kill inferiors.
36180
36181 @item qTfSTM
36182 @xref{qTfSTM}.
36183 @item qTsSTM
36184 @xref{qTsSTM}.
36185 @item qTSTMat
36186 @xref{qTSTMat}.
36187 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
36188 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
36189
36190 Replies:
36191 @table @samp
36192 @item E @var{NN}
36193 for an error
36194 @end table
36195 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
36196 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
36197 @end table
36198
36199 @node GDB Bugs
36200 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
36201 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
36202 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
36203
36204 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
36205
36206 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
36207 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
36208 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
36209 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
36210
36211 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
36212 information that enables us to fix the bug.
36213
36214 @menu
36215 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
36216 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
36217 @end menu
36218
36219 @node Bug Criteria
36220 @section Have You Found a Bug?
36221 @cindex bug criteria
36222
36223 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
36224
36225 @itemize @bullet
36226 @cindex fatal signal
36227 @cindex debugger crash
36228 @cindex crash of debugger
36229 @item
36230 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
36231 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
36232
36233 @cindex error on valid input
36234 @item
36235 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
36236 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
36237 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
36238
36239 @cindex invalid input
36240 @item
36241 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
36242 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
36243 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
36244 for traditional practice''.
36245
36246 @item
36247 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
36248 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
36249 @end itemize
36250
36251 @node Bug Reporting
36252 @section How to Report Bugs
36253 @cindex bug reports
36254 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
36255
36256 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
36257 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
36258 contact that organization first.
36259
36260 You can find contact information for many support companies and
36261 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
36262 distribution.
36263 @c should add a web page ref...
36264
36265 @ifset BUGURL
36266 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
36267 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
36268 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
36269 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
36270 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
36271 be used.
36272
36273 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
36274 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
36275 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
36276 @samp{bug-gdb}.
36277
36278 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
36279 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
36280 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
36281 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
36282 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
36283 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
36284 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
36285 bug reports to the mailing list.
36286 @end ifset
36287 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
36288 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
36289 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
36290 @end ifclear
36291 @end ifset
36292
36293 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
36294 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
36295 fact or leave it out, state it!
36296
36297 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
36298 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
36299 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
36300 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
36301 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
36302 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
36303 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
36304 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
36305 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
36306
36307 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
36308 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
36309 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
36310 self-contained.
36311
36312 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36313 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
36314 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
36315 bugs properly.
36316
36317 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
36318
36319 @itemize @bullet
36320 @item
36321 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
36322 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
36323 version}.
36324
36325 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
36326 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
36327
36328 @item
36329 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
36330 version number.
36331
36332 @item
36333 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
36334 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
36335 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
36336 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
36337
36338 @item
36339 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
36340 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
36341
36342 @item
36343 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
36344 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
36345 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
36346 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
36347 those compilers.
36348
36349 @item
36350 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
36351 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
36352 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
36353 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
36354
36355 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
36356 and then we might not encounter the bug.
36357
36358 @item
36359 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
36360 reproduce the bug.
36361
36362 @item
36363 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
36364 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
36365
36366 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
36367 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
36368 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
36369 a chance to make a mistake.
36370
36371 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
36372 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
36373 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
36374 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
36375 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
36376 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
36377 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
36378 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
36379
36380 @pindex script
36381 @cindex recording a session script
36382 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
36383 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
36384 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
36385 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
36386
36387 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
36388 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
36389
36390 @item
36391 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
36392 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
36393 it by context, not by line number.
36394
36395 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
36396 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
36397
36398 @end itemize
36399
36400 Here are some things that are not necessary:
36401
36402 @itemize @bullet
36403 @item
36404 A description of the envelope of the bug.
36405
36406 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
36407 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
36408 changes will not affect it.
36409
36410 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
36411 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
36412 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
36413 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
36414
36415 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
36416 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
36417 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
36418 less time, and so on.
36419
36420 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
36421 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
36422
36423 @item
36424 A patch for the bug.
36425
36426 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
36427 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
36428 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
36429 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
36430
36431 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
36432 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
36433 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
36434 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
36435
36436 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
36437 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
36438 help us to understand.
36439
36440 @item
36441 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
36442
36443 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
36444 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
36445 @end itemize
36446
36447 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
36448 @c and consists of the two following files:
36449 @c rluser.texi
36450 @c hsuser.texi
36451 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
36452 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
36453 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
36454 @include rluser.texi
36455 @include hsuser.texi
36456 @end ifclear
36457
36458 @node In Memoriam
36459 @appendix In Memoriam
36460
36461 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
36462 contributors:
36463
36464 @table @code
36465 @item Fred Fish
36466 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
36467 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
36468 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
36469
36470 @item Michael Snyder
36471 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
36472 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
36473 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
36474 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
36475 @end table
36476
36477 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
36478 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
36479
36480 @node Formatting Documentation
36481 @appendix Formatting Documentation
36482
36483 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
36484 @cindex reference card
36485 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
36486 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
36487 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
36488 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
36489 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
36490 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
36491
36492 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
36493 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
36494
36495 @smallexample
36496 make refcard.dvi
36497 @end smallexample
36498
36499 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
36500 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
36501 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
36502 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
36503 your @sc{dvi} output program.
36504
36505 @cindex documentation
36506
36507 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
36508 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
36509 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
36510 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
36511 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
36512 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
36513
36514 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
36515 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
36516 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
36517 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
36518 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
36519 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
36520 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
36521 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
36522
36523 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
36524 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
36525 @code{makeinfo}.
36526
36527 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
36528 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
36529 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
36530
36531 @smallexample
36532 cd gdb
36533 make gdb.info
36534 @end smallexample
36535
36536 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
36537 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
36538 Texinfo definitions file.
36539
36540 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
36541 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
36542 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
36543 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
36544 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
36545 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
36546 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
36547
36548 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
36549 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
36550 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
36551 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
36552 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
36553 directory.
36554
36555 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
36556 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
36557 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
36558 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
36559
36560 @smallexample
36561 make gdb.dvi
36562 @end smallexample
36563
36564 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
36565
36566 @node Installing GDB
36567 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
36568 @cindex installation
36569
36570 @menu
36571 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
36572 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
36573 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
36574 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
36575 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
36576 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
36577 @end menu
36578
36579 @node Requirements
36580 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
36581 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
36582
36583 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
36584 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
36585
36586 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
36587 @table @asis
36588 @item C@t{++}11 compiler
36589 @value{GDBN} is written in C@t{++}11. It should be buildable with any
36590 recent C@t{++}11 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
36591
36592 @item GNU make
36593 @value{GDBN}'s build system relies on features only found in the GNU
36594 make program. Other variants of @code{make} will not work.
36595 @end table
36596
36597 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
36598 @table @asis
36599 @item Expat
36600 @anchor{Expat}
36601 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
36602 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
36603 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
36604 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
36605 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
36606 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
36607
36608 Expat is used for:
36609
36610 @itemize @bullet
36611 @item
36612 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
36613 @item
36614 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
36615 @item
36616 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
36617 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
36618 @item
36619 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
36620 @item
36621 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
36622 @item
36623 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
36624 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
36625 @end itemize
36626
36627 @item Guile
36628 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using GNU Guile. @xref{Guile}. By
36629 default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Guile libraries are
36630 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
36631 @code{--with-guile} option to request Guile, and pass either the Guile
36632 version number or the file name of the relevant @code{pkg-config}
36633 program to choose a particular version of Guile.
36634
36635 @item iconv
36636 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
36637 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
36638 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
36639 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
36640
36641 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
36642 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to
36643 find it. This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies
36644 the directory that contains the @code{iconv} program. This program is
36645 run in order to make a list of the available character sets.
36646
36647 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If
36648 Libiconv is installed in a standard place, @value{GDBN} will
36649 automatically use it if it is needed. If you have previously
36650 installed Libiconv in a non-standard place, you can use the
36651 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to @file{configure}.
36652
36653 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
36654 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
36655 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
36656 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
36657 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
36658 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
36659 Libiconv, unpack it inside the top-level directory of the @value{GDBN}
36660 source tree, and then rename the directory holding the Libiconv source
36661 code to @samp{libiconv}.
36662
36663 @item lzma
36664 @value{GDBN} can support debugging sections that are compressed with
36665 the LZMA library. @xref{MiniDebugInfo}. If this library is not
36666 included with your operating system, you can find it in the xz package
36667 at @url{http://tukaani.org/xz/}. If the LZMA library is available in
36668 the usual place, then the @file{configure} script will use it
36669 automatically. If it is installed in an unusual path, you can use the
36670 @option{--with-lzma-prefix} option to specify its location.
36671
36672 @item MPFR
36673 @anchor{MPFR}
36674 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
36675 library. This library may be included with your operating system
36676 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
36677 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
36678 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
36679 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
36680 option to specify its location.
36681
36682 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
36683 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
36684 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
36685 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
36686
36687 @item Python
36688 @value{GDBN} can be scripted using Python language. @xref{Python}.
36689 By default, @value{GDBN} will be compiled if the Python libraries are
36690 installed and are found by @file{configure}. You can use the
36691 @code{--with-python} option to request Python, and pass either the
36692 file name of the relevant @code{python} executable, or the name of the
36693 directory in which Python is installed, to choose a particular
36694 installation of Python.
36695
36696 @item zlib
36697 @cindex compressed debug sections
36698 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
36699 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
36700 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
36701 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
36702 information in such binaries.
36703
36704 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
36705 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
36706 @url{http://zlib.net}.
36707 @end table
36708
36709 @node Running Configure
36710 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
36711 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
36712 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
36713 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
36714 build the @code{gdb} program.
36715 @iftex
36716 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
36717 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
36718 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
36719 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
36720 @end iftex
36721
36722 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
36723 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
36724 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
36725
36726 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
36727 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
36728
36729 @table @code
36730 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
36731 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
36732
36733 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
36734 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
36735
36736 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
36737 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
36738
36739 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
36740 @sc{gnu} include files
36741
36742 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
36743 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
36744
36745 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
36746 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
36747
36748 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
36749 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
36750 @end table
36751
36752 There may be other subdirectories as well.
36753
36754 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
36755 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
36756 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
36757
36758 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
36759 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
36760 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
36761 argument.
36762
36763 For example:
36764
36765 @smallexample
36766 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
36767 ./configure
36768 make
36769 @end smallexample
36770
36771 Running @samp{configure} and then running @code{make} builds the
36772 included supporting libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured
36773 source files, and the binaries, are left in the corresponding source
36774 directories.
36775
36776 @need 750
36777 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
36778 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
36779 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
36780
36781 @smallexample
36782 sh configure
36783 @end smallexample
36784
36785 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
36786 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
36787 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
36788 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
36789 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
36790 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
36791 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
36792 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
36793 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
36794
36795 You can install @code{@value{GDBN}} anywhere. The best way to do this
36796 is to pass the @code{--prefix} option to @code{configure}, and then
36797 install it with @code{make install}.
36798
36799 @node Separate Objdir
36800 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
36801
36802 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
36803 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
36804 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
36805 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
36806 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
36807 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
36808 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
36809 program specified there.
36810
36811 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
36812 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
36813 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
36814 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
36815 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
36816 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
36817
36818 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
36819 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
36820
36821 @smallexample
36822 @group
36823 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
36824 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
36825 cd ../gdb-sun4
36826 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure
36827 make
36828 @end group
36829 @end smallexample
36830
36831 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
36832 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
36833 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
36834 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
36835 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
36836 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
36837
36838 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
36839 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
36840 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
36841 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
36842 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
36843
36844 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
36845 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
36846 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
36847 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
36848 You specify a cross-debugging target by
36849 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
36850
36851 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
36852 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
36853 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
36854
36855 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
36856 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
36857 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
36858 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
36859 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
36860
36861 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
36862 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
36863 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
36864 with each other.
36865
36866 @node Config Names
36867 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
36868
36869 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
36870 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
36871 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
36872 of information in the following pattern:
36873
36874 @smallexample
36875 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
36876 @end smallexample
36877
36878 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
36879 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
36880 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
36881
36882 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
36883 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
36884 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
36885 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
36886 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
36887 abbreviations---for example:
36888
36889 @smallexample
36890 % sh config.sub i386-linux
36891 i386-pc-linux-gnu
36892 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
36893 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
36894 % sh config.sub hp9k700
36895 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
36896 % sh config.sub sun4
36897 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
36898 % sh config.sub sun3
36899 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
36900 % sh config.sub i986v
36901 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
36902 @end smallexample
36903
36904 @noindent
36905 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
36906 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
36907
36908 @node Configure Options
36909 @section @file{configure} Options
36910
36911 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
36912 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure}
36913 also has several other options not listed here. @inforef{Running
36914 configure scripts,,autoconf.info}, for a full
36915 explanation of @file{configure}.
36916
36917 @smallexample
36918 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
36919 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
36920 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
36921 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
36922 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
36923 @end smallexample
36924
36925 @noindent
36926 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
36927 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
36928 @samp{--}.
36929
36930 @table @code
36931 @item --help
36932 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
36933
36934 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
36935 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
36936 @file{@var{dir}}.
36937
36938 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
36939 Configure the source to install programs under directory
36940 @file{@var{dir}}.
36941
36942 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
36943 @need 2000
36944 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
36945 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
36946 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
36947 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
36948 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
36949 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
36950 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
36951 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
36952 @var{dirname}.
36953
36954 @item --target=@var{target}
36955 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
36956 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
36957 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
36958
36959 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available
36960 targets. Also see the @code{--enable-targets} option, below.
36961 @end table
36962
36963 There are many other options that are specific to @value{GDBN}. This
36964 lists just the most common ones; there are some very specialized
36965 options not described here.
36966
36967 @table @code
36968 @item --enable-targets=@r{[}@var{target}@r{]}@dots{}
36969 @itemx --enable-targets=all
36970 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the
36971 specified list of targets. The special value @samp{all} configures
36972 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs running on any target it supports.
36973
36974 @item --with-gdb-datadir=@var{path}
36975 Set the @value{GDBN}-specific data directory. @value{GDBN} will look
36976 here for certain supporting files or scripts. This defaults to the
36977 @file{gdb} subdirectory of @samp{datadi} (which can be set using
36978 @code{--datadir}).
36979
36980 @item --with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}
36981 Sets up the default source path substitution rule so that directory
36982 names recorded in debug information will be automatically adjusted for
36983 any directory under @var{dir}. @var{dir} should be a subdirectory of
36984 @value{GDBN}'s configured prefix, the one mentioned in the
36985 @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix} options to configure. This
36986 option is useful if GDB is supposed to be moved to a different place
36987 after it is built.
36988
36989 @item --enable-64-bit-bfd
36990 Enable 64-bit support in BFD on 32-bit hosts.
36991
36992 @item --disable-gdbmi
36993 Build @value{GDBN} without the GDB/MI machine interface
36994 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
36995
36996 @item --enable-tui
36997 Build @value{GDBN} with the text-mode full-screen user interface
36998 (TUI). Requires a curses library (ncurses and cursesX are also
36999 supported).
37000
37001 @item --with-curses
37002 Use the curses library instead of the termcap library, for text-mode
37003 terminal operations.
37004
37005 @item --with-libunwind-ia64
37006 Use the libunwind library for unwinding function call stack on ia64
37007 target platforms. See http://www.nongnu.org/libunwind/index.html for
37008 details.
37009
37010 @item --with-system-readline
37011 Use the readline library installed on the host, rather than the
37012 library supplied as part of @value{GDBN}. Readline 7 or newer is
37013 required; this is enforced by the build system.
37014
37015 @item --with-system-zlib
37016 Use the zlib library installed on the host, rather than the library
37017 supplied as part of @value{GDBN}.
37018
37019 @item --with-expat
37020 Build @value{GDBN} with Expat, a library for XML parsing. (Done by
37021 default if libexpat is installed and found at configure time.) This
37022 library is used to read XML files supplied with @value{GDBN}. If it
37023 is unavailable, some features, such as remote protocol memory maps,
37024 target descriptions, and shared library lists, that are based on XML
37025 files, will not be available in @value{GDBN}. If your host does not
37026 have libexpat installed, you can get the latest version from
37027 `http://expat.sourceforge.net'.
37028
37029 @item --with-libiconv-prefix@r{[}=@var{dir}@r{]}
37030
37031 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU libiconv, a character set encoding
37032 conversion library. This is not done by default, as on GNU systems
37033 the @code{iconv} that is built in to the C library is sufficient. If
37034 your host does not have a working @code{iconv}, you can get the latest
37035 version of GNU iconv from `https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/'.
37036
37037 @value{GDBN}'s build system also supports building GNU libiconv as
37038 part of the overall build. @xref{Requirements}.
37039
37040 @item --with-lzma
37041 Build @value{GDBN} with LZMA, a compression library. (Done by default
37042 if liblzma is installed and found at configure time.) LZMA is used by
37043 @value{GDBN}'s "mini debuginfo" feature, which is only useful on
37044 platforms using the ELF object file format. If your host does not
37045 have liblzma installed, you can get the latest version from
37046 `https://tukaani.org/xz/'.
37047
37048 @item --with-mpfr
37049 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU MPFR, a library for multiple-precision
37050 floating-point computation with correct rounding. (Done by default if
37051 GNU MPFR is installed and found at configure time.) This library is
37052 used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during expression
37053 evaluation when the target uses different floating-point formats than
37054 the host. If GNU MPFR is not available, @value{GDBN} will fall back
37055 to using host floating-point arithmetic. If your host does not have
37056 GNU MPFR installed, you can get the latest version from
37057 `http://www.mpfr.org'.
37058
37059 @item --with-python@r{[}=@var{python}@r{]}
37060 Build @value{GDBN} with Python scripting support. (Done by default if
37061 libpython is present and found at configure time.) Python makes
37062 @value{GDBN} scripting much more powerful than the restricted CLI
37063 scripting language. If your host does not have Python installed, you
37064 can find it on `http://www.python.org/download/'. The oldest version
37065 of Python supported by GDB is 2.6. The optional argument @var{python}
37066 is used to find the Python headers and libraries. It can be either
37067 the name of a Python executable, or the name of the directory in which
37068 Python is installed.
37069
37070 @item --with-guile[=GUILE]'
37071 Build @value{GDBN} with GNU Guile scripting support. (Done by default
37072 if libguile is present and found at configure time.) If your host
37073 does not have Guile installed, you can find it at
37074 `https://www.gnu.org/software/guile/'. The optional argument GUILE
37075 can be a version number, which will cause @code{configure} to try to
37076 use that version of Guile; or the file name of a @code{pkg-config}
37077 executable, which will be queried to find the information needed to
37078 compile and link against Guile.
37079
37080 @item --without-included-regex
37081 Don't use the regex library included with @value{GDBN} (as part of the
37082 libiberty library). This is the default on hosts with version 2 of
37083 the GNU C library.
37084
37085 @item --with-sysroot=@var{dir}
37086 Use @var{dir} as the default system root directory for libraries whose
37087 file names begin with @file{/lib}' or @file{/usr/lib'}. (The value of
37088 @var{dir} can be modified at run time by using the @command{set
37089 sysroot} command.) If @var{dir} is under the @value{GDBN} configured
37090 prefix (set with @code{--prefix} or @code{--exec-prefix options}, the
37091 default system root will be automatically adjusted if and when
37092 @value{GDBN} is moved to a different location.
37093
37094 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
37095 Configure @value{GDBN} to automatically load a system-wide init file.
37096 @var{file} should be an absolute file name. If @var{file} is in a
37097 directory under the configured prefix, and @value{GDBN} is moved to
37098 another location after being built, the location of the system-wide
37099 init file will be adjusted accordingly.
37100
37101 @item --enable-build-warnings
37102 When building the @value{GDBN} sources, ask the compiler to warn about
37103 any code which looks even vaguely suspicious. It passes many
37104 different warning flags, depending on the exact version of the
37105 compiler you are using.
37106
37107 @item --enable-werror
37108 Treat compiler warnings as werrors. It adds the @code{-Werror} flag
37109 to the compiler, which will fail the compilation if the compiler
37110 outputs any warning messages.
37111
37112 @item --enable-ubsan
37113 Enable the GCC undefined behavior sanitizer. This is disabled by
37114 default, but passing @code{--enable-ubsan=yes} or
37115 @code{--enable-ubsan=auto} to @code{configure} will enable it. The
37116 undefined behavior sanitizer checks for C@t{++} undefined behavior.
37117 It has a performance cost, so if you are looking at @value{GDBN}'s
37118 performance, you should disable it. The undefined behavior sanitizer
37119 was first introduced in GCC 4.9.
37120 @end table
37121
37122 @node System-wide configuration
37123 @section System-wide configuration and settings
37124 @cindex system-wide init file
37125
37126 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
37127 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
37128 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
37129
37130 Here is the corresponding configure option:
37131
37132 @table @code
37133 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
37134 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
37135 @var{file}.
37136 @end table
37137
37138 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
37139 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
37140
37141 @itemize @bullet
37142 @item
37143 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
37144 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
37145 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
37146 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
37147 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
37148 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
37149
37150 @item
37151 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
37152 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
37153 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
37154 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
37155 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
37156 @end itemize
37157
37158 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
37159 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
37160 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
37161 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
37162 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
37163 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
37164 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
37165 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
37166 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
37167 reread.
37168
37169 @menu
37170 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
37171 @end menu
37172
37173 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
37174 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
37175 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
37176
37177 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
37178 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
37179 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
37180 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
37181 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
37182 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
37183
37184 The following scripts are currently available:
37185 @itemize @bullet
37186
37187 @item @file{elinos.py}
37188 @pindex elinos.py
37189 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
37190 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
37191 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
37192 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
37193 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
37194 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
37195
37196 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
37197 @pindex wrs-linux.py
37198 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
37199 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
37200 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
37201 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
37202
37203 @end itemize
37204
37205 @node Maintenance Commands
37206 @appendix Maintenance Commands
37207 @cindex maintenance commands
37208 @cindex internal commands
37209
37210 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
37211 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
37212 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
37213 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
37214 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
37215
37216 @table @code
37217 @kindex maint agent
37218 @kindex maint agent-eval
37219 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
37220 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
37221 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
37222 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
37223 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
37224 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
37225 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
37226 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
37227 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
37228 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
37229 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
37230 addition and return the sum.
37231 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
37232 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
37233
37234 @kindex maint agent-printf
37235 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
37236 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
37237 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
37238 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
37239 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
37240
37241 @kindex maint info breakpoints
37242 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
37243 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
37244 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
37245 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
37246 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
37247 is shown:
37248
37249 @table @code
37250 @item breakpoint
37251 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
37252
37253 @item watchpoint
37254 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
37255
37256 @item longjmp
37257 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
37258 @code{longjmp} calls.
37259
37260 @item longjmp resume
37261 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
37262
37263 @item until
37264 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
37265
37266 @item finish
37267 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
37268
37269 @item shlib events
37270 Shared library events.
37271
37272 @end table
37273
37274 @kindex maint info btrace
37275 @item maint info btrace
37276 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
37277
37278 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
37279 @item maint btrace packet-history
37280 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
37281 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
37282 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
37283 recording format.
37284
37285 @table @code
37286 @item bts
37287 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
37288 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
37289
37290 @table @asis
37291 @item Block number
37292 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
37293 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
37294 @item Highest @samp{PC}
37295 @end table
37296
37297 @item pt
37298 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
37299 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
37300 information is printed:
37301
37302 @table @asis
37303 @item Packet number
37304 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
37305 @item Trace offset
37306 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
37307 @item Packet opcode and payload
37308 @end table
37309 @end table
37310
37311 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
37312 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
37313 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
37314 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
37315 needed.
37316
37317 @kindex maint btrace clear
37318 @item maint btrace clear
37319 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
37320 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
37321
37322 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
37323 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
37324 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
37325 buffer.
37326
37327 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
37328 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
37329 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
37330 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
37331 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
37332 packet history.
37333
37334 @kindex set displaced-stepping
37335 @kindex show displaced-stepping
37336 @cindex displaced stepping support
37337 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
37338 @item set displaced-stepping
37339 @itemx show displaced-stepping
37340 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
37341 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
37342 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
37343 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
37344 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
37345
37346 @table @code
37347 @item set displaced-stepping on
37348 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
37349 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
37350
37351 @item set displaced-stepping off
37352 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
37353 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
37354
37355 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
37356 @item set displaced-stepping auto
37357 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
37358 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
37359 architecture supports displaced stepping.
37360 @end table
37361
37362 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
37363 @item maint check-psymtabs
37364 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
37365 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
37366
37367 @kindex maint check-symtabs
37368 @item maint check-symtabs
37369 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
37370
37371 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
37372 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
37373 Expand symbol tables.
37374 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
37375 names matching @var{regexp}.
37376
37377 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
37378 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
37379 @cindex demangler crashes
37380 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
37381 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
37382 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
37383 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
37384 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
37385 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
37386 option to terminate the current session.
37387
37388 @kindex maint cplus first_component
37389 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
37390 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
37391
37392 @kindex maint cplus namespace
37393 @item maint cplus namespace
37394 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
37395
37396 @kindex maint deprecate
37397 @kindex maint undeprecate
37398 @cindex deprecated commands
37399 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
37400 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
37401 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
37402 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
37403 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
37404 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
37405 the replacement as part of the warning.
37406
37407 @kindex maint dump-me
37408 @item maint dump-me
37409 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
37410 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
37411 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
37412 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
37413
37414 @kindex maint internal-error
37415 @kindex maint internal-warning
37416 @kindex maint demangler-warning
37417 @cindex demangler crashes
37418 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
37419 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
37420 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
37421
37422 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
37423 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
37424 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
37425 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
37426 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
37427 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
37428 @value{GDBN} session.
37429
37430 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
37431 used as the text of the error or warning message.
37432
37433 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
37434
37435 @smallexample
37436 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
37437 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
37438 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
37439 debugging may prove unreliable.
37440 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
37441 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
37442 (@value{GDBP})
37443 @end smallexample
37444
37445 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
37446 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
37447 @cindex demangler crashes
37448
37449 @kindex maint set internal-error
37450 @kindex maint show internal-error
37451 @kindex maint set internal-warning
37452 @kindex maint show internal-warning
37453 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
37454 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
37455 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
37456 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
37457 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
37458 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
37459 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
37460 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
37461 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
37462 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
37463 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
37464 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
37465 described in the table below.
37466
37467 @table @samp
37468 @item quit
37469 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
37470 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
37471
37472 @item corefile
37473 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
37474 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
37475 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
37476 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
37477 disabled.
37478 @end table
37479
37480 @kindex maint packet
37481 @item maint packet @var{text}
37482 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
37483 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
37484 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
37485 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
37486 checksum.
37487
37488 @kindex maint print architecture
37489 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37490 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
37491 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
37492
37493 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37494 @item maint print c-tdesc
37495 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
37496 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
37497 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
37498 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
37499 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
37500 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
37501 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
37502 modify XML target descriptions.
37503
37504 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
37505 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
37506 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
37507 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
37508
37509 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
37510 @kindex maint check libthread-db
37511 @item maint check libthread-db
37512 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
37513 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
37514 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
37515 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
37516 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
37517 on some platforms when debugging core files.
37518
37519 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
37520 @item maint print dummy-frames
37521 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
37522
37523 @smallexample
37524 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
37525 @dots{}
37526 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
37527 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
37528 58 return (a + b);
37529 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
37530 @dots{}
37531 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
37532 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
37533 (@value{GDBP})
37534 @end smallexample
37535
37536 Takes an optional file parameter.
37537
37538 @kindex maint print registers
37539 @kindex maint print raw-registers
37540 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
37541 @kindex maint print register-groups
37542 @kindex maint print remote-registers
37543 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37544 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37545 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37546 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37547 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37548 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
37549
37550 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
37551 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
37552 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
37553 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
37554 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
37555 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
37556 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
37557 and offsets in the `G' packets.
37558
37559 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
37560 write the information.
37561
37562 @kindex maint print reggroups
37563 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
37564 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
37565 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
37566 information.
37567
37568 The register groups info looks like this:
37569
37570 @smallexample
37571 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
37572 Group Type
37573 general user
37574 float user
37575 all user
37576 vector user
37577 system user
37578 save internal
37579 restore internal
37580 @end smallexample
37581
37582 @kindex flushregs
37583 @item flushregs
37584 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
37585
37586 @kindex maint print objfiles
37587 @cindex info for known object files
37588 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
37589 Print a dump of all known object files.
37590 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
37591 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
37592 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
37593
37594 @kindex maint print user-registers
37595 @cindex user registers
37596 @item maint print user-registers
37597 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
37598 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
37599 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
37600 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
37601 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
37602 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
37603 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
37604
37605 @kindex maint print section-scripts
37606 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
37607 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
37608 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
37609 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
37610 matching @var{regexp}.
37611 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
37612 and the full path if known.
37613 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
37614
37615 @kindex maint print statistics
37616 @cindex bcache statistics
37617 @item maint print statistics
37618 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
37619 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
37620 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
37621 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
37622 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
37623 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
37624 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
37625 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
37626 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
37627 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
37628 lengths.
37629
37630 @kindex maint print target-stack
37631 @cindex target stack description
37632 @item maint print target-stack
37633 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
37634 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
37635 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
37636 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
37637 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
37638 address.
37639
37640 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
37641 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
37642
37643 @kindex maint print type
37644 @cindex type chain of a data type
37645 @item maint print type @var{expr}
37646 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
37647 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
37648 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
37649 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
37650 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
37651
37652 @kindex maint selftest
37653 @cindex self tests
37654 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
37655 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
37656 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
37657 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
37658 name will by ran.
37659
37660 @kindex maint info selftests
37661 @cindex self tests
37662 @item maint info selftests
37663 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
37664
37665 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
37666 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
37667 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
37668 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
37669 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
37670 information.
37671
37672 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
37673 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
37674 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
37675 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
37676 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
37677 always see the disassembly form.
37678
37679 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
37680
37681 @smallexample
37682 (gdb) info addr argc
37683 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
37684 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
37685 @end smallexample
37686
37687 For more information on these expressions, see
37688 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
37689
37690 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
37691 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
37692 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
37693 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
37694 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
37695
37696 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
37697 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
37698 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
37699 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
37700 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
37701 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
37702 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
37703 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
37704 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
37705
37706 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
37707 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
37708 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
37709 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
37710 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
37711
37712 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
37713 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
37714 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
37715 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
37716 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
37717 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
37718
37719 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
37720 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
37721 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
37722
37723 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
37724 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
37725 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
37726 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
37727
37728 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
37729 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
37730 @kindex maint set profile
37731 @kindex maint show profile
37732 @cindex profiling GDB
37733 @item maint set profile
37734 @itemx maint show profile
37735 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
37736
37737 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
37738 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
37739 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
37740 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
37741 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
37742 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
37743 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
37744
37745 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
37746 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
37747
37748 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
37749 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
37750 @cindex hardware debug registers
37751 @item maint set show-debug-regs
37752 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
37753 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
37754 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
37755 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
37756 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
37757 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
37758
37759 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
37760 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
37761 @item maint set show-all-tib
37762 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
37763 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
37764 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
37765 command.
37766
37767 @kindex maint set target-async
37768 @kindex maint show target-async
37769 @item maint set target-async
37770 @itemx maint show target-async
37771 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
37772 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
37773 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
37774 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
37775
37776 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
37777 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
37778 @item maint set target-non-stop
37779 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
37780
37781 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
37782 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
37783 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
37784 if supported by the target.
37785
37786 @table @code
37787 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
37788 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
37789 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
37790
37791 @item maint set target-non-stop on
37792 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
37793 does not indicate support.
37794
37795 @item maint set target-non-stop off
37796 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
37797 target supports it.
37798 @end table
37799
37800 @kindex maint set per-command
37801 @kindex maint show per-command
37802 @item maint set per-command
37803 @itemx maint show per-command
37804 @cindex resources used by commands
37805
37806 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
37807 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
37808
37809 @table @code
37810 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
37811 @itemx maint show per-command space
37812 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
37813 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
37814 took, following the command's own output.
37815 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
37816 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
37817
37818 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
37819 @itemx maint show per-command time
37820 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
37821 for each command.
37822 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
37823 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
37824 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
37825 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
37826 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
37827 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
37828 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
37829 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
37830 spent by the program been debugged.
37831 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
37832 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
37833
37834 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
37835 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
37836 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
37837 for each command.
37838 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
37839
37840 @enumerate a
37841 @item
37842 number of symbol tables
37843 @item
37844 number of primary symbol tables
37845 @item
37846 number of blocks in the blockvector
37847 @end enumerate
37848 @end table
37849
37850 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
37851 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
37852 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
37853 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
37854 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
37855 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
37856 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
37857 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
37858 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
37859 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
37860
37861 @kindex maint space
37862 @cindex memory used by commands
37863 @item maint space @var{value}
37864 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
37865 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
37866
37867 @kindex maint time
37868 @cindex time of command execution
37869 @item maint time @var{value}
37870 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
37871 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
37872
37873 @kindex maint translate-address
37874 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
37875 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
37876 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
37877 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
37878 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
37879 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
37880 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
37881
37882 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
37883 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
37884 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
37885
37886 @kindex maint test-options
37887 @item maint test-options require-delimiter
37888 @itemx maint test-options unknown-is-error
37889 @itemx maint test-options unknown-is-operand
37890 These commands are used by the testsuite to validate the command
37891 options framework. The @code{require-delimiter} variant requires a
37892 double-dash delimiter to indicate end of options. The
37893 @code{unknown-is-error} and @code{unknown-is-operand} do not. The
37894 @code{unknown-is-error} variant throws an error on unknown option,
37895 while @code{unknown-is-operand} treats unknown options as the start of
37896 the command's operands. When run, the commands output the result of
37897 the processed options. When completed, the commands store the
37898 internal result of completion in a variable exposed by the @code{maint
37899 show test-options-completion-result} command.
37900
37901 @kindex maint show test-options-completion-result
37902 @item maint show test-options-completion-result
37903 Shows the result of completing the @code{maint test-options}
37904 subcommands. This is used by the testsuite to validate completion
37905 support in the command options framework.
37906
37907 @kindex maint set test-settings
37908 @kindex maint show test-settings
37909 @item maint set test-settings @var{kind}
37910 @itemx maint show test-settings @var{kind}
37911 These are representative commands for each @var{kind} of setting type
37912 @value{GDBN} supports. They are used by the testsuite for exercising
37913 the settings infrastructure.
37914
37915 @kindex maint with
37916 @item maint with @var{setting} [@var{value}] [-- @var{command}]
37917 Like the @code{with} command, but works with @code{maintenance set}
37918 variables. This is used by the testsuite to exercise the @code{with}
37919 command's infrastructure.
37920
37921 @end table
37922
37923 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
37924 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
37925
37926 @table @code
37927 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
37928 @kindex set watchdog
37929 @cindex watchdog timer
37930 @cindex timeout for commands
37931 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
37932 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
37933 reports and error and the command is aborted.
37934
37935 @item show watchdog
37936 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
37937 @end table
37938
37939 @node Remote Protocol
37940 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
37941
37942 @menu
37943 * Overview::
37944 * Packets::
37945 * Stop Reply Packets::
37946 * General Query Packets::
37947 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
37948 * Tracepoint Packets::
37949 * Host I/O Packets::
37950 * Interrupts::
37951 * Notification Packets::
37952 * Remote Non-Stop::
37953 * Packet Acknowledgment::
37954 * Examples::
37955 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
37956 * Library List Format::
37957 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
37958 * Memory Map Format::
37959 * Thread List Format::
37960 * Traceframe Info Format::
37961 * Branch Trace Format::
37962 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
37963 @end menu
37964
37965 @node Overview
37966 @section Overview
37967
37968 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
37969 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
37970 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
37971 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
37972
37973 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
37974 transmitted and received data, respectively.
37975
37976 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
37977 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
37978 @cindex remote serial protocol
37979 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
37980 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
37981 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
37982 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
37983 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
37984
37985 @smallexample
37986 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
37987 @end smallexample
37988 @noindent
37989
37990 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
37991 @noindent
37992 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
37993 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
37994 eight bit unsigned checksum).
37995
37996 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
37997 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
37998
37999 @smallexample
38000 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
38001 @end smallexample
38002
38003 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
38004 @noindent
38005 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
38006 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
38007 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
38008
38009 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
38010 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
38011 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
38012 retransmission):
38013
38014 @smallexample
38015 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
38016 <- @code{+}
38017 @end smallexample
38018 @noindent
38019
38020 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
38021 once a connection is established.
38022 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
38023
38024 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
38025 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
38026 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
38027 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
38028 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
38029 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
38030 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
38031
38032 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
38033 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
38034 exceptions).
38035
38036 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
38037 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
38038 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
38039 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
38040
38041 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
38042 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
38043 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
38044
38045 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
38046 @anchor{Binary Data}
38047 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
38048 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
38049 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
38050 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
38051 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
38052 binary data.
38053
38054 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
38055 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
38056 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
38057 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
38058 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
38059 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
38060 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
38061 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
38062 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
38063 (described next).
38064
38065 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
38066 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
38067 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
38068 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
38069 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
38070 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
38071 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
38072 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
38073 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
38074 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
38075 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
38076 3}} more times.
38077
38078 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
38079 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
38080 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
38081 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
38082 @samp{0*"00}.
38083
38084 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
38085 error number. That number is not well defined.
38086
38087 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
38088 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
38089 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
38090 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
38091 on that response.
38092
38093 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
38094 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
38095 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
38096 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
38097 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
38098 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
38099
38100 @node Packets
38101 @section Packets
38102
38103 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
38104 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
38105 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
38106 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
38107
38108 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
38109 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
38110 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
38111 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
38112 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
38113 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
38114 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
38115 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
38116 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
38117 @var{baz}.
38118
38119 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
38120 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
38121 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
38122 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
38123 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
38124 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
38125 pick any thread.
38126
38127 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
38128 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
38129 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
38130 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
38131 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
38132 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
38133 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
38134 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
38135 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
38136 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
38137 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
38138 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
38139 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
38140
38141 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
38142 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
38143 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
38144 more information.
38145
38146 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
38147 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
38148
38149 Here are the packet descriptions.
38150
38151 @table @samp
38152
38153 @item !
38154 @cindex @samp{!} packet
38155 @anchor{extended mode}
38156 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
38157 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
38158 debugged.
38159
38160 Reply:
38161 @table @samp
38162 @item OK
38163 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
38164 @end table
38165
38166 @item ?
38167 @cindex @samp{?} packet
38168 @anchor{? packet}
38169 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
38170 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
38171 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
38172
38173 Reply:
38174 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38175
38176 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
38177 @cindex @samp{A} packet
38178 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
38179 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
38180 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
38181
38182 Reply:
38183 @table @samp
38184 @item OK
38185 The arguments were set.
38186 @item E @var{NN}
38187 An error occurred.
38188 @end table
38189
38190 @item b @var{baud}
38191 @cindex @samp{b} packet
38192 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
38193 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
38194
38195 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
38196 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
38197 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
38198
38199 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
38200 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
38201 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
38202 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
38203 of view, nothing actually happened.}
38204
38205 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
38206 @cindex @samp{B} packet
38207 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
38208 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
38209
38210 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
38211 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
38212
38213 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
38214 @anchor{bc}
38215 @item bc
38216 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
38217 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
38218
38219 Reply:
38220 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38221
38222 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
38223 @anchor{bs}
38224 @item bs
38225 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
38226 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
38227
38228 Reply:
38229 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38230
38231 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
38232 @cindex @samp{c} packet
38233 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
38234 is omitted, resume at current address.
38235
38236 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38237 packet}.
38238
38239 Reply:
38240 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38241
38242 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
38243 @cindex @samp{C} packet
38244 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
38245 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
38246
38247 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38248 packet}.
38249
38250 Reply:
38251 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38252
38253 @item d
38254 @cindex @samp{d} packet
38255 Toggle debug flag.
38256
38257 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
38258 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
38259
38260 @item D
38261 @itemx D;@var{pid}
38262 @cindex @samp{D} packet
38263 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
38264 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
38265 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
38266
38267 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
38268 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
38269 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
38270 big-endian hex string.
38271
38272 Reply:
38273 @table @samp
38274 @item OK
38275 for success
38276 @item E @var{NN}
38277 for an error
38278 @end table
38279
38280 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
38281 @cindex @samp{F} packet
38282 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
38283 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
38284 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
38285
38286 @item g
38287 @anchor{read registers packet}
38288 @cindex @samp{g} packet
38289 Read general registers.
38290
38291 Reply:
38292 @table @samp
38293 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
38294 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
38295 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
38296 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
38297 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
38298 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
38299
38300 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
38301 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
38302 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
38303 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
38304 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
38305 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
38306 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
38307 have been collected, and both have zero value:
38308
38309 @smallexample
38310 -> @code{g}
38311 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
38312 @end smallexample
38313
38314 @item E @var{NN}
38315 for an error.
38316 @end table
38317
38318 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
38319 @cindex @samp{G} packet
38320 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
38321 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
38322
38323 Reply:
38324 @table @samp
38325 @item OK
38326 for success
38327 @item E @var{NN}
38328 for an error
38329 @end table
38330
38331 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
38332 @cindex @samp{H} packet
38333 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
38334 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
38335 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
38336 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
38337 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
38338 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
38339 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
38340
38341 Reply:
38342 @table @samp
38343 @item OK
38344 for success
38345 @item E @var{NN}
38346 for an error
38347 @end table
38348
38349 @c FIXME: JTC:
38350 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
38351 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
38352 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
38353 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
38354 @c described. For example:
38355 @c
38356 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
38357 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
38358 @c otherwise returns current registers.
38359 @c
38360 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
38361 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
38362 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
38363
38364 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
38365 @anchor{cycle step packet}
38366 @cindex @samp{i} packet
38367 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
38368 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
38369 step starting at that address.
38370
38371 @item I
38372 @cindex @samp{I} packet
38373 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
38374 step packet}.
38375
38376 @item k
38377 @cindex @samp{k} packet
38378 Kill request.
38379
38380 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
38381
38382 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
38383 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
38384
38385 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
38386
38387 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
38388 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
38389 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
38390
38391 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
38392 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
38393 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
38394
38395 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
38396 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
38397 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
38398 (@pxref{? packet}).
38399
38400 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
38401 @cindex @samp{m} packet
38402 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
38403 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
38404 any particular boundary.
38405
38406 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
38407 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
38408 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
38409 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
38410 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
38411 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
38412 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
38413 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
38414
38415 Reply:
38416 @table @samp
38417 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
38418 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
38419 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
38420 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
38421 @item E @var{NN}
38422 @var{NN} is errno
38423 @end table
38424
38425 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
38426 @cindex @samp{M} packet
38427 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
38428 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
38429 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
38430
38431 Reply:
38432 @table @samp
38433 @item OK
38434 for success
38435 @item E @var{NN}
38436 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
38437 written).
38438 @end table
38439
38440 @item p @var{n}
38441 @cindex @samp{p} packet
38442 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
38443 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
38444 register value is encoded.
38445
38446 Reply:
38447 @table @samp
38448 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
38449 the register's value
38450 @item E @var{NN}
38451 for an error
38452 @item @w{}
38453 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
38454 @end table
38455
38456 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
38457 @anchor{write register packet}
38458 @cindex @samp{P} packet
38459 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
38460 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
38461 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
38462
38463 Reply:
38464 @table @samp
38465 @item OK
38466 for success
38467 @item E @var{NN}
38468 for an error
38469 @end table
38470
38471 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
38472 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
38473 @cindex @samp{q} packet
38474 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
38475 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
38476 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
38477
38478 @item r
38479 @cindex @samp{r} packet
38480 Reset the entire system.
38481
38482 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
38483
38484 @item R @var{XX}
38485 @cindex @samp{R} packet
38486 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
38487 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38488
38489 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
38490
38491 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
38492 @cindex @samp{s} packet
38493 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
38494 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
38495
38496 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38497 packet}.
38498
38499 Reply:
38500 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38501
38502 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
38503 @anchor{step with signal packet}
38504 @cindex @samp{S} packet
38505 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
38506 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
38507
38508 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
38509 packet}.
38510
38511 Reply:
38512 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38513
38514 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
38515 @cindex @samp{t} packet
38516 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
38517 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
38518 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
38519
38520 @item T @var{thread-id}
38521 @cindex @samp{T} packet
38522 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
38523
38524 Reply:
38525 @table @samp
38526 @item OK
38527 thread is still alive
38528 @item E @var{NN}
38529 thread is dead
38530 @end table
38531
38532 @item v
38533 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
38534 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
38535
38536 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
38537 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
38538 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
38539 The process ID is a
38540 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
38541 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
38542 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
38543
38544 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
38545 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
38546 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
38547 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
38548 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
38549 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
38550 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
38551 @c stopping or restarting threads.
38552
38553 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38554
38555 Reply:
38556 @table @samp
38557 @item E @var{nn}
38558 for an error
38559 @item @r{Any stop packet}
38560 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
38561 @item OK
38562 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
38563 @end table
38564
38565 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
38566 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
38567 @anchor{vCont packet}
38568 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
38569
38570 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
38571 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
38572 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
38573 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
38574 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
38575 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
38576 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
38577 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
38578 error.
38579
38580 Currently supported actions are:
38581
38582 @table @samp
38583 @item c
38584 Continue.
38585 @item C @var{sig}
38586 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
38587 @item s
38588 Step.
38589 @item S @var{sig}
38590 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
38591 @item t
38592 Stop.
38593 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
38594 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
38595 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
38596 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
38597 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
38598 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
38599
38600 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
38601 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
38602 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
38603 jumps to @var{start}).
38604
38605 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
38606 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
38607 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
38608
38609 @end table
38610
38611 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
38612 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
38613 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
38614
38615 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
38616 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
38617 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
38618 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
38619 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
38620 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
38621 as an implementation detail.
38622
38623 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
38624 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
38625 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
38626 stopped.
38627
38628 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
38629 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
38630 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
38631
38632 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
38633 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
38634
38635 Reply:
38636 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
38637
38638 @item vCont?
38639 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
38640 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
38641
38642 Reply:
38643 @table @samp
38644 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
38645 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
38646 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
38647 @item @w{}
38648 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
38649 @end table
38650
38651 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
38652 @item vCtrlC
38653 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
38654 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
38655 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
38656 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
38657 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
38658 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
38659 variant.
38660
38661 Reply:
38662 @table @samp
38663 @item E @var{nn}
38664 for an error
38665 @item OK
38666 for success
38667 @end table
38668
38669 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
38670 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
38671 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
38672 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
38673
38674 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
38675 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
38676 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
38677 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
38678 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
38679 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
38680 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
38681 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
38682 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
38683 packet is received.
38684
38685 Reply:
38686 @table @samp
38687 @item OK
38688 for success
38689 @item E @var{NN}
38690 for an error
38691 @end table
38692
38693 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
38694 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
38695 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
38696 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
38697 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
38698 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
38699 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
38700 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
38701 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
38702 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
38703 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
38704 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
38705
38706
38707 Reply:
38708 @table @samp
38709 @item OK
38710 for success
38711 @item E.memtype
38712 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
38713 @item E @var{NN}
38714 for an error
38715 @end table
38716
38717 @item vFlashDone
38718 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
38719 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
38720 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
38721 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
38722 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
38723 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
38724 request is completed.
38725
38726 @item vKill;@var{pid}
38727 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
38728 @anchor{vKill packet}
38729 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
38730 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
38731 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
38732 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
38733
38734 Reply:
38735 @table @samp
38736 @item E @var{nn}
38737 for an error
38738 @item OK
38739 for success
38740 @end table
38741
38742 @item vMustReplyEmpty
38743 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
38744 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
38745 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
38746 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
38747
38748 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
38749 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
38750 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
38751 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
38752 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
38753 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
38754
38755 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
38756 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
38757 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
38758 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
38759 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
38760 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
38761 state.
38762
38763 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
38764
38765 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
38766
38767 Reply:
38768 @table @samp
38769 @item E @var{nn}
38770 for an error
38771 @item @r{Any stop packet}
38772 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
38773 @end table
38774
38775 @item vStopped
38776 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
38777 @xref{Notification Packets}.
38778
38779 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
38780 @anchor{X packet}
38781 @cindex @samp{X} packet
38782 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
38783 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
38784 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
38785 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
38786
38787 Reply:
38788 @table @samp
38789 @item OK
38790 for success
38791 @item E @var{NN}
38792 for an error
38793 @end table
38794
38795 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
38796 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
38797 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
38798 @cindex @samp{z} packet
38799 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
38800 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
38801 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
38802
38803 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
38804 separately.
38805
38806 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
38807 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
38808 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
38809 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
38810 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
38811 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
38812
38813 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38814 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
38815 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
38816 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
38817 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
38818 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
38819
38820 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
38821 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
38822 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
38823 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
38824 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
38825 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
38826 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
38827 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
38828 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
38829 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
38830 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
38831 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
38832 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
38833
38834 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
38835 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
38836
38837 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
38838 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
38839
38840 @table @samp
38841
38842 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38843 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
38844 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
38845
38846 @end table
38847
38848 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
38849 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
38850 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
38851 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
38852 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
38853 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
38854 separators. Each expression has the following form:
38855
38856 @table @samp
38857
38858 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
38859 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
38860 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
38861
38862 @end table
38863
38864 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
38865 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
38866 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
38867 target, is not defined.}
38868
38869 Reply:
38870 @table @samp
38871 @item OK
38872 success
38873 @item @w{}
38874 not supported
38875 @item E @var{NN}
38876 for an error
38877 @end table
38878
38879 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38880 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
38881 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
38882 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
38883 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
38884 address @var{addr}.
38885
38886 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
38887 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
38888 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
38889 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
38890
38891 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
38892 movement.}
38893
38894 Reply:
38895 @table @samp
38896 @item OK
38897 success
38898 @item @w{}
38899 not supported
38900 @item E @var{NN}
38901 for an error
38902 @end table
38903
38904 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38905 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38906 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
38907 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
38908 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38909 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
38910
38911 Reply:
38912 @table @samp
38913 @item OK
38914 success
38915 @item @w{}
38916 not supported
38917 @item E @var{NN}
38918 for an error
38919 @end table
38920
38921 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38922 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38923 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
38924 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
38925 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38926 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
38927
38928 Reply:
38929 @table @samp
38930 @item OK
38931 success
38932 @item @w{}
38933 not supported
38934 @item E @var{NN}
38935 for an error
38936 @end table
38937
38938 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38939 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
38940 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
38941 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
38942 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
38943 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
38944
38945 Reply:
38946 @table @samp
38947 @item OK
38948 success
38949 @item @w{}
38950 not supported
38951 @item E @var{NN}
38952 for an error
38953 @end table
38954
38955 @end table
38956
38957 @node Stop Reply Packets
38958 @section Stop Reply Packets
38959 @cindex stop reply packets
38960
38961 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
38962 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
38963 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
38964 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
38965 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
38966 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
38967 @value{GDBN} source code.
38968
38969 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
38970 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
38971 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
38972
38973 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
38974 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
38975 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
38976 components.
38977
38978 @table @samp
38979
38980 @item S @var{AA}
38981 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
38982 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
38983 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
38984
38985 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
38986 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
38987 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
38988 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
38989 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
38990 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
38991 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
38992 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
38993
38994 @itemize @bullet
38995 @item
38996 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
38997 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
38998 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
38999 two-digit hex number.
39000
39001 @item
39002 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
39003 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
39004
39005 @item
39006 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
39007 the core on which the stop event was detected.
39008
39009 @item
39010 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
39011 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
39012 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
39013 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
39014
39015 @item
39016 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
39017 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
39018 future.
39019 @end itemize
39020
39021 The currently defined stop reasons are:
39022
39023 @table @samp
39024 @item watch
39025 @itemx rwatch
39026 @itemx awatch
39027 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
39028 hex.
39029
39030 @item syscall_entry
39031 @itemx syscall_return
39032 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
39033 syscall number, in hex.
39034
39035 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
39036 @item library
39037 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
39038 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
39039 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
39040
39041 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
39042 @item replaylog
39043 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
39044 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
39045 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
39046 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
39047 for more information.
39048
39049 @item swbreak
39050 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
39051 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
39052 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
39053 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
39054 part must be left empty.
39055
39056 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
39057 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
39058 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
39059 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
39060 address.
39061
39062 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39063 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39064 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39065 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39066 indicating support.
39067
39068 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
39069
39070 @item hwbreak
39071 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
39072 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
39073
39074 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
39075 apply.
39076
39077 @cindex fork events, remote reply
39078 @item fork
39079 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
39080 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
39081 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
39082 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
39083 fork events.
39084
39085 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39086 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39087 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39088 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39089 indicating support.
39090
39091 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
39092 @item vfork
39093 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
39094 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
39095 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
39096 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
39097 vfork events.
39098
39099 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39100 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39101 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39102 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39103 indicating support.
39104
39105 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
39106 @item vforkdone
39107 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
39108 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
39109 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
39110 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
39111 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
39112
39113 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39114 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39115 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39116 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39117 indicating support.
39118
39119 @cindex exec events, remote reply
39120 @item exec
39121 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
39122 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
39123 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
39124
39125 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
39126 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
39127 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
39128 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
39129 indicating support.
39130
39131 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
39132 @anchor{thread create event}
39133 @item create
39134 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
39135 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
39136 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
39137 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
39138 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
39139 @var{r} part is ignored.
39140
39141 @end table
39142
39143 @item W @var{AA}
39144 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
39145 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
39146 applicable to certain targets.
39147
39148 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
39149 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
39150 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
39151 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
39152 hex strings.
39153
39154 @item X @var{AA}
39155 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
39156 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
39157
39158 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
39159 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
39160 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
39161 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
39162 hex strings.
39163
39164 @anchor{thread exit event}
39165 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
39166 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
39167
39168 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
39169 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
39170 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
39171 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
39172
39173 @item N
39174 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
39175 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
39176 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
39177 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
39178 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
39179 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
39180 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
39181 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
39182 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
39183 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
39184 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
39185 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
39186 support.
39187
39188 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
39189 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
39190 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
39191 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
39192 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
39193
39194 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
39195 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
39196 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
39197 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
39198 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
39199 system calls.
39200
39201 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
39202 this very system call.
39203
39204 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
39205 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
39206 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
39207 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
39208 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
39209 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
39210
39211 @end table
39212
39213 @node General Query Packets
39214 @section General Query Packets
39215 @cindex remote query requests
39216
39217 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
39218 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
39219 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
39220 sending information to and from the stub.
39221
39222 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
39223 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
39224 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
39225 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
39226 conventions:
39227
39228 @itemize @bullet
39229 @item
39230 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
39231 @item
39232 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
39233 letter.
39234 @item
39235 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
39236 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
39237 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
39238 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
39239 @end itemize
39240
39241 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
39242 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
39243 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
39244 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
39245 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
39246 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
39247 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
39248 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
39249 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
39250 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
39251 packet.}.
39252
39253 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
39254 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
39255 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
39256 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
39257 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
39258
39259 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
39260
39261 @table @samp
39262
39263 @item QAgent:1
39264 @itemx QAgent:0
39265 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
39266 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
39267
39268 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
39269 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
39270 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
39271 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
39272 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
39273 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
39274 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
39275 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
39276 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
39277 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
39278 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
39279
39280 @item qC
39281 @cindex current thread, remote request
39282 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
39283 Return the current thread ID.
39284
39285 Reply:
39286 @table @samp
39287 @item QC @var{thread-id}
39288 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
39289 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
39290 @item @r{(anything else)}
39291 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
39292 @end table
39293
39294 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
39295 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
39296 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
39297 @anchor{qCRC packet}
39298 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
39299 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
39300 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
39301 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
39302
39303 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
39304 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
39305 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
39306 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
39307 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
39308 detect trailing zeros.
39309
39310 Reply:
39311 @table @samp
39312 @item E @var{NN}
39313 An error (such as memory fault)
39314 @item C @var{crc32}
39315 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
39316 @end table
39317
39318 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
39319 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
39320 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
39321 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
39322 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
39323 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
39324 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
39325 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
39326 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
39327 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
39328 randomization.
39329
39330 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
39331
39332 Reply:
39333 @table @samp
39334 @item OK
39335 The request succeeded.
39336
39337 @item E @var{nn}
39338 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39339
39340 @item @w{}
39341 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
39342 by the stub.
39343 @end table
39344
39345 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39346 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39347 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
39348 address space randomization.
39349
39350 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
39351 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
39352 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
39353 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
39354 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
39355 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
39356 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
39357 inferior using a shell or not.
39358
39359 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
39360 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
39361 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
39362 values are considered an error.
39363
39364 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39365 mode}).
39366
39367 Reply:
39368 @table @samp
39369 @item OK
39370 The request succeeded.
39371
39372 @item E @var{nn}
39373 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39374 @end table
39375
39376 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39377 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39378 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
39379 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
39380
39381 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
39382 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
39383
39384 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
39385 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
39386 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
39387 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
39388 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
39389 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
39390 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
39391 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
39392 environment}).
39393
39394 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
39395 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
39396 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
39397 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
39398 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
39399 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
39400 not be present.
39401
39402 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39403 mode}).
39404
39405 Reply:
39406 @table @samp
39407 @item OK
39408 The request succeeded.
39409 @end table
39410
39411 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39412 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39413 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
39414 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
39415 inferior.
39416
39417 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
39418 @pxref{set environment}.
39419
39420 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
39421 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
39422 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
39423 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
39424 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
39425 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
39426 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
39427 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
39428
39429 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
39430 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
39431
39432 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39433 mode}).
39434
39435 Reply:
39436 @table @samp
39437 @item OK
39438 The request succeeded.
39439 @end table
39440
39441 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39442 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39443 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
39444 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
39445 inferior.
39446
39447 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
39448 @pxref{unset environment}.
39449
39450 @item QEnvironmentReset
39451 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
39452 @cindex reset environment, remote request
39453 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
39454 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
39455 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
39456 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
39457 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
39458 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
39459 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
39460 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
39461 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
39462
39463 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39464 mode}).
39465
39466 Reply:
39467 @table @samp
39468 @item OK
39469 The request succeeded.
39470 @end table
39471
39472 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39473 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39474 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
39475 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
39476 inferior.
39477
39478 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
39479 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
39480 @cindex set working directory, remote request
39481 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
39482 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
39483 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
39484
39485 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
39486 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
39487 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
39488 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
39489 directory to its original, empty value.
39490
39491 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
39492 mode}).
39493
39494 Reply:
39495 @table @samp
39496 @item OK
39497 The request succeeded.
39498 @end table
39499
39500 @item qfThreadInfo
39501 @itemx qsThreadInfo
39502 @cindex list active threads, remote request
39503 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
39504 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
39505 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
39506 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
39507 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
39508 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
39509 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
39510 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
39511
39512 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
39513
39514 Reply:
39515 @table @samp
39516 @item m @var{thread-id}
39517 A single thread ID
39518 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
39519 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
39520 @item l
39521 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
39522 @end table
39523
39524 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39525 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
39526 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
39527 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
39528 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
39529 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
39530 fields.
39531
39532 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
39533 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
39534 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
39535 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
39536 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
39537
39538 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
39539 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
39540 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
39541 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
39542 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
39543
39544 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
39545 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
39546
39547 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
39548 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
39549 information associated with the variable.)
39550
39551 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
39552 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
39553 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
39554 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
39555 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
39556 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
39557
39558 Reply:
39559 @table @samp
39560 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39561 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
39562 local storage requested.
39563
39564 @item E @var{nn}
39565 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39566
39567 @item @w{}
39568 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
39569 @end table
39570
39571 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
39572 @cindex get thread information block address
39573 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
39574 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
39575
39576 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
39577
39578 Reply:
39579 @table @samp
39580 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
39581 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
39582 thread information block.
39583
39584 @item E @var{nn}
39585 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
39586 address could not be retrieved.
39587
39588 @item @w{}
39589 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
39590 @end table
39591
39592 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
39593 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
39594 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
39595 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
39596 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
39597 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
39598 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
39599
39600 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
39601
39602 Reply:
39603 @table @samp
39604 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
39605 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
39606 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
39607 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
39608 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
39609 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
39610 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
39611 @end table
39612
39613 @item qOffsets
39614 @cindex section offsets, remote request
39615 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
39616 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
39617 image.
39618
39619 Reply:
39620 @table @samp
39621 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
39622 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
39623 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
39624 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
39625 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
39626 segments by the supplied offsets.
39627
39628 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
39629 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
39630 to the @code{Bss} section.}
39631
39632 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
39633 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
39634 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
39635 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
39636 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
39637 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
39638 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
39639 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
39640 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
39641 @end table
39642
39643 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
39644 @cindex thread information, remote request
39645 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
39646 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
39647 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
39648 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
39649
39650 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
39651 (see below).
39652
39653 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
39654
39655 @item QNonStop:1
39656 @itemx QNonStop:0
39657 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
39658 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
39659 @anchor{QNonStop}
39660 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
39661 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
39662
39663 Reply:
39664 @table @samp
39665 @item OK
39666 The request succeeded.
39667
39668 @item E @var{nn}
39669 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39670
39671 @item @w{}
39672 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
39673 the stub.
39674 @end table
39675
39676 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39677 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39678 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
39679 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
39680
39681 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
39682 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
39683 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
39684 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
39685 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
39686 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
39687 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
39688
39689 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
39690 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
39691 is listed, every system call should be reported.
39692
39693 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
39694 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
39695 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
39696 report the requested syscalls.
39697
39698 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
39699 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
39700
39701 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
39702 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
39703 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
39704 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
39705
39706 Reply:
39707 @table @samp
39708 @item OK
39709 The request succeeded.
39710
39711 @item E @var{nn}
39712 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
39713
39714 @item @w{}
39715 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
39716 the stub.
39717 @end table
39718
39719 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
39720 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
39721 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39722 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39723
39724 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
39725 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
39726 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
39727 @anchor{QPassSignals}
39728 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
39729 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
39730 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
39731 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
39732 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
39733 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
39734 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
39735 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
39736 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
39737
39738 Reply:
39739 @table @samp
39740 @item OK
39741 The request succeeded.
39742
39743 @item E @var{nn}
39744 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39745
39746 @item @w{}
39747 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
39748 the stub.
39749 @end table
39750
39751 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
39752 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
39753 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39754 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39755
39756 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
39757 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
39758 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
39759 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
39760 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
39761 Others should be silently discarded.
39762
39763 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
39764 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
39765 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
39766 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
39767 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
39768 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
39769 signals.
39770
39771 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
39772 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
39773
39774 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
39775 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
39776 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
39777 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
39778 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
39779
39780 Reply:
39781 @table @samp
39782 @item OK
39783 The request succeeded.
39784
39785 @item E @var{nn}
39786 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39787
39788 @item @w{}
39789 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
39790 by the stub.
39791 @end table
39792
39793 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
39794 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
39795 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39796 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39797
39798 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
39799 @item QThreadEvents:1
39800 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
39801 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
39802 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
39803
39804 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
39805 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
39806 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
39807 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
39808 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
39809 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
39810 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
39811 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
39812 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
39813 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39814
39815 Reply:
39816 @table @samp
39817 @item OK
39818 The request succeeded.
39819
39820 @item E @var{nn}
39821 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39822
39823 @item @w{}
39824 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
39825 the stub.
39826 @end table
39827
39828 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
39829 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
39830
39831 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
39832 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
39833 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
39834 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
39835 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
39836 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
39837 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
39838 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
39839 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
39840
39841 Reply:
39842 @table @samp
39843 @item OK
39844 A command response with no output.
39845 @item @var{OUTPUT}
39846 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
39847 @item E @var{NN}
39848 Indicate a badly formed request.
39849 @item @w{}
39850 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
39851 @end table
39852
39853 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
39854 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
39855 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
39856 packets.)
39857
39858 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
39859 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
39860 @ifnotinfo
39861 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
39862 @end ifnotinfo
39863 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
39864 @anchor{qSearch memory}
39865 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
39866 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
39867 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
39868
39869 Reply:
39870 @table @samp
39871 @item 0
39872 The pattern was not found.
39873 @item 1,address
39874 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
39875 @item E @var{NN}
39876 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
39877 @item @w{}
39878 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
39879 @end table
39880
39881 @item QStartNoAckMode
39882 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
39883 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
39884 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
39885 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
39886
39887 Reply:
39888 @table @samp
39889 @item OK
39890 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
39891 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
39892 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
39893 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
39894 @item @w{}
39895 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
39896 @end table
39897
39898 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
39899 @cindex supported packets, remote query
39900 @cindex features of the remote protocol
39901 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
39902 @anchor{qSupported}
39903 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
39904 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
39905 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
39906 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
39907 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
39908 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
39909 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
39910 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
39911 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
39912 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
39913 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
39914 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
39915 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
39916 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
39917
39918 Reply:
39919 @table @samp
39920 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
39921 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
39922 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
39923 possible forms).
39924 @item @w{}
39925 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
39926 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
39927 @end table
39928
39929 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
39930 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
39931 are:
39932
39933 @table @samp
39934 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
39935 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
39936 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
39937 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
39938 @item @var{name}+
39939 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
39940 need an associated value.
39941 @item @var{name}-
39942 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
39943 @item @var{name}?
39944 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
39945 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
39946 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
39947 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
39948 @end table
39949
39950 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
39951 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
39952 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
39953 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
39954 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
39955
39956 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
39957 are defined:
39958
39959 @table @samp
39960 @item multiprocess
39961 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
39962 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39963 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39964 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39965 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
39966
39967 @item xmlRegisters
39968 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
39969 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
39970 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
39971 description.
39972
39973 @item qRelocInsn
39974 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
39975 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39976 instruction reply packet}).
39977
39978 @item swbreak
39979 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
39980 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
39981
39982 @item hwbreak
39983 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
39984 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
39985
39986 @item fork-events
39987 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
39988 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39989 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39990 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39991
39992 @item vfork-events
39993 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
39994 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
39995 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
39996 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
39997
39998 @item exec-events
39999 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
40000 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
40001 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
40002 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
40003
40004 @item vContSupported
40005 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
40006 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
40007 @end table
40008
40009 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
40010 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
40011 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
40012 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
40013 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
40014 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
40015 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
40016 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
40017 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
40018 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
40019 all the features it supports.
40020
40021 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
40022 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
40023
40024 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
40025 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
40026 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
40027 form response.
40028
40029 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
40030 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
40031 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
40032 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
40033
40034 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
40035 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
40036 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
40037 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
40038 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
40039
40040 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
40041
40042 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
40043 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
40044 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
40045 @item Feature Name
40046 @tab Value Required
40047 @tab Default
40048 @tab Probe Allowed
40049
40050 @item @samp{PacketSize}
40051 @tab Yes
40052 @tab @samp{-}
40053 @tab No
40054
40055 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
40056 @tab No
40057 @tab @samp{-}
40058 @tab Yes
40059
40060 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40061 @tab No
40062 @tab @samp{-}
40063 @tab Yes
40064
40065 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40066 @tab No
40067 @tab @samp{-}
40068 @tab Yes
40069
40070 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
40071 @tab No
40072 @tab @samp{-}
40073 @tab Yes
40074
40075 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
40076 @tab No
40077 @tab @samp{-}
40078 @tab Yes
40079
40080 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
40081 @tab No
40082 @tab @samp{-}
40083 @tab Yes
40084
40085 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
40086 @tab No
40087 @tab @samp{-}
40088 @tab Yes
40089
40090 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
40091 @tab No
40092 @tab @samp{-}
40093 @tab No
40094
40095 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
40096 @tab No
40097 @tab @samp{-}
40098 @tab Yes
40099
40100 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
40101 @tab No
40102 @tab @samp{-}
40103 @tab Yes
40104
40105 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
40106 @tab No
40107 @tab @samp{-}
40108 @tab Yes
40109
40110 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
40111 @tab No
40112 @tab @samp{-}
40113 @tab Yes
40114
40115 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
40116 @tab No
40117 @tab @samp{-}
40118 @tab Yes
40119
40120 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
40121 @tab No
40122 @tab @samp{-}
40123 @tab Yes
40124
40125 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
40126 @tab No
40127 @tab @samp{-}
40128 @tab Yes
40129
40130 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40131 @tab No
40132 @tab @samp{-}
40133 @tab Yes
40134
40135 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
40136 @tab No
40137 @tab @samp{-}
40138 @tab Yes
40139
40140 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
40141 @tab No
40142 @tab @samp{-}
40143 @tab Yes
40144
40145 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
40146 @tab Yes
40147 @tab @samp{-}
40148 @tab Yes
40149
40150 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
40151 @tab Yes
40152 @tab @samp{-}
40153 @tab Yes
40154
40155 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
40156 @tab Yes
40157 @tab @samp{-}
40158 @tab Yes
40159
40160 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
40161 @tab Yes
40162 @tab @samp{-}
40163 @tab Yes
40164
40165 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
40166 @tab Yes
40167 @tab @samp{-}
40168 @tab Yes
40169
40170 @item @samp{QNonStop}
40171 @tab No
40172 @tab @samp{-}
40173 @tab Yes
40174
40175 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
40176 @tab No
40177 @tab @samp{-}
40178 @tab Yes
40179
40180 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
40181 @tab No
40182 @tab @samp{-}
40183 @tab Yes
40184
40185 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
40186 @tab No
40187 @tab @samp{-}
40188 @tab Yes
40189
40190 @item @samp{multiprocess}
40191 @tab No
40192 @tab @samp{-}
40193 @tab No
40194
40195 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
40196 @tab No
40197 @tab @samp{-}
40198 @tab No
40199
40200 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
40201 @tab No
40202 @tab @samp{-}
40203 @tab No
40204
40205 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
40206 @tab No
40207 @tab @samp{-}
40208 @tab No
40209
40210 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
40211 @tab No
40212 @tab @samp{-}
40213 @tab No
40214
40215 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
40216 @tab No
40217 @tab @samp{-}
40218 @tab No
40219
40220 @item @samp{QAgent}
40221 @tab No
40222 @tab @samp{-}
40223 @tab No
40224
40225 @item @samp{QAllow}
40226 @tab No
40227 @tab @samp{-}
40228 @tab No
40229
40230 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
40231 @tab No
40232 @tab @samp{-}
40233 @tab No
40234
40235 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
40236 @tab No
40237 @tab @samp{-}
40238 @tab No
40239
40240 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
40241 @tab No
40242 @tab @samp{-}
40243 @tab No
40244
40245 @item @samp{tracenz}
40246 @tab No
40247 @tab @samp{-}
40248 @tab No
40249
40250 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
40251 @tab No
40252 @tab @samp{-}
40253 @tab No
40254
40255 @item @samp{swbreak}
40256 @tab No
40257 @tab @samp{-}
40258 @tab No
40259
40260 @item @samp{hwbreak}
40261 @tab No
40262 @tab @samp{-}
40263 @tab No
40264
40265 @item @samp{fork-events}
40266 @tab No
40267 @tab @samp{-}
40268 @tab No
40269
40270 @item @samp{vfork-events}
40271 @tab No
40272 @tab @samp{-}
40273 @tab No
40274
40275 @item @samp{exec-events}
40276 @tab No
40277 @tab @samp{-}
40278 @tab No
40279
40280 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
40281 @tab No
40282 @tab @samp{-}
40283 @tab No
40284
40285 @item @samp{no-resumed}
40286 @tab No
40287 @tab @samp{-}
40288 @tab No
40289
40290 @end multitable
40291
40292 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
40293
40294 @table @samp
40295 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
40296 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
40297 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
40298 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
40299 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
40300 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
40301 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
40302 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
40303 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
40304 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
40305
40306 @item qXfer:auxv:read
40307 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
40308 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
40309
40310 @item qXfer:btrace:read
40311 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
40312 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
40313
40314 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
40315 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
40316 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
40317
40318 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
40319 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
40320 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
40321
40322 @item qXfer:features:read
40323 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
40324 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
40325
40326 @item qXfer:libraries:read
40327 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
40328 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
40329
40330 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
40331 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
40332 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
40333
40334 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
40335 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
40336 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
40337 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
40338
40339 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
40340 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
40341 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
40342
40343 @item qXfer:sdata:read
40344 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
40345 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
40346
40347 @item qXfer:spu:read
40348 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
40349 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
40350
40351 @item qXfer:spu:write
40352 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
40353 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
40354
40355 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
40356 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
40357 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
40358
40359 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
40360 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
40361 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
40362
40363 @item qXfer:threads:read
40364 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
40365 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
40366
40367 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
40368 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
40369 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
40370
40371 @item qXfer:uib:read
40372 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
40373 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
40374
40375 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
40376 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
40377 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
40378
40379 @item QNonStop
40380 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
40381 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
40382
40383 @item QCatchSyscalls
40384 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
40385 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
40386
40387 @item QPassSignals
40388 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
40389 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
40390
40391 @item QStartNoAckMode
40392 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
40393 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
40394
40395 @item multiprocess
40396 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
40397 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
40398 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
40399 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
40400 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
40401 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
40402 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
40403 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
40404 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
40405 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
40406 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
40407
40408 @item qXfer:osdata:read
40409 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
40410 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
40411
40412 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
40413 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
40414 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
40415 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
40416
40417 @item ConditionalTracepoints
40418 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
40419 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
40420
40421 @item ReverseContinue
40422 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
40423 (@pxref{bc}).
40424
40425 @item ReverseStep
40426 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
40427 (@pxref{bs}).
40428
40429 @item TracepointSource
40430 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
40431 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
40432
40433 @item QAgent
40434 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
40435
40436 @item QAllow
40437 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
40438
40439 @item QDisableRandomization
40440 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
40441
40442 @item StaticTracepoint
40443 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
40444 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
40445
40446 @item InstallInTrace
40447 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
40448 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
40449
40450 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
40451 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
40452 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
40453 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
40454
40455 @item QTBuffer:size
40456 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
40457 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
40458
40459 @item tracenz
40460 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
40461 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
40462 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
40463
40464 @item BreakpointCommands
40465 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
40466 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
40467 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
40468
40469 @item Qbtrace:off
40470 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
40471
40472 @item Qbtrace:bts
40473 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
40474
40475 @item Qbtrace:pt
40476 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
40477
40478 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
40479 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
40480
40481 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
40482 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
40483
40484 @item swbreak
40485 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
40486 breakpoints.
40487
40488 @item hwbreak
40489 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
40490 breakpoints.
40491
40492 @item fork-events
40493 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
40494
40495 @item vfork-events
40496 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
40497 and vforkdone events.
40498
40499 @item exec-events
40500 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
40501
40502 @item vContSupported
40503 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
40504 @samp{vCont?} packet.
40505
40506 @item QThreadEvents
40507 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
40508
40509 @item no-resumed
40510 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
40511
40512 @end table
40513
40514 @item qSymbol::
40515 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
40516 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
40517 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
40518 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
40519
40520 Reply:
40521 @table @samp
40522 @item OK
40523 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
40524 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
40525 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
40526 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
40527 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
40528 below.
40529 @end table
40530
40531 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
40532 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
40533
40534 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
40535 target has previously requested.
40536
40537 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
40538 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
40539 will be empty.
40540
40541 Reply:
40542 @table @samp
40543 @item OK
40544 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
40545 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
40546 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
40547 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
40548 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
40549 @end table
40550
40551 @item qTBuffer
40552 @itemx QTBuffer
40553 @itemx QTDisconnected
40554 @itemx QTDP
40555 @itemx QTDPsrc
40556 @itemx QTDV
40557 @itemx qTfP
40558 @itemx qTfV
40559 @itemx QTFrame
40560 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
40561
40562 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
40563
40564 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
40565 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
40566 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
40567 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
40568 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
40569 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
40570 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
40571 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
40572 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
40573 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
40574 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
40575
40576 Reply:
40577 @table @samp
40578 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
40579 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
40580 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
40581 the thread's attributes.
40582 @end table
40583
40584 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
40585 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
40586 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
40587 packets.)
40588
40589 @item QTNotes
40590 @itemx qTP
40591 @itemx QTSave
40592 @itemx qTsP
40593 @itemx qTsV
40594 @itemx QTStart
40595 @itemx QTStop
40596 @itemx QTEnable
40597 @itemx QTDisable
40598 @itemx QTinit
40599 @itemx QTro
40600 @itemx qTStatus
40601 @itemx qTV
40602 @itemx qTfSTM
40603 @itemx qTsSTM
40604 @itemx qTSTMat
40605 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
40606
40607 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40608 @cindex read special object, remote request
40609 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
40610 @anchor{qXfer read}
40611 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
40612 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
40613 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
40614 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
40615 additional details about what data to access.
40616
40617 Reply:
40618 @table @samp
40619 @item m @var{data}
40620 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
40621 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
40622 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
40623 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
40624 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
40625 request.
40626
40627 @item l @var{data}
40628 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
40629 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
40630 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
40631
40632 @item l
40633 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
40634 There is no more data to be read.
40635
40636 @item E00
40637 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
40638
40639 @item E @var{nn}
40640 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
40641 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
40642
40643 @item @w{}
40644 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
40645 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
40646 @end table
40647
40648 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
40649 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
40650 formats, listed above.
40651
40652 @table @samp
40653 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40654 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
40655 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
40656 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
40657
40658 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40659 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40660
40661 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40662 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
40663
40664 Return a description of the current branch trace.
40665 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
40666 packet may have one of the following values:
40667
40668 @table @code
40669 @item all
40670 Returns all available branch trace.
40671
40672 @item new
40673 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
40674 the last read request.
40675
40676 @item delta
40677 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
40678 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
40679 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
40680 used to stitch traces together.
40681
40682 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
40683 @end table
40684
40685 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
40686 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40687
40688 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40689 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
40690
40691 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
40692 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
40693
40694 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
40695 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40696
40697 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40698 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
40699 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
40700 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
40701 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
40702 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
40703 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
40704
40705 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40706 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40707
40708 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40709 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
40710 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
40711 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
40712 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
40713
40714 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40715 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40716
40717 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40718 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
40719 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
40720 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
40721 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40722
40723 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
40724 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
40725 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
40726
40727 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40728 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40729
40730 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40731 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
40732 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
40733 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
40734 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
40735 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
40736 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40737 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
40738
40739 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
40740 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
40741
40742 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40743 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40744
40745 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
40746 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
40747 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
40748 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
40749
40750 @table @code
40751 @item start=@var{address}
40752 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
40753 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
40754 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
40755 chosen as the starting point.
40756
40757 @item prev=@var{address}
40758 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
40759 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
40760 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
40761 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
40762 exists prior to the starting point.
40763
40764 @end table
40765
40766 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
40767 ignored.
40768
40769 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40770 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
40771 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
40772 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
40773 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40774
40775 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40776 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40777
40778 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40779 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
40780
40781 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
40782 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
40783 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
40784 Action Lists}.
40785
40786 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40787 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40788 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40789
40790 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40791 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
40792 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
40793 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
40794 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40795
40796 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40797 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40798 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40799
40800 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40801 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
40802 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
40803 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
40804 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
40805 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
40806 in that context to be accessed.
40807
40808 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40809 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40810 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40811
40812 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40813 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
40814 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
40815 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
40816 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40817
40818 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40819 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40820
40821 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40822 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
40823
40824 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
40825 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
40826 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
40827
40828 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40829 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40830
40831 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40832 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
40833
40834 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
40835 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
40836
40837 This packet is not probed by default.
40838
40839 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
40840 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
40841 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
40842 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
40843 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
40844
40845 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40846 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40847
40848 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
40849 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
40850 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
40851 @xref{Operating System Information}.
40852
40853 @end table
40854
40855 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
40856 @cindex write data into object, remote request
40857 @anchor{qXfer write}
40858 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
40859 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
40860 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
40861 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
40862 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
40863 to access.
40864
40865 Reply:
40866 @table @samp
40867 @item @var{nn}
40868 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
40869 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
40870
40871 @item E00
40872 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
40873
40874 @item E @var{nn}
40875 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
40876 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
40877
40878 @item @w{}
40879 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
40880 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
40881 @end table
40882
40883 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
40884 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
40885 formats, listed above.
40886
40887 @table @samp
40888 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
40889 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
40890 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
40891 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
40892 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
40893
40894 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40895 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
40896 (@pxref{qSupported}).
40897
40898 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
40899 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
40900 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
40901 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
40902 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
40903 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
40904 in that context to be accessed.
40905
40906 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
40907 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40908 @end table
40909
40910 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
40911 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
40912 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
40913 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
40914 must respond with an empty packet.
40915
40916 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
40917 @cindex query attached, remote request
40918 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
40919 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
40920 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
40921 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
40922 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
40923 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
40924 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
40925
40926 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
40927 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
40928 the @code{quit} command.
40929
40930 Reply:
40931 @table @samp
40932 @item 1
40933 The remote server attached to an existing process.
40934 @item 0
40935 The remote server created a new process.
40936 @item E @var{NN}
40937 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40938 @end table
40939
40940 @item Qbtrace:bts
40941 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
40942
40943 Reply:
40944 @table @samp
40945 @item OK
40946 Branch tracing has been enabled.
40947 @item E.errtext
40948 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40949 @end table
40950
40951 @item Qbtrace:pt
40952 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
40953
40954 Reply:
40955 @table @samp
40956 @item OK
40957 Branch tracing has been enabled.
40958 @item E.errtext
40959 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40960 @end table
40961
40962 @item Qbtrace:off
40963 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
40964
40965 Reply:
40966 @table @samp
40967 @item OK
40968 Branch tracing has been disabled.
40969 @item E.errtext
40970 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40971 @end table
40972
40973 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
40974 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
40975 btrace recording method in bts format.
40976
40977 Reply:
40978 @table @samp
40979 @item OK
40980 The ring buffer size has been set.
40981 @item E.errtext
40982 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40983 @end table
40984
40985 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
40986 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
40987 btrace recording method in pt format.
40988
40989 Reply:
40990 @table @samp
40991 @item OK
40992 The ring buffer size has been set.
40993 @item E.errtext
40994 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
40995 @end table
40996
40997 @end table
40998
40999 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
41000 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
41001
41002 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
41003 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
41004 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
41005
41006 @menu
41007 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
41008 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
41009 @end menu
41010
41011 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
41012 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
41013
41014 @menu
41015 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
41016 @end menu
41017
41018 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
41019 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
41020 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
41021
41022 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
41023
41024 @table @r
41025
41026 @item 2
41027 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
41028
41029 @item 3
41030 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
41031
41032 @item 4
41033 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
41034
41035 @end table
41036
41037 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
41038 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
41039
41040 @menu
41041 * MIPS Register packet Format::
41042 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
41043 @end menu
41044
41045 @node MIPS Register packet Format
41046 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
41047 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
41048
41049 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
41050 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
41051 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
41052 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
41053 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
41054 most-significant -- least-significant.
41055
41056 @table @r
41057
41058 @item MIPS32
41059 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
41060 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
41061 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
41062
41063 @item MIPS64
41064 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
41065 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
41066 as @code{MIPS32}.
41067
41068 @end table
41069
41070 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
41071 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
41072 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
41073
41074 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
41075
41076 @table @r
41077
41078 @item 2
41079 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
41080
41081 @item 3
41082 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
41083
41084 @item 4
41085 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
41086
41087 @item 5
41088 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
41089
41090 @end table
41091
41092 @node Tracepoint Packets
41093 @section Tracepoint Packets
41094 @cindex tracepoint packets
41095 @cindex packets, tracepoint
41096
41097 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
41098 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
41099
41100 @table @samp
41101
41102 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
41103 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
41104 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
41105 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
41106 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
41107 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
41108 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
41109 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
41110 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
41111 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
41112 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
41113 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
41114 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
41115 actions.
41116
41117 Replies:
41118 @table @samp
41119 @item OK
41120 The packet was understood and carried out.
41121 @item qRelocInsn
41122 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
41123 @item @w{}
41124 The packet was not recognized.
41125 @end table
41126
41127 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
41128 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
41129 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
41130 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
41131 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
41132 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
41133 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
41134
41135 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
41136 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
41137 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
41138 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
41139 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
41140 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
41141 tracepoint actions.
41142
41143 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
41144 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
41145 following forms:
41146
41147 @table @samp
41148
41149 @item R @var{mask}
41150 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
41151 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
41152 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
41153 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
41154 not fit in a 32-bit word.
41155
41156 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
41157 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
41158 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
41159 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
41160 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
41161 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
41162 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
41163
41164 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
41165 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
41166 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
41167 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
41168 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
41169 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
41170 packet).
41171
41172 @end table
41173
41174 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
41175 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
41176 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
41177 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
41178 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
41179 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
41180 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
41181 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
41182
41183 Replies:
41184 @table @samp
41185 @item OK
41186 The packet was understood and carried out.
41187 @item qRelocInsn
41188 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
41189 @item @w{}
41190 The packet was not recognized.
41191 @end table
41192
41193 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
41194 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
41195 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
41196 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
41197 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
41198 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
41199 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
41200 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
41201
41202 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
41203 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
41204 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
41205 fit in a single packet.
41206 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
41207 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
41208
41209 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
41210 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
41211 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
41212 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
41213
41214 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
41215 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
41216 query packets.
41217
41218 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
41219 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
41220 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
41221 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
41222 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
41223 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
41224 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
41225 be found.
41226
41227 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
41228 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
41229 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
41230 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
41231 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
41232 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
41233 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
41234 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
41235 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
41236 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
41237 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
41238 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
41239 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
41240 variable.
41241
41242 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
41243 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
41244 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
41245 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
41246 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
41247
41248 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
41249 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
41250 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
41251 one of the following forms:
41252
41253 @table @samp
41254 @item F @var{f}
41255 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
41256 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
41257 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
41258
41259 @item T @var{t}
41260 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
41261 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
41262
41263 @end table
41264
41265 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
41266 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
41267 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
41268 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
41269
41270 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
41271 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
41272 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
41273 is a hexadecimal number.
41274
41275 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
41276 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
41277 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
41278 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
41279 numbers.
41280
41281 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
41282 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
41283 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
41284
41285 @item qTMinFTPILen
41286 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
41287 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
41288 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
41289 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
41290 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
41291 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
41292 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
41293 arrange for that.
41294
41295 Replies:
41296
41297 @table @samp
41298 @item 0
41299 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
41300 @item @var{length}
41301 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
41302 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
41303 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
41304 regardless of size.
41305 @item E
41306 An error has occurred.
41307 @item @w{}
41308 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
41309 @end table
41310
41311 @item QTStart
41312 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
41313 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
41314 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
41315 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
41316 instruction reply packet}).
41317
41318 @item QTStop
41319 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
41320 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
41321
41322 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
41323 @anchor{QTEnable}
41324 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
41325 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
41326 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
41327 of data from it will resume.
41328
41329 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
41330 @anchor{QTDisable}
41331 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
41332 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
41333 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
41334 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
41335
41336 @item QTinit
41337 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
41338 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
41339
41340 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
41341 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
41342 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
41343 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
41344 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
41345
41346 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
41347 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
41348 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
41349 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
41350
41351 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
41352 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
41353 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
41354 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
41355 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
41356 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
41357
41358 @item qTStatus
41359 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
41360 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
41361
41362 The reply has the form:
41363
41364 @table @samp
41365
41366 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
41367 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
41368 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
41369 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
41370
41371 @end table
41372
41373 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
41374 explanations as one of the optional fields:
41375
41376 @table @samp
41377
41378 @item tnotrun:0
41379 No trace has been run yet.
41380
41381 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
41382 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
41383 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
41384 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
41385 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
41386
41387 @item tfull:0
41388 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
41389
41390 @item tdisconnected:0
41391 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
41392
41393 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
41394 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
41395
41396 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
41397 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
41398 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
41399 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
41400 is hex encoded.
41401
41402 @item tunknown:0
41403 The trace stopped for some other reason.
41404
41405 @end table
41406
41407 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
41408 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
41409 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
41410 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
41411 trace.
41412
41413 @table @samp
41414
41415 @item tframes:@var{n}
41416 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
41417
41418 @item tcreated:@var{n}
41419 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
41420 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
41421
41422 @item tsize:@var{n}
41423 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
41424
41425 @item tfree:@var{n}
41426 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
41427
41428 @item circular:@var{n}
41429 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
41430 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
41431 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
41432 and may fill up.
41433
41434 @item disconn:@var{n}
41435 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
41436 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
41437 that the trace run will stop.
41438
41439 @end table
41440
41441 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
41442 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
41443 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
41444 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
41445 address @var{addr}.
41446
41447 Replies:
41448 @table @samp
41449 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
41450 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
41451 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
41452 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
41453 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
41454
41455 @end table
41456
41457 @item qTV:@var{var}
41458 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
41459 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
41460 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
41461
41462 Replies:
41463 @table @samp
41464 @item V@var{value}
41465 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
41466 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
41467 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
41468 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
41469 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
41470 program is running.
41471
41472 @item U
41473 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
41474 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
41475 was not collected.
41476 @end table
41477
41478 @item qTfP
41479 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
41480 @itemx qTsP
41481 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
41482 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
41483 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
41484 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
41485 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
41486 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
41487
41488 @item qTfV
41489 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
41490 @itemx qTsV
41491 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
41492 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
41493 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
41494 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
41495 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
41496 trace state variables.
41497
41498 @item qTfSTM
41499 @itemx qTsSTM
41500 @anchor{qTfSTM}
41501 @anchor{qTsSTM}
41502 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
41503 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
41504 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
41505 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
41506 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
41507 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
41508
41509 Reply:
41510 @table @samp
41511 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
41512 A single marker
41513 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
41514 a comma-separated list of markers
41515 @item l
41516 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
41517 @item E @var{nn}
41518 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
41519 @item @w{}
41520 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
41521 stub.
41522 @end table
41523
41524 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
41525 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
41526
41527 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
41528 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
41529 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
41530 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
41531 @dfn{last}).
41532
41533 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
41534 @anchor{qTSTMat}
41535 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
41536 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
41537 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
41538 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
41539 tracepoint markers.
41540
41541 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
41542 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
41543 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
41544 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
41545 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
41546 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
41547
41548 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
41549 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
41550 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
41551 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
41552 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
41553 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
41554 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
41555 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
41556 available.
41557
41558 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
41559 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
41560 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
41561
41562 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
41563 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
41564 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
41565 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
41566 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
41567 use whatever size it prefers.
41568
41569 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
41570 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
41571 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
41572 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
41573 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
41574
41575 @end table
41576
41577 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
41578 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
41579 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
41580 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
41581 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
41582 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
41583 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
41584 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
41585 it had executed in the original location.
41586
41587 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
41588 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
41589 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
41590 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
41591 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
41592 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
41593 format of the request is:
41594
41595 @table @samp
41596 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
41597
41598 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
41599 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
41600 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
41601 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
41602 memory starting at @var{to}.
41603 @end table
41604
41605 Replies:
41606 @table @samp
41607 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
41608 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
41609 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
41610 @item E @var{NN}
41611 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
41612 relocating the instruction.
41613 @end table
41614
41615 @node Host I/O Packets
41616 @section Host I/O Packets
41617 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
41618 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
41619
41620 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
41621 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
41622 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
41623 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
41624 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
41625 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
41626 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
41627 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
41628 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
41629 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
41630
41631 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
41632 its arguments. They have this format:
41633
41634 @table @samp
41635
41636 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
41637 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
41638 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
41639 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
41640 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
41641 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
41642 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
41643 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
41644 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
41645
41646 @end table
41647
41648 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
41649
41650 @table @samp
41651
41652 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
41653 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
41654 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
41655 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
41656 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
41657 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
41658 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
41659 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
41660 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
41661 @var{attachment}.
41662
41663 @item @w{}
41664 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
41665
41666 @end table
41667
41668 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
41669
41670 @table @samp
41671 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
41672 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
41673 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
41674 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
41675 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
41676 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
41677 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
41678
41679 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
41680 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
41681 -1 if an error occurs.
41682
41683 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
41684 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
41685 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
41686 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
41687 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
41688 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
41689 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
41690 @var{count} was zero.
41691
41692 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
41693 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
41694 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
41695 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
41696 some characters were escaped.
41697
41698 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
41699 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
41700 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
41701 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
41702 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
41703 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
41704 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
41705 error occurred.
41706
41707 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
41708 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
41709 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
41710 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
41711 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
41712 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
41713
41714 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
41715 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
41716 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
41717
41718 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
41719 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
41720 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
41721
41722 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
41723 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
41724 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
41725 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
41726 some characters were escaped.
41727
41728 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
41729 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
41730 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
41731 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
41732 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
41733 inferior(s).
41734
41735 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
41736 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
41737 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
41738 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
41739 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
41740 operation.
41741
41742 @end table
41743
41744 @node Interrupts
41745 @section Interrupts
41746 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
41747 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
41748
41749 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
41750 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
41751 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
41752 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
41753
41754 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
41755 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
41756 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
41757 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
41758 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
41759
41760 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
41761 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
41762 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
41763 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
41764 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
41765 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
41766 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
41767 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
41768
41769 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
41770 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
41771 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
41772
41773 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
41774 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
41775 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
41776 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
41777 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
41778 @code{0x03}.
41779
41780 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
41781 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
41782 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
41783 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
41784 currently-executing threads and processes.
41785 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
41786 running program, it should send one of the stop
41787 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
41788 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
41789 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
41790 Interrupts received while the
41791 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
41792 it is resumed next time.
41793
41794 @node Notification Packets
41795 @section Notification Packets
41796 @cindex notification packets
41797 @cindex packets, notification
41798
41799 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
41800 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
41801 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
41802 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
41803 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
41804 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
41805 is not a problem.
41806
41807 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
41808 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
41809 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
41810 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
41811 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
41812 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
41813 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
41814
41815 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
41816 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
41817
41818 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
41819 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
41820 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
41821 not they understand it.
41822
41823 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
41824 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
41825 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
41826 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
41827 recipients.
41828
41829 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
41830 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
41831 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
41832 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
41833 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
41834
41835 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
41836 @table @samp
41837 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
41838 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
41839 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
41840 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
41841 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
41842 @item @var{ack}
41843 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
41844 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
41845 @end table
41846
41847 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
41848 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
41849
41850 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
41851 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
41852 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
41853 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
41854 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
41855 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
41856 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
41857 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
41858 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
41859 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
41860
41861 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
41862 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
41863 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
41864 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
41865 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
41866 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
41867
41868 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
41869 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
41870 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
41871 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
41872 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
41873
41874 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
41875 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
41876 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
41877 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
41878 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
41879 normally.
41880
41881 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
41882 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
41883 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
41884 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
41885 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
41886 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
41887 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
41888 the process shall be repeated.
41889
41890 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
41891 following example:
41892 @smallexample
41893 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
41894 @code{...}
41895 -> @code{vStopped}
41896 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
41897 -> @code{vStopped}
41898 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
41899 -> @code{vStopped}
41900 <- @code{OK}
41901 @end smallexample
41902
41903 The following notifications are defined:
41904 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
41905
41906 @item Notification
41907 @tab Ack
41908 @tab Event
41909 @tab Description
41910
41911 @item Stop
41912 @tab vStopped
41913 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
41914 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
41915 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
41916 @value{GDBN}.
41917 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
41918
41919 @end multitable
41920
41921 @node Remote Non-Stop
41922 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
41923
41924 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
41925 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
41926 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
41927 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
41928
41929 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
41930 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
41931 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
41932 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
41933 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
41934 probe the target state after a mode change.
41935
41936 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
41937 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
41938 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
41939 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
41940 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
41941 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
41942 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
41943 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
41944 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
41945 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
41946 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
41947
41948 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
41949 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
41950 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
41951 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
41952 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
41953 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
41954 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
41955 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
41956 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
41957 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
41958 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
41959 @samp{OK}.
41960
41961 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
41962 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
41963 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
41964 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
41965 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
41966 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
41967 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
41968 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
41969 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
41970 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
41971 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
41972 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
41973 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
41974
41975 @node Packet Acknowledgment
41976 @section Packet Acknowledgment
41977
41978 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
41979 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
41980 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
41981 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
41982 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
41983 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
41984 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
41985
41986 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
41987 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
41988 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
41989 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
41990 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
41991
41992 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
41993 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
41994 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
41995 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
41996
41997 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
41998 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
41999 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
42000 @pxref{qSupported}.
42001 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
42002 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
42003 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
42004 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
42005 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
42006 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
42007 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
42008
42009 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
42010 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
42011 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
42012 connection.
42013 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
42014 new connection is established,
42015 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
42016 for the current connection, once disabled.
42017
42018 @node Examples
42019 @section Examples
42020
42021 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
42022 does not get any direct output:
42023
42024 @smallexample
42025 -> @code{R00}
42026 <- @code{+}
42027 @emph{target restarts}
42028 -> @code{?}
42029 <- @code{+}
42030 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
42031 -> @code{+}
42032 @end smallexample
42033
42034 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
42035
42036 @smallexample
42037 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
42038 <- @code{+}
42039 -> @code{s}
42040 <- @code{+}
42041 @emph{time passes}
42042 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
42043 -> @code{+}
42044 -> @code{g}
42045 <- @code{+}
42046 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
42047 -> @code{+}
42048 @end smallexample
42049
42050 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
42051 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
42052 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
42053
42054 @menu
42055 * File-I/O Overview::
42056 * Protocol Basics::
42057 * The F Request Packet::
42058 * The F Reply Packet::
42059 * The Ctrl-C Message::
42060 * Console I/O::
42061 * List of Supported Calls::
42062 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
42063 * Constants::
42064 * File-I/O Examples::
42065 @end menu
42066
42067 @node File-I/O Overview
42068 @subsection File-I/O Overview
42069 @cindex file-i/o overview
42070
42071 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
42072 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
42073 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
42074 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
42075 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
42076 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
42077
42078 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
42079 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
42080 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
42081 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
42082 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
42083
42084 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
42085 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
42086 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
42087 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
42088 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
42089 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
42090 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
42091
42092 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
42093 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
42094 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
42095 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
42096 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
42097
42098 @smallexample
42099 (@value{GDBP}) continue
42100 <- target requests 'system call X'
42101 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
42102 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
42103 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
42104 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
42105 @end smallexample
42106
42107 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
42108 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
42109 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
42110 system are not supported by this protocol.
42111
42112 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
42113
42114 @node Protocol Basics
42115 @subsection Protocol Basics
42116 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
42117
42118 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
42119 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
42120 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
42121 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
42122 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
42123 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
42124 to call the appropriate host system call:
42125
42126 @itemize @bullet
42127 @item
42128 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
42129
42130 @item
42131 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
42132 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
42133 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
42134 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
42135
42136 @end itemize
42137
42138 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
42139
42140 @itemize @bullet
42141 @item
42142 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
42143 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
42144 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
42145 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
42146 packet.
42147
42148 @item
42149 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
42150 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
42151
42152 @item
42153 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
42154
42155 @item
42156 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
42157
42158 @item
42159 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
42160 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
42161 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
42162 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
42163 packet.
42164
42165 @end itemize
42166
42167 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
42168 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
42169
42170 @itemize @bullet
42171 @item
42172 Return value.
42173
42174 @item
42175 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
42176
42177 @item
42178 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
42179
42180 @end itemize
42181
42182 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
42183 the latest continue or step action.
42184
42185 @node The F Request Packet
42186 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
42187 @cindex file-i/o request packet
42188 @cindex @code{F} request packet
42189
42190 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
42191
42192 @table @samp
42193 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
42194
42195 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
42196 This is just the name of the function.
42197
42198 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
42199 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
42200 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
42201 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
42202 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
42203 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
42204 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
42205
42206 @end table
42207
42208
42209
42210 @node The F Reply Packet
42211 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
42212 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
42213 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
42214
42215 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
42216
42217 @table @samp
42218
42219 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
42220
42221 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
42222
42223 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
42224 representation.
42225 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
42226
42227 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
42228 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
42229 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
42230
42231 @smallexample
42232 F0,0,C
42233 @end smallexample
42234
42235 @noindent
42236 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
42237
42238 @smallexample
42239 F-1,4,C
42240 @end smallexample
42241
42242 @noindent
42243 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
42244
42245 @end table
42246
42247
42248 @node The Ctrl-C Message
42249 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
42250 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
42251
42252 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
42253 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
42254 the target should behave as if it had
42255 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
42256 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
42257 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
42258 packet.
42259
42260 It's important for the target to know in which
42261 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
42262
42263 @itemize @bullet
42264 @item
42265 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
42266
42267 @item
42268 The system call on the host has been finished.
42269
42270 @end itemize
42271
42272 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
42273 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
42274 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
42275 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
42276 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
42277 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
42278
42279 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
42280 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
42281 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
42282 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
42283 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
42284 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
42285 or the full action has been completed.
42286
42287 @node Console I/O
42288 @subsection Console I/O
42289 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
42290
42291 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
42292 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
42293 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
42294 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
42295 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
42296 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
42297 conditions is met:
42298
42299 @itemize @bullet
42300 @item
42301 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
42302 @code{read}
42303 system call is treated as finished.
42304
42305 @item
42306 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
42307 newline.
42308
42309 @item
42310 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
42311 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
42312
42313 @end itemize
42314
42315 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
42316 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
42317 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
42318 is stopped at the user's request.
42319
42320
42321 @node List of Supported Calls
42322 @subsection List of Supported Calls
42323 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
42324
42325 @menu
42326 * open::
42327 * close::
42328 * read::
42329 * write::
42330 * lseek::
42331 * rename::
42332 * unlink::
42333 * stat/fstat::
42334 * gettimeofday::
42335 * isatty::
42336 * system::
42337 @end menu
42338
42339 @node open
42340 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
42341 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
42342
42343 @table @asis
42344 @item Synopsis:
42345 @smallexample
42346 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
42347 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
42348 @end smallexample
42349
42350 @item Request:
42351 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
42352
42353 @noindent
42354 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
42355
42356 @table @code
42357 @item O_CREAT
42358 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
42359 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
42360 are concerned.
42361
42362 @item O_EXCL
42363 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
42364 an error and open() fails.
42365
42366 @item O_TRUNC
42367 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
42368 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
42369 truncated to zero length.
42370
42371 @item O_APPEND
42372 The file is opened in append mode.
42373
42374 @item O_RDONLY
42375 The file is opened for reading only.
42376
42377 @item O_WRONLY
42378 The file is opened for writing only.
42379
42380 @item O_RDWR
42381 The file is opened for reading and writing.
42382 @end table
42383
42384 @noindent
42385 Other bits are silently ignored.
42386
42387
42388 @noindent
42389 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
42390
42391 @table @code
42392 @item S_IRUSR
42393 User has read permission.
42394
42395 @item S_IWUSR
42396 User has write permission.
42397
42398 @item S_IRGRP
42399 Group has read permission.
42400
42401 @item S_IWGRP
42402 Group has write permission.
42403
42404 @item S_IROTH
42405 Others have read permission.
42406
42407 @item S_IWOTH
42408 Others have write permission.
42409 @end table
42410
42411 @noindent
42412 Other bits are silently ignored.
42413
42414
42415 @item Return value:
42416 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
42417 occurred.
42418
42419 @item Errors:
42420
42421 @table @code
42422 @item EEXIST
42423 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
42424
42425 @item EISDIR
42426 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
42427
42428 @item EACCES
42429 The requested access is not allowed.
42430
42431 @item ENAMETOOLONG
42432 @var{pathname} was too long.
42433
42434 @item ENOENT
42435 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
42436
42437 @item ENODEV
42438 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
42439
42440 @item EROFS
42441 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
42442 write access was requested.
42443
42444 @item EFAULT
42445 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
42446
42447 @item ENOSPC
42448 No space on device to create the file.
42449
42450 @item EMFILE
42451 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
42452
42453 @item ENFILE
42454 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
42455 has been reached.
42456
42457 @item EINTR
42458 The call was interrupted by the user.
42459 @end table
42460
42461 @end table
42462
42463 @node close
42464 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
42465 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
42466
42467 @table @asis
42468 @item Synopsis:
42469 @smallexample
42470 int close(int fd);
42471 @end smallexample
42472
42473 @item Request:
42474 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
42475
42476 @item Return value:
42477 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
42478
42479 @item Errors:
42480
42481 @table @code
42482 @item EBADF
42483 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
42484
42485 @item EINTR
42486 The call was interrupted by the user.
42487 @end table
42488
42489 @end table
42490
42491 @node read
42492 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
42493 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
42494
42495 @table @asis
42496 @item Synopsis:
42497 @smallexample
42498 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
42499 @end smallexample
42500
42501 @item Request:
42502 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
42503
42504 @item Return value:
42505 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
42506 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
42507 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
42508
42509 @item Errors:
42510
42511 @table @code
42512 @item EBADF
42513 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
42514 reading.
42515
42516 @item EFAULT
42517 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42518
42519 @item EINTR
42520 The call was interrupted by the user.
42521 @end table
42522
42523 @end table
42524
42525 @node write
42526 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
42527 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
42528
42529 @table @asis
42530 @item Synopsis:
42531 @smallexample
42532 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
42533 @end smallexample
42534
42535 @item Request:
42536 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
42537
42538 @item Return value:
42539 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
42540 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
42541 is returned.
42542
42543 @item Errors:
42544
42545 @table @code
42546 @item EBADF
42547 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
42548 writing.
42549
42550 @item EFAULT
42551 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42552
42553 @item EFBIG
42554 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
42555 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
42556
42557 @item ENOSPC
42558 No space on device to write the data.
42559
42560 @item EINTR
42561 The call was interrupted by the user.
42562 @end table
42563
42564 @end table
42565
42566 @node lseek
42567 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
42568 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
42569
42570 @table @asis
42571 @item Synopsis:
42572 @smallexample
42573 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
42574 @end smallexample
42575
42576 @item Request:
42577 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
42578
42579 @var{flag} is one of:
42580
42581 @table @code
42582 @item SEEK_SET
42583 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
42584
42585 @item SEEK_CUR
42586 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
42587 bytes.
42588
42589 @item SEEK_END
42590 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
42591 bytes.
42592 @end table
42593
42594 @item Return value:
42595 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
42596 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
42597 value of -1 is returned.
42598
42599 @item Errors:
42600
42601 @table @code
42602 @item EBADF
42603 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
42604
42605 @item ESPIPE
42606 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
42607
42608 @item EINVAL
42609 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
42610
42611 @item EINTR
42612 The call was interrupted by the user.
42613 @end table
42614
42615 @end table
42616
42617 @node rename
42618 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
42619 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
42620
42621 @table @asis
42622 @item Synopsis:
42623 @smallexample
42624 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
42625 @end smallexample
42626
42627 @item Request:
42628 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
42629
42630 @item Return value:
42631 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
42632
42633 @item Errors:
42634
42635 @table @code
42636 @item EISDIR
42637 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
42638 directory.
42639
42640 @item EEXIST
42641 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
42642
42643 @item EBUSY
42644 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
42645 process.
42646
42647 @item EINVAL
42648 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
42649 of itself.
42650
42651 @item ENOTDIR
42652 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
42653 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
42654 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
42655
42656 @item EFAULT
42657 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
42658
42659 @item EACCES
42660 No access to the file or the path of the file.
42661
42662 @item ENAMETOOLONG
42663
42664 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
42665
42666 @item ENOENT
42667 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
42668
42669 @item EROFS
42670 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
42671
42672 @item ENOSPC
42673 The device containing the file has no room for the new
42674 directory entry.
42675
42676 @item EINTR
42677 The call was interrupted by the user.
42678 @end table
42679
42680 @end table
42681
42682 @node unlink
42683 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
42684 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
42685
42686 @table @asis
42687 @item Synopsis:
42688 @smallexample
42689 int unlink(const char *pathname);
42690 @end smallexample
42691
42692 @item Request:
42693 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
42694
42695 @item Return value:
42696 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
42697
42698 @item Errors:
42699
42700 @table @code
42701 @item EACCES
42702 No access to the file or the path of the file.
42703
42704 @item EPERM
42705 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
42706
42707 @item EBUSY
42708 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
42709 being used by another process.
42710
42711 @item EFAULT
42712 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42713
42714 @item ENAMETOOLONG
42715 @var{pathname} was too long.
42716
42717 @item ENOENT
42718 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
42719
42720 @item ENOTDIR
42721 A component of the path is not a directory.
42722
42723 @item EROFS
42724 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
42725
42726 @item EINTR
42727 The call was interrupted by the user.
42728 @end table
42729
42730 @end table
42731
42732 @node stat/fstat
42733 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
42734 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
42735 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
42736
42737 @table @asis
42738 @item Synopsis:
42739 @smallexample
42740 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
42741 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
42742 @end smallexample
42743
42744 @item Request:
42745 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
42746 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
42747
42748 @item Return value:
42749 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
42750
42751 @item Errors:
42752
42753 @table @code
42754 @item EBADF
42755 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
42756
42757 @item ENOENT
42758 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
42759 path is an empty string.
42760
42761 @item ENOTDIR
42762 A component of the path is not a directory.
42763
42764 @item EFAULT
42765 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42766
42767 @item EACCES
42768 No access to the file or the path of the file.
42769
42770 @item ENAMETOOLONG
42771 @var{pathname} was too long.
42772
42773 @item EINTR
42774 The call was interrupted by the user.
42775 @end table
42776
42777 @end table
42778
42779 @node gettimeofday
42780 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
42781 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
42782
42783 @table @asis
42784 @item Synopsis:
42785 @smallexample
42786 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
42787 @end smallexample
42788
42789 @item Request:
42790 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
42791
42792 @item Return value:
42793 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
42794
42795 @item Errors:
42796
42797 @table @code
42798 @item EINVAL
42799 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
42800
42801 @item EFAULT
42802 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
42803 @end table
42804
42805 @end table
42806
42807 @node isatty
42808 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
42809 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
42810
42811 @table @asis
42812 @item Synopsis:
42813 @smallexample
42814 int isatty(int fd);
42815 @end smallexample
42816
42817 @item Request:
42818 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
42819
42820 @item Return value:
42821 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
42822
42823 @item Errors:
42824
42825 @table @code
42826 @item EINTR
42827 The call was interrupted by the user.
42828 @end table
42829
42830 @end table
42831
42832 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
42833 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
42834 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
42835 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
42836 needed.
42837
42838
42839 @node system
42840 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
42841 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
42842
42843 @table @asis
42844 @item Synopsis:
42845 @smallexample
42846 int system(const char *command);
42847 @end smallexample
42848
42849 @item Request:
42850 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
42851
42852 @item Return value:
42853 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
42854 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
42855 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
42856 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
42857 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
42858 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
42859 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
42860
42861 @item Errors:
42862
42863 @table @code
42864 @item EINTR
42865 The call was interrupted by the user.
42866 @end table
42867
42868 @end table
42869
42870 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
42871 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
42872 the host is simplified before it's returned
42873 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
42874 is discarded, and the return value consists
42875 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
42876
42877 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
42878 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
42879 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
42880
42881 @table @code
42882 @item set remote system-call-allowed
42883 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
42884 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
42885 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
42886
42887 @item show remote system-call-allowed
42888 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
42889 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
42890 protocol.
42891 @end table
42892
42893 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
42894 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
42895 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
42896
42897 @menu
42898 * Integral Datatypes::
42899 * Pointer Values::
42900 * Memory Transfer::
42901 * struct stat::
42902 * struct timeval::
42903 @end menu
42904
42905 @node Integral Datatypes
42906 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
42907 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
42908
42909 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
42910 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
42911 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
42912
42913 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
42914 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
42915
42916 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
42917
42918 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
42919 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
42920
42921 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
42922
42923 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
42924 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
42925 byte order.
42926
42927 @node Pointer Values
42928 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
42929 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
42930
42931 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
42932 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
42933 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
42934 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
42935
42936 @smallexample
42937 @code{1aaf/12}
42938 @end smallexample
42939
42940 @noindent
42941 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
42942 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
42943 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
42944 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
42945
42946 @smallexample
42947 @code{123456/d}
42948 @end smallexample
42949
42950 @node Memory Transfer
42951 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
42952 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
42953
42954 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
42955 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
42956 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
42957 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
42958 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
42959 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
42960 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
42961
42962
42963 @node struct stat
42964 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
42965 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
42966
42967 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
42968 is defined as follows:
42969
42970 @smallexample
42971 struct stat @{
42972 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
42973 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
42974 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
42975 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
42976 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
42977 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
42978 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
42979 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
42980 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
42981 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
42982 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
42983 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
42984 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
42985 @};
42986 @end smallexample
42987
42988 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
42989 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
42990 structure is of size 64 bytes.
42991
42992 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
42993 range of values.
42994
42995 @table @code
42996
42997 @item st_dev
42998 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
42999
43000 @item st_ino
43001 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
43002
43003 @item st_mode
43004 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
43005 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
43006
43007 @item st_uid
43008 @itemx st_gid
43009 @itemx st_rdev
43010 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
43011
43012 @item st_atime
43013 @itemx st_mtime
43014 @itemx st_ctime
43015 These values have a host and file system dependent
43016 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
43017 support exact timing values.
43018 @end table
43019
43020 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
43021 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
43022 continuing.
43023
43024 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
43025 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
43026 get truncated on the target.
43027
43028 @node struct timeval
43029 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
43030 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
43031
43032 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
43033 is defined as follows:
43034
43035 @smallexample
43036 struct timeval @{
43037 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
43038 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
43039 @};
43040 @end smallexample
43041
43042 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
43043 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
43044 structure is of size 8 bytes.
43045
43046 @node Constants
43047 @subsection Constants
43048 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
43049
43050 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
43051 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
43052 values before and after the call as needed.
43053
43054 @menu
43055 * Open Flags::
43056 * mode_t Values::
43057 * Errno Values::
43058 * Lseek Flags::
43059 * Limits::
43060 @end menu
43061
43062 @node Open Flags
43063 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
43064 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
43065
43066 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
43067
43068 @smallexample
43069 O_RDONLY 0x0
43070 O_WRONLY 0x1
43071 O_RDWR 0x2
43072 O_APPEND 0x8
43073 O_CREAT 0x200
43074 O_TRUNC 0x400
43075 O_EXCL 0x800
43076 @end smallexample
43077
43078 @node mode_t Values
43079 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
43080 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
43081
43082 All values are given in octal representation.
43083
43084 @smallexample
43085 S_IFREG 0100000
43086 S_IFDIR 040000
43087 S_IRUSR 0400
43088 S_IWUSR 0200
43089 S_IXUSR 0100
43090 S_IRGRP 040
43091 S_IWGRP 020
43092 S_IXGRP 010
43093 S_IROTH 04
43094 S_IWOTH 02
43095 S_IXOTH 01
43096 @end smallexample
43097
43098 @node Errno Values
43099 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
43100 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
43101
43102 All values are given in decimal representation.
43103
43104 @smallexample
43105 EPERM 1
43106 ENOENT 2
43107 EINTR 4
43108 EBADF 9
43109 EACCES 13
43110 EFAULT 14
43111 EBUSY 16
43112 EEXIST 17
43113 ENODEV 19
43114 ENOTDIR 20
43115 EISDIR 21
43116 EINVAL 22
43117 ENFILE 23
43118 EMFILE 24
43119 EFBIG 27
43120 ENOSPC 28
43121 ESPIPE 29
43122 EROFS 30
43123 ENAMETOOLONG 91
43124 EUNKNOWN 9999
43125 @end smallexample
43126
43127 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
43128 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
43129
43130 @node Lseek Flags
43131 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
43132 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
43133
43134 @smallexample
43135 SEEK_SET 0
43136 SEEK_CUR 1
43137 SEEK_END 2
43138 @end smallexample
43139
43140 @node Limits
43141 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
43142 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
43143
43144 All values are given in decimal representation.
43145
43146 @smallexample
43147 INT_MIN -2147483648
43148 INT_MAX 2147483647
43149 UINT_MAX 4294967295
43150 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
43151 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
43152 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
43153 @end smallexample
43154
43155 @node File-I/O Examples
43156 @subsection File-I/O Examples
43157 @cindex file-i/o examples
43158
43159 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
43160 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
43161
43162 @smallexample
43163 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
43164 @emph{request memory read from target}
43165 -> @code{m1234,6}
43166 <- XXXXXX
43167 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
43168 -> @code{F6}
43169 @end smallexample
43170
43171 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
43172 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
43173
43174 @smallexample
43175 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
43176 @emph{request memory write to target}
43177 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
43178 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
43179 -> @code{F6}
43180 @end smallexample
43181
43182 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
43183 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
43184
43185 @smallexample
43186 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
43187 -> @code{F-1,9}
43188 @end smallexample
43189
43190 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
43191 host is called:
43192
43193 @smallexample
43194 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
43195 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
43196 <- @code{T02}
43197 @end smallexample
43198
43199 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
43200 host is called:
43201
43202 @smallexample
43203 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
43204 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
43205 <- @code{T02}
43206 @end smallexample
43207
43208 @node Library List Format
43209 @section Library List Format
43210 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
43211
43212 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
43213 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
43214 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
43215 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
43216 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
43217 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
43218 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
43219 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
43220 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
43221 are loaded.
43222
43223 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
43224 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
43225 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
43226 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
43227
43228 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
43229 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
43230 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
43231 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
43232 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
43233 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
43234
43235 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43236 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
43237
43238 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
43239 offset, looks like this:
43240
43241 @smallexample
43242 <library-list>
43243 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
43244 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
43245 </library>
43246 </library-list>
43247 @end smallexample
43248
43249 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
43250 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
43251
43252 @smallexample
43253 <library-list>
43254 <library name="sharedlib.o">
43255 <section address="0x10000000"/>
43256 <section address="0x20000000"/>
43257 <section address="0x30000000"/>
43258 </library>
43259 </library-list>
43260 @end smallexample
43261
43262 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
43263
43264 @smallexample
43265 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
43266 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
43267 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43268 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
43269 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
43270 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
43271 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
43272 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
43273 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
43274 @end smallexample
43275
43276 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
43277 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
43278 section for each library.
43279
43280 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
43281 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
43282 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
43283
43284 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
43285 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
43286 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
43287 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
43288
43289 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
43290 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
43291 target, the following parameters are reported:
43292
43293 @itemize @minus
43294 @item
43295 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
43296 @code{struct link_map}.
43297 @item
43298 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
43299 (Thread Local Storage) access.
43300 @item
43301 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
43302 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
43303 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
43304 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
43305 @item
43306 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
43307 @end itemize
43308
43309 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
43310 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
43311 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
43312
43313 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43314 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
43315
43316 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
43317 looks like this:
43318
43319 @smallexample
43320 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
43321 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
43322 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
43323 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
43324 l_ld="0x152350"/>
43325 </library-list-svr>
43326 @end smallexample
43327
43328 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
43329
43330 @smallexample
43331 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
43332 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
43333 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43334 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
43335 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
43336 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
43337 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
43338 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
43339 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
43340 @end smallexample
43341
43342 @node Memory Map Format
43343 @section Memory Map Format
43344 @cindex memory map format
43345
43346 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
43347 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
43348 memory map.
43349
43350 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
43351 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
43352 lists memory regions.
43353
43354 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43355 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
43356
43357 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
43358
43359 @smallexample
43360 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43361 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
43362 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
43363 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
43364 <memory-map>
43365 region...
43366 </memory-map>
43367 @end smallexample
43368
43369 Each region can be either:
43370
43371 @itemize
43372
43373 @item
43374 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
43375 bytes from there:
43376
43377 @smallexample
43378 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
43379 @end smallexample
43380
43381
43382 @item
43383 A region of read-only memory:
43384
43385 @smallexample
43386 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
43387 @end smallexample
43388
43389
43390 @item
43391 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
43392 bytes in length:
43393
43394 @smallexample
43395 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
43396 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
43397 </memory>
43398 @end smallexample
43399
43400 @end itemize
43401
43402 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
43403 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
43404 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
43405
43406 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
43407
43408 @smallexample
43409 <!-- ................................................... -->
43410 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
43411 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
43412 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
43413 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
43414 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
43415 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
43416 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
43417 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
43418 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
43419 and its type, or device. -->
43420 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
43421 start CDATA #REQUIRED
43422 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
43423 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
43424 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
43425 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
43426 @end smallexample
43427
43428 @node Thread List Format
43429 @section Thread List Format
43430 @cindex thread list format
43431
43432 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
43433 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
43434 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
43435 the following structure:
43436
43437 @smallexample
43438 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43439 <threads>
43440 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
43441 ... description ...
43442 </thread>
43443 </threads>
43444 @end smallexample
43445
43446 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
43447 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
43448 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
43449 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
43450 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
43451 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
43452 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
43453 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
43454
43455
43456 @node Traceframe Info Format
43457 @section Traceframe Info Format
43458 @cindex traceframe info format
43459
43460 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
43461 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
43462 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
43463 collected in a traceframe.
43464
43465 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
43466 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
43467
43468 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43469 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
43470
43471 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
43472
43473 @smallexample
43474 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43475 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
43476 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
43477 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
43478 <traceframe-info>
43479 block...
43480 </traceframe-info>
43481 @end smallexample
43482
43483 Each traceframe block can be either:
43484
43485 @itemize
43486
43487 @item
43488 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
43489 @var{length} bytes from there:
43490
43491 @smallexample
43492 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
43493 @end smallexample
43494
43495 @item
43496 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
43497 collected:
43498
43499 @smallexample
43500 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
43501 @end smallexample
43502
43503 @end itemize
43504
43505 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
43506
43507 @smallexample
43508 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
43509 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43510
43511 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
43512 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
43513 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
43514 <!ELEMENT tvar>
43515 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
43516 @end smallexample
43517
43518 @node Branch Trace Format
43519 @section Branch Trace Format
43520 @cindex branch trace format
43521
43522 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
43523 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
43524 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
43525 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
43526
43527 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
43528 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
43529
43530 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43531 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
43532
43533 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
43534
43535 @smallexample
43536 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43537 <!DOCTYPE btrace
43538 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
43539 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
43540 <btrace>
43541 block...
43542 </btrace>
43543 @end smallexample
43544
43545 @itemize
43546
43547 @item
43548 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
43549 and ending at @var{end}:
43550
43551 @smallexample
43552 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
43553 @end smallexample
43554
43555 @end itemize
43556
43557 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
43558
43559 @smallexample
43560 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
43561 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43562
43563 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
43564 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
43565 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
43566
43567 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
43568
43569 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
43570
43571 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
43572 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
43573 family CDATA #REQUIRED
43574 model CDATA #REQUIRED
43575 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
43576
43577 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
43578 @end smallexample
43579
43580 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
43581 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
43582 @cindex branch trace configuration format
43583
43584 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
43585 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
43586 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
43587
43588 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
43589 settings for that format. The following information is described:
43590
43591 @table @code
43592 @item bts
43593 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
43594 @table @code
43595 @item size
43596 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
43597 @end table
43598 @item pt
43599 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
43600 PT}) format.
43601 @table @code
43602 @item size
43603 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
43604 @end table
43605 @end table
43606
43607 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43608 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
43609
43610 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
43611
43612 @smallexample
43613 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
43614 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
43615
43616 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
43617 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
43618
43619 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
43620 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
43621 @end smallexample
43622
43623 @include agentexpr.texi
43624
43625 @node Target Descriptions
43626 @appendix Target Descriptions
43627 @cindex target descriptions
43628
43629 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
43630 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
43631 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
43632 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
43633 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
43634 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
43635 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
43636
43637 @itemize @bullet
43638 @item
43639 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
43640 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
43641 @item
43642 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
43643 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
43644 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
43645 @item
43646 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
43647 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
43648 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
43649 @end itemize
43650
43651 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
43652 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
43653 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
43654 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
43655 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
43656
43657 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
43658 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
43659
43660 @menu
43661 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
43662 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
43663 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
43664 descriptions.
43665 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
43666 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
43667 @end menu
43668
43669 @node Retrieving Descriptions
43670 @section Retrieving Descriptions
43671
43672 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
43673 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
43674 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
43675 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
43676 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
43677 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
43678 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
43679 Format}.
43680
43681 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
43682 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
43683 specify a file are:
43684
43685 @table @code
43686 @cindex set tdesc filename
43687 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
43688 Read the target description from @var{path}.
43689
43690 @cindex unset tdesc filename
43691 @item unset tdesc filename
43692 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
43693 will use the description supplied by the current target.
43694
43695 @cindex show tdesc filename
43696 @item show tdesc filename
43697 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
43698 @end table
43699
43700
43701 @node Target Description Format
43702 @section Target Description Format
43703 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
43704
43705 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
43706 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
43707 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
43708 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
43709 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
43710 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
43711 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
43712
43713 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
43714 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
43715 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
43716 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
43717 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
43718
43719 Here is a simple target description:
43720
43721 @smallexample
43722 <target version="1.0">
43723 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
43724 </target>
43725 @end smallexample
43726
43727 @noindent
43728 This minimal description only says that the target uses
43729 the x86-64 architecture.
43730
43731 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
43732 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
43733 are explained further below.
43734
43735 @smallexample
43736 <?xml version="1.0"?>
43737 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
43738 <target version="1.0">
43739 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
43740 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
43741 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
43742 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
43743 </target>
43744 @end smallexample
43745
43746 @noindent
43747 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
43748 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
43749 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
43750 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
43751 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
43752 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
43753 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
43754 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
43755 the version mismatch.
43756
43757 @subsection Inclusion
43758 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
43759 @cindex XInclude
43760 @ifnotinfo
43761 @cindex <xi:include>
43762 @end ifnotinfo
43763
43764 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
43765 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
43766 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
43767 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
43768 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
43769
43770 @smallexample
43771 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
43772 @end smallexample
43773
43774 @noindent
43775 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
43776 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
43777 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
43778 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
43779 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
43780 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
43781 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
43782 original description.
43783
43784 @subsection Architecture
43785 @cindex <architecture>
43786
43787 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
43788
43789 @smallexample
43790 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
43791 @end smallexample
43792
43793 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
43794 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
43795
43796 @subsection OS ABI
43797 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
43798
43799 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
43800 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
43801
43802 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
43803
43804 @smallexample
43805 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
43806 @end smallexample
43807
43808 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
43809 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
43810
43811 @subsection Compatible Architecture
43812 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
43813
43814 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
43815 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
43816
43817 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
43818
43819 @smallexample
43820 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
43821 @end smallexample
43822
43823 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
43824 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
43825
43826 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
43827 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
43828 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
43829 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
43830 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
43831 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
43832 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
43833
43834 @smallexample
43835 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
43836 <compatible>spu</compatible>
43837 @end smallexample
43838
43839 @subsection Features
43840 @cindex <feature>
43841
43842 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
43843 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
43844 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
43845 has this form:
43846
43847 @smallexample
43848 <feature name="@var{name}">
43849 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
43850 @var{reg}@dots{}
43851 </feature>
43852 @end smallexample
43853
43854 @noindent
43855 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
43856 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
43857 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
43858 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
43859
43860 @subsection Types
43861
43862 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
43863 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
43864 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
43865 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
43866 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
43867 and enum types.
43868
43869 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
43870 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
43871 Types must be defined before they are used.
43872
43873 @cindex <vector>
43874 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
43875 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
43876 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
43877 @var{count}:
43878
43879 @smallexample
43880 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
43881 @end smallexample
43882
43883 @cindex <union>
43884 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
43885 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
43886 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
43887 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
43888
43889 @smallexample
43890 <union id="@var{id}">
43891 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
43892 @dots{}
43893 </union>
43894 @end smallexample
43895
43896 @cindex <struct>
43897 @cindex <flags>
43898 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
43899 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
43900 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
43901 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
43902 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
43903 specified.
43904
43905 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
43906
43907 @smallexample
43908 <struct id="@var{id}">
43909 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
43910 @dots{}
43911 </struct>
43912 @end smallexample
43913
43914 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
43915 No implicit padding is added.
43916
43917 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
43918
43919 @smallexample
43920 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43921 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
43922 @dots{}
43923 </struct>
43924 @end smallexample
43925
43926 @smallexample
43927 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
43928 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
43929 @dots{}
43930 </flags>
43931 @end smallexample
43932
43933 The @var{name} value is required.
43934 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
43935 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
43936 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
43937
43938 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
43939 is optional.
43940 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
43941 and zero represents the least significant bit.
43942
43943 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
43944 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
43945
43946 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
43947
43948 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
43949 defining them with @samp{struct}:
43950
43951 @itemize @bullet
43952 @item
43953 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
43954 @item
43955 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
43956 @end itemize
43957
43958 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
43959 defining them with @samp{flags}:
43960
43961 @itemize @bullet
43962 @item
43963 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
43964
43965 @smallexample
43966 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
43967 $1 = 42
43968 @end smallexample
43969
43970 @end itemize
43971
43972 @subsection Registers
43973 @cindex <reg>
43974
43975 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
43976
43977 @smallexample
43978 <reg name="@var{name}"
43979 bitsize="@var{size}"
43980 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
43981 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
43982 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
43983 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
43984 @end smallexample
43985
43986 @noindent
43987 The components are as follows:
43988
43989 @table @var
43990
43991 @item name
43992 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
43993
43994 @item bitsize
43995 The register's size, in bits.
43996
43997 @item regnum
43998 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
43999 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
44000 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
44001 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
44002 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
44003 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
44004 in order of increasing register number.
44005
44006 @item save-restore
44007 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
44008 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
44009 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
44010 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
44011 ABI.
44012
44013 @item type
44014 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
44015 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
44016 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
44017 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
44018 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
44019 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
44020
44021 @item group
44022 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
44023 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
44024 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
44025 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
44026 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
44027 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
44028 @code{info registers}.
44029
44030 @end table
44031
44032 @node Predefined Target Types
44033 @section Predefined Target Types
44034 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
44035
44036 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
44037 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
44038 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
44039 types. The currently supported types are:
44040
44041 @table @code
44042
44043 @item bool
44044 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
44045
44046 @item int8
44047 @itemx int16
44048 @itemx int24
44049 @itemx int32
44050 @itemx int64
44051 @itemx int128
44052 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
44053
44054 @item uint8
44055 @itemx uint16
44056 @itemx uint24
44057 @itemx uint32
44058 @itemx uint64
44059 @itemx uint128
44060 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
44061
44062 @item code_ptr
44063 @itemx data_ptr
44064 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
44065 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
44066 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
44067 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
44068 may be marked as data pointers.
44069
44070 @item ieee_single
44071 Single precision IEEE floating point.
44072
44073 @item ieee_double
44074 Double precision IEEE floating point.
44075
44076 @item arm_fpa_ext
44077 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
44078
44079 @item i387_ext
44080 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
44081
44082 @item i386_eflags
44083 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
44084
44085 @item i386_mxcsr
44086 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
44087
44088 @end table
44089
44090 @node Enum Target Types
44091 @section Enum Target Types
44092 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
44093
44094 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
44095 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
44096
44097 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
44098
44099 @smallexample
44100 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
44101 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
44102 @dots{}
44103 </enum>
44104 @end smallexample
44105
44106 Enums must be defined before they are used.
44107
44108 @smallexample
44109 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
44110 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
44111 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
44112 </enum>
44113 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
44114 <field name="X" start="0"/>
44115 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
44116 </flags>
44117 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
44118 @end smallexample
44119
44120 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
44121 would be printed as:
44122
44123 @smallexample
44124 (gdb) info register flags
44125 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
44126 @end smallexample
44127
44128 @node Standard Target Features
44129 @section Standard Target Features
44130 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
44131
44132 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
44133 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
44134 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
44135 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
44136 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
44137 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
44138 can recognize them.
44139
44140 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
44141 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
44142 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
44143 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
44144 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
44145 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
44146 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
44147 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
44148
44149 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
44150 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
44151 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
44152
44153 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
44154 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
44155 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
44156 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
44157
44158 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
44159 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
44160 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
44161
44162 @menu
44163 * AArch64 Features::
44164 * ARC Features::
44165 * ARM Features::
44166 * i386 Features::
44167 * MicroBlaze Features::
44168 * MIPS Features::
44169 * M68K Features::
44170 * NDS32 Features::
44171 * Nios II Features::
44172 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
44173 * PowerPC Features::
44174 * RISC-V Features::
44175 * RX Features::
44176 * S/390 and System z Features::
44177 * Sparc Features::
44178 * TIC6x Features::
44179 @end menu
44180
44181
44182 @node AArch64 Features
44183 @subsection AArch64 Features
44184 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
44185
44186 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
44187 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
44188 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
44189
44190 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
44191 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
44192 and @samp{fpcr}.
44193
44194 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
44195 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
44196 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
44197
44198 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.pauth} feature is optional. If present,
44199 it should contain registers @samp{pauth_dmask} and @samp{pauth_cmask}.
44200
44201 @node ARC Features
44202 @subsection ARC Features
44203 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
44204
44205 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
44206 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
44207 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
44208 that one of the core registers features is present.
44209 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
44210
44211 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
44212 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
44213 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
44214 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
44215 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
44216 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
44217 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
44218
44219 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
44220 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
44221 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
44222 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
44223 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
44224 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
44225
44226 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
44227 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
44228 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
44229 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
44230 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
44231 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
44232 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
44233 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
44234 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
44235 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
44236
44237 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
44238 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
44239
44240 @node ARM Features
44241 @subsection ARM Features
44242 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
44243
44244 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
44245 ARM targets.
44246 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
44247 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
44248
44249 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
44250 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
44251 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
44252 and @samp{xpsr}.
44253
44254 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
44255 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
44256
44257 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
44258 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
44259 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
44260 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
44261
44262 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
44263 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
44264 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
44265 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
44266 halves of the double-precision registers.
44267
44268 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
44269 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
44270 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
44271 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
44272 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
44273 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
44274
44275 @node i386 Features
44276 @subsection i386 Features
44277 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
44278
44279 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
44280 targets. It should describe the following registers:
44281
44282 @itemize @minus
44283 @item
44284 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
44285 @item
44286 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
44287 @item
44288 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
44289 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
44290 @item
44291 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
44292 @item
44293 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
44294 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
44295 @end itemize
44296
44297 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
44298
44299 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
44300 describe registers:
44301
44302 @itemize @minus
44303 @item
44304 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
44305 @item
44306 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
44307 @item
44308 @samp{mxcsr}
44309 @end itemize
44310
44311 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
44312 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
44313 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
44314
44315 @itemize @minus
44316 @item
44317 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
44318 @item
44319 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
44320 @end itemize
44321
44322 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
44323 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
44324
44325 @itemize @minus
44326 @item
44327 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
44328 @item
44329 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
44330 @end itemize
44331
44332 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
44333 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
44334
44335 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
44336 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
44337
44338 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
44339 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
44340 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
44341
44342 @itemize @minus
44343 @item
44344 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
44345 @end itemize
44346
44347 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
44348
44349 @itemize @minus
44350 @item
44351 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
44352 @end itemize
44353
44354 It should
44355 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
44356
44357 @itemize @minus
44358 @item
44359 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
44360 @item
44361 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
44362 @end itemize
44363
44364 It should
44365 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
44366
44367 @itemize @minus
44368 @item
44369 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
44370 @end itemize
44371
44372 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
44373 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
44374 valid for i386 and amd64.
44375
44376 @node MicroBlaze Features
44377 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
44378 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
44379
44380 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
44381 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
44382 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
44383 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
44384 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
44385
44386 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
44387 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
44388
44389 @node MIPS Features
44390 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
44391 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
44392
44393 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
44394 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
44395 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
44396 on the target.
44397
44398 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
44399 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
44400 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44401
44402 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
44403 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
44404 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
44405 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44406
44407 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
44408 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
44409 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
44410 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44411
44412 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
44413 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
44414 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
44415
44416 @node M68K Features
44417 @subsection M68K Features
44418 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
44419
44420 @table @code
44421 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
44422 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
44423 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
44424 One of those features must be always present.
44425 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
44426 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
44427 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
44428 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
44429
44430 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
44431 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
44432 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
44433 @samp{fpiaddr}.
44434 @end table
44435
44436 @node NDS32 Features
44437 @subsection NDS32 Features
44438 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
44439
44440 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
44441 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
44442 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
44443 and @samp{pc}.
44444
44445 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
44446 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
44447 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
44448 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
44449
44450 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
44451 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
44452 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
44453 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
44454 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
44455 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
44456 support to it could be totally removed some day.
44457
44458 @node Nios II Features
44459 @subsection Nios II Features
44460 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
44461
44462 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
44463 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
44464 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
44465 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
44466 @samp{mpuacc}).
44467
44468 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
44469 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
44470 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
44471
44472 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
44473 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
44474 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
44475
44476 @node PowerPC Features
44477 @subsection PowerPC Features
44478 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
44479
44480 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
44481 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
44482 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
44483 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44484
44485 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
44486 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
44487
44488 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
44489 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr}, and
44490 @samp{vrsave}. @value{GDBN} will define pseudo-registers @samp{v0}
44491 through @samp{v31} as aliases for the corresponding @samp{vrX}
44492 registers.
44493
44494 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
44495 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN} will
44496 combine these registers with the floating point registers (@samp{f0}
44497 through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0} through
44498 @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0} through
44499 @samp{vs63}, the set of vector-scalar registers for POWER7.
44500 Therefore, this feature requires both @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} and
44501 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec}.
44502
44503 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
44504 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
44505 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
44506 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
44507 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
44508 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
44509 user.
44510
44511 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ppr} feature is optional. It should
44512 contain the 64-bit register @samp{ppr}.
44513
44514 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.dscr} feature is optional. It should
44515 contain the 64-bit register @samp{dscr}.
44516
44517 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.tar} feature is optional. It should
44518 contain the 64-bit register @samp{tar}.
44519
44520 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.ebb} feature is optional. It should
44521 contain registers @samp{bescr}, @samp{ebbhr} and @samp{ebbrr}, all
44522 64-bit wide.
44523
44524 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.linux.pmu} feature is optional. It should
44525 contain registers @samp{mmcr0}, @samp{mmcr2}, @samp{siar}, @samp{sdar}
44526 and @samp{sier}, all 64-bit wide. This is the subset of the isa 2.07
44527 server PMU registers provided by @sc{gnu}/Linux.
44528
44529 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.spr} feature is optional. It should
44530 contain registers @samp{tfhar}, @samp{texasr} and @samp{tfiar}, all
44531 64-bit wide.
44532
44533 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.core} feature is optional. It should
44534 contain the checkpointed general-purpose registers @samp{cr0} through
44535 @samp{cr31}, as well as the checkpointed registers @samp{clr} and
44536 @samp{cctr}. These registers may all be either 32-bit or 64-bit
44537 depending on the target. It should also contain the checkpointed
44538 registers @samp{ccr} and @samp{cxer}, which should both be 32-bit
44539 wide.
44540
44541 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu} feature is optional. It should
44542 contain the checkpointed 64-bit floating-point registers @samp{cf0}
44543 through @samp{cf31}, as well as the checkpointed 64-bit register
44544 @samp{cfpscr}.
44545
44546 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} feature is optional. It
44547 should contain the checkpointed altivec registers @samp{cvr0} through
44548 @samp{cvr31}, all 128-bit wide. It should also contain the
44549 checkpointed registers @samp{cvscr} and @samp{cvrsave}, both 32-bit
44550 wide.
44551
44552 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.vsx} feature is optional. It should
44553 contain registers @samp{cvs0h} through @samp{cvs31h}. @value{GDBN}
44554 will combine these registers with the checkpointed floating point
44555 registers (@samp{cf0} through @samp{cf31}) and the checkpointed
44556 altivec registers (@samp{cvr0} through @samp{cvr31}) to present the
44557 128-bit wide checkpointed vector-scalar registers @samp{cvs0} through
44558 @samp{cvs63}. Therefore, this feature requires both
44559 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.altivec} and
44560 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.fpu}.
44561
44562 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.ppr} feature is optional. It should
44563 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cppr}.
44564
44565 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.dscr} feature is optional. It should
44566 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{cdscr}.
44567
44568 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.htm.tar} feature is optional. It should
44569 contain the 64-bit checkpointed register @samp{ctar}.
44570
44571
44572 @node RISC-V Features
44573 @subsection RISC-V Features
44574 @cindex target descriptions, RISC-V Features
44575
44576 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.cpu} feature is required for RISC-V
44577 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{x0} through
44578 @samp{x31}, and @samp{pc}. Either the architectural names (@samp{x0},
44579 @samp{x1}, etc) can be used, or the ABI names (@samp{zero}, @samp{ra},
44580 etc).
44581
44582 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.fpu} feature is optional. If present, it
44583 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fflags},
44584 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr}. As with the cpu feature, either the
44585 architectural register names, or the ABI names can be used.
44586
44587 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.virtual} feature is optional. If present,
44588 it should contain registers that are not backed by real registers on
44589 the target, but are instead virtual, where the register value is
44590 derived from other target state. In many ways these are like
44591 @value{GDBN}s pseudo-registers, except implemented by the target.
44592 Currently the only register expected in this set is the one byte
44593 @samp{priv} register that contains the target's privilege level in the
44594 least significant two bits.
44595
44596 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.riscv.csr} feature is optional. If present, it
44597 should contain all of the target's standard CSRs. Standard CSRs are
44598 those defined in the RISC-V specification documents. There is some
44599 overlap between this feature and the fpu feature; the @samp{fflags},
44600 @samp{frm}, and @samp{fcsr} registers could be in either feature. The
44601 expectation is that these registers will be in the fpu feature if the
44602 target has floating point hardware, but can be moved into the csr
44603 feature if the target has the floating point control registers, but no
44604 other floating point hardware.
44605
44606 @node RX Features
44607 @subsection RX Features
44608 @cindex target descriptions, RX Features
44609
44610 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.rx.core} feature is required for RX
44611 targets. It should contain the registers @samp{r0} through
44612 @samp{r15}, @samp{usp}, @samp{isp}, @samp{psw}, @samp{pc}, @samp{intb},
44613 @samp{bpsw}, @samp{bpc}, @samp{fintv}, @samp{fpsw}, and @samp{acc}.
44614
44615 @node S/390 and System z Features
44616 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
44617 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
44618 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
44619
44620 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
44621 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
44622 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
44623 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
44624 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
44625 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
44626 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
44627 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
44628 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
44629
44630 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
44631 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
44632 @samp{fpc}.
44633
44634 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
44635 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
44636
44637 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
44638 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
44639 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
44640 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
44641 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
44642 32-bit wide.
44643
44644 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
44645 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
44646 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
44647
44648 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
44649 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
44650 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
44651 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
44652 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
44653 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
44654 @samp{v31}.
44655
44656 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
44657 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
44658 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
44659
44660 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
44661 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
44662 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
44663
44664 @node Sparc Features
44665 @subsection Sparc Features
44666 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
44667 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
44668 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
44669 targets. It should describe the following registers:
44670
44671 @itemize @minus
44672 @item
44673 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
44674 @item
44675 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
44676 @item
44677 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
44678 @item
44679 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
44680 @end itemize
44681
44682 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
44683
44684 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
44685 targets. It should describe the following registers:
44686
44687 @itemize @minus
44688 @item
44689 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
44690 @item
44691 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
44692 @end itemize
44693
44694 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
44695 targets. It should describe the following registers:
44696
44697 @itemize @minus
44698 @item
44699 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
44700 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
44701 @item
44702 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
44703 for sparc64
44704 @end itemize
44705
44706 @node TIC6x Features
44707 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
44708 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
44709 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
44710 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
44711 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
44712 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
44713
44714 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
44715 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
44716 through @samp{B31}.
44717
44718 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
44719 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
44720
44721 @node Operating System Information
44722 @appendix Operating System Information
44723 @cindex operating system information
44724
44725 @menu
44726 * Process list::
44727 @end menu
44728
44729 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
44730 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
44731 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
44732 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
44733 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
44734 on a different aspect of target.
44735
44736 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
44737 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
44738 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
44739 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
44740
44741 @node Process list
44742 @appendixsection Process list
44743 @cindex operating system information, process list
44744
44745 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
44746 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
44747 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
44748 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
44749
44750 An example document is:
44751
44752 @smallexample
44753 <?xml version="1.0"?>
44754 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
44755 <osdata type="processes">
44756 <item>
44757 <column name="pid">1</column>
44758 <column name="user">root</column>
44759 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
44760 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
44761 </item>
44762 </osdata>
44763 @end smallexample
44764
44765 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
44766 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
44767 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
44768 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
44769 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
44770 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
44771 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
44772
44773 @node Trace File Format
44774 @appendix Trace File Format
44775 @cindex trace file format
44776
44777 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
44778 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
44779
44780 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
44781 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
44782 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
44783 in the future.
44784
44785 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
44786 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
44787 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
44788 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
44789 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
44790 of this section.
44791
44792 @table @code
44793 @item R @var{size}
44794 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
44795 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
44796 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
44797 a single trace file.
44798
44799 @item status @var{status}
44800 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
44801 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
44802 file.
44803
44804 @item tp @var{payload}
44805 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
44806 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
44807 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
44808 reply packets.
44809
44810 @item tsv @var{payload}
44811 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
44812 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
44813 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
44814 reply packets.
44815
44816 @item tdesc @var{payload}
44817 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
44818 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
44819 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
44820 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
44821 file. Includes are not allowed.
44822
44823 @end table
44824
44825 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
44826 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
44827 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
44828 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
44829 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
44830 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
44831 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
44832 endianness.
44833
44834 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
44835
44836 @table @code
44837 @item R @var{bytes}
44838 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
44839 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
44840 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
44841
44842 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
44843 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
44844 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
44845 @var{length} bytes.
44846
44847 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
44848 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
44849 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
44850
44851 @end table
44852
44853 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
44854 of blocks.
44855
44856 @node Index Section Format
44857 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
44858 @cindex .gdb_index section format
44859 @cindex index section format
44860
44861 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
44862 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
44863 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
44864 description.
44865
44866 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
44867 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
44868 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
44869 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
44870 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
44871 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
44872
44873 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
44874
44875 @enumerate
44876 @item
44877 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
44878 unless otherwise noted:
44879
44880 @enumerate
44881 @item
44882 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
44883 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
44884 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
44885 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
44886 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
44887 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
44888 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
44889
44890 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
44891 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
44892 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
44893 currently not flagged as deprecated.
44894
44895 @item
44896 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
44897
44898 @item
44899 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
44900 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
44901 to the next offset.
44902
44903 @item
44904 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
44905
44906 @item
44907 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
44908
44909 @item
44910 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
44911 @end enumerate
44912
44913 @item
44914 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
44915 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
44916 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
44917 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
44918 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
44919 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
44920 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
44921 CU indices.
44922
44923 @item
44924 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
44925 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
44926 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
44927 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
44928
44929 @item
44930 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
44931 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
44932
44933 @enumerate
44934 @item
44935 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
44936
44937 @item
44938 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
44939 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
44940
44941 @item
44942 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
44943 @end enumerate
44944
44945 @item
44946 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
44947 the hash table is always a power of 2.
44948
44949 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
44950 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
44951 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
44952 constant pool.
44953
44954 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
44955 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
44956 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
44957
44958 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
44959 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
44960 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
44961 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
44962 index version:
44963
44964 @table @asis
44965 @item Version 4
44966 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
44967
44968 @item Versions 5 to 7
44969 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
44970 @end table
44971
44972 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
44973
44974 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
44975 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
44976 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
44977 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
44978 collision.
44979
44980 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
44981 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
44982 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
44983 the code.
44984
44985 @item
44986 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
44987 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
44988 strings.
44989
44990 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
44991 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
44992 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
44993 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
44994 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
44995 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
44996
44997 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
44998 @end enumerate
44999
45000 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
45001 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
45002 CU index+attributes value for each use.
45003
45004 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
45005 (bit 0 = LSB):
45006
45007 @table @asis
45008
45009 @item Bits 0-23
45010 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
45011 @item Bits 24-27
45012 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
45013 @item Bits 28-30
45014 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
45015
45016 @table @asis
45017 @item 0
45018 This value is reserved and should not be used.
45019 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
45020 with previous versions of the index.
45021 @item 1
45022 The symbol is a type.
45023 @item 2
45024 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
45025 @item 3
45026 The symbol is a function.
45027 @item 4
45028 Any other kind of symbol.
45029 @item 5,6,7
45030 These values are reserved.
45031 @end table
45032
45033 @item Bit 31
45034 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
45035
45036 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
45037 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
45038 @value{GDBN} sources.
45039
45040 @end table
45041
45042 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
45043 global/static attributes in the index.
45044
45045 @smallexample
45046 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
45047 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
45048 switch (die->tag)
45049 @{
45050 case DW_TAG_typedef:
45051 case DW_TAG_base_type:
45052 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
45053 kind = TYPE;
45054 is_static = 1;
45055 break;
45056 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
45057 kind = VARIABLE;
45058 is_static = language != CPLUS;
45059 break;
45060 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
45061 kind = FUNCTION;
45062 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
45063 break;
45064 case DW_TAG_constant:
45065 kind = VARIABLE;
45066 is_static = ! is_external;
45067 break;
45068 case DW_TAG_variable:
45069 kind = VARIABLE;
45070 is_static = ! is_external;
45071 break;
45072 case DW_TAG_namespace:
45073 kind = TYPE;
45074 is_static = 0;
45075 break;
45076 case DW_TAG_class_type:
45077 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
45078 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
45079 case DW_TAG_union_type:
45080 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
45081 kind = TYPE;
45082 is_static = language != CPLUS;
45083 break;
45084 default:
45085 assert (0);
45086 @}
45087 @end smallexample
45088
45089 @node Man Pages
45090 @appendix Manual pages
45091 @cindex Man pages
45092
45093 @menu
45094 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
45095 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
45096 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
45097 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
45098 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
45099 @end menu
45100
45101 @node gdb man
45102 @heading gdb man
45103
45104 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
45105
45106 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
45107 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
45108 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
45109 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
45110 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
45111 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
45112 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
45113 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
45114 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
45115 @c man end
45116
45117 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
45118 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
45119 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
45120 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
45121
45122 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
45123 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
45124
45125 @itemize @bullet
45126 @item
45127 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
45128
45129 @item
45130 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
45131
45132 @item
45133 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
45134
45135 @item
45136 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
45137 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
45138 @end itemize
45139
45140 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
45141 Modula-2.
45142
45143 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
45144 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
45145 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
45146 by using the command @code{help}.
45147
45148 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
45149 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
45150 executable program as the argument:
45151
45152 @smallexample
45153 gdb program
45154 @end smallexample
45155
45156 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
45157
45158 @smallexample
45159 gdb program core
45160 @end smallexample
45161
45162 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument or use option
45163 @code{-p}, if you want to debug a running process:
45164
45165 @smallexample
45166 gdb program 1234
45167 gdb -p 1234
45168 @end smallexample
45169
45170 @noindent
45171 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234}. With option @option{-p} you
45172 can omit the @var{program} filename.
45173
45174 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
45175
45176 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
45177 @table @env
45178 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
45179 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
45180
45181 @item run [@var{arglist}]
45182 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
45183
45184 @item bt
45185 Backtrace: display the program stack.
45186
45187 @item print @var{expr}
45188 Display the value of an expression.
45189
45190 @item c
45191 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
45192
45193 @item next
45194 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
45195 function calls in the line.
45196
45197 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
45198 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
45199
45200 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
45201 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
45202
45203 @item step
45204 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
45205 function calls in the line.
45206
45207 @item help [@var{name}]
45208 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
45209 about using @value{GDBN}.
45210
45211 @item quit
45212 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
45213 @end table
45214
45215 @ifset man
45216 For full details on @value{GDBN},
45217 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45218 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
45219 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
45220 @end ifset
45221 @c man end
45222
45223 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
45224 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
45225 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
45226 encountered with no
45227 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
45228 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
45229 Many options have
45230 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
45231 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
45232 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
45233 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
45234 more usual convention.)
45235
45236 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
45237 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
45238 option is used.
45239
45240 @table @env
45241 @item -help
45242 @itemx -h
45243 List all options, with brief explanations.
45244
45245 @item -symbols=@var{file}
45246 @itemx -s @var{file}
45247 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
45248
45249 @item -write
45250 Enable writing into executable and core files.
45251
45252 @item -exec=@var{file}
45253 @itemx -e @var{file}
45254 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
45255 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
45256 dump.
45257
45258 @item -se=@var{file}
45259 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
45260 file.
45261
45262 @item -core=@var{file}
45263 @itemx -c @var{file}
45264 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
45265
45266 @item -command=@var{file}
45267 @itemx -x @var{file}
45268 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
45269
45270 @item -ex @var{command}
45271 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
45272
45273 @item -directory=@var{directory}
45274 @itemx -d @var{directory}
45275 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
45276
45277 @item -nh
45278 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
45279
45280 @item -nx
45281 @itemx -n
45282 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
45283
45284 @item -quiet
45285 @itemx -q
45286 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
45287 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
45288
45289 @item -batch
45290 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
45291 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
45292 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
45293 commands in the command files.
45294
45295 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
45296 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
45297 more useful, the message
45298
45299 @smallexample
45300 Program exited normally.
45301 @end smallexample
45302
45303 @noindent
45304 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
45305 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
45306
45307 @item -cd=@var{directory}
45308 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
45309 instead of the current directory.
45310
45311 @item -fullname
45312 @itemx -f
45313 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
45314 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
45315 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
45316 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
45317 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
45318 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
45319 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
45320 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
45321
45322 @item -b @var{bps}
45323 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
45324 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
45325
45326 @item -tty=@var{device}
45327 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
45328 @end table
45329 @c man end
45330
45331 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
45332 @ifset man
45333 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45334 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45335 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45336
45337 @smallexample
45338 info gdb
45339 @end smallexample
45340
45341 @noindent
45342 should give you access to the complete manual.
45343
45344 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45345 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45346 @end ifset
45347 @c man end
45348
45349 @node gdbserver man
45350 @heading gdbserver man
45351
45352 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
45353 @format
45354 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
45355 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
45356
45357 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
45358
45359 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
45360 @c man end
45361 @end format
45362
45363 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
45364 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
45365 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
45366
45367 @ifclear man
45368 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
45369 @end ifclear
45370 @ifset man
45371 Usage (server (target) side):
45372 @end ifset
45373
45374 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
45375 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
45376 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
45377 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
45378
45379 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
45380 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
45381 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
45382
45383 @smallexample
45384 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
45385 @end smallexample
45386
45387 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
45388
45389 @smallexample
45390 @ifset man
45391 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
45392 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
45393 @end ifset
45394 @ifclear man
45395 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
45396 @end ifclear
45397 @end smallexample
45398
45399 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
45400 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
45401 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
45402
45403 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
45404
45405 @smallexample
45406 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
45407 @end smallexample
45408
45409 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
45410 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
45411 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
45412 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
45413 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
45414 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
45415 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
45416 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
45417 print an error message and exit.
45418
45419 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
45420 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
45421
45422 @smallexample
45423 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
45424 @end smallexample
45425
45426 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
45427 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
45428
45429 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
45430 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
45431 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
45432 the program you want to debug.
45433
45434 @smallexample
45435 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
45436 @end smallexample
45437
45438 @ifclear man
45439 @subheading Usage (host side)
45440 @end ifclear
45441 @ifset man
45442 Usage (host side):
45443 @end ifset
45444
45445 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
45446 @value{GDBN} needs to examine its symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
45447 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
45448 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
45449 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
45450 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
45451 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
45452 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
45453 descriptor. For example:
45454
45455 @smallexample
45456 @ifset man
45457 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
45458 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
45459 @end ifset
45460 @ifclear man
45461 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
45462 @end ifclear
45463 @end smallexample
45464
45465 @noindent
45466 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
45467
45468 @smallexample
45469 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
45470 @end smallexample
45471
45472 @noindent
45473 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
45474 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
45475 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
45476 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
45477 `Connection refused'.
45478
45479 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
45480 described in
45481 @ifset man
45482 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
45483 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
45484 @end ifset
45485 @ifclear man
45486 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
45487 @end ifclear
45488 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
45489
45490 @smallexample
45491 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
45492 @end smallexample
45493
45494 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
45495 case.
45496 @c man end
45497
45498 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
45499 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
45500
45501 @itemize @bullet
45502
45503 @item
45504 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
45505
45506 @smallexample
45507 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
45508 @end smallexample
45509
45510 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
45511 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
45512 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
45513 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
45514 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
45515 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
45516 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
45517
45518 @item
45519 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
45520 program:
45521
45522 @smallexample
45523 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
45524 @end smallexample
45525
45526 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
45527 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
45528 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
45529 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
45530
45531 @item
45532 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
45533
45534 @smallexample
45535 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
45536 @end smallexample
45537
45538 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
45539 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
45540 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
45541 debug several processes in the same session.
45542 @end itemize
45543
45544 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
45545
45546 @table @env
45547
45548 @item --help
45549 List all options, with brief explanations.
45550
45551 @item --version
45552 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
45553
45554 @item --attach
45555 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
45556
45557 @smallexample
45558 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
45559 @end smallexample
45560
45561 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
45562 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
45563
45564 @item --multi
45565 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
45566 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
45567 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
45568 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
45569
45570 @smallexample
45571 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
45572 @end smallexample
45573
45574 @item --debug
45575 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
45576 process.
45577 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
45578 the developers.
45579
45580 @item --remote-debug
45581 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
45582 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
45583 the developers.
45584
45585 @item --debug-file=@var{filename}
45586 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to send any debug output to the given @var{filename}.
45587 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
45588 the developers.
45589
45590 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
45591 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
45592 of debugging output.
45593 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
45594
45595 @item --wrapper
45596 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
45597 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
45598 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
45599 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
45600
45601 @item --once
45602 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
45603 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
45604 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
45605 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
45606
45607 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
45608
45609 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
45610 @c QDisableRandomization.
45611
45612 @end table
45613 @c man end
45614
45615 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
45616 @ifset man
45617 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45618 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45619 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45620
45621 @smallexample
45622 info gdb
45623 @end smallexample
45624
45625 should give you access to the complete manual.
45626
45627 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45628 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45629 @end ifset
45630 @c man end
45631
45632 @node gcore man
45633 @heading gcore
45634
45635 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
45636
45637 @format
45638 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
45639 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
45640 @c man end
45641 @end format
45642
45643 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
45644 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
45645 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
45646 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
45647 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
45648 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
45649 its job the program remains running without any change.
45650 @c man end
45651
45652 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
45653 @table @env
45654 @item -a
45655 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
45656 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
45657 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
45658 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
45659 dump-excluded-mappings}).
45660
45661 @item -o @var{prefix}
45662 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
45663 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
45664 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
45665 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
45666 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
45667 @end table
45668 @c man end
45669
45670 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
45671 @ifset man
45672 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45673 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45674 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45675
45676 @smallexample
45677 info gdb
45678 @end smallexample
45679
45680 @noindent
45681 should give you access to the complete manual.
45682
45683 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45684 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45685 @end ifset
45686 @c man end
45687
45688 @node gdbinit man
45689 @heading gdbinit
45690
45691 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
45692
45693 @format
45694 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
45695 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
45696 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
45697 @end ifset
45698
45699 ~/.gdbinit
45700
45701 ./.gdbinit
45702 @c man end
45703 @end format
45704
45705 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
45706 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
45707 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
45708 described in
45709 @ifset man
45710 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
45711 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
45712 @end ifset
45713 @ifclear man
45714 @ref{Sequences}.
45715 @end ifclear
45716
45717 Please read more in
45718 @ifset man
45719 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
45720 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
45721 @end ifset
45722 @ifclear man
45723 @ref{Startup}.
45724 @end ifclear
45725
45726 @table @env
45727 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
45728 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
45729 @end ifset
45730 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
45731 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
45732 @end ifclear
45733 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
45734 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
45735 See more in
45736 @ifset man
45737 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
45738 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
45739 @end ifset
45740 @ifclear man
45741 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
45742 @end ifclear
45743
45744 @item ~/.gdbinit
45745 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
45746 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
45747
45748 @item ./.gdbinit
45749 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
45750 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
45751 See more in
45752 @ifset man
45753 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
45754 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
45755 @end ifset
45756 @ifclear man
45757 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
45758 @end ifclear
45759 @end table
45760 @c man end
45761
45762 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
45763 @ifset man
45764 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
45765
45766 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45767 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45768 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45769
45770 @smallexample
45771 info gdb
45772 @end smallexample
45773
45774 should give you access to the complete manual.
45775
45776 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45777 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45778 @end ifset
45779 @c man end
45780
45781 @node gdb-add-index man
45782 @heading gdb-add-index
45783 @pindex gdb-add-index
45784 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
45785
45786 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
45787
45788 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
45789 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
45790 @c man end
45791
45792 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
45793 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
45794 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
45795 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
45796 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
45797 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
45798
45799 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
45800 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
45801 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
45802 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
45803 named @code{.debug_*}).
45804
45805 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
45806 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
45807 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
45808 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
45809
45810 See more in
45811 @ifset man
45812 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
45813 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
45814 @end ifset
45815 @ifclear man
45816 @ref{Index Files}.
45817 @end ifclear
45818 @c man end
45819
45820 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
45821 @ifset man
45822 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
45823 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
45824 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
45825
45826 @smallexample
45827 info gdb
45828 @end smallexample
45829
45830 should give you access to the complete manual.
45831
45832 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
45833 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
45834 @end ifset
45835 @c man end
45836
45837 @include gpl.texi
45838
45839 @node GNU Free Documentation License
45840 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
45841 @include fdl.texi
45842
45843 @node Concept Index
45844 @unnumbered Concept Index
45845
45846 @printindex cp
45847
45848 @node Command and Variable Index
45849 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
45850
45851 @printindex fn
45852
45853 @tex
45854 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
45855 % meantime:
45856 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
45857 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
45858 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
45859 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
45860 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
45861 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
45862 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
45863 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
45864 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
45865 \page\colophon
45866 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
45867 @end tex
45868
45869 @bye
This page took 1.936061 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.